53 0 22MB
I
IN DENTAL ESTHETICS CLINICAL AND LABORATORY PROCEDURES
ISBN 88-7492-011-3
€ 220,00
9 788874 920112
PRECISION IN DENTAL ESTHETICS 'fhi.. hook j, dedirall'd to 111� ..plt·ndid daugl11er. Sarah." ho ha., tnadl' 111� lifl' nH·aniugful. and to 111� part'llh.
\
!0
CLINICAL AND LABORATORY PROCEDURES
an• n·,polhihlt· fur all th:11 j., �ood in IIH'.
IJoiiU'IIiro .lla.'.iiroui
T'hi, l,ook
j,
dedicmed to 111� l':llnil�. tl w �OIIIT(' of lo\f' and hapl'illt'"' tlwt
gi\t·� IIH' rru•r-� and ,('fllrit� in all tiling.. /(omNJ
DOMENICO MASSIRONI, MD, DMD
Pust·rllfl
Private Practice, Milan, Italy 'Thi .. hook j, d(·dirml'd to all 111� dt·are,l. wond('rful frit·rHI ..-111� part'lth. inrluding my fath('r. Sih io. ''Ito left 11, all too ,ooiL uncl111� n1olitt·r. Ho ..alha. "ho j., happy for nw wda�. and 111� cltildren. Chri ..tian nnd Cahrit·li·. '' ho hring j o� to 111� lifl'. To thi, li.t I arid m� hr1hrr. Bol,eno. and 111� �Iarina. who are nnill'd
Gillsl•ppe
Jloltii'O
\
id1
lh
\,� llu· I-896. 8.
oral camera and operating microscope for the detection
17. Sheets CG, Paquette IM. Hatate K. The clinical micro·
precision dentistry. Compend Conlin Educ Dent 1999;
scope in an esthetic restorative practice. J Esthet Restor
9· Michaelides PL. USe of the operating microscope in dentistry. I calif Dent Assoc 1996;24:45-50.
25. Sheets CG, Paquette IM. Practical applications of the
for teaching histology. I Dent Educ 1984;48:566-567.
clinical microscope in a restorative dental practice. Com·
20. Khayat BG. The use or magnification in endodontic therapy. The operating microscope. Pract Periodontics Aesthet Dent 1998;10:137-144·
In: Hardin I (ed). Clark's Clinical Dentistry, vol 4- St Louis: Mosby, 1998:1-14.
ment or Strabismus, ed 3 · St Louis: Mosby, 1985. 27. Zoz Nl, Kuznetsov luA. Some health aspects of vision during work with microscopes (in Russian]. Gig Tr Prof
22. Arens DE. Introduction to magniication in endodontics.
Zabol 1972;16:5-9. 28. Richards W. Instrument myopia-Microscopy. Am I
Esthet Restor Dent 2003;15:426-439.
23. Sempira HN, Hatwell GR. Frequency or second mesio· buccal canals in maxillary molars as determined by use of an operating microscope: A clinical study.
Burian MM, von Noorden GC. Burian-von Noorden's Binocular Vision and Ocular Motility: Theory and anage
21. Carr GB. Magnification and illumination in endodontics.
1
pend Contin Educ Dent 2000;21:1084-1090. 26.
I
Endod
2000;26:673674·
Optom Physiol Opt 1976;53:658663. 29. Friedman MI. Landesman HM. Microscope-assisted pre cision (MAP) dentistry. A challenge for new knowledge. I (ali[ Dent Assoc 1998;26:90-905.
24. Pecora G, Andreana S. Use of dental operating micro· scopes in endodontic surgery. Oral Surg Oral ed Oral Pathol 1993;75:751-759.
667671.
Friedman M, ora AF, Schmidt R. Microscope-assisted
20:723-7)6.
19. Powell GL, Stevens W. The use of conference microscopes
Dent 2001;1):187-200. 18. Winter RR, Cornell OF, Vingoren Gl, Patrick RB. Use of magnification in dental technology. I Esthet Restor Dent 2003;15:409-415;discussion 416.
2
3
CHAPTER 2 Magnification Systems Used in Dentistry
R E F E R E N CES
10. Erten H, Uctasli MB, Akarslan U, Uzun 0, Baspinar E. The assessment of unaided visual examination, intra·
1. Weathers A K . Access to success: Taking a closer look a t magnification. Dent Today 2005;24:to6, 108-111. 2. van As G. Magnification and the alternatives for micro· dentistry. Compend Contm Educ Dent 2001;22:10o8tOt2, 1014-1016. ). Garcia A. Dental magniication: A clear view of the pres· ent and a close-up view of the future. Compend Cantin Educ Dent 205;26:459-463. 4· Caplan SA. agniication in dentistry. I Esthet Dent
1990;2:17-21. 5 · Shanelec DA. Optical principles of loupes. I Calif Dent Assoc 1992;20:25-32. 6. Millar Bl. Focus on loupes. Br Dent I 1998;185:504-508. 7. Zaugg B. Stassinakis A. Holl P. lnnuence or magnifica
or occlusal caries lesions. Oper Dent 2005;30:t9cr194· 11. Behle C. Photography and the operating microscope in dentistry. I (ali[ Dent Assoc 2001;29:765-771. 12. Tibbetts LS, Shanelec DA. An overview of periodontal microsurgery. Curr Opin Periodontal 1994:187-193. 13. Shanelec OA, Tibbetts LS. A perspective on the future of periodontal microsurgery. Periodontal 2000 1996;11: 58-64. 14. Cortellini P. Tonetti MS. Microsurgical approach to peri· odontal regeneration. Initial evaluation in a case report. 1 Periodontal 2001;4:559-569.
15. Tibbetts LS, Shanelec DA. Periodontal microsurgery. Dent Clin North Am 1998;42:339-359.
tion tools on the recognition of simulated preparation
16. Whitehead SA. Wilson NH. Restorative decision-making
and filling errors (in German� Schweiz Monatsschr
behavior with magnification. Quintessence tnt 1992;23:
Zahnmed 2004; 114:89>-896. 8.
oral camera and operating microscope for the detection
17. Sheets CG, Paquette IM. Hatate K. The clinical micro·
precision dentistry. Compend Conlin Educ Dent 1999;
scope in an esthetic restorative practice. J Esthet Restor
9· Michaelides PL. USe of the operating microscope in dentistry. I calif Dent Assoc 1996;24:45-50.
25. Sheets CG, Paquette IM. Practical applications of the
for teaching histology. I Dent Educ 1984;48:566-567.
clinical microscope in a restorative dental practice. Com·
20. Khayat BG. The use or magnification in endodontic therapy. The operating microscope. Pract Periodontics Aesthet Dent 1998;10:137-144·
In: Hardin I (ed). Clark's Clinical Dentistry, vol 4- St Louis: Mosby, 1998:1-14.
ment or Strabismus, ed 3 · St Louis: Mosby, 1985. 27. Zoz Nl, Kuznetsov luA. Some health aspects of vision during work with microscopes (in Russian]. Gig Tr Prof
22. Arens DE. Introduction to magniication in endodontics.
Zabol 1972;16:5-9. 28. Richards W. Instrument myopia-Microscopy. Am I
Esthet Restor Dent 2003;15:426-439.
23. Sempira HN, Hatwell GR. Frequency or second mesio· buccal canals in maxillary molars as determined by use of an operating microscope: A clinical study.
Burian MM, von Noorden GC. Burian-von Noorden's Binocular Vision and Ocular Motility: Theory and anage
21. Carr GB. Magnification and illumination in endodontics.
1
pend Contin Educ Dent 2000;21:1084-1090. 26.
I
Endod
2000;26:673674·
Optom Physiol Opt 1976;53:658663. 29. Friedman MI. Landesman HM. Microscope-assisted pre cision (MAP) dentistry. A challenge for new knowledge. I (ali[ Dent Assoc 1998;26:90-905.
24. Pecora G, Andreana S. Use of dental operating micro· scopes in endodontic surgery. Oral Surg Oral ed Oral Pathol 1993;75:751-759.
667671.
Friedman M, ora AF, Schmidt R. Microscope-assisted
20:723-7)6.
19. Powell GL, Stevens W. The use of conference microscopes
Dent 2001;1):187-200. 18. Winter RR, Cornell OF, Vingoren Gl, Patrick RB. Use of magnification in dental technology. I Esthet Restor Dent 2003;15:409-415;discussion 416.
2
3
C H A P T E R
3
T O O T H P RE PARAT I O N C O M P L E TE C R O W N S
F OR
A X I A L . ANATO M I C L I M ITS Prosthetic restoration involves a number of proce
4
O C C L U S A L .
A N D
G I N G I V A L
L I M I T S
Devitalization of the tooth for this purpose is con sidered overtreatment. 1
With respect to the occlusal limit, proper reduc·
dures designed to integrate the restoration in the
tion of the occlusal or palatal surface of the tooth
patient's mouth in keeping with functional, esthetic,
should not exceed limits of minimum tooth structure
and anatomic concerns. Tooth preparation is an es
or adversely affect the masticatory function. This
sential pat of this process. The success of this pro
limit depends on the relation of the pulp chamber to
cedure requires optimal use of various materials for
the occlusal surface during reduction, and it some
impressions, restoration, and adhesion, exploiting
times conflicts with the goal of achieving ideal thick
certain properties and minimizing others. Preparation
ness for a ceramic or metal-ceramic prosthesis. One
requires controlled reduction of tooth form and vol
of the most common errors committed during tooth
ume (Figs 3-1 to 3-3). Too much or too little thick
preparation is insufficient reduction of the occlusal
ness or depth can initiate a series of imprecisions
surface of prepared teeth (molars and premolars).
and errors that jeopardize the success of the
particularly in the middle third of canines and in the
restoration. The clinician must be reasonably dex
palatal area of incisors.
terous and, above all, have a clear vision of how to
In a study of 25 canines prepared for restoration,
proceed with the tooth reduction while keeping in
Zanetti et al' found the reduction too shallow in
mind the three fundamental anatomic limits: axial,
Bs% of the cases, excessive in 15% of the cases,
occlusal, and gingivaL
and of average correct depth in only 10% of the
The term axial limit refers to the consideration of
cases. For 25% of the cases, the reduction did not
pulpal vitality. It is now widely accepted that reduc
even reach a depth of o.s mm, a serious error for
ing a tooth for prosthetic purposes is compatible
the longevity of the definitive restoration. To avoid
with the integrity and health of the dental pulp.
th i s problem when preparing the palatal area of
Fig 3-1 S i l i cone index positioned over a model of a maxillary central incisor. The longitudinally sectioned silicone index clearly illustrates the necessary reduction for a ceramic or ceramometal restoration. Use of a silicone index allows the clinician to define the proportions and dimensions of the prosthetic tooth before beginning reduction to ensure the proper integration of the restoration.
Figs 3-2 and 3-3 Examples of preparations with controlled reduction. The clinician can measure reduction with the diameter size of the b u rs to preserve the overall shape of the prepared tooth and provide the necessary space for the restorative materiaL
_
Ftg 3-4 When the shape of the reduction tool impedes accurate measurement of the amount of tissue removed. a clinician may prepare the tooth one half at a lime. as recommended by Mclean.3 Figs 3-5 and 3-6 Tooth extracted with periodontal tissue and sectioned using a microtome. The periodontal tissue. with its delicate structure. must always be treated carefully during preparation and the positioning of the finish line.
S
C H A P T E R
3
T O O T H P RE PARAT I O N C O M P L E TE C R O W N S
F OR
A X I A L . ANATO M I C L I M ITS Prosthetic restoration involves a number of proce
4
O C C L U S A L .
A N D
G I N G I V A L
L I M I T S
Devitalization of the tooth for this purpose is con sidered overtreatment. 1
With respect to the occlusal limit, proper reduc·
dures designed to integrate the restoration in the
tion of the occlusal or palatal surface of the tooth
patient's mouth in keeping with functional, esthetic,
should not exceed limits of minimum tooth structure
and anatomic concerns. Tooth preparation is an es
or adversely affect the masticatory function. This
sential pat of this process. The success of this pro
limit depends on the relation of the pulp chamber to
cedure requires optimal use of various materials for
the occlusal surface during reduction, and it some
impressions, restoration, and adhesion, exploiting
times conflicts with the goal of achieving ideal thick
certain properties and minimizing others. Preparation
ness for a ceramic or metal-ceramic prosthesis. One
requires controlled reduction of tooth form and vol
of the most common errors committed during tooth
ume (Figs 3-1 to 3-3). Too much or too little thick
preparation is insufficient reduction of the occlusal
ness or depth can initiate a series of imprecisions
surface of prepared teeth (molars and premolars).
and errors that jeopardize the success of the
particularly in the middle third of canines and in the
restoration. The clinician must be reasonably dex
palatal area of incisors.
terous and, above all, have a clear vision of how to
In a study of 25 canines prepared for restoration,
proceed with the tooth reduction while keeping in
Zanetti et al' found the reduction too shallow in
mind the three fundamental anatomic limits: axial,
Bs% of the cases, excessive in 15% of the cases,
occlusal, and gingivaL
and of average correct depth in only 10% of the
The term axial limit refers to the consideration of
cases. For 25% of the cases, the reduction did not
pulpal vitality. It is now widely accepted that reduc
even reach a depth of o.s mm, a serious error for
ing a tooth for prosthetic purposes is compatible
the longevity of the definitive restoration. To avoid
with the integrity and health of the dental pulp.
th i s problem when preparing the palatal area of
Fig 3-1 S i l i cone index positioned over a model of a maxillary central incisor. The longitudinally sectioned silicone index clearly illustrates the necessary reduction for a ceramic or ceramometal restoration. Use of a silicone index allows the clinician to define the proportions and dimensions of the prosthetic tooth before beginning reduction to ensure the proper integration of the restoration.
Figs 3-2 and 3-3 Examples of preparations with controlled reduction. The clinician can measure reduction with the diameter size of the b u rs to preserve the overall shape of the prepared tooth and provide the necessary space for the restorative materiaL
_
Ftg 3-4 When the shape of the reduction tool impedes accurate measurement of the amount of tissue removed. a clinician may prepare the tooth one half at a lime. as recommended by Mclean.3 Figs 3-5 and 3-6 Tooth extracted with periodontal tissue and sectioned using a microtome. The periodontal tissue. with its delicate structure. must always be treated carefully during preparation and the positioning of the finish line.
S
CHAPTER 3 Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
. incisors and canines, the clinician should reduce one
axial surfaces. In 1955. )orgensen6 recommended a
half of a tooth at a time. Using this technique, de·
value of 2 to 5 degrees, which was supported by
scribed by Mclean,3 a football contour point is used
retention tests measuring tensile strength and con
to reduce one half of the tooth (Fig 3-4). By follow·
firmed in 1994 by Wilson and Chan7 (Fig 3-7). These
ing this procedure, the clinician can make an imme
recommended values for the TOC appear to be ideal
diate evaluation of the amount of dental structure
values for maximum retention, though they are rarely
removed, even when using convex points, which do
achieved in clinical practice. Indeed, the average
not permit measurement of the amount and depth
TOC angle ranges from 12 to 27 degrees, with no ap·
of reduction.
parent correlation to the level of experience of the
The gingiva/ limit is defined by an area known as
clinicians sampled.s-1 1
the biologic width, a concept that is universally rec
These studies underscore the influence of several
ognized but remains dificult to quantify numerical·
factors on the TOC angle, including the type of tooth
ly.4·S According to Gargiulo et al,4 the biologic width
(anterior or posterior), the arch in which it is located
varies from tooth to tooth, but the authors report
(maxilla or mandible), and the tooth surface being
the following average values: o.69 mm for the gin·
prepared. The authors noted the following factors:
FIG 3-7
TH E TOC ANGLE
FIG 3-8
RAN G ES
FROM
gival sulcus, 0.97 mm for the epithelial attachment, and 1.07 mm for the connective tissue attachment, for a total biologic width of 2.04 mm (0.97 mm
+
1.07 mm). For prosthetic purposes, the biologic width
•
•
or by the prosthetic margin after cementation. If the
Mandibular teeth had a greater TOC angle than Posterior teeth had a greater TOC angle than an· terior teeth (Fig 3·8)
•
upon during the initial positioning of the finish line biologic width is not preserved, the tissues react with
0 22 DEGREES
maxillay teeth
represents the minimum distance from the finish line to the bone crest, and it must never be intruded
1 0 T
Buccolingual surfaces had a greater TOC angle than mesiodistal surfaces
•
Monocular vision yielded a greater TOC than binocular vision
chronic gingival inflammation and bone recession. Therefore the clinician must stay within these limits to
In defense of the TOC values obtained by clini
maintain healthy and stable gingival tissue (Figs 3·5
cians, some studies have offered a modified per·
and 3·6).
spective.9·"·'3 Oodge et al'4 tested the resistance of cemented crowns in teeth 10 mm in diameter and
SCIENTIFIC PRINCIPLES
3 - 5 mm in height with three diferent TOC angles. The 22-degree angle proved inadequate in resisting
The clinical approach to tooth preparation for com·
lateral forces, while no significant difference was
plete crowns must take into consideration certain
noted between the IO· and 16-degree angles. The
scientific principles to ensure the biomechanical and
authors concluded that 16 degrees was ideal, since
esthetic success of the restoration. One preparation
to-degree angles are not easily achieved in clinical
requisite that has attracted clinical interest is the
practice. In 1997, Shillingburg et ai'S recommended
total occlusal convergence (TOQ, which is defined
that the TOC angle should be confined to a range of
as the angle of convergence b etween two opposing
10 to 2 2 degrees (Figs 3·9 and 3·1o).
FIG 3-9
.
FIG 3-10
Fig J-7 TOC of a prepared maxillary central incisor. The TOC. calculated by measuring the angle between the mesial and distal surfaces. is about 8 degrees. This value is lower than optimal. according to several researchers 1·7
Fig3-8 TOC of a prepared posterior tooth. Posterior teeth have a greater TOC than do anterior teeth. and the angle formed by the buccal and palatal walls is larger than that between the mesial and distal walls. F1gs 3-g and 3·10 Examples of prepared teeth with optimal TOC angles \between 1 0 and 2 2 degrees) for prosthetic purposes.
11
CHAPTER 3 Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
. incisors and canines, the clinician should reduce one
axial surfaces. In 1955. )orgensen6 recommended a
half of a tooth at a time. Using this technique, de·
value of 2 to 5 degrees, which was supported by
scribed by Mclean,3 a football contour point is used
retention tests measuring tensile strength and con
to reduce one half of the tooth (Fig 3-4). By follow·
firmed in 1994 by Wilson and Chan7 (Fig 3-7). These
ing this procedure, the clinician can make an imme
recommended values for the TOC appear to be ideal
diate evaluation of the amount of dental structure
values for maximum retention, though they are rarely
removed, even when using convex points, which do
achieved in clinical practice. Indeed, the average
not permit measurement of the amount and depth
TOC angle ranges from 12 to 27 degrees, with no ap·
of reduction.
parent correlation to the level of experience of the
The gingiva/ limit is defined by an area known as
clinicians sampled.s-1 1
the biologic width, a concept that is universally rec
These studies underscore the influence of several
ognized but remains dificult to quantify numerical·
factors on the TOC angle, including the type of tooth
ly.4·S According to Gargiulo et al,4 the biologic width
(anterior or posterior), the arch in which it is located
varies from tooth to tooth, but the authors report
(maxilla or mandible), and the tooth surface being
the following average values: o.69 mm for the gin·
prepared. The authors noted the following factors:
FIG 3-7
TH E TOC ANGLE
FIG 3-8
RAN G ES
FROM
gival sulcus, 0.97 mm for the epithelial attachment, and 1.07 mm for the connective tissue attachment, for a total biologic width of 2.04 mm (0.97 mm
+
1.07 mm). For prosthetic purposes, the biologic width
•
•
or by the prosthetic margin after cementation. If the
Mandibular teeth had a greater TOC angle than Posterior teeth had a greater TOC angle than an· terior teeth (Fig 3·8)
•
upon during the initial positioning of the finish line biologic width is not preserved, the tissues react with
0 22 DEGREES
maxillay teeth
represents the minimum distance from the finish line to the bone crest, and it must never be intruded
1 0 T
Buccolingual surfaces had a greater TOC angle than mesiodistal surfaces
•
Monocular vision yielded a greater TOC than binocular vision
chronic gingival inflammation and bone recession. Therefore the clinician must stay within these limits to
In defense of the TOC values obtained by clini
maintain healthy and stable gingival tissue (Figs 3·5
cians, some studies have offered a modified per·
and 3·6).
spective.9·"·'3 Oodge et al'4 tested the resistance of cemented crowns in teeth 10 mm in diameter and
SCIENTIFIC PRINCIPLES
3 - 5 mm in height with three diferent TOC angles. The 22-degree angle proved inadequate in resisting
The clinical approach to tooth preparation for com·
lateral forces, while no significant difference was
plete crowns must take into consideration certain
noted between the IO· and 16-degree angles. The
scientific principles to ensure the biomechanical and
authors concluded that 16 degrees was ideal, since
esthetic success of the restoration. One preparation
to-degree angles are not easily achieved in clinical
requisite that has attracted clinical interest is the
practice. In 1997, Shillingburg et ai'S recommended
total occlusal convergence (TOQ, which is defined
that the TOC angle should be confined to a range of
as the angle of convergence b etween two opposing
10 to 2 2 degrees (Figs 3·9 and 3·1o).
FIG 3-9
.
FIG 3-10
Fig J-7 TOC of a prepared maxillary central incisor. The TOC. calculated by measuring the angle between the mesial and distal surfaces. is about 8 degrees. This value is lower than optimal. according to several researchers 1·7
Fig3-8 TOC of a prepared posterior tooth. Posterior teeth have a greater TOC than do anterior teeth. and the angle formed by the buccal and palatal walls is larger than that between the mesial and distal walls. F1gs 3-g and 3·10 Examples of prepared teeth with optimal TOC angles \between 1 0 and 2 2 degrees) for prosthetic purposes.
11
CHAPTER 3 Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
�
Another study'6 showed that the most important
is the use of boxes, grooves, or pin holes. 21 These
factor in the stability of the prosthetic restoration is
secondary retentions must be constructed with
its resistance to lateral forces, rather than its inser
regard to the dislocating forces, which differ accord
tion axis or TOC angle. The clinician must seek to
ing to restoration type. For single crowns, the dislo
create convergence angles that are reproducible with
cating forces are primarily buccolingual and the
restorative materials and yet will ensure the lateral
boxes and grooves must be placed on the proximal,
stability of the prosthetic restoration. The authors
mesial, and distal surfaces. For fixed patial den
believe that an angle measuring between 10 and 20
tures, the forces are primarily mesiodistal and the
degrees will provide such stability. A TOC angle over
retentive elements should be placed on the buccal
the limit leads to certain dislocation of the restora
and lingual surfaces" (Figs 3-11 and 3-12).
tion,'7 but it is impossible to set a maximum limit
In a literature review, Goodacre et ai'J list sever
since other variables, such as the height of the pre
al preparation guidelines to ensure the mechanical,
pared tooth, are involved in determining the stability.
biologic, and esthetic success of a restoration.
Another point of clinical interest with regard to
Among the principles listed are those regarding the
retention is the minimum occlusogingival height of
preparation of the tooth in its entirety, including the
the prepared tooth in relation to the angle of con
TOC, the occlusogingival and incisogingival dimen
vergence. In an analysis of the stability of incisors
sions, the relationship between the occlusogingival
and premolars with occlusogingival heights of 1, 2,
dimension and the buccolingual dimension, and the
3, and 5 mm and a minimal TOC angle of 6 degrees,
circumferential morphology. Other principles concern
Maxwell et al'8 concluded that the height must be at
aspects of the inish line (le, its position, form, and
least 3 mm. Another study'9 introduced the concept
depth in relation to the various restorative materi
of a critical TOC value over which a crown cannot
als), the depth of axial and occlusaVincisal reduc
maintain adequate stability. The study indicated
tion, the form of the linear angle, and the surface of
that, theoretically, stability criteria are met when a
the prepared tooth.
molar 10 mm in diameter and 3 mm in occlusogin
I
I
- ·
FIG 3-11
G R O O V E S M U ST B E P R E P A R E D TO O P P O S E T H E D I S P LA C E M E N T F O R C E S
Their conclusions can be summarized as follows:
gival height has a TOC of 17-4 degrees or less. Woolsey and Matich20 conirmed these data, con
•
cluding that a height of 3 mm is suficient if associ ated with an angle of 10 degrees but insuficient
degrees. •
Recommended minimum heights are 4 mm for
with an angle of 20 degrees, which is common in
prepared molars and 3 mm for other prepared
molars. For molars, the ideal occlusocervical height
teeth. If the values are lower, axial grooves and
is 4 mm.
boxes can be added to the proximal surface for
When working with convergence angles of 10 to
single crowns or to the buccolingual areas for
20 degrees, the clinician should prepare incisors and premolars with a minimum occlusogingival height of
fixed partial dentures. •
3 mm and molars with a minimum height of 4 mm. When the clinician is faced with a clinical case in
8
The TOC angle should be between 10 and 20
The occlusogingivaVbuccolingual dimension ratio
FIG 3-12
should be equal to or greater than 0.4 mm. •
Facioproximal and linguoproximal line angles
which more stability is needed in teeth that do not
should be preserved whenever possible. Exces-
have the minimum dimensions, a viable alternative
sive rounding is to be avoided.
.
Figs 3-11 and 3-12 Retention grooves can be prepared on the mesial or distal walls for a single crown or on the buccal or palatal surfaces for a fixed partial denture. The grooves should create resistance against the dislocating forces. which have different vectors for a single crown (buccolingual) or a fixed partial denture (mesiodistal).
I
CHAPTER 3 Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
�
Another study'6 showed that the most important
is the use of boxes, grooves, or pin holes. 21 These
factor in the stability of the prosthetic restoration is
secondary retentions must be constructed with
its resistance to lateral forces, rather than its inser
regard to the dislocating forces, which differ accord
tion axis or TOC angle. The clinician must seek to
ing to restoration type. For single crowns, the dislo
create convergence angles that are reproducible with
cating forces are primarily buccolingual and the
restorative materials and yet will ensure the lateral
boxes and grooves must be placed on the proximal,
stability of the prosthetic restoration. The authors
mesial, and distal surfaces. For fixed patial den
believe that an angle measuring between 10 and 20
tures, the forces are primarily mesiodistal and the
degrees will provide such stability. A TOC angle over
retentive elements should be placed on the buccal
the limit leads to certain dislocation of the restora
and lingual surfaces" (Figs 3-11 and 3-12).
tion,'7 but it is impossible to set a maximum limit
In a literature review, Goodacre et ai'J list sever
since other variables, such as the height of the pre
al preparation guidelines to ensure the mechanical,
pared tooth, are involved in determining the stability.
biologic, and esthetic success of a restoration.
Another point of clinical interest with regard to
Among the principles listed are those regarding the
retention is the minimum occlusogingival height of
preparation of the tooth in its entirety, including the
the prepared tooth in relation to the angle of con
TOC, the occlusogingival and incisogingival dimen
vergence. In an analysis of the stability of incisors
sions, the relationship between the occlusogingival
and premolars with occlusogingival heights of 1, 2,
dimension and the buccolingual dimension, and the
3, and 5 mm and a minimal TOC angle of 6 degrees,
circumferential morphology. Other principles concern
Maxwell et al'8 concluded that the height must be at
aspects of the inish line (le, its position, form, and
least 3 mm. Another study'9 introduced the concept
depth in relation to the various restorative materi
of a critical TOC value over which a crown cannot
als), the depth of axial and occlusaVincisal reduc
maintain adequate stability. The study indicated
tion, the form of the linear angle, and the surface of
that, theoretically, stability criteria are met when a
the prepared tooth.
molar 10 mm in diameter and 3 mm in occlusogin
I
I
- ·
FIG 3-11
G R O O V E S M U ST B E P R E P A R E D TO O P P O S E T H E D I S P LA C E M E N T F O R C E S
Their conclusions can be summarized as follows:
gival height has a TOC of 17-4 degrees or less. Woolsey and Matich20 conirmed these data, con
•
cluding that a height of 3 mm is suficient if associ ated with an angle of 10 degrees but insuficient
degrees. •
Recommended minimum heights are 4 mm for
with an angle of 20 degrees, which is common in
prepared molars and 3 mm for other prepared
molars. For molars, the ideal occlusocervical height
teeth. If the values are lower, axial grooves and
is 4 mm.
boxes can be added to the proximal surface for
When working with convergence angles of 10 to
single crowns or to the buccolingual areas for
20 degrees, the clinician should prepare incisors and premolars with a minimum occlusogingival height of
fixed partial dentures. •
3 mm and molars with a minimum height of 4 mm. When the clinician is faced with a clinical case in
8
The TOC angle should be between 10 and 20
The occlusogingivaVbuccolingual dimension ratio
FIG 3-12
should be equal to or greater than 0.4 mm. •
Facioproximal and linguoproximal line angles
which more stability is needed in teeth that do not
should be preserved whenever possible. Exces-
have the minimum dimensions, a viable alternative
sive rounding is to be avoided.
.
Figs 3-11 and 3-12 Retention grooves can be prepared on the mesial or distal walls for a single crown or on the buccal or palatal surfaces for a fixed partial denture. The grooves should create resistance against the dislocating forces. which have different vectors for a single crown (buccolingual) or a fixed partial denture (mesiodistal).
I
CHAPTER 3 Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
11
Conclusions regarding the finish line can be sum-
Bur design
marized as follows: Handpieces'S are classified according to the maxi •
•
•
The choice of finish line depends on the type of
mum diameter of the bur, for example, a cone
restoration, the esthetic demands, the ease of
shaped bur is classified by the maximum diameter
execution, and the clinician's experience.
rather than by the diameter of the point, which is
Esthetics and the condition of the prepared teeth
considerably narrower. The handpiece is completed
determine the position of the finish line. The
by a shank made of tempered stainless steel, which
supragingival position is most recommended.
is corrosion-resistant and, above all, flex-resistant
Line angles should be rounded and well pol·
even at high speeds.
ished.
FIG 3-13
There are two categories of burs. The first essen
determined by the head shape (eg, cylindrical, con
adaptation with the various types of finish lines
ical, inverted cone) and the geometric blade design'S
because results of comparative studies are biased
(eg, surgical osteotrites used in implant surgery).
by the varied abilities and skills of dental techni
Tungsten carbide burs are made of a sintered mate
cians who make the prostheses.
Fig 3-14 Coarse-grit bur at rest.
of tungsten carbide. The design of these burs is
dificult to scientifically correlate better marginal
FIG 3-15
Fig 3-13 Fine-gril (30-�ml and coarse-grit (1 80-�ml burs. When not in motion the fine-grit bur appears to have a larger diameter.
tially performs a boring action and is usually made The most important aspect, however, is that it is
FIG 3-14
F1g 3-15 Coarse-grit bur in motion. demonstrating a diameter equal to the fine-g rit bur.
rial of 90% tungsten carbide and 10% cobalt, which acts as a binder, and they have a characteristic hard
0
11
cone}, but the abrasion layer is determined by the
risk of breakage and maintain the integrity of the
ROTATING I N STRUMENTS
ness value of 1,6oo (compare with the hardness value of 400 for stainless steel). The tungsten carbide bur
random distribution of diamond grains on the bur.
high-speed air turbine. The clinician must maintain
Before the practical aspects of tooth preparation can
is attached by means of hydrostatic pressure, heat
The diamond grains, selected by size, are bonded to
congruity between the shape and total diameter of
be addressed, the required instruments should be
(hot isostatic pressure [HIPD. and welding to the
the bur head of the instrument through an electro
the bur, depending on the grit of the abrasion layer
described to clariy their selection and proper use.
neck of the instrument, which in turn is connected
lytic bath, whereby two thirds of each grain be
(coarse, medium, or fine). For example, a bur with a
Tooth preparation using rotating instruments must be
to the stainless steel shank. The blade design of the
come embedded in the nickel bonding compound.
coarse grit should have a diameter that is smaller
carried out following a systematic process through
bur may be helicoidal, transversal, straight, or cross
Diamonds are used for abrasion because they have
than that of a bur with a finer grit and yet still pre
out treatment. Every clinician must be completely
cutting, with cutting and finishing options that vary
a hardness superior to that of the surfaces to be
serve optimal rigidity. To avoid excessive weakening
familiar with these instruments, which are used pri
according to the clinical or laboratory application
abraded.
of the shank, coarse grits are most efective for burs
marily for abrasion.
(eg, finishing of the tooth preparation, crown sepa
The eficacy and quality of an abrasion bur are
of reduced diameter, such as 0.14 mm, whereas
There is considerable debate as to the proper
ration, cavity preparation, fabrication of resin crowns
determined by the type of abrasion material, the
extra-coarse grits are more efective for burs of 0.1B
shape, diameter, and blade design or grit of the bur.
or removable partial dentures, casting, waxing, fin
coaxiality and concentric rotation, the shape and
mm diameter or larger. Burs with coarse- and extra
For example, one study24 incorrectly recommends
ishing, and polishing).
diameter of the bur. and the grit of the abrasion
coarse grit will appear smaller than a bur with the
the use of sharp, medium-grit diamonds of small
The second type of bur works with the abrasion
layer. The coaxiality, or symmetry, of the bur controls
same diameter but finer grit. Only during rotation is
diameter, claiming that this will ensure maximum
of a diamond layer. Diamond burs also have a vari
vibration accompanied by percussive efects and the
it possible to see that the diameters are identical
conservation of dental tissue and pulp.
ety of head shapes (eg, conical, cylindrical, inverted .
bur's degree of precision. It also helps reduce the
(Figs 3-13 to 3-15).
..
91
CHAPTER 3 Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
11
Conclusions regarding the finish line can be sum-
Bur design
marized as follows: Handpieces'S are classified according to the maxi •
•
•
The choice of finish line depends on the type of
mum diameter of the bur, for example, a cone
restoration, the esthetic demands, the ease of
shaped bur is classified by the maximum diameter
execution, and the clinician's experience.
rather than by the diameter of the point, which is
Esthetics and the condition of the prepared teeth
considerably narrower. The handpiece is completed
determine the position of the finish line. The
by a shank made of tempered stainless steel, which
supragingival position is most recommended.
is corrosion-resistant and, above all, flex-resistant
Line angles should be rounded and well pol·
even at high speeds.
ished.
FIG 3-13
There are two categories of burs. The first essen
determined by the head shape (eg, cylindrical, con
adaptation with the various types of finish lines
ical, inverted cone) and the geometric blade design'S
because results of comparative studies are biased
(eg, surgical osteotrites used in implant surgery).
by the varied abilities and skills of dental techni
Tungsten carbide burs are made of a sintered mate
cians who make the prostheses.
Fig 3-14 Coarse-grit bur at rest.
of tungsten carbide. The design of these burs is
dificult to scientifically correlate better marginal
FIG 3-15
Fig 3-13 Fine-gril (30-�ml and coarse-grit (1 80-�ml burs. When not in motion the fine-grit bur appears to have a larger diameter.
tially performs a boring action and is usually made The most important aspect, however, is that it is
FIG 3-14
F1g 3-15 Coarse-grit bur in motion. demonstrating a diameter equal to the fine-g rit bur.
rial of 90% tungsten carbide and 10% cobalt, which acts as a binder, and they have a characteristic hard
0
11
cone}, but the abrasion layer is determined by the
risk of breakage and maintain the integrity of the
ROTATING I N STRUMENTS
ness value of 1,6oo (compare with the hardness value of 400 for stainless steel). The tungsten carbide bur
random distribution of diamond grains on the bur.
high-speed air turbine. The clinician must maintain
Before the practical aspects of tooth preparation can
is attached by means of hydrostatic pressure, heat
The diamond grains, selected by size, are bonded to
congruity between the shape and total diameter of
be addressed, the required instruments should be
(hot isostatic pressure [HIPD. and welding to the
the bur head of the instrument through an electro
the bur, depending on the grit of the abrasion layer
described to clariy their selection and proper use.
neck of the instrument, which in turn is connected
lytic bath, whereby two thirds of each grain be
(coarse, medium, or fine). For example, a bur with a
Tooth preparation using rotating instruments must be
to the stainless steel shank. The blade design of the
come embedded in the nickel bonding compound.
coarse grit should have a diameter that is smaller
carried out following a systematic process through
bur may be helicoidal, transversal, straight, or cross
Diamonds are used for abrasion because they have
than that of a bur with a finer grit and yet still pre
out treatment. Every clinician must be completely
cutting, with cutting and finishing options that vary
a hardness superior to that of the surfaces to be
serve optimal rigidity. To avoid excessive weakening
familiar with these instruments, which are used pri
according to the clinical or laboratory application
abraded.
of the shank, coarse grits are most efective for burs
marily for abrasion.
(eg, finishing of the tooth preparation, crown sepa
The eficacy and quality of an abrasion bur are
of reduced diameter, such as 0.14 mm, whereas
There is considerable debate as to the proper
ration, cavity preparation, fabrication of resin crowns
determined by the type of abrasion material, the
extra-coarse grits are more efective for burs of 0.1B
shape, diameter, and blade design or grit of the bur.
or removable partial dentures, casting, waxing, fin
coaxiality and concentric rotation, the shape and
mm diameter or larger. Burs with coarse- and extra
For example, one study24 incorrectly recommends
ishing, and polishing).
diameter of the bur. and the grit of the abrasion
coarse grit will appear smaller than a bur with the
the use of sharp, medium-grit diamonds of small
The second type of bur works with the abrasion
layer. The coaxiality, or symmetry, of the bur controls
same diameter but finer grit. Only during rotation is
diameter, claiming that this will ensure maximum
of a diamond layer. Diamond burs also have a vari
vibration accompanied by percussive efects and the
it possible to see that the diameters are identical
conservation of dental tissue and pulp.
ety of head shapes (eg, conical, cylindrical, inverted .
bur's degree of precision. It also helps reduce the
(Figs 3-13 to 3-15).
..
91
TAB L E 3 - 1 Characteristics of diamond b u rs with various grit levels
CHAPTER 3
GRIT LEVEL
Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
FINE
COARSE
LOW
HIGH
HIGHER
LOW
WORKING JORCE
LOW
HIGHER
GENERATED•HEAi
LIMITED
LESS LIMITED
PRETIO. EFFECT
LOW
HIGHER
BETTER
POOR
WORKING TIME·
LONGER
SHORTER
BUR ENDURANCE •··.
HIGHER
LOWER
PARAMETER .
In the authors' opinion, the quality of lhe dia-
preparation. Table 3-1 shows that diamond burs wilh
mond burs is much more essential for selecting a
coarse grits have greater abrasion and cut more effi·
manufacturer than the range of bur shapes and
ciently, permitting the operator lo use a working
designs. A high-quality abrasion handpiece has a grit
force of aboul 100 g, 26- 27 while the working force
that is uniform in both size and shape. Allhough it
that can be used with fine-grit burs is about 30 g.
should have no bald spots, which would remove
Some authors28•29 have shown that when a clinician
material unevenly, the diamond layer should contain
reduces a tooth using a fine-gril diamond bur with
spaces that allow for the elimination of debris.
suficient water cooling,3° the increase in tooth tem
Burs are available in a vast array of shapes and
perature is less than for burs with coarse and extra
diameters, but tooth preparation for prostheses
coarse grits. Galindo and othersJ• analyzed the use
mostly requires large diameters that are easier for
of burs with coarse and extra-coarse grit (12S and
the operator to use, cause less lrauma to the pulp,
180 �m) and noted that the mean lemperature
and also function as measuring instruments. The shape and peripheral definition of the tooth preparation usually reflects the last application of
recorded during and after the cutting procedures was lower than baseline temperature. A comparative study32 showed that the tooth tem
the bur on the tooth, during which the entire point
perature rises an average of o.8°C with fine-grit burs,
remains in contact with the tooth's longitudinal axis.
1.3°C with medium-grit burs, and t.S°C and 1.8°C with
Large-diameter burs are much easier to control than
coarse- and extra-coarse-grit burs, respectively. How
smaller-diameter burs, and the correct preparation
ever, the trials in this study were carried out by
shape can be deined with fewer applications. In
making three successive cuts of o.8, o.s. and o.s mm
addition, the tooth temperature does not increase
toward the tooth's center. In clinical practice, the clin
as much with large-diameter burs, thus protecting
ician works the bur around the circumference of the
the pulp. Large-diameter burs produce less heat
tooth to progressively abrade the surface and never
because they develop greater peripheral velocity
removes such thicknesses in one cut.
and therefore dissipate more heat. This rule is ex pressed through the following formula:
Vp (peripheral velocity) where K
�
�
diameter of the tool X no. of revolutions x T K
6o,ooo
All hough the conclusions of these in vitro exper
�
ABRASION '"
,.. -
. �
J FINISHING .,
.'.ll
... p..
·�
.. iS reduced by SO%, 3S0fo, and 2S0/o for the three grades, respectively. A reduction in eficiency translates into a longer working time, an increased working force applied by
iments are valid, the authors of this text argue in
the operator, and a greater likelihood of clogging of
favor of the coarse- and extra-coarse-grit burs be
the cutting edges of the diamonds. These factors
cause of the better cutting efficiency and debris
lead to an increase in temperature, which in turn
mond grains of 30 �m. are suitable only for inishing the tooth preparation and should be used with very little cutting force to keep the tooth temperature from rising too much and damaging the pulp.
H i g h-speed handp ieces Clinicians must use high-speed instruments, either
elimination, which leads consequently to substan
detrimentally affects the pulp. For this reason, a clin
tial decreases in the operating time and stress on
ician should reduce teeth using coarse- and extra
high-speed air turbine handpieces or handpieces
the tooth. Although the greater eficiency of burs
coarse-grit burs, leaving the fine-grit burs exclusive
with a torque multiplier. The high-speed air turbine
with coarse and extra-coarse grit is not widely rec
ly for finishing the tooth preparation.
handpiece, invented in the 196os, remains the most
With a high peripheral velocity, which is directly
ognized,JJ Siegel and Von Fraunhofer34 have dis
Because of their superior abrasion, coarse and
commonly used instrument for tooth preparation,
proportional to the diameter of the bur, not only can
cussed the importance of reduced operating times
extra-coarse burs produce a very irregular surface
especially in Mediterranean countries. However, this
heat dissipate more efficiently, but chips and shav
and how efficiency decreases after the initial cut.
with a high degree of surface roughness (Fig 3-16),
instrument is being replaced by handpieces with
ings are eliminated more easily.
Their study comparing diamond burs with medium,
and they sufer more wear during use and must be
torque multipliers (Fig 3·17).
coarse, and extra-coarse grit making three succes
replaced relatively often. Fine-particle burs, with dia-
The correct use of rotating instruments must also address grit selection and the techniques of tooth
.
sive cuts shows that the eficiency of the third cut .
93
TAB L E 3 - 1 Characteristics of diamond b u rs with various grit levels
CHAPTER 3
GRIT LEVEL
Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
FINE
COARSE
LOW
HIGH
HIGHER
LOW
WORKING JORCE
LOW
HIGHER
GENERATED•HEAi
LIMITED
LESS LIMITED
PRETIO. EFFECT
LOW
HIGHER
BETTER
POOR
WORKING TIME·
LONGER
SHORTER
BUR ENDURANCE •··.
HIGHER
LOWER
PARAMETER .
In the authors' opinion, the quality of lhe dia-
preparation. Table 3-1 shows that diamond burs wilh
mond burs is much more essential for selecting a
coarse grits have greater abrasion and cut more effi·
manufacturer than the range of bur shapes and
ciently, permitting the operator lo use a working
designs. A high-quality abrasion handpiece has a grit
force of aboul 100 g, 26- 27 while the working force
that is uniform in both size and shape. Allhough it
that can be used with fine-grit burs is about 30 g.
should have no bald spots, which would remove
Some authors28•29 have shown that when a clinician
material unevenly, the diamond layer should contain
reduces a tooth using a fine-gril diamond bur with
spaces that allow for the elimination of debris.
suficient water cooling,3° the increase in tooth tem
Burs are available in a vast array of shapes and
perature is less than for burs with coarse and extra
diameters, but tooth preparation for prostheses
coarse grits. Galindo and othersJ• analyzed the use
mostly requires large diameters that are easier for
of burs with coarse and extra-coarse grit (12S and
the operator to use, cause less lrauma to the pulp,
180 �m) and noted that the mean lemperature
and also function as measuring instruments. The shape and peripheral definition of the tooth preparation usually reflects the last application of
recorded during and after the cutting procedures was lower than baseline temperature. A comparative study32 showed that the tooth tem
the bur on the tooth, during which the entire point
perature rises an average of o.8°C with fine-grit burs,
remains in contact with the tooth's longitudinal axis.
1.3°C with medium-grit burs, and t.S°C and 1.8°C with
Large-diameter burs are much easier to control than
coarse- and extra-coarse-grit burs, respectively. How
smaller-diameter burs, and the correct preparation
ever, the trials in this study were carried out by
shape can be deined with fewer applications. In
making three successive cuts of o.8, o.s. and o.s mm
addition, the tooth temperature does not increase
toward the tooth's center. In clinical practice, the clin
as much with large-diameter burs, thus protecting
ician works the bur around the circumference of the
the pulp. Large-diameter burs produce less heat
tooth to progressively abrade the surface and never
because they develop greater peripheral velocity
removes such thicknesses in one cut.
and therefore dissipate more heat. This rule is ex pressed through the following formula:
Vp (peripheral velocity) where K
�
�
diameter of the tool X no. of revolutions x T K
6o,ooo
All hough the conclusions of these in vitro exper
�
ABRASION '"
,.. -
. �
J FINISHING .,
.'.ll
... p..
·�
.. iS reduced by SO%, 3S0fo, and 2S0/o for the three grades, respectively. A reduction in eficiency translates into a longer working time, an increased working force applied by
iments are valid, the authors of this text argue in
the operator, and a greater likelihood of clogging of
favor of the coarse- and extra-coarse-grit burs be
the cutting edges of the diamonds. These factors
cause of the better cutting efficiency and debris
lead to an increase in temperature, which in turn
mond grains of 30 �m. are suitable only for inishing the tooth preparation and should be used with very little cutting force to keep the tooth temperature from rising too much and damaging the pulp.
H i g h-speed handp ieces Clinicians must use high-speed instruments, either
elimination, which leads consequently to substan
detrimentally affects the pulp. For this reason, a clin
tial decreases in the operating time and stress on
ician should reduce teeth using coarse- and extra
high-speed air turbine handpieces or handpieces
the tooth. Although the greater eficiency of burs
coarse-grit burs, leaving the fine-grit burs exclusive
with a torque multiplier. The high-speed air turbine
with coarse and extra-coarse grit is not widely rec
ly for finishing the tooth preparation.
handpiece, invented in the 196os, remains the most
With a high peripheral velocity, which is directly
ognized,JJ Siegel and Von Fraunhofer34 have dis
Because of their superior abrasion, coarse and
commonly used instrument for tooth preparation,
proportional to the diameter of the bur, not only can
cussed the importance of reduced operating times
extra-coarse burs produce a very irregular surface
especially in Mediterranean countries. However, this
heat dissipate more efficiently, but chips and shav
and how efficiency decreases after the initial cut.
with a high degree of surface roughness (Fig 3-16),
instrument is being replaced by handpieces with
ings are eliminated more easily.
Their study comparing diamond burs with medium,
and they sufer more wear during use and must be
torque multipliers (Fig 3·17).
coarse, and extra-coarse grit making three succes
replaced relatively often. Fine-particle burs, with dia-
The correct use of rotating instruments must also address grit selection and the techniques of tooth
.
sive cuts shows that the eficiency of the third cut .
93
CHAPTER 3 Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
.
The free-running speed of 30o,ooo to 40o,ooo
with a diameter of 0.10 mm and a cylindrical shape
rpm produced by the high-speed air turbine drops
(6879-314- 0IO [6 = grit, 879 = shape , 314
sharply as soon as the bur comes into contact with
grip, 010
the tooth. In contrast, the handpiece with torque
cone-shaped needle points with small diameters.
multiplier produces a free-running speed of 230,000
Needle point burs quickly lose diamond particles in
rpm, which can be maintained during abrasion and
the excessively fine tip, and their conical shape
adjusted to the lower speeds when necessary. The
often creates conical tooth preparations with little
technology of the torque multiplier permits the oper
retention, a defect that is dificult to correct in sub
ator to multiply the basic speed of 40,000 rpm by 4,
sequent stages.
=
=
friction
diameter], Komet) is preferable to the
s . or 5 - 7· increasing the speed to 16o,ooo, 2oo,ooo,
The simultaneous preparation of multiple teeth
and 230,000 rpm, respectively. Two settings for the
requires greater concentration of the clinician than
torque multiplier are used during tooth preparation.
the preparation of a single tooth. If the multiple
The maximum multiplication setting is used for the
restorations are to be connected, the prepared teeth
stages of separation and preliminary preparation,
must have the same insertion path to ensure prop
while the lowest multiplication setting (4 multiplica·
er prosthetic fit. Even in the case of unconnected
tions) is used for finishing.
FIG J-17
FIG 3-16
Fig 3-16 Fine- 130 �ml and coarse-grit 1 1 80 �ml b u rs seen under a stereomicroscope at high magnification 1 2 5 X ) .
Fig 3-17 Handpiece with torque multiplier a n d three water-spray jets f o r cooling. T h i s handpiece h a s a multiplication factor o f five.
fixed restorations in which each tooth is restored independently, proper parallelism is critical for limit
Choosing the right instrument for tooth preparation
ing the subsequent stress and possible distortion of the impression materials (see chapter 9 for more details about impressions). Therefore, when prepar
For didactic purposes, tooth preparation can be divid
ing multiple teeth, the clinician must prepare each
ed into three sequential stages: separation, prelimi
tooth before moving on to the next stage. Separa
nary preparation, and inishing. In each stage, dif
tion, however, is performed only on the teeth adja
ferent burs and instruments are used to optimize
cent to the preserved natural dentition.
results while minimizing operator stress and the
"
. at a rate of 44 m/minl 5 through three holes in the
appear on the bur where only the binding substance
upper part of the handpiece. The convergence of the
remains, the result would be pulpal damage. There
water on the working area reduces or eliminates the
is currently no standard method for evaluating the
possibility of damaging the tooth.
Prelim i nary preparation
Preliminary preparation is the most demanding stage
generated heatJ6 (Figs 3-20 and 3-21) . To optimize
degree of wear of a bur; manufacturers rely on the
Separation
because it establishes the conditions for the pros
this stage, large-diameter burs (0.14, 0.16, and 0.18
sensitivity of the operator, an empirical criterion that
The critical separation stage requires great precision
thetic outcome. The objective is to reduce the tooth
mm) with the coarsest possible grit (180 �m) are
is not without error.
to avoid causing i rreversible damage to adjacent
in volume and shape and to correctly position the
used to achieve the maximum efect with the least
teeth and establishing inaccurate parallelism of the
gingival margins (Figs 3-18 and 3-19). This stage is
damage to the pulpal tissue (see Table 3-1).
prepared teeth. The use of a small-diameter cylin
carried out using the torque multiplier at the mini
Another i m portant factor i n minimizing trauma
visual checks with magnifying instruments in two
drical bur is preferred for the interproximal zone.
mum level of multiplication, and a working pressure
during a dental preparation involves the wear of the
ways. A static examination of wear is made by
Esthetic appearance is not crucial in this area, but
at a maximum of 100 g.
diamond abrasion layer, which is most significant
checking the visible ratio of diamonds to binding
with the coarsest grit. Wear manifests through the
substance. A dynamic examination involves observ
The authors' method is to change the b u rs fre quently (every six to eight preparations) and make
the clinician must create sufficient space for the
During preliminay preparation of the dental tis
preparation burs to place the buccopalatal grooves
sue, the clinician must cool the working area with a
loss of the diamond grains on the surface during
ing the bur in motion, to ensure that the diamond
(see Figs 4-82 and 4-83). A chamfer diamond bur
continuous jet of water. The water ideally is sprayed .
rotation (Fig 3-22). I f use continues after bald spots
grains produce the most uniform shape possible.
.
CHAPTER 3 Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
.
The free-running speed of 30o,ooo to 40o,ooo
with a diameter of 0.10 mm and a cylindrical shape
rpm produced by the high-speed air turbine drops
(6879-314- 0IO [6 = grit, 879 = shape , 314
sharply as soon as the bur comes into contact with
grip, 010
the tooth. In contrast, the handpiece with torque
cone-shaped needle points with small diameters.
multiplier produces a free-running speed of 230,000
Needle point burs quickly lose diamond particles in
rpm, which can be maintained during abrasion and
the excessively fine tip, and their conical shape
adjusted to the lower speeds when necessary. The
often creates conical tooth preparations with little
technology of the torque multiplier permits the oper
retention, a defect that is dificult to correct in sub
ator to multiply the basic speed of 40,000 rpm by 4,
sequent stages.
=
=
friction
diameter], Komet) is preferable to the
s . or 5 - 7· increasing the speed to 16o,ooo, 2oo,ooo,
The simultaneous preparation of multiple teeth
and 230,000 rpm, respectively. Two settings for the
requires greater concentration of the clinician than
torque multiplier are used during tooth preparation.
the preparation of a single tooth. If the multiple
The maximum multiplication setting is used for the
restorations are to be connected, the prepared teeth
stages of separation and preliminary preparation,
must have the same insertion path to ensure prop
while the lowest multiplication setting (4 multiplica·
er prosthetic fit. Even in the case of unconnected
tions) is used for finishing.
FIG J-17
FIG 3-16
Fig 3-16 Fine- 130 �ml and coarse-grit 1 1 80 �ml b u rs seen under a stereomicroscope at high magnification 1 2 5 X ) .
Fig 3-17 Handpiece with torque multiplier a n d three water-spray jets f o r cooling. T h i s handpiece h a s a multiplication factor o f five.
fixed restorations in which each tooth is restored independently, proper parallelism is critical for limit
Choosing the right instrument for tooth preparation
ing the subsequent stress and possible distortion of the impression materials (see chapter 9 for more details about impressions). Therefore, when prepar
For didactic purposes, tooth preparation can be divid
ing multiple teeth, the clinician must prepare each
ed into three sequential stages: separation, prelimi
tooth before moving on to the next stage. Separa
nary preparation, and inishing. In each stage, dif
tion, however, is performed only on the teeth adja
ferent burs and instruments are used to optimize
cent to the preserved natural dentition.
results while minimizing operator stress and the
"
. at a rate of 44 m/minl 5 through three holes in the
appear on the bur where only the binding substance
upper part of the handpiece. The convergence of the
remains, the result would be pulpal damage. There
water on the working area reduces or eliminates the
is currently no standard method for evaluating the
possibility of damaging the tooth.
Prelim i nary preparation
Preliminary preparation is the most demanding stage
generated heatJ6 (Figs 3-20 and 3-21) . To optimize
degree of wear of a bur; manufacturers rely on the
Separation
because it establishes the conditions for the pros
this stage, large-diameter burs (0.14, 0.16, and 0.18
sensitivity of the operator, an empirical criterion that
The critical separation stage requires great precision
thetic outcome. The objective is to reduce the tooth
mm) with the coarsest possible grit (180 �m) are
is not without error.
to avoid causing i rreversible damage to adjacent
in volume and shape and to correctly position the
used to achieve the maximum efect with the least
teeth and establishing inaccurate parallelism of the
gingival margins (Figs 3-18 and 3-19). This stage is
damage to the pulpal tissue (see Table 3-1).
prepared teeth. The use of a small-diameter cylin
carried out using the torque multiplier at the mini
Another i m portant factor i n minimizing trauma
visual checks with magnifying instruments in two
drical bur is preferred for the interproximal zone.
mum level of multiplication, and a working pressure
during a dental preparation involves the wear of the
ways. A static examination of wear is made by
Esthetic appearance is not crucial in this area, but
at a maximum of 100 g.
diamond abrasion layer, which is most significant
checking the visible ratio of diamonds to binding
with the coarsest grit. Wear manifests through the
substance. A dynamic examination involves observ
The authors' method is to change the b u rs fre quently (every six to eight preparations) and make
the clinician must create sufficient space for the
During preliminay preparation of the dental tis
preparation burs to place the buccopalatal grooves
sue, the clinician must cool the working area with a
loss of the diamond grains on the surface during
ing the bur in motion, to ensure that the diamond
(see Figs 4-82 and 4-83). A chamfer diamond bur
continuous jet of water. The water ideally is sprayed .
rotation (Fig 3-22). I f use continues after bald spots
grains produce the most uniform shape possible.
.
CHAPTER 3 Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
. Fintshing
The last stage is finishing, which is usually performed
knows the anatomic and clinical aspects of the case and has a clear idea of the type of preparation
with a fine-grit bur, silicon carbide or Arkansas
required for the restoration. Once these objectives
stones, polishing rubbers, and manual cutting tools
have been established, the clinician can select a pre
(ie. rounded chisel). When finishing with rotating
cise and effective procedure for a successful out·
instruments. the clinician should use the multiplier
come. There are several step-by-step approaches to
torque at the lowest multiplication level and a
tooth preparation that are designed to simpliy tooth
working force of 30 g. The aim is to make the sur
reduction,
faces smoother and more uniform. Any attempt to
nique,J8 Mclean's reduction of half of the tooth at a
including Stei n's guide-groove tech
modify the shape of the prepared tooth would gen
time,J and Martignoni and Schonenberger's slant·
erate excessive heat and damage the pulp. The
cutting method.J9 Regardless of the technique, the
authors use a fine-grit bur (30 �m) to finish the axial
clinician must always keep anatomic references in
walls and the finish line (Fig 3-23). To make the fin
mind and control the tooth reduction through an
ish line more regular. the authors use rounded chis
awareness of the bur's diameter and the quantity of
els with suitable shapes and diameters (Fig 3-24).
dental matter being removed.
FIG 3-18
FIG 3-19
Knowing the amount of material to remove is possible by using a silicone index with a shore hard
SYSTEMATIZED TOOTH PREPARATION
ness of 85 to 90 (Zetalabor, Zhermack).•0 A silicone index is made on a diagnostic cast or waxup pre pared in the laboratory. The clinician can use a sili
Tooth preparation is a clinical operation t h a t c a n be
cone index that is properly cut longitudinally, hori
carried out successfully.J7 provided the clinician
zontally, or serially (depending on the practical
�
FIG 3-20
FIG 3-21
FIG 3-22
Fig l-18 At high magnification. the rough surface of the tooth prepared with the 1 80-�m-grit bur is evident. ig 3-1 g Note the irregular profile resulting from the use of the 1 80-�m-grit bur. Figs 3-20 Bur in motion with jets of water aimed at the point . F1Q 3-21 8ur that does not provide adequate spray because of clogged or damaged water jets.
Fig 3;22 A worn bur (left) and a new one (right) of identical grit and shape. Coarse-grit burs are particularly subject to wear as d1amond gra1ns tome loose. Fig� 3-23 and 3-24 Prep ared tooth finished with a fine-grit bur and a manual chisel _ rehn1ng the preparat1on.
16
fDM1.
Oeppeler). the ideal instruments for
FIG 3-23
FIG 3-24
CHAPTER 3 Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
. Fintshing
The last stage is finishing, which is usually performed
knows the anatomic and clinical aspects of the case and has a clear idea of the type of preparation
with a fine-grit bur, silicon carbide or Arkansas
required for the restoration. Once these objectives
stones, polishing rubbers, and manual cutting tools
have been established, the clinician can select a pre
(ie. rounded chisel). When finishing with rotating
cise and effective procedure for a successful out·
instruments. the clinician should use the multiplier
come. There are several step-by-step approaches to
torque at the lowest multiplication level and a
tooth preparation that are designed to simpliy tooth
working force of 30 g. The aim is to make the sur
reduction,
faces smoother and more uniform. Any attempt to
nique,J8 Mclean's reduction of half of the tooth at a
including Stei n's guide-groove tech
modify the shape of the prepared tooth would gen
time,J and Martignoni and Schonenberger's slant·
erate excessive heat and damage the pulp. The
cutting method.J9 Regardless of the technique, the
authors use a fine-grit bur (30 �m) to finish the axial
clinician must always keep anatomic references in
walls and the finish line (Fig 3-23). To make the fin
mind and control the tooth reduction through an
ish line more regular. the authors use rounded chis
awareness of the bur's diameter and the quantity of
els with suitable shapes and diameters (Fig 3-24).
dental matter being removed.
FIG 3-18
FIG 3-19
Knowing the amount of material to remove is possible by using a silicone index with a shore hard
SYSTEMATIZED TOOTH PREPARATION
ness of 85 to 90 (Zetalabor, Zhermack).•0 A silicone index is made on a diagnostic cast or waxup pre pared in the laboratory. The clinician can use a sili
Tooth preparation is a clinical operation t h a t c a n be
cone index that is properly cut longitudinally, hori
carried out successfully.J7 provided the clinician
zontally, or serially (depending on the practical
�
FIG 3-20
FIG 3-21
FIG 3-22
Fig l-18 At high magnification. the rough surface of the tooth prepared with the 1 80-�m-grit bur is evident. ig 3-1 g Note the irregular profile resulting from the use of the 1 80-�m-grit bur. Figs 3-20 Bur in motion with jets of water aimed at the point . F1Q 3-21 8ur that does not provide adequate spray because of clogged or damaged water jets.
Fig 3;22 A worn bur (left) and a new one (right) of identical grit and shape. Coarse-grit burs are particularly subject to wear as d1amond gra1ns tome loose. Fig� 3-23 and 3-24 Prep ared tooth finished with a fine-grit bur and a manual chisel _ rehn1ng the preparat1on.
16
fDM1.
Oeppeler). the ideal instruments for
FIG 3-23
FIG 3-24
CHAPTER 3 Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
4
needs of the operator), to evaluate the tooth prepa
bur to access the entire occlusal surface, including
ration and determine what remains to be done (Figs
the lingual aspect. The object is to prepare the difi
3-25 to 3-28).
cult lingual side with as much precision as the buc
The initial stage of preparation consists of sepa
cal side (Figs 3-33 to 3-36). The authors prefer con
rating the preserved natural dentition from the teeth
ical burs to the barrel contour burs because they are
to be restored by using a thin cylindrical bur and a
more practical and versatile; the barrel contour bur
chamfer with a diameter of 0.10 (6879 - 314 - 010) (Fig
is often incongruent with the occlusal morphology of
3-29). Special care must be taken to protect the
the teeth. In the case of incisors and canines. the
interproximal area, preventing any lesions to the
palatal surface is prepared with a football contour
adjacent teeth or gingiva. The gingival reference
bur, using the Mclean techniquel to reduce half of
must never be lost; extending the preparation
the tooth at a time (Figs 3-37 and 3-38).
beyond the gingival margin not only damages the soft tissue, but also loses the positional reference.
two ridges and a groove are sufficient. Excessive sculpting of the occlusal surface could lead to a lack
each clinical stage before proceeding, since each
of correspondence during occlusion. with areas of
stage is preparatory for the next step. An incorrect or
the restoration presenting insufficient thickness.
incomplete procedure would require the operator to
Finally, the clinician may round the palatal and buc
change burs several times to complete the next
cal surfaces for the insertion of the prosthesis, or,
stage, thus disrupting the clinician's concentration.
according to Kuwata's three-plane theory,•' to create
The finish line is repositioned only after the retraction cord (no. ooo or no. oo) has been placed.
face of the middle third of the tooth (Fig 3-30).
The anatomy of the gingiva and the technique of
According to Stein's technique,l8 other grooves
using retraction cords (see chapter 6) determines to
are made on the buccal and palatal surfaces (Fig 3-
what extent the restoration margin can be posi
31) to the desired depth. If the preparation is being
tioned subgingivally. The thickness of the cord deter
made with a so-degree shoulder bur or a chamfer
mines the amount of vertical retraction, and the pre
bur, the depth is half the width of the instrument.
cision of the gingival retraction dictates the subgin
After the first groove is made, the second is pre
gival restoration margin. Once the impression has
pared by leaning on the first guide groove and
been made and the cord has been removed, the gin
matching the inclination of the tooth. The reduction
giva should return to its normal level prior to the
of the tooth surface is then completed according to
insertion of the cord. Gingival retraction gives the clinician access to
procedure results in a uniform reduction of tooth
reposition the finish line to a subgingival level. For
volume and thickness (Fig 3-32).
about a decade, the authors have performed reposi
The clinician reduces the occlusal surface of the
I
shape and thickness (Figs 3-39 to 3-41).
careful to avoid contact with the gingiva or the sur
tooth with a large-diameter, short conical diamond
FIG 3-28
the requi red space for the restoration buildup in
operator places the groove with the bur slanted,
the limits set by the Stein grooves. The controlled
FIG 3-27
The clinician need not reproduce all the crests,
Another important element is the overall efficien
buccal and palatal margins with a guide groove. The
FIG 3-26
grooves, and other features of the occlusal anatomy;
cy of the preparation. The operator should complete
After separation, the clinician must position the
FIG 3-25
tioning using sonic or ultrasonic oscillating instru ments. These nonrotating instruments do not dam- ..
Fig 3-25 Silicone index of a shore hardness of 85 (Zetalaborl made directly on the diagnostic waxup or cast. These functional guides can be sectioned to determine the volumes of the various longitudinal or horizontal planes.
Fig 3-26 1ndex has been sectioned horizontally with cuts at 2-mm intervals. leaving the peripheral portion intact. to help ualyze buccal reduc tion at the apical. middle. and coronal levels. Fig 3-27 Horizontal section of a silicone index. It is possible to make other index sections. for instance. by removing the buccal area entirely but leaving 1 to 2 mm of the incisal area on the buccal side. or by sectioning only the incisal portion. yielding an indirect view of available space.
Fig 3-28 Longitudinal section of a silicone index. Positioned at the midpoint of the tooth. the index provides exact values for the buccal. palatal. and incisal reduction.
"
CHAPTER 3 Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
4
needs of the operator), to evaluate the tooth prepa
bur to access the entire occlusal surface, including
ration and determine what remains to be done (Figs
the lingual aspect. The object is to prepare the difi
3-25 to 3-28).
cult lingual side with as much precision as the buc
The initial stage of preparation consists of sepa
cal side (Figs 3-33 to 3-36). The authors prefer con
rating the preserved natural dentition from the teeth
ical burs to the barrel contour burs because they are
to be restored by using a thin cylindrical bur and a
more practical and versatile; the barrel contour bur
chamfer with a diameter of 0.10 (6879 - 314 - 010) (Fig
is often incongruent with the occlusal morphology of
3-29). Special care must be taken to protect the
the teeth. In the case of incisors and canines. the
interproximal area, preventing any lesions to the
palatal surface is prepared with a football contour
adjacent teeth or gingiva. The gingival reference
bur, using the Mclean techniquel to reduce half of
must never be lost; extending the preparation
the tooth at a time (Figs 3-37 and 3-38).
beyond the gingival margin not only damages the soft tissue, but also loses the positional reference.
two ridges and a groove are sufficient. Excessive sculpting of the occlusal surface could lead to a lack
each clinical stage before proceeding, since each
of correspondence during occlusion. with areas of
stage is preparatory for the next step. An incorrect or
the restoration presenting insufficient thickness.
incomplete procedure would require the operator to
Finally, the clinician may round the palatal and buc
change burs several times to complete the next
cal surfaces for the insertion of the prosthesis, or,
stage, thus disrupting the clinician's concentration.
according to Kuwata's three-plane theory,•' to create
The finish line is repositioned only after the retraction cord (no. ooo or no. oo) has been placed.
face of the middle third of the tooth (Fig 3-30).
The anatomy of the gingiva and the technique of
According to Stein's technique,l8 other grooves
using retraction cords (see chapter 6) determines to
are made on the buccal and palatal surfaces (Fig 3-
what extent the restoration margin can be posi
31) to the desired depth. If the preparation is being
tioned subgingivally. The thickness of the cord deter
made with a so-degree shoulder bur or a chamfer
mines the amount of vertical retraction, and the pre
bur, the depth is half the width of the instrument.
cision of the gingival retraction dictates the subgin
After the first groove is made, the second is pre
gival restoration margin. Once the impression has
pared by leaning on the first guide groove and
been made and the cord has been removed, the gin
matching the inclination of the tooth. The reduction
giva should return to its normal level prior to the
of the tooth surface is then completed according to
insertion of the cord. Gingival retraction gives the clinician access to
procedure results in a uniform reduction of tooth
reposition the finish line to a subgingival level. For
volume and thickness (Fig 3-32).
about a decade, the authors have performed reposi
The clinician reduces the occlusal surface of the
I
shape and thickness (Figs 3-39 to 3-41).
careful to avoid contact with the gingiva or the sur
tooth with a large-diameter, short conical diamond
FIG 3-28
the requi red space for the restoration buildup in
operator places the groove with the bur slanted,
the limits set by the Stein grooves. The controlled
FIG 3-27
The clinician need not reproduce all the crests,
Another important element is the overall efficien
buccal and palatal margins with a guide groove. The
FIG 3-26
grooves, and other features of the occlusal anatomy;
cy of the preparation. The operator should complete
After separation, the clinician must position the
FIG 3-25
tioning using sonic or ultrasonic oscillating instru ments. These nonrotating instruments do not dam- ..
Fig 3-25 Silicone index of a shore hardness of 85 (Zetalaborl made directly on the diagnostic waxup or cast. These functional guides can be sectioned to determine the volumes of the various longitudinal or horizontal planes.
Fig 3-26 1ndex has been sectioned horizontally with cuts at 2-mm intervals. leaving the peripheral portion intact. to help ualyze buccal reduc tion at the apical. middle. and coronal levels. Fig 3-27 Horizontal section of a silicone index. It is possible to make other index sections. for instance. by removing the buccal area entirely but leaving 1 to 2 mm of the incisal area on the buccal side. or by sectioning only the incisal portion. yielding an indirect view of available space.
Fig 3-28 Longitudinal section of a silicone index. Positioned at the midpoint of the tooth. the index provides exact values for the buccal. palatal. and incisal reduction.
"
CHAPTER 3 Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
Fig 3-31 Central buccal reduction grooves as recommended by Stein.31 Knowing the diameter and size of the bur. the amount of the initial reduction can be determined by making vertical notches in the tooth. start1ng from the gu1de groove made previOusly. Fig 3-32 Preparation proceeds to even out the rest of the palatal and buccal surfaces with the reduction grooves. always starting from the guide groove.
Fig 3-33 Reduction of the occlusal surface of the tooth. B y reducing the surface one half at a time. the clinician can visualize the extent of the reduction. Figs 3-34 and 3-35 Note how the occlusal reference points are maintained.
Fig 3-2g Separation of the tooth. Using metal matrices and wooden wedges as separators. care is taken not to impact the integrity of the neigh boring tooth. For this stage. the authors prefer to use a cylindrical bur with a small diameter 10.10 mm) rather than a needle-point bur. which wears down rapidly at the tip and can make the walls too conical. Fig 3-30 A g o-degree guide groove made while keeping the bur in an undercut direction. A chamfer. 50-degree. or round bur could also be used. The purpose of this step is to make a distinct line to mark the start of the preparation so that it is above the gingival margin and not touching the soft tissues. This is done on both the buccal and palatal surfaces. Normally the authors use a modified chamfer bur.
10
Fig 3-36 Barrel contour bur used for the o c clusal reduction. The authors prefer to use a short conical bur with a diameter of 2 . 5 mm.
Figs 3-37 and 3-38 Tooth preparation using football contour burs. The palatal surface of an anterior tooth is prepared with a coarse-grit bur fol lowed by a fine-grit bur. reducing one half of the tooth at a time.
101
CHAPTER 3 Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
Fig 3-31 Central buccal reduction grooves as recommended by Stein.31 Knowing the diameter and size of the bur. the amount of the initial reduction can be determined by making vertical notches in the tooth. start1ng from the gu1de groove made previOusly. Fig 3-32 Preparation proceeds to even out the rest of the palatal and buccal surfaces with the reduction grooves. always starting from the guide groove.
Fig 3-33 Reduction of the occlusal surface of the tooth. B y reducing the surface one half at a time. the clinician can visualize the extent of the reduction. Figs 3-34 and 3-35 Note how the occlusal reference points are maintained.
Fig 3-2g Separation of the tooth. Using metal matrices and wooden wedges as separators. care is taken not to impact the integrity of the neigh boring tooth. For this stage. the authors prefer to use a cylindrical bur with a small diameter 10.10 mm) rather than a needle-point bur. which wears down rapidly at the tip and can make the walls too conical. Fig 3-30 A g o-degree guide groove made while keeping the bur in an undercut direction. A chamfer. 50-degree. or round bur could also be used. The purpose of this step is to make a distinct line to mark the start of the preparation so that it is above the gingival margin and not touching the soft tissues. This is done on both the buccal and palatal surfaces. Normally the authors use a modified chamfer bur.
10
Fig 3-36 Barrel contour bur used for the o c clusal reduction. The authors prefer to use a short conical bur with a diameter of 2 . 5 mm.
Figs 3-37 and 3-38 Tooth preparation using football contour burs. The palatal surface of an anterior tooth is prepared with a coarse-grit bur fol lowed by a fine-grit bur. reducing one half of the tooth at a time.
101
CHAPTER 3 Principles of Preparation for Complete Crowns
�
age gingival tissue and are easier to control, result· ing in a more precise finish line (see chapter s).
preparation (ie, separation, preliminary preparation, and finishing) involves different priorities and foci.
The next stage is finishing, which is performed
A level of concentration (medium, medium-high, or
using fine-grit (Jo �m) diamond burs and roughing
high) can be assigned to each factor of tooth prepa
stones of the same diameter. Roughing stones (sili
ration based on the stage of preparation and the
con carbide and Arkansas). can be modified in shape
objectives (Fig 3-48). During the separation stage,
and size according to the operator's needs (Figs 3-42
concentration must be medium-high with respect to
to 3-44). Perfect shoulder polishing can be achieved
parallelism and medium for the tooth form and the
only through the use of manual chisels of appropri
execution of the finish line. In the primary reduction
ate size and shape. Rounded chisels work via traction
stage, the level of concentration should be high for
in a clockwise and counterclockwise direction and are
parallelism and tooth form and medium-high for the
easy to use, permitting precise completion of the fin·
finish line. In the finishing stage, which is completed
ish line (Figs 3-45 and 3-46).
at low speed, maximum concentration is required for
SELECTIVE CO NCENTRATION
pleting the finish line. Parallelism is already estab
FIG 3-39
FIG 3-40
FIG 3-41
FIG 3-42
FIG 3-43
FIG 3-4
FIG 3-45
FIG 3-46
polishing and finishing of the shoulder and for com lished at this point and requires little attention. In
T h e clinician must set t h e correct handpiece speed
this way, the necessary level of concentration can be
and choose burs with cutting or abrasion properties
focused on the principal objective of each stage,
to best address the specific task at hand and suc
rather than concentrating equally on each factor, at
cessfully complete all stages of tooth preparation (Fig
all times. Selective attention helps the practitioner
3-47). These operating principles require the constant
avoid fatigue and lapses in concentration and con-
focused concentration of the clinician. Each stage of
tributes to the success of tooth preparation.
fig 3-3g Buccal and palatal surfaces are rounded holding the bur at a 45-degree angle to the tooth's longitudinal axis. figs 3-0 and 3-41 Preliminary preparation has provided adequate volume for the restorative materials. Note the presence of rough surfaces and sharp edges. from the occlusal mw. note the favorable spacing of the prepared tooth and the total visi bility of the shoulder mcumference. free of the shaded areas that i n dicate undercuts. fig 3-41 finishing stage of preparation carried out using fine-grit diamond burs or silicon carbide or corundum stones. figs 3-43 and3-44 A clin ician may customize the torm of Arkansas burs by direct abrasion on a stone of greater hardness. adapt _ to match Ing thm shape and me the spaces 1n the finiSh line obtained during preliminary preparation. figs 3;45 and 3-4i The last instrument needed for smoothing the surface is the rounded chisel. which can be used on every sur face 1n a clockwiSe and counterclockwise direction. Note the degree of smoothness on the finish tine obtained through the use of the rounded chiSel.
•
12 tl3
CHAPTER 3 Principles of Preparation for Complete Crowns
�
age gingival tissue and are easier to control, result· ing in a more precise finish line (see chapter s).
preparation (ie, separation, preliminary preparation, and finishing) involves different priorities and foci.
The next stage is finishing, which is performed
A level of concentration (medium, medium-high, or
using fine-grit (Jo �m) diamond burs and roughing
high) can be assigned to each factor of tooth prepa
stones of the same diameter. Roughing stones (sili
ration based on the stage of preparation and the
con carbide and Arkansas). can be modified in shape
objectives (Fig 3-48). During the separation stage,
and size according to the operator's needs (Figs 3-42
concentration must be medium-high with respect to
to 3-44). Perfect shoulder polishing can be achieved
parallelism and medium for the tooth form and the
only through the use of manual chisels of appropri
execution of the finish line. In the primary reduction
ate size and shape. Rounded chisels work via traction
stage, the level of concentration should be high for
in a clockwise and counterclockwise direction and are
parallelism and tooth form and medium-high for the
easy to use, permitting precise completion of the fin·
finish line. In the finishing stage, which is completed
ish line (Figs 3-45 and 3-46).
at low speed, maximum concentration is required for
SELECTIVE CO NCENTRATION
pleting the finish line. Parallelism is already estab
FIG 3-39
FIG 3-40
FIG 3-41
FIG 3-42
FIG 3-43
FIG 3-4
FIG 3-45
FIG 3-46
polishing and finishing of the shoulder and for com lished at this point and requires little attention. In
T h e clinician must set t h e correct handpiece speed
this way, the necessary level of concentration can be
and choose burs with cutting or abrasion properties
focused on the principal objective of each stage,
to best address the specific task at hand and suc
rather than concentrating equally on each factor, at
cessfully complete all stages of tooth preparation (Fig
all times. Selective attention helps the practitioner
3-47). These operating principles require the constant
avoid fatigue and lapses in concentration and con-
focused concentration of the clinician. Each stage of
tributes to the success of tooth preparation.
fig 3-3g Buccal and palatal surfaces are rounded holding the bur at a 45-degree angle to the tooth's longitudinal axis. figs 3-0 and 3-41 Preliminary preparation has provided adequate volume for the restorative materials. Note the presence of rough surfaces and sharp edges. from the occlusal mw. note the favorable spacing of the prepared tooth and the total visi bility of the shoulder mcumference. free of the shaded areas that i n dicate undercuts. fig 3-41 finishing stage of preparation carried out using fine-grit diamond burs or silicon carbide or corundum stones. figs 3-43 and3-44 A clin ician may customize the torm of Arkansas burs by direct abrasion on a stone of greater hardness. adapt _ to match Ing thm shape and me the spaces 1n the finiSh line obtained during preliminary preparation. figs 3;45 and 3-4i The last instrument needed for smoothing the surface is the rounded chisel. which can be used on every sur face 1n a clockwiSe and counterclockwise direction. Note the degree of smoothness on the finish tine obtained through the use of the rounded chiSel.
•
12 tl3
CHAPTER l Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
� '
� t
w 1 ( : ..
Reduct1on
Separation Handptece spud
Level
Handp'ec' speed
l
Level Speed
Speed
$"
F1msh tme
Key
0100
=
=
Fmal flmshmg
Margm repos•t•on1ng
Level
Lew!
+
� NA
NA
0
NA
NA
000
Med1um concentrat•on
00 0I00 0 0
n
Fin i s h i g
0000
L
post lion
-+
$"
1
Form
w 1 ( : ..
=
Med1um-h1gh concentration
High concentration
pOSitiOn
00000
Ultrasonic tnstrument
Some
00000
tnstrument
Rounded ChiSel
NA
0000
Save e n e rgy u s i n g : Fig 3-47 Maxillary premolar and molar prepared for complete crowns. All stages of preparation are complete.
• • •
Clea r o bj ectives
Syst e m a t i c p roce d u re s
S e lective c o n c e n t ra t i o n
Fig 3-48 Diagram illustrating the selective concentration needed during the various stages o f preparation. The objective i s t o avoid fatigue b y focusing on the task at hand requiring the most attention. NA = not applicable.
14
105
CHAPTER l Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
� '
� t
w 1 ( : ..
Reduct1on
Separation Handptece spud
Level
Handp'ec' speed
l
Level Speed
Speed
$"
F1msh tme
Key
0100
=
=
Fmal flmshmg
Margm repos•t•on1ng
Level
Lew!
+
� NA
NA
0
NA
NA
000
Med1um concentrat•on
00 0I00 0 0
n
Fin i s h i g
0000
L
post lion
-+
$"
1
Form
w 1 ( : ..
=
Med1um-h1gh concentration
High concentration
pOSitiOn
00000
Ultrasonic tnstrument
Some
00000
tnstrument
Rounded ChiSel
NA
0000
Save e n e rgy u s i n g : Fig 3-47 Maxillary premolar and molar prepared for complete crowns. All stages of preparation are complete.
• • •
Clea r o bj ectives
Syst e m a t i c p roce d u re s
S e lective c o n c e n t ra t i o n
Fig 3-48 Diagram illustrating the selective concentration needed during the various stages o f preparation. The objective i s t o avoid fatigue b y focusing on the task at hand requiring the most attention. NA = not applicable.
14
105
CHAPTER 3 Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
REFERENCES
12. Lempoel Pi. Snoek PA. van1 Hof M. Lemmens Pl. The
2z. Wiskott HW, Nicholls 11. Belser UC. The efect of tooth
convergence angle of crown preparations with clinically
preparation height and diameter on the resistance of
satisactorv retention [in Dutch[. Ned Tijdschr Tand·
complete crowns to atigue loading. lnt J Prosthodont
diamond burs of diferent grit.
heelkd 1993;100:336-338.
1997;10:207-215.
80:12-19.
1. Kois JC. New paradigms for anterior tooth preparation. Rationale and technique. Oral Health 1998;88:19-30.
32.
Ottl P, Lauer HC. Temperature response in the pulpal chamber during ultrahigh-speed tooth preparation with
I Prosthet Dent 1998;
2. Zanetti AL, engar A. Novelli MD. Lagana DC. Thick·
13. Mou SH. Chai T, Wang )S. Shiau Y. Influence of difer
23. Goodacre CJ. Campagni V, Aquilino SA. Tooth prepa·
ness of the remaining enamel after preparation of cin
ent convergence angles and tooth preparation heights
rations for complete crowns: An art form based on sci
ment of diferent grit on dental hard tissue [in Genman].
I Prosthet Dent
on the internal adaptation of Cerec crowns. J Prosthet
entiic principles. I Prosthet Dent 2001;85:363-376.
Dtsch Stomatal 1991;41:32>-322.
3· Mclean JW. The Science and M of Dental Ceramics.
14. Dodge W. Weed RM. Baez RJ. Buchanan RN. The efect
gulum rest seats on maxillay canines. 1998;8o:31-322.
Chicago: Quintessence. 1979.
of convergence angle on retention and resistance form.
4. Gargiulo AW. Wentz FM. Orban 81. Dimensions and rela· tion of the dentogingival junction in humans. J Peri
mond burs: Heavy·handed or light-touch? I Prosthodont
cago: Quintessence. 1997.
1999:8:39·
ment of temperature change in the pulp chamber dur·
forces at high speed. J Prosthet Dent 2003;89:286-291.
ing cavity preparation. J Prosthet Dent 2004;91:436-440.
crowns to dynamic loading. lnt J Prosthodont 1996;9:
28. Carson J. Rider T, Nash D. A thermographic study of heat
37. Castellani D. La Preparazione dei pilastri per corone in
117-139 ·
ation of resistance form of dislodged crowns and retain ers. J Prosthet Dent 1998;80:405-409.
preparation height on the retention and resistance of gold castings. Gen Dent 1990;38:20>-202.
1993;2:61�6.
mented for dental students and general practitioners.
1
Am Dent
Assoc 1978:97:978980. 21.
1990:63:407-414.
change in the pulp chamber during complete crown preparation. I Prosthet Dent 1991;65:5Ht. 31. Galindo OF, Ercoli C. Funkenbusch PO, et al. Tooth
the resistance form of cast restorations.
pared for atiicial crowns. I Oral Rehabil 1978;5:371-375.
Acta Odontol Scand 1996:54:10-112.
Prosthodont
20. Woolsey GO. atich JA. The efect of axial grooves on
10. Ohm E, Silness J. The convergence angle in teeth pre
U, Hansson . et al. xial wall
1
New guidelines for preparation taper.
Prosthet Dent
30. Laforgia PO, Milano V. Morea C, Desiate A. Temperature
19. Parker MH, Calverley MI. Gardner FM. Gunderson RB.
walls of full veneer crown preparations in a dental
29. Lauer HC, Kraft E. Rothlauf W. Zwingers l Efects of the
ultrahigh-speed tooth preparation. I
metal·ceramica. Bologna: Martina. 1994:207-2o8. 38. Stein RS, Kuwata M. A dentist and a dental technologist
Dent Res 1979;58:1681-1684.
temperature of cooling water during high-speed and
18. Maxwell AW, Blank LW, Pelleu GB Jr. Efect of crown
9· Noonan IE Jr. Goldfogel MH. Convergence of the axial
. Engstrom
distribution during ultra-speed cavity preparation. J
17. Trier AC. Parker MH. Cameron SM. Brousseau JS. Evalu·
criterion for the full veneer crown preparation in pre
convergence of full veneer crown preparations. Docu
25:544-548. 36. Ozturk B, Usumez A. Ozturk AN, Ozer . In vitro assess
27. Elias K, Am is A. Setchell OJ. The magnitude of cutting
tion convergence and retention of extracoronal retain
school environment. J Prosthet Dent 1991;66:70-708.
coolant Row rates and dental cutting. Oper Dent 2000:
between abutment taper and resistance of cemented
7- Wilson AH, Chan DC. The relationship between prepara
clinical prosthodontics. I Prosthodont 1999;8:196-200.
diamond bur grit sizes. J Am Dent Assoc 200;131: 1706-1710.
16. Wiskott HW. Nicholls II, Belser UC. The relationship
convergence angle in cemented veneer crowns. Acta
8. Smith T. Garv 11. Conkin IE. Franks HL Efective taper
34· Siegel SC, Von Fraunhofer JA. Cutting eiciency of three
35· von Fraunhofer )A. Siegel SC. Feldman S. Handpiece
SE. Fundamentals of Fixed Prosthodontics, ed 3· Chi·
6. Jorgensen KD. The relationship between retention and
ers. I Prosthodont 1994;3:74-78.
I Prosthet Dent 2005;
26. Siegel SC, von Fraunhofer JA. Dental cutting with dia·
Omegan 1977;70:62�5.
Odontol Scand 1955;13:35-40.
25. Glossav of Prosthodontic Tenms. 94:192.
Quintessence lnt 1985;16:191-194.
5· Ingber JS, Rose LF, Coslet JG. The "biologic width"-A concept in periodontics and restorative dentistry. Alpha
Prlparationstechnik. Quintessenz 2001;52:873-883.
15. Shillingburg HT. Hobo S. Whitsett LD. Jacobi R, Brackett
odontal 1961;32:261-267.
11. Annerstedt
24. Kimmel K. Veahren und Probleme der oralmedizinischen
Dent 2002;87=24&-255·
33. )ung M, Pantke H . The efect of diamond grinding instru
preparation: A study on the efect of diferent variables and a comparison between conventional and channeled
analyze current ceramo-metal procedures. Dent Clin North Am 1977; 21:729-749. 39- Martignoni M, Schonenberger J. Precision Fixed Pros thodontics: Clinical and Laboratorv Aspects. Chicago; Quintessence, 1989. 40. Magne P, Belser U. Bonded Porcelain Restorations in the Anterior Dentition: A Biomimetic Approach. Berlin: Quintessence, 2002:244-247· 41. Kuwata M. Color Atlas of Ceramo-Metal Technology. St Louis: lshiyaku EuroAmenca, 1986.
diamond burs. J Prosthodont 2004;13:3-16.
Proussaefs P, Campagni W, Bernal G, Goodacre C, Kim J. The efectiveness of auxiliay features on a tooth prepa ration with inadequate resistance form. 2004;91:3)-41.
1
Prosthet Dent
14 107
CHAPTER 3 Tooth Preparation for Complete Crowns
REFERENCES
12. Lempoel Pi. Snoek PA. van1 Hof M. Lemmens Pl. The
2z. Wiskott HW, Nicholls 11. Belser UC. The efect of tooth
convergence angle of crown preparations with clinically
preparation height and diameter on the resistance of
satisactorv retention [in Dutch[. Ned Tijdschr Tand·
complete crowns to atigue loading. lnt J Prosthodont
diamond burs of diferent grit.
heelkd 1993;100:336-338.
1997;10:207-215.
80:12-19.
1. Kois JC. New paradigms for anterior tooth preparation. Rationale and technique. Oral Health 1998;88:19-30.
32.
Ottl P, Lauer HC. Temperature response in the pulpal chamber during ultrahigh-speed tooth preparation with
I Prosthet Dent 1998;
2. Zanetti AL, engar A. Novelli MD. Lagana DC. Thick·
13. Mou SH. Chai T, Wang )S. Shiau Y. Influence of difer
23. Goodacre CJ. Campagni V, Aquilino SA. Tooth prepa·
ness of the remaining enamel after preparation of cin
ent convergence angles and tooth preparation heights
rations for complete crowns: An art form based on sci
ment of diferent grit on dental hard tissue [in Genman].
I Prosthet Dent
on the internal adaptation of Cerec crowns. J Prosthet
entiic principles. I Prosthet Dent 2001;85:363-376.
Dtsch Stomatal 1991;41:32>-322.
3· Mclean JW. The Science and M of Dental Ceramics.
14. Dodge W. Weed RM. Baez RJ. Buchanan RN. The efect
gulum rest seats on maxillay canines. 1998;8o:31-322.
Chicago: Quintessence. 1979.
of convergence angle on retention and resistance form.
4. Gargiulo AW. Wentz FM. Orban 81. Dimensions and rela· tion of the dentogingival junction in humans. J Peri
mond burs: Heavy·handed or light-touch? I Prosthodont
cago: Quintessence. 1997.
1999:8:39·
ment of temperature change in the pulp chamber dur·
forces at high speed. J Prosthet Dent 2003;89:286-291.
ing cavity preparation. J Prosthet Dent 2004;91:436-440.
crowns to dynamic loading. lnt J Prosthodont 1996;9:
28. Carson J. Rider T, Nash D. A thermographic study of heat
37. Castellani D. La Preparazione dei pilastri per corone in
117-139 ·
ation of resistance form of dislodged crowns and retain ers. J Prosthet Dent 1998;80:405-409.
preparation height on the retention and resistance of gold castings. Gen Dent 1990;38:20>-202.
1993;2:61�6.
mented for dental students and general practitioners.
1
Am Dent
Assoc 1978:97:978980. 21.
1990:63:407-414.
change in the pulp chamber during complete crown preparation. I Prosthet Dent 1991;65:5Ht. 31. Galindo OF, Ercoli C. Funkenbusch PO, et al. Tooth
the resistance form of cast restorations.
pared for atiicial crowns. I Oral Rehabil 1978;5:371-375.
Acta Odontol Scand 1996:54:10-112.
Prosthodont
20. Woolsey GO. atich JA. The efect of axial grooves on
10. Ohm E, Silness J. The convergence angle in teeth pre
U, Hansson . et al. xial wall
1
New guidelines for preparation taper.
Prosthet Dent
30. Laforgia PO, Milano V. Morea C, Desiate A. Temperature
19. Parker MH, Calverley MI. Gardner FM. Gunderson RB.
walls of full veneer crown preparations in a dental
29. Lauer HC, Kraft E. Rothlauf W. Zwingers l Efects of the
ultrahigh-speed tooth preparation. I
metal·ceramica. Bologna: Martina. 1994:207-2o8. 38. Stein RS, Kuwata M. A dentist and a dental technologist
Dent Res 1979;58:1681-1684.
temperature of cooling water during high-speed and
18. Maxwell AW, Blank LW, Pelleu GB Jr. Efect of crown
9· Noonan IE Jr. Goldfogel MH. Convergence of the axial
. Engstrom
distribution during ultra-speed cavity preparation. J
17. Trier AC. Parker MH. Cameron SM. Brousseau JS. Evalu·
criterion for the full veneer crown preparation in pre
convergence of full veneer crown preparations. Docu
25:544-548. 36. Ozturk B, Usumez A. Ozturk AN, Ozer . In vitro assess
27. Elias K, Am is A. Setchell OJ. The magnitude of cutting
tion convergence and retention of extracoronal retain
school environment. J Prosthet Dent 1991;66:70-708.
coolant Row rates and dental cutting. Oper Dent 2000:
between abutment taper and resistance of cemented
7- Wilson AH, Chan DC. The relationship between prepara
clinical prosthodontics. I Prosthodont 1999;8:196-200.
diamond bur grit sizes. J Am Dent Assoc 200;131: 1706-1710.
16. Wiskott HW. Nicholls II, Belser UC. The relationship
convergence angle in cemented veneer crowns. Acta
8. Smith T. Garv 11. Conkin IE. Franks HL Efective taper
34· Siegel SC, Von Fraunhofer JA. Cutting eiciency of three
35· von Fraunhofer )A. Siegel SC. Feldman S. Handpiece
SE. Fundamentals of Fixed Prosthodontics, ed 3· Chi·
6. Jorgensen KD. The relationship between retention and
ers. I Prosthodont 1994;3:74-78.
I Prosthet Dent 2005;
26. Siegel SC, von Fraunhofer JA. Dental cutting with dia·
Omegan 1977;70:62�5.
Odontol Scand 1955;13:35-40.
25. Glossav of Prosthodontic Tenms. 94:192.
Quintessence lnt 1985;16:191-194.
5· Ingber JS, Rose LF, Coslet JG. The "biologic width"-A concept in periodontics and restorative dentistry. Alpha
Prlparationstechnik. Quintessenz 2001;52:873-883.
15. Shillingburg HT. Hobo S. Whitsett LD. Jacobi R, Brackett
odontal 1961;32:261-267.
11. Annerstedt
24. Kimmel K. Veahren und Probleme der oralmedizinischen
Dent 2002;87=24&-255·
33. )ung M, Pantke H . The efect of diamond grinding instru
preparation: A study on the efect of diferent variables and a comparison between conventional and channeled
analyze current ceramo-metal procedures. Dent Clin North Am 1977; 21:729-749. 39- Martignoni M, Schonenberger J. Precision Fixed Pros thodontics: Clinical and Laboratorv Aspects. Chicago; Quintessence, 1989. 40. Magne P, Belser U. Bonded Porcelain Restorations in the Anterior Dentition: A Biomimetic Approach. Berlin: Quintessence, 2002:244-247· 41. Kuwata M. Color Atlas of Ceramo-Metal Technology. St Louis: lshiyaku EuroAmenca, 1986.
diamond burs. J Prosthodont 2004;13:3-16.
Proussaefs P, Campagni W, Bernal G, Goodacre C, Kim J. The efectiveness of auxiliay features on a tooth prepa ration with inadequate resistance form. 2004;91:3)-41.
1
Prosthet Dent
14 107
C H A P T E R
4
F INISH L INE DESIGNS F OR C OM PLETE CROWN PRE PARATIONS
A
ccording to Castellani,' the finish line is
addition to the restorative materials, namely the
defined as the border between the intact por
anatomy and tooth position; the number of teeth
tion of the tooth and the most apical point of
involved; the skill, precision. and experience of the
the preparation. The design of the finish line is critical
operator; and the practicality and convenience of the
in preparing complete crowns; it must be well defined.
design (Table 4-1). These criteria force the clinician to
regular, and, above all. well positioned. All of these
make diicult and complicated treatment choices that
properties are heavily inluenced by the accessibility,
are often case specific and require nonroutine and
or depth, of the inish line (igs 4-1 and 4-2).
unfamiliar procedures.l·•
TABLE 4-1 Comparison of restorative fi nish lines and their effects on restoration margin
Level of d i ficulty
Esthetics
Restoration margin
Marginal stress
Indications or contraindications
Feather edge
Easy
Poor
Metal collar
Very high
Indicated for fixed restorations with
Knife edge
Easy
Poor
Metal collar
Very high
intraoperative dental preparation
Type
There are numerous types of finish lines dis Aea inish lines
cussed in the literature, and their use in clinical prac tice depends on dental school curricula' and current
CHARACTERISTICS O F T H E
trends, as well as the kinds of materials used in the
VARIOUS F I N ISH L I N ES
advanced peri-odontal disease;
restoration. In practical terms. the key factors influ encing the design are the restorative material (eg,
The classification of finish lines involves an impor
metal-ceramic, collarless metal-ceramic, all-ceramic).
tant distinction between area and linear finish lines
the type of connection, and the prosthetic treatment
(Figs 4-3 and 4-4). both of which have various con·
plan. It is now common for manufacturers to recom
figurations. Area finish lines are either feather edged
mend a certai n type of finish line for materials with
or knife edged. Linear finish lines are either complex
speciic characteristics.
or simple and have either a shoulder or a chamfer.
The complexity of biomechanics requires advanced
An area finish line does not clearly delineate the
techniques, which also must be carefully considered
end of the prepared area from the intact portion of
when planning the restoration. The selection of a fin
the tooth. These finish lines are oten erroneously
ish line. therefore, depends on several actors in
confused with nonpreparation of a tooth and are .
Rg 4-1 The finish line of the prep ara ti on must be regular. linear. and properly positioned. Preparations for both complete crowns or _inlays depend on the mobohty of the f1nish line. Rg 4-2 finish tine on a stone cast for a gold inlay restoration. This finish line. with an external bevel· a support plane · and an Internal bevel. guarantees the long-term success of the restoration.
Complex linear inish lines Beveled shoulder
Diicult
Poor
Metal collar
Very high
Indicated for multiple connected restorations
Beveled chamfer
Dificult
Poor
Metal collar
Vey high
Indicated for multiple connected restorations
Easy
Moderate
Metal collar
Moderate
Indicated for multiple connected restorations
Simple inish lines so-degree
Classic chamfer
Easy
Moderate
Metal collar
Minimal
Permits a good lit i n cases with buccolingual unevenness; m u ltiple
or micromargin
connected restorations Rounded shoulder
Difficult
Excellent
90-degee
May use all
Minimal
Dificult
Excellent
May use all
Moderate
Easy
Excellent
Optimal lit
Not to be used for multiple connected restorations
materials
shoulder
Not to be used for multiple connected restorations
materials
short chamfer
Modified chamfer
11
or micromargin
shoulder
Minimal
Permits a good fit in cases of
with all
buccolingual unevenness; multiple
materials
connected restorations
C H A P T E R
4
F INISH L INE DESIGNS F OR C OM PLETE CROWN PRE PARATIONS
A
ccording to Castellani,' the finish line is
addition to the restorative materials, namely the
defined as the border between the intact por
anatomy and tooth position; the number of teeth
tion of the tooth and the most apical point of
involved; the skill, precision. and experience of the
the preparation. The design of the finish line is critical
operator; and the practicality and convenience of the
in preparing complete crowns; it must be well defined.
design (Table 4-1). These criteria force the clinician to
regular, and, above all. well positioned. All of these
make diicult and complicated treatment choices that
properties are heavily inluenced by the accessibility,
are often case specific and require nonroutine and
or depth, of the inish line (igs 4-1 and 4-2).
unfamiliar procedures.l·•
TABLE 4-1 Comparison of restorative fi nish lines and their effects on restoration margin
Level of d i ficulty
Esthetics
Restoration margin
Marginal stress
Indications or contraindications
Feather edge
Easy
Poor
Metal collar
Very high
Indicated for fixed restorations with
Knife edge
Easy
Poor
Metal collar
Very high
intraoperative dental preparation
Type
There are numerous types of finish lines dis Aea inish lines
cussed in the literature, and their use in clinical prac tice depends on dental school curricula' and current
CHARACTERISTICS O F T H E
trends, as well as the kinds of materials used in the
VARIOUS F I N ISH L I N ES
advanced peri-odontal disease;
restoration. In practical terms. the key factors influ encing the design are the restorative material (eg,
The classification of finish lines involves an impor
metal-ceramic, collarless metal-ceramic, all-ceramic).
tant distinction between area and linear finish lines
the type of connection, and the prosthetic treatment
(Figs 4-3 and 4-4). both of which have various con·
plan. It is now common for manufacturers to recom
figurations. Area finish lines are either feather edged
mend a certai n type of finish line for materials with
or knife edged. Linear finish lines are either complex
speciic characteristics.
or simple and have either a shoulder or a chamfer.
The complexity of biomechanics requires advanced
An area finish line does not clearly delineate the
techniques, which also must be carefully considered
end of the prepared area from the intact portion of
when planning the restoration. The selection of a fin
the tooth. These finish lines are oten erroneously
ish line. therefore, depends on several actors in
confused with nonpreparation of a tooth and are .
Rg 4-1 The finish line of the prep ara ti on must be regular. linear. and properly positioned. Preparations for both complete crowns or _inlays depend on the mobohty of the f1nish line. Rg 4-2 finish tine on a stone cast for a gold inlay restoration. This finish line. with an external bevel· a support plane · and an Internal bevel. guarantees the long-term success of the restoration.
Complex linear inish lines Beveled shoulder
Diicult
Poor
Metal collar
Very high
Indicated for multiple connected restorations
Beveled chamfer
Dificult
Poor
Metal collar
Vey high
Indicated for multiple connected restorations
Easy
Moderate
Metal collar
Moderate
Indicated for multiple connected restorations
Simple inish lines so-degree
Classic chamfer
Easy
Moderate
Metal collar
Minimal
Permits a good lit i n cases with buccolingual unevenness; m u ltiple
or micromargin
connected restorations Rounded shoulder
Difficult
Excellent
90-degee
May use all
Minimal
Dificult
Excellent
May use all
Moderate
Easy
Excellent
Optimal lit
Not to be used for multiple connected restorations
materials
shoulder
Not to be used for multiple connected restorations
materials
short chamfer
Modified chamfer
11
or micromargin
shoulder
Minimal
Permits a good fit in cases of
with all
buccolingual unevenness; multiple
materials
connected restorations
CHAPtER 4 Fin1sh Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
A R E A A N D L I N E A R F I N ISH L I N ES
Figs 4-3 and 4-4 Two principal types of f1nish line, linear I Fig 4-1 and area I Fig 4-4). Tooth preparation with a linear finish line ends on a distinct line for its entire circumference. An area finish adapts the tooth preparation to the entire surface rather than to an exact li ne .
..commonly found under old fixed dental restorations.
subject to distortion and tension.s However, area in
Although feather and knife edges are valid finish
ish lines are sometimes the best clinical solution dur
lines that require the removal of dental tissue and
ing the surgical stage for cases of advanced peri
the definition of form and volume, they are used
odontal disease that require a fixed dental prosthe
less frequently in current clinical practice. It is the
sis.6 Area inish lines may also be useful for con
authors' opinion, however, that a mediocre area fin
necting several restorative crowns together to stabi
ish line is preferable to a mediocre linear inish line.
lize dental movement in the presence of signiicant
With an area finish line (Fig 4-5), the marginal seal
ly reduced periodontal support.7 In �uch a situation,
will be more sure, whereas an inadequate linear fin
it would be impossible to splint many crowns pre
ish line inevitably produces a significant gap at the
pared, for example, with a shoulder design because
restoration margin (Fig 4-6).
of the lack of space between the tooth abutments
The main problem with area finish lines is that,
during the laboratory work and because of a prob
given the preparation space and the thickness of re
lem with the angles and planes. Although area finish
storative materials, they are suitable only for crowns
lines yield good marginal adaptation, the authors
with metal collars. furthermore, the thickness of the
prefer, even in such a case, to perform seconday
restorations at the margin does not meet minimum
welds once the margins are closed individually on
recommended values for laboratory procedures,
chamfer, modified chamfer, or other linear finish lines
which may result in a margin that is weak and thus
110
(Figs 4-7 and 4-8).8.9
Fig 4-5 1ncorrect area finish line. The obvious convexity of this preparation in profile creates an undercut. which presents a drawback for both adaptation and insertion of the prosthesis.
.
Fig4-6 Evident gap from the matching of an inadequate linear finish line to an ill-fitting metal margin. The same error for an area fin ish line is more acceptable because the seal covers an entire area of the surface instead of just a line. Figs 4-7 and 4-8 Clinical case of a patient with advanced periodontal disease and considerable buccal flaring of the teeth. The teeth were realigned through orthodontic and periodontal treatment and required a fixed prosthesis. The treatment aimed to cause u lit tle damage to the pulp as possible. Ceramic crowns were made individually and united using secondary welds i n three sections equipped with interlock devices. The area for the secondary weld was prepared by the dental technician along with the waxing of the framework and ceramic coating of the connections. The welding was completed only after the ceramic was applied.
1t1
CHAPtER 4 Fin1sh Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
A R E A A N D L I N E A R F I N ISH L I N ES
Figs 4-3 and 4-4 Two principal types of f1nish line, linear I Fig 4-1 and area I Fig 4-4). Tooth preparation with a linear finish line ends on a distinct line for its entire circumference. An area finish adapts the tooth preparation to the entire surface rather than to an exact li ne .
..commonly found under old fixed dental restorations.
subject to distortion and tension.s However, area in
Although feather and knife edges are valid finish
ish lines are sometimes the best clinical solution dur
lines that require the removal of dental tissue and
ing the surgical stage for cases of advanced peri
the definition of form and volume, they are used
odontal disease that require a fixed dental prosthe
less frequently in current clinical practice. It is the
sis.6 Area inish lines may also be useful for con
authors' opinion, however, that a mediocre area fin
necting several restorative crowns together to stabi
ish line is preferable to a mediocre linear inish line.
lize dental movement in the presence of signiicant
With an area finish line (Fig 4-5), the marginal seal
ly reduced periodontal support.7 In �uch a situation,
will be more sure, whereas an inadequate linear fin
it would be impossible to splint many crowns pre
ish line inevitably produces a significant gap at the
pared, for example, with a shoulder design because
restoration margin (Fig 4-6).
of the lack of space between the tooth abutments
The main problem with area finish lines is that,
during the laboratory work and because of a prob
given the preparation space and the thickness of re
lem with the angles and planes. Although area finish
storative materials, they are suitable only for crowns
lines yield good marginal adaptation, the authors
with metal collars. furthermore, the thickness of the
prefer, even in such a case, to perform seconday
restorations at the margin does not meet minimum
welds once the margins are closed individually on
recommended values for laboratory procedures,
chamfer, modified chamfer, or other linear finish lines
which may result in a margin that is weak and thus
110
(Figs 4-7 and 4-8).8.9
Fig 4-5 1ncorrect area finish line. The obvious convexity of this preparation in profile creates an undercut. which presents a drawback for both adaptation and insertion of the prosthesis.
.
Fig4-6 Evident gap from the matching of an inadequate linear finish line to an ill-fitting metal margin. The same error for an area fin ish line is more acceptable because the seal covers an entire area of the surface instead of just a line. Figs 4-7 and 4-8 Clinical case of a patient with advanced periodontal disease and considerable buccal flaring of the teeth. The teeth were realigned through orthodontic and periodontal treatment and required a fixed prosthesis. The treatment aimed to cause u lit tle damage to the pulp as possible. Ceramic crowns were made individually and united using secondary welds i n three sections equipped with interlock devices. The area for the secondary weld was prepared by the dental technician along with the waxing of the framework and ceramic coating of the connections. The welding was completed only after the ceramic was applied.
1t1
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
�
Area finish lines
occlusal force. The authors avoid this type of finish
Area finish lines (Fig 4-9 to 4-11), both feather- and
vanced periodontal disease, finish lines that include
knife-edged, offer several advantages clinically and in
a minimal angle to properly support the restorative
the laboratory. The angle between the axial wall and
materials.
line when possible, preferring, even in cases of ad
the radicular wall is near or slightly less than 180 degrees. Clinicians distinguish between a feather edge,
Linear finish lines
with an angle of approximately 180 degrees, and a knife edge, with an angle slightly less than 180
The following distinctions can be made between
degrees. Area finish lines are relatively easy to com
preparations with a linear finish lines. Complex linear
plete because the operator does not have to focus on
finish lines have a beveled shoulder or a beveled
creating a distinct linear finish line, thus reducing the
chamfer. Simple linear finish lines have a so- or 135-
clinician's stress and fatigue. However, circular and
degree shoulder, a classic chamfer, a rounded shoul
rotational movements and the use of small-diameter
der, a 90-degree shoulder, or a modified chamfer.
burs should be avoided during the preparation to
112
prevent irregular surfaces, conical tooth preparations,
Complex, Beveled chamfer and beveled shoulder
or overheating of the pulp.
Although complex finish lines require the formation of
The area inish line is indicated for fixed dental
an angle, they are addressed first because their bevel
restorations i n periodontal cases, for intraoperative
is, in some ways, similar to the area finish lines. The
dental preparation, and for multiple fixed restora
beveled chamfer inish line is often cited i n the liter
tions. It is the authors' belief that because of modern
ature but rarely used in clinical practice. Given its
implant technology, full-mouth fixed restorations
similarity to the beveled shoulder design, it will be
should be avoided, and instead connecting and link
included in the analysis of the beveled shoulder.
ing should take place for partial segments. This has
The beveled shoulder finish line is complex be
clear advantages for precision in all operative stages,
cause the design is obtained through the intersection
not least in the cementation stage.
of two lines, but this finish line provides no clear
FIG 4-10
FIG 4-9
FIG 4-1 1
Fig 4- g Cross section o f a tooth preparation with a n area finish line. The near absence o f a definitive line permits a strong seal at the restoration margin.
Fig 4-10 Area finish line completed with a flame-shaped bur. I n the authors' view. the shape of this bur i s wrong for creating an area finish line. Fig 4-11 Use of a large-diameter conical cham fe r b u r i s generally recommended for area finish lines.
�
years of experience. This finish line reduces the
gina I adaptation. Bevels with angles greater than 70
amount of exposed cement. which would seem to
degrees require edges so thin that the stability can
Area inish lines also have several disadvantages.
advantage over less dificult designs (Fig 4-12). The
indicate a better marginal seal."·" On the other
not be checked during the working stages. and any
Excellent esthetics are unlikely to result from an area
beveled shoulder can be accomplished in two ways.
hand, a finish line with an internal angle close to 90
openings or distortions i n the restorative margins
inish line because the thin area of support at the fin
In one case, the entire preparation is executed using
degrees could impede the normal cement flow,
cannot be corrected in subsequent stages. Moreover,
ish line is insuicient for ceramic material, with or
a 90-degree bur, and, after the shoulder is made, the
especially under conditions of abnormal fluidity,'J
such edges lose their shape during laboratory pro
without metal margins. Therefore, a metallic border of
exterior finish line is rounded off until the desired
and result in occlusal lifting.
cedures or because of occlusal force.8
significant height is needed, making the cervical area
bevel is formed (Figs 4-13 and 4-14). The other tech
One possible advantage of the bevel is that it
less esthetic. Horizontally, the space is too limited to
Another point made in the literature' in fa vor of
nique involves first designing the finish line with a
could be used i n conjunction with the shoulder to
beveled finish lines is the possibility of burnishing
ofer proper support for any restorative material
long chamfer (this will later constitute the bevel), and
because of the minimal angle that is created with the
combine the benefits of a greater support area of
the margin a fter cementation by using rotating burs
then using a 90-degree bur to execute the shoulder
axial wall. The stress that is distributed to this finish
the shoulder and the ferrule efect of the bevel.
at low speed. The authors believe that, from a prac
in the internal portion of the chamfer (Fig 4-15).
According to Mclean and Wilson,'4 however, the
tical standpoint, this is impossible because of the
line exceeds that of other types of finish lines'0 and
In analyzing the advantages of this finish line, the
results in distortion of the thin metal at the margin of
angle of the bevel must be at least 45 degrees to
subgingival extension of the restoration margins and
authors find it impossible to confine their discussion
the restoration during iring or when subjected to
obtain the retention and ferrule efects. but only
the likelihood of damaging the metallic margins.
to theoretical concepts without drawing upon their ..
bevels with more than 70 degrees improve the mar-
..
113
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
�
Area finish lines
occlusal force. The authors avoid this type of finish
Area finish lines (Fig 4-9 to 4-11), both feather- and
vanced periodontal disease, finish lines that include
knife-edged, offer several advantages clinically and in
a minimal angle to properly support the restorative
the laboratory. The angle between the axial wall and
materials.
line when possible, preferring, even in cases of ad
the radicular wall is near or slightly less than 180 degrees. Clinicians distinguish between a feather edge,
Linear finish lines
with an angle of approximately 180 degrees, and a knife edge, with an angle slightly less than 180
The following distinctions can be made between
degrees. Area finish lines are relatively easy to com
preparations with a linear finish lines. Complex linear
plete because the operator does not have to focus on
finish lines have a beveled shoulder or a beveled
creating a distinct linear finish line, thus reducing the
chamfer. Simple linear finish lines have a so- or 135-
clinician's stress and fatigue. However, circular and
degree shoulder, a classic chamfer, a rounded shoul
rotational movements and the use of small-diameter
der, a 90-degree shoulder, or a modified chamfer.
burs should be avoided during the preparation to
112
prevent irregular surfaces, conical tooth preparations,
Complex, Beveled chamfer and beveled shoulder
or overheating of the pulp.
Although complex finish lines require the formation of
The area inish line is indicated for fixed dental
an angle, they are addressed first because their bevel
restorations i n periodontal cases, for intraoperative
is, in some ways, similar to the area finish lines. The
dental preparation, and for multiple fixed restora
beveled chamfer inish line is often cited i n the liter
tions. It is the authors' belief that because of modern
ature but rarely used in clinical practice. Given its
implant technology, full-mouth fixed restorations
similarity to the beveled shoulder design, it will be
should be avoided, and instead connecting and link
included in the analysis of the beveled shoulder.
ing should take place for partial segments. This has
The beveled shoulder finish line is complex be
clear advantages for precision in all operative stages,
cause the design is obtained through the intersection
not least in the cementation stage.
of two lines, but this finish line provides no clear
FIG 4-10
FIG 4-9
FIG 4-1 1
Fig 4- g Cross section o f a tooth preparation with a n area finish line. The near absence o f a definitive line permits a strong seal at the restoration margin.
Fig 4-10 Area finish line completed with a flame-shaped bur. I n the authors' view. the shape of this bur i s wrong for creating an area finish line. Fig 4-11 Use of a large-diameter conical cham fe r b u r i s generally recommended for area finish lines.
�
years of experience. This finish line reduces the
gina I adaptation. Bevels with angles greater than 70
amount of exposed cement. which would seem to
degrees require edges so thin that the stability can
Area inish lines also have several disadvantages.
advantage over less dificult designs (Fig 4-12). The
indicate a better marginal seal."·" On the other
not be checked during the working stages. and any
Excellent esthetics are unlikely to result from an area
beveled shoulder can be accomplished in two ways.
hand, a finish line with an internal angle close to 90
openings or distortions i n the restorative margins
inish line because the thin area of support at the fin
In one case, the entire preparation is executed using
degrees could impede the normal cement flow,
cannot be corrected in subsequent stages. Moreover,
ish line is insuicient for ceramic material, with or
a 90-degree bur, and, after the shoulder is made, the
especially under conditions of abnormal fluidity,'J
such edges lose their shape during laboratory pro
without metal margins. Therefore, a metallic border of
exterior finish line is rounded off until the desired
and result in occlusal lifting.
cedures or because of occlusal force.8
significant height is needed, making the cervical area
bevel is formed (Figs 4-13 and 4-14). The other tech
One possible advantage of the bevel is that it
less esthetic. Horizontally, the space is too limited to
Another point made in the literature' in fa vor of
nique involves first designing the finish line with a
could be used i n conjunction with the shoulder to
beveled finish lines is the possibility of burnishing
ofer proper support for any restorative material
long chamfer (this will later constitute the bevel), and
because of the minimal angle that is created with the
combine the benefits of a greater support area of
the margin a fter cementation by using rotating burs
then using a 90-degree bur to execute the shoulder
axial wall. The stress that is distributed to this finish
the shoulder and the ferrule efect of the bevel.
at low speed. The authors believe that, from a prac
in the internal portion of the chamfer (Fig 4-15).
According to Mclean and Wilson,'4 however, the
tical standpoint, this is impossible because of the
line exceeds that of other types of finish lines'0 and
In analyzing the advantages of this finish line, the
results in distortion of the thin metal at the margin of
angle of the bevel must be at least 45 degrees to
subgingival extension of the restoration margins and
authors find it impossible to confine their discussion
the restoration during iring or when subjected to
obtain the retention and ferrule efects. but only
the likelihood of damaging the metallic margins.
to theoretical concepts without drawing upon their ..
bevels with more than 70 degrees improve the mar-
..
113
CH�PTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
.
Among the shortcomings of this complex design
tal tissues and enables the clinician to prepare a
is the difficulty of adequately establishing the finish
subgingival margin without retracting the gingiva. For
line, realizing it equally on all sides of the tooth,
cases in which a retraction cord is not used in the
and taking impressions of the bevel. The clinician is
initial stage of preparation, this technique may be
required to use a high degree of concentration to
used to position an intrasulcular restoration margin.
precisely define the position of two lines and the exact spacing between them.
Because more than one third of the longitudinal
The design of the most exterior portion of the fin·
area, this preparation design considerably reduces the surface retention for the crown. The area of the
material. To provide suficient resistance against the
preparation that usually provides the greatest sup
flexure forces that are generated at the margin, it is
port (that is, the area with the largest diameter and
necessary to use a metal edge to seal the margin,
hence the greatest surface area) is very conical in
which provides less than optimal esthetics. More
this design because the finish line develops on a
over, the thin metal edges used with bevels of
slant (Figs 4-17 and 4-18).21 The conical shape makes
angles greater than 70 degrees have a tendency to
this technique unsuitable for teeth of reduced height
lose their shape during laboratory preparation or
but advisable for splinted prostheses connecting
because of the vey high marginal stress during
multiple teeth.
The authors believe that this type of complex fin
In the authors' view, this finish line represents an evolutionary step, in esthetic terms, from area finish
ish line is now obsolete because it is difficult to
lines. Nonetheless, the so- and 135-degree shoul
master, requires considerable dexterity and concen
ders are outdated because they do not provide a
tration and does not provide the benefits it was
suficient zone of support for newer esthetic restora
designed to furnish.'S-18 Moreover, most patients con
tion materials with ceramic margins (Fig 4-19).
sider the visible metal margin unesthetic.
·.
axis of the prepared tooth consists of the finish line
ish line provides insuficient support for all-ceramic
occlusion.8
\
For this design, the best esthetic results can be achieved with the ceramic micromargin, a restora
Simple: 50- and 1 35-degree shoulder
tion margin of metal that is coated in an opaque
The 50- and 135-degree shoulders are simple finish
material and then layered in ceramic. This complex
lines. They are based on the plane of reference used
technique requires the use of a microscope in the
to measure the size of the angle, either the hori
laboratoy and a dental technician who has experi
zontal or longitudinal axis of the toothl4-t9 (Fig 4-16).
ence working at high magnification. All three types
The popularity of this type of finish line during the
of restorative materials are used in this margin, pro
198os and 1990s is largely due to the studies con
viding the advantages of a metal closure and con
ducted by Kuwatas and by Martignoni and Shonen
ventional cementation along with the esthetics of a
berger20 as well as its intrinsic simplicity.
ceramic margin. The greatest problem is how to fit
Visibility while working with the bur is excellent.
the three materials in such a small space; it is
The clinician may immediately determine the final
almost impossible without resorting to horizontal
angle and shape of the preparation by using half the
contours, although these are of limited extension
diameter of the instrument, held vetically. The bur's
and are clinically insignificant if reduced correctly.
ig 4-12 Cross section of a tooth prepared with complex beveled shoulder finish line.
Fig 4-13 Thin flame-shaped bur. 2.5 m m long. used to prepare the finish line without interfering with the walls of the tooth preparation itself or with the adjacent tooth. Fig 4-14 Small-diameter football-shaped tungsten carbide bur used to make a shorter. concave bevel. -
Fig 4-15 Beveled shoulder finish line may be completed even after preparation of a long chamfer by shifting the shoulder internally with degree bur.
1
90-
pointed shape causes minimal damage to periodon-
114 115
CH�PTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
.
Among the shortcomings of this complex design
tal tissues and enables the clinician to prepare a
is the difficulty of adequately establishing the finish
subgingival margin without retracting the gingiva. For
line, realizing it equally on all sides of the tooth,
cases in which a retraction cord is not used in the
and taking impressions of the bevel. The clinician is
initial stage of preparation, this technique may be
required to use a high degree of concentration to
used to position an intrasulcular restoration margin.
precisely define the position of two lines and the exact spacing between them.
Because more than one third of the longitudinal
The design of the most exterior portion of the fin·
area, this preparation design considerably reduces the surface retention for the crown. The area of the
material. To provide suficient resistance against the
preparation that usually provides the greatest sup
flexure forces that are generated at the margin, it is
port (that is, the area with the largest diameter and
necessary to use a metal edge to seal the margin,
hence the greatest surface area) is very conical in
which provides less than optimal esthetics. More
this design because the finish line develops on a
over, the thin metal edges used with bevels of
slant (Figs 4-17 and 4-18).21 The conical shape makes
angles greater than 70 degrees have a tendency to
this technique unsuitable for teeth of reduced height
lose their shape during laboratory preparation or
but advisable for splinted prostheses connecting
because of the vey high marginal stress during
multiple teeth.
The authors believe that this type of complex fin
In the authors' view, this finish line represents an evolutionary step, in esthetic terms, from area finish
ish line is now obsolete because it is difficult to
lines. Nonetheless, the so- and 135-degree shoul
master, requires considerable dexterity and concen
ders are outdated because they do not provide a
tration and does not provide the benefits it was
suficient zone of support for newer esthetic restora
designed to furnish.'S-18 Moreover, most patients con
tion materials with ceramic margins (Fig 4-19).
sider the visible metal margin unesthetic.
·.
axis of the prepared tooth consists of the finish line
ish line provides insuficient support for all-ceramic
occlusion.8
\
For this design, the best esthetic results can be achieved with the ceramic micromargin, a restora
Simple: 50- and 1 35-degree shoulder
tion margin of metal that is coated in an opaque
The 50- and 135-degree shoulders are simple finish
material and then layered in ceramic. This complex
lines. They are based on the plane of reference used
technique requires the use of a microscope in the
to measure the size of the angle, either the hori
laboratoy and a dental technician who has experi
zontal or longitudinal axis of the toothl4-t9 (Fig 4-16).
ence working at high magnification. All three types
The popularity of this type of finish line during the
of restorative materials are used in this margin, pro
198os and 1990s is largely due to the studies con
viding the advantages of a metal closure and con
ducted by Kuwatas and by Martignoni and Shonen
ventional cementation along with the esthetics of a
berger20 as well as its intrinsic simplicity.
ceramic margin. The greatest problem is how to fit
Visibility while working with the bur is excellent.
the three materials in such a small space; it is
The clinician may immediately determine the final
almost impossible without resorting to horizontal
angle and shape of the preparation by using half the
contours, although these are of limited extension
diameter of the instrument, held vetically. The bur's
and are clinically insignificant if reduced correctly.
ig 4-12 Cross section of a tooth prepared with complex beveled shoulder finish line.
Fig 4-13 Thin flame-shaped bur. 2.5 m m long. used to prepare the finish line without interfering with the walls of the tooth preparation itself or with the adjacent tooth. Fig 4-14 Small-diameter football-shaped tungsten carbide bur used to make a shorter. concave bevel. -
Fig 4-15 Beveled shoulder finish line may be completed even after preparation of a long chamfer by shifting the shoulder internally with degree bur.
1
90-
pointed shape causes minimal damage to periodon-
114 115
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
Taking an impression of the finish line contours
it is decidedly m o re versatile than both and less de
The classic chamfer is a finish line that generally
palatal levels, which is accentuated in natural teeth,
is also difficult. A shoulder finish line with an under·
manding of the clinician's effort and time (Fig 4-40).
exploits the absence of a sharp internal angle and is
make it impossible to achieve exact adaptation with
lying "horizontal plate" design may stress the im
To execute a modified chamfer, the clinician may
defined as long or short, according to the degree of
this design.
pression material's resistance to tearing when the
use half the diameter of the diamond bur to mea
impression is removed from the mouth. Therefore, it
sure the reduction, keeping the finish line a s close
. Simple. Classtc chamfer
.
shoulders and the differences in the buccal and
concavity in the preparation (Fig 4-20). This design
The popularity of this finish line is driven by
is easy to execute, in practical clinical terms, and
patients' continuing demand for improved esthetics.
is more dificult to make a clear impression with an
as possible to the center of the bur (Fig 4-41). This
can be adapted to various restoration scenarios
The drive for esthetics has resulted in widespread
intact tooth structure beyond the finish line, com
design may be used for various restorative materi
(Figs 4-21 to 4-23). The classic chamfer is ideal for
use of all-ceramic crowns and the popularity of
pared with a more vertical or a slanted finish line
als, and it leaves the type of margin open to decision
teeth with substantial differences in buccal and lin
implant-supported prostheses, which have greatly
design.
at any stage of treatment, even after the i m p ression
gual levels or multiple connected restorations. The
improved the esthetics of restorative solutions for
restoration margins endure reduced stress because
the edentulous. For these reasons, especially i n
S i m ple: 90-degree shoulder
applicable to any type of restoration margin. With
the occlusal force is more evenly distributed over
recent years, restorations have become more depen·
The last of the common finish lines is the go-degree
the proper area of support executed by the clinician,
has been made. This finish line is thus u niversally
the entire restoration. The finish line cannot take a
dent on adhesives rather than metal structural sup
shoulder (Figs 4-33 to 4-3s). Though still discussed,
this design can accept all-ceramic crowns, metal
collarless metal-ceramic restoration but works with a
ports. Clinicians now use porcelain laminate veneers
the 90-degree shoulder finish line has been sup
ceramic crowns, collarless metal-ceramic, or metal
metal margin or micromargin. However, the dental
or all-ceramic crowns on nonvital teeth reconstruct
planted by the rounded shoulder design for practi
ceramic crowns with a metallic margin or micromar
technician has difficulty controlling the stability of
ed with fiberglass dowels. For larger edentulous
cal and ergonomic reasons. Moreover, the diamond
gin (Figs 4-42 to 4-44).
the metal, resulting in frequent distortions during
areas, small fixed partial dentures are being made
at the vey tip of the new bur is the first to be dis
The micromargin may be used because clinicians
firing.22
using the collarless technique" or with a structure
lodged during the rotating impact, thus impeding
have found that a so-degree bur is the least dam aging to the periodontal tissues during the defini
This preparation has many of the same charac
of nonmetallic materials. With ample support at the
the formation of a sharp angle (Figs 4-36 and 4-37).
teristics as the so-degree finish line, as well as some
marginal level, the clinician may use all-ceramic
However, this design is still used when the clinical
tion of the finish line and permits a restoration at
improvements owing to the concave design. This dif
restorations with this finish line. Feldspathic ce
crown of a short tooth cannot be surgically length
the critical angleS where metal, opaque, and ceram
ference allots more space for the restorative materi
ramic crowns impart the most esthetically pleasing
ened or orthodontically extruded. In such a case, the
ic layers meet. In addition to the esthetic problems
als and improves the esthetics. However, the greater
effect, but crowns with an alumina core or pressable
90-degree shoulder is the only finish line that per
related to the limited space available for the ceram
lateral or external extension of the rotation of the
ceramic crowns ofer better function, especially ater
mits maximum surface retention. This finish line is
ic, described earlier, the authors believe that an
diamond bur causes slightly more damage to the
cementation, combined with long-term resistance to
also frequently used for ceramic inlay preparations
angle of this size does not have room for adequate
gingival tissue.
occlusal force (Figs 4-29 and 4-30).
(Figs 4-38 and 4-39). Although clinicians no longer
metal material. If the metal is not sufficient, the den
For the clinician, this design is not easy to exe
use this design for complete crown restorations, any
tal technician will ace problems of instability during
Simple: Short chamfer or rounded shoulder
cute. The center of the rounded bur is difficult to
clinician doing prosthetic work would be advised to
the various firing cycles and a margin design that
Deepening the chamfer by using a more rounded
identify, and, because measurment is compromised,
become familiar with it and learn how to position
cannot absorb the tensions caused by the crystal
point produces a short chamfer or rounded shoulder
excessive abrasion along the axial surface can result
and finish this well-defined finish line.
lattice of the alloy.'4
finish line, which is currently the design most fre
in weakened areas that lack support and give an
quently used in US dental schools' (Figs 4-24 to
undesirable curl to the finish line (Figs 4-31 and
Simple: Modified chamfer
adaptation, Massironi et at'S perfected a technique known as the counter-chamfer that involves increas
To stabilize the metal during iring for a precise
4-28). The short chamfer finish line is a modern
4-32). This obstacle creates considerable difficulty,
The design known as the modied chamfer was
version of the long chamfer, developed to meet de
sometimes preventing the dental technician from
created to provide adequate space for all kinds of
ing the thickness of the metal used for the restora
mands for better esthetics at the expense of some
producing a precise prosthesis. Above all, the pres
restorations and to leave the decision of the restora
tion margin, which is a medium title, 54% gold
functional features. The shot chamfer creates greater
ence of a curl creates a fragile area in the margin,
tion margin open at every stage of treatment.'l The
(BegoStar, Bego), creating a slightly convex shape.
difficulties in connecting several crowns and in using
which may break during use and can even lead to
modified chamfer finish line is described as a long
While this technique works admirably to increase
certain metal alloys. In cases where several prepared
secondary caries.
chamfer combined with a rounded shoulder, though
the stability of the metal, it further reduces the ..
teeth are connected, the presence of numerous flat
..
111 117
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
Taking an impression of the finish line contours
it is decidedly m o re versatile than both and less de
The classic chamfer is a finish line that generally
palatal levels, which is accentuated in natural teeth,
is also difficult. A shoulder finish line with an under·
manding of the clinician's effort and time (Fig 4-40).
exploits the absence of a sharp internal angle and is
make it impossible to achieve exact adaptation with
lying "horizontal plate" design may stress the im
To execute a modified chamfer, the clinician may
defined as long or short, according to the degree of
this design.
pression material's resistance to tearing when the
use half the diameter of the diamond bur to mea
impression is removed from the mouth. Therefore, it
sure the reduction, keeping the finish line a s close
. Simple. Classtc chamfer
.
shoulders and the differences in the buccal and
concavity in the preparation (Fig 4-20). This design
The popularity of this finish line is driven by
is easy to execute, in practical clinical terms, and
patients' continuing demand for improved esthetics.
is more dificult to make a clear impression with an
as possible to the center of the bur (Fig 4-41). This
can be adapted to various restoration scenarios
The drive for esthetics has resulted in widespread
intact tooth structure beyond the finish line, com
design may be used for various restorative materi
(Figs 4-21 to 4-23). The classic chamfer is ideal for
use of all-ceramic crowns and the popularity of
pared with a more vertical or a slanted finish line
als, and it leaves the type of margin open to decision
teeth with substantial differences in buccal and lin
implant-supported prostheses, which have greatly
design.
at any stage of treatment, even after the i m p ression
gual levels or multiple connected restorations. The
improved the esthetics of restorative solutions for
restoration margins endure reduced stress because
the edentulous. For these reasons, especially i n
S i m ple: 90-degree shoulder
applicable to any type of restoration margin. With
the occlusal force is more evenly distributed over
recent years, restorations have become more depen·
The last of the common finish lines is the go-degree
the proper area of support executed by the clinician,
has been made. This finish line is thus u niversally
the entire restoration. The finish line cannot take a
dent on adhesives rather than metal structural sup
shoulder (Figs 4-33 to 4-3s). Though still discussed,
this design can accept all-ceramic crowns, metal
collarless metal-ceramic restoration but works with a
ports. Clinicians now use porcelain laminate veneers
the 90-degree shoulder finish line has been sup
ceramic crowns, collarless metal-ceramic, or metal
metal margin or micromargin. However, the dental
or all-ceramic crowns on nonvital teeth reconstruct
planted by the rounded shoulder design for practi
ceramic crowns with a metallic margin or micromar
technician has difficulty controlling the stability of
ed with fiberglass dowels. For larger edentulous
cal and ergonomic reasons. Moreover, the diamond
gin (Figs 4-42 to 4-44).
the metal, resulting in frequent distortions during
areas, small fixed partial dentures are being made
at the vey tip of the new bur is the first to be dis
The micromargin may be used because clinicians
firing.22
using the collarless technique" or with a structure
lodged during the rotating impact, thus impeding
have found that a so-degree bur is the least dam aging to the periodontal tissues during the defini
This preparation has many of the same charac
of nonmetallic materials. With ample support at the
the formation of a sharp angle (Figs 4-36 and 4-37).
teristics as the so-degree finish line, as well as some
marginal level, the clinician may use all-ceramic
However, this design is still used when the clinical
tion of the finish line and permits a restoration at
improvements owing to the concave design. This dif
restorations with this finish line. Feldspathic ce
crown of a short tooth cannot be surgically length
the critical angleS where metal, opaque, and ceram
ference allots more space for the restorative materi
ramic crowns impart the most esthetically pleasing
ened or orthodontically extruded. In such a case, the
ic layers meet. In addition to the esthetic problems
als and improves the esthetics. However, the greater
effect, but crowns with an alumina core or pressable
90-degree shoulder is the only finish line that per
related to the limited space available for the ceram
lateral or external extension of the rotation of the
ceramic crowns ofer better function, especially ater
mits maximum surface retention. This finish line is
ic, described earlier, the authors believe that an
diamond bur causes slightly more damage to the
cementation, combined with long-term resistance to
also frequently used for ceramic inlay preparations
angle of this size does not have room for adequate
gingival tissue.
occlusal force (Figs 4-29 and 4-30).
(Figs 4-38 and 4-39). Although clinicians no longer
metal material. If the metal is not sufficient, the den
For the clinician, this design is not easy to exe
use this design for complete crown restorations, any
tal technician will ace problems of instability during
Simple: Short chamfer or rounded shoulder
cute. The center of the rounded bur is difficult to
clinician doing prosthetic work would be advised to
the various firing cycles and a margin design that
Deepening the chamfer by using a more rounded
identify, and, because measurment is compromised,
become familiar with it and learn how to position
cannot absorb the tensions caused by the crystal
point produces a short chamfer or rounded shoulder
excessive abrasion along the axial surface can result
and finish this well-defined finish line.
lattice of the alloy.'4
finish line, which is currently the design most fre
in weakened areas that lack support and give an
quently used in US dental schools' (Figs 4-24 to
undesirable curl to the finish line (Figs 4-31 and
Simple: Modified chamfer
adaptation, Massironi et at'S perfected a technique known as the counter-chamfer that involves increas
To stabilize the metal during iring for a precise
4-28). The short chamfer finish line is a modern
4-32). This obstacle creates considerable difficulty,
The design known as the modied chamfer was
version of the long chamfer, developed to meet de
sometimes preventing the dental technician from
created to provide adequate space for all kinds of
ing the thickness of the metal used for the restora
mands for better esthetics at the expense of some
producing a precise prosthesis. Above all, the pres
restorations and to leave the decision of the restora
tion margin, which is a medium title, 54% gold
functional features. The shot chamfer creates greater
ence of a curl creates a fragile area in the margin,
tion margin open at every stage of treatment.'l The
(BegoStar, Bego), creating a slightly convex shape.
difficulties in connecting several crowns and in using
which may break during use and can even lead to
modified chamfer finish line is described as a long
While this technique works admirably to increase
certain metal alloys. In cases where several prepared
secondary caries.
chamfer combined with a rounded shoulder, though
the stability of the metal, it further reduces the ..
teeth are connected, the presence of numerous flat
..
111 117
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
TOOTH METHACRY LATE RESIN
Fig 4-16 Cross section of a 50-degree shoulder. Fig 4-17 Coarse-grit bur used to create a 50-degree shoulder on an extracted tooth.
Fig 4-18 Fine-grit bur used to create a 50-degree shoulder on an extracted tooth. This design exhibits low retention. The use of collarless metal-ceramic restorative materials is impossible. Fig 4-1 g A cross section of a 50-degree shoulder photographed through the microscope under polarized light. The preparation records the negative image of the bur used to abrade the tooth.
118
Fig 4-20 Cross section showing the slight concavity of the classic long chamfer design. which permits better esthetics than the 50-degree shoulder design. Figs 4-21 and 4-22 Coarse- and fine-grit round burs. used for preliminary preparation and finishing, respectively. of the classic chamfer. Fig 4-23 Cross section of a metal-ceramic restoration with a long chamfer design.
119
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
TOOTH METHACRY LATE RESIN
Fig 4-16 Cross section of a 50-degree shoulder. Fig 4-17 Coarse-grit bur used to create a 50-degree shoulder on an extracted tooth.
Fig 4-18 Fine-grit bur used to create a 50-degree shoulder on an extracted tooth. This design exhibits low retention. The use of collarless metal-ceramic restorative materials is impossible. Fig 4-1 g A cross section of a 50-degree shoulder photographed through the microscope under polarized light. The preparation records the negative image of the bur used to abrade the tooth.
118
Fig 4-20 Cross section showing the slight concavity of the classic long chamfer design. which permits better esthetics than the 50-degree shoulder design. Figs 4-21 and 4-22 Coarse- and fine-grit round burs. used for preliminary preparation and finishing, respectively. of the classic chamfer. Fig 4-23 Cross section of a metal-ceramic restoration with a long chamfer design.
119
I CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
\
i
I
Fig 4-24 Rounded burs in coarse and fine grit and in 0.14- and 0.1 6-mm diameters. used for the shoulder design. Figs 4-15 o. 4-18 Different diameters are � sed for the interproximal spaces and for the palatal and buccal areas. and different grits are used . for prellmmary reductiOn and for fmosh1ng. The short chamfer or rounded shoulder finish line produces the ideal support for feldspathic ceramic and all-ceramic restorations.
10
Figs 4-19 and 4-30 Frontal and sagittal views of a prepared central incisor. The spatial proportions of the tooth are maintained by removing an adequate amount of tooth from the correct areas. The different positions of the buccal and palatal shoulders result from the natural differ ence in levels.
Figs 4-31 and 4-31 Excessive longitudinal abrasion of the bur and the loss of a measurement reference can result i n a curled finish line design that can not be adequately supported and is likely lo break under occlusal force. lt is also difficult for a dental technician lo fabricate a restoration for this type of incorrect finish line preparation.
121
I CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
\
i
I
Fig 4-24 Rounded burs in coarse and fine grit and in 0.14- and 0.1 6-mm diameters. used for the shoulder design. Figs 4-15 o. 4-18 Different diameters are � sed for the interproximal spaces and for the palatal and buccal areas. and different grits are used . for prellmmary reductiOn and for fmosh1ng. The short chamfer or rounded shoulder finish line produces the ideal support for feldspathic ceramic and all-ceramic restorations.
10
Figs 4-19 and 4-30 Frontal and sagittal views of a prepared central incisor. The spatial proportions of the tooth are maintained by removing an adequate amount of tooth from the correct areas. The different positions of the buccal and palatal shoulders result from the natural differ ence in levels.
Figs 4-31 and 4-31 Excessive longitudinal abrasion of the bur and the loss of a measurement reference can result i n a curled finish line design that can not be adequately supported and is likely lo break under occlusal force. lt is also difficult for a dental technician lo fabricate a restoration for this type of incorrect finish line preparation.
121
CHAPil ' Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
Fig 4-33 Simple 90-degree shoulder finish line. This design provides support for maximum esthetics and retention. Figs 4-4 and 4-35 Buccal and palatal views of a 90-degree shoulder.
Figs 4-36 and 4-37 Cross section of a tooth illustrating the proximity of the prepared area to the pulp chamber. AI higher magnification. it is pos.s1ble to see the slight round1ng of the Internal angle. which occurs because the diamond on the very tip of the bur tends to come loose rapidly.
12
Figs 4-38 and 4-39 Ninety-degree shoulder design could be ideal for preparations with little retention. for extrasulcular preparations. a n d for restorations using ceramic or resin composite onlays.
Fig 4-40 Cross section of a tooth prepared with a modified chamfer design. Fig 4-41 Preparation of a modified chamfer finish line. The clinician must keep the bur in contact with the surface being prepared. along the lon gitudinal axis of the tooth. When working on long or surgically lengthened teeth. the finish line looks like a small or mini chamfer. whereas for short teeth or to address esthetic concerns. the modified chamfer looks like a rounded-off shoulder.
12]
CHAPil ' Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
Fig 4-33 Simple 90-degree shoulder finish line. This design provides support for maximum esthetics and retention. Figs 4-4 and 4-35 Buccal and palatal views of a 90-degree shoulder.
Figs 4-36 and 4-37 Cross section of a tooth illustrating the proximity of the prepared area to the pulp chamber. AI higher magnification. it is pos.s1ble to see the slight round1ng of the Internal angle. which occurs because the diamond on the very tip of the bur tends to come loose rapidly.
12
Figs 4-38 and 4-39 Ninety-degree shoulder design could be ideal for preparations with little retention. for extrasulcular preparations. a n d for restorations using ceramic or resin composite onlays.
Fig 4-40 Cross section of a tooth prepared with a modified chamfer design. Fig 4-41 Preparation of a modified chamfer finish line. The clinician must keep the bur in contact with the surface being prepared. along the lon gitudinal axis of the tooth. When working on long or surgically lengthened teeth. the finish line looks like a small or mini chamfer. whereas for short teeth or to address esthetic concerns. the modified chamfer looks like a rounded-off shoulder.
12]
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
MODIFIED
CHAMFER
P R E P A R AT I O N
SYSTEM
Modified chamfer design
Figs 4-42 o 4-4 Modified chamfer is versatile and can be adapted to all kinds of restoration margins, all-ceramic (Fig 4-42!. ceramic shoul der. metallic margin (Fig 4-43). and metal-ceramic micromargin (Fig 4-44).
.. amount of space available for the esthetic material.
and 0.18 mm. Each group includes a coarse-grit (180
Therefore, a new chamfer finish line that is close to
�m) bur with a so-degree point and two modified
6o degrees has been designed, answering the need
chamfer burs of varying grits, one coarse (180 �m)
for a greater area of support for both all-ceramic and
and one fine (jo �m) (Figs 4·47 and 4-48).
metal-ceramic materials (Figs 4·4S and 4-46).
The clinician must be able to keep half of the bur in sight to define the depth and location of the fin·
Assembled preparaion
124
kis
ish line. A so-degree point diamond bur is the best
An assembled preparation kit is a procedure system
instrument for tracing the guide groove (Figs 4-49
that has instruments divided into various shapes and
and 4·so). The guide groove may also be made using
diameters for the different stages in the preparation
the modified chamfer bur.
of the finish line: guide groove creation, peripheral
In the preliminary preparation stage immediately
delimitation, and margin inishing. It is composed of
following the placement of the guide groove, the
groups of three burs with diameters of 0.14, 0.16,
clinician uses a coarse-grit modified chamfer bur to .
Fig 4-45 Counter-chamfer technique permits increased support provided by the thicker metal in the marginal area. with increased stability of the metal during firing. but reduces the space for the ceramic layer.
Fig 4-46 Modified chamfer design has an angle of roughly 60 degrees and provides better esthetics in the marginal area even if the thickness of the metal is increased from the counter-chamfer.
125
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
MODIFIED
CHAMFER
P R E P A R AT I O N
SYSTEM
Modified chamfer design
Figs 4-42 o 4-4 Modified chamfer is versatile and can be adapted to all kinds of restoration margins, all-ceramic (Fig 4-42!. ceramic shoul der. metallic margin (Fig 4-43). and metal-ceramic micromargin (Fig 4-44).
.. amount of space available for the esthetic material.
and 0.18 mm. Each group includes a coarse-grit (180
Therefore, a new chamfer finish line that is close to
�m) bur with a so-degree point and two modified
6o degrees has been designed, answering the need
chamfer burs of varying grits, one coarse (180 �m)
for a greater area of support for both all-ceramic and
and one fine (jo �m) (Figs 4·47 and 4-48).
metal-ceramic materials (Figs 4·4S and 4-46).
The clinician must be able to keep half of the bur in sight to define the depth and location of the fin·
Assembled preparaion
124
kis
ish line. A so-degree point diamond bur is the best
An assembled preparation kit is a procedure system
instrument for tracing the guide groove (Figs 4-49
that has instruments divided into various shapes and
and 4·so). The guide groove may also be made using
diameters for the different stages in the preparation
the modified chamfer bur.
of the finish line: guide groove creation, peripheral
In the preliminary preparation stage immediately
delimitation, and margin inishing. It is composed of
following the placement of the guide groove, the
groups of three burs with diameters of 0.14, 0.16,
clinician uses a coarse-grit modified chamfer bur to .
Fig 4-45 Counter-chamfer technique permits increased support provided by the thicker metal in the marginal area. with increased stability of the metal during firing. but reduces the space for the ceramic layer.
Fig 4-46 Modified chamfer design has an angle of roughly 60 degrees and provides better esthetics in the marginal area even if the thickness of the metal is increased from the counter-chamfer.
125
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
�
create the peripheral outline of the preparation, cor
The complete preparation system is also avail
recting the initial angle (Figs 4-51 and 4-52) without
able in a cylindrical version (kit TD 1272, Komet, by
altering the apical level of the finish line. The clini
D. Massironi), which contains nine burs and is used
cian then finishes the prepared tooth using a fine
most frequently in preparations involving a single·
grit bur of the same shape and diameter as the pre
unit restoration or small fixed partial dentures,
vious one (Rgs 4-53 and 4-54).
where there is little space for instruments of various
The modified chamfer system preparation includes
diameters (Figs 4-60 to 4·7!l - For more extensive
a kit and two oscillating tips: the ultrasonic point kit
cases with multiple preparations or restorations for
(with two points, 0.14 and 0.16) (TO 1073A Komet
patients who have undergone crown-lengthening
with EMS instrument device) and the sonic point kit
surgery, there is a conical version (kit TD 86o,
(with two points, 0.14 and 0.16) (SF 979 Kava with
Komet, by D. Massironi). This kit, which contains six
soninex instrument) (Rg 4-55). There are also two
burs, can be very useful in helping the clinician
rounded chisels, 0.14 and 0.16 mm in diameter, for
achieve ideal parallelism between the tooth prepa
manual use (DM1 and DM2, Deppeler) (Figs 4- 56 and
rations because of a 3-degree conicity and a diame
4-57). The shapes and diameters of the chisels cor
ter that is the same as the cylindrical burs (0.16 to
respond to those of the modified chamfer burs and
0.18 mm) (Rgs 4-72 to 4-80).
are specifically designed for completing the finish
The modified chamfer kit is a procedure system' l-28
line. They can be used in a clockwise or (by invert
comprising a limited number of burs specific to pre
ing the handpiece) counterclockwise direction (Rgs
paring a modified chamfer finish line. The burs can
4-58 and 4-59). The chisels have a contra-angle
not be used for occlusal reduction, palatal reduction,
design that allows the user to employ the instru
or separation, which considerably limits the cost of
ment in all areas of the preparation, provided the
the kit while still providing for the practical needs
cutting edge is kept against the shoulder, in con
and creativity of the clinician (Fig 4-81).
junction with the longitudinal axis of the tooth. This
As stated earlier, the great advantage of this fin
also allows the operator to check for undercuts.
ish line design lies in its versatility, which allows it
Rnishing the prepared tooth with a properly pol
to be applied to almost every clinical situation and
ished surface is critical for making accurate impres
with diferent types of margins, including the metal
sions. If the preparation is excessively rough, the
impression materials may tear.'6
collar (oten used in laboratory cases), metal micro margin coated in ceramic, collarless, and all-ceramic restorations (Rgs 4-82 to 4-15 7).
..
Figs 4-47 and 4-48 Procedure systems provide the clinician with appropriate working tools. thus reducing stress a n d working times. The prepa ration kit includes nine points. including two rounded chisels and two types of oscillating devices !sonic and ultrasonic). Rgs 4-4g and 4-50 Fifty-degree bur used for initial reduction. The pointed tip permits a clear view of the working area. It also causes less damage to marginal gingiva. as can be seen in the magnified view. Figs4-51 and 4-52 After the guide groove is prepared. the SO-degree shoulder !see Fig 4-46. fixed points A and 8) is rectified with a modified chamfer diamond bur tFig 4-52). thus delimiting the periphery and the shoulders final shape.
16
127
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
�
create the peripheral outline of the preparation, cor
The complete preparation system is also avail
recting the initial angle (Figs 4-51 and 4-52) without
able in a cylindrical version (kit TD 1272, Komet, by
altering the apical level of the finish line. The clini
D. Massironi), which contains nine burs and is used
cian then finishes the prepared tooth using a fine
most frequently in preparations involving a single·
grit bur of the same shape and diameter as the pre
unit restoration or small fixed partial dentures,
vious one (Rgs 4-53 and 4-54).
where there is little space for instruments of various
The modified chamfer system preparation includes
diameters (Figs 4-60 to 4·7!l - For more extensive
a kit and two oscillating tips: the ultrasonic point kit
cases with multiple preparations or restorations for
(with two points, 0.14 and 0.16) (TO 1073A Komet
patients who have undergone crown-lengthening
with EMS instrument device) and the sonic point kit
surgery, there is a conical version (kit TD 86o,
(with two points, 0.14 and 0.16) (SF 979 Kava with
Komet, by D. Massironi). This kit, which contains six
soninex instrument) (Rg 4-55). There are also two
burs, can be very useful in helping the clinician
rounded chisels, 0.14 and 0.16 mm in diameter, for
achieve ideal parallelism between the tooth prepa
manual use (DM1 and DM2, Deppeler) (Figs 4- 56 and
rations because of a 3-degree conicity and a diame
4-57). The shapes and diameters of the chisels cor
ter that is the same as the cylindrical burs (0.16 to
respond to those of the modified chamfer burs and
0.18 mm) (Rgs 4-72 to 4-80).
are specifically designed for completing the finish
The modified chamfer kit is a procedure system' l-28
line. They can be used in a clockwise or (by invert
comprising a limited number of burs specific to pre
ing the handpiece) counterclockwise direction (Rgs
paring a modified chamfer finish line. The burs can
4-58 and 4-59). The chisels have a contra-angle
not be used for occlusal reduction, palatal reduction,
design that allows the user to employ the instru
or separation, which considerably limits the cost of
ment in all areas of the preparation, provided the
the kit while still providing for the practical needs
cutting edge is kept against the shoulder, in con
and creativity of the clinician (Fig 4-81).
junction with the longitudinal axis of the tooth. This
As stated earlier, the great advantage of this fin
also allows the operator to check for undercuts.
ish line design lies in its versatility, which allows it
Rnishing the prepared tooth with a properly pol
to be applied to almost every clinical situation and
ished surface is critical for making accurate impres
with diferent types of margins, including the metal
sions. If the preparation is excessively rough, the
impression materials may tear.'6
collar (oten used in laboratory cases), metal micro margin coated in ceramic, collarless, and all-ceramic restorations (Rgs 4-82 to 4-15 7).
..
Figs 4-47 and 4-48 Procedure systems provide the clinician with appropriate working tools. thus reducing stress a n d working times. The prepa ration kit includes nine points. including two rounded chisels and two types of oscillating devices !sonic and ultrasonic). Rgs 4-4g and 4-50 Fifty-degree bur used for initial reduction. The pointed tip permits a clear view of the working area. It also causes less damage to marginal gingiva. as can be seen in the magnified view. Figs4-51 and 4-52 After the guide groove is prepared. the SO-degree shoulder !see Fig 4-46. fixed points A and 8) is rectified with a modified chamfer diamond bur tFig 4-52). thus delimiting the periphery and the shoulders final shape.
16
127
CHAPTER Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
Rg 4-53 Bur in motion. about to modify a line traced earlier by the 50-degree bur. Rg 4-54 The preparation is finished with a fine-grit dia mond bur. Rg 4-55 Diamond- coated tips with a modified chamfer shape are powered by sonic and ultrasonic oscillating instruments. They can be used to reposition and complete the finish line without rotating movements. thus causing no damage to the gingiva. Rg 4-56 Manual round ed chosels for f1nosh1ng IDMl and DMZI. w1th shapes and diameters to match the rotating burs. The rounded chisels can work on all sides of the tooth preparations beca � se they are angled so that they can be held in the ideal positions for working in traction movement. The blades are also contra-angled. wh1ch perm1ts the�r use even 1n interproximal and other inaccessible areas. Rg 4-57 Note the congruity of shape between the rotat1ng bur and the chos � l. Rg 4-58 During completion of the finish line. the chisel must be held against the axis of the tooth. espwally to check for undercuts or 1rregulant1es 1n the preparation. Rg 4-59 Excellent finish denoting a well-controlled reduction of the prosthetic plane. 128
Rg 4-60 Clinical case of a z g -year-old woman who presented with a metal-ceramic crown on the maxillary right central incisor. three endodontically treated teeth. and numerous composite restorations. Rg 4-61 Treatment plan in cluded re-treatment of the canals and prepros thetic reconstruction with gold posts and cores. The posts and cores have been cemented. Rg 4-62 After an i mpression was taken in elas tomeric material. a master cast was fabricated in epoxy resin. Rg 4-63 High magnification reveals the shoulder obtained from a modified chamfer design. There is ample support for all-ceramic or metal-ceramic crowns.Rg 4-64 Four metallic frameworks obtained by means of 540. of gold and palladium alloy with a micromargin. Rg 4-65 After the opaque layer is brushed on. space remains for the entire margin to be covered by the esthetic ceramic material.
19
CHAPTER Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
Rg 4-53 Bur in motion. about to modify a line traced earlier by the 50-degree bur. Rg 4-54 The preparation is finished with a fine-grit dia mond bur. Rg 4-55 Diamond- coated tips with a modified chamfer shape are powered by sonic and ultrasonic oscillating instruments. They can be used to reposition and complete the finish line without rotating movements. thus causing no damage to the gingiva. Rg 4-56 Manual round ed chosels for f1nosh1ng IDMl and DMZI. w1th shapes and diameters to match the rotating burs. The rounded chisels can work on all sides of the tooth preparations beca � se they are angled so that they can be held in the ideal positions for working in traction movement. The blades are also contra-angled. wh1ch perm1ts the�r use even 1n interproximal and other inaccessible areas. Rg 4-57 Note the congruity of shape between the rotat1ng bur and the chos � l. Rg 4-58 During completion of the finish line. the chisel must be held against the axis of the tooth. espwally to check for undercuts or 1rregulant1es 1n the preparation. Rg 4-59 Excellent finish denoting a well-controlled reduction of the prosthetic plane. 128
Rg 4-60 Clinical case of a z g -year-old woman who presented with a metal-ceramic crown on the maxillary right central incisor. three endodontically treated teeth. and numerous composite restorations. Rg 4-61 Treatment plan in cluded re-treatment of the canals and prepros thetic reconstruction with gold posts and cores. The posts and cores have been cemented. Rg 4-62 After an i mpression was taken in elas tomeric material. a master cast was fabricated in epoxy resin. Rg 4-63 High magnification reveals the shoulder obtained from a modified chamfer design. There is ample support for all-ceramic or metal-ceramic crowns.Rg 4-64 Four metallic frameworks obtained by means of 540. of gold and palladium alloy with a micromargin. Rg 4-65 After the opaque layer is brushed on. space remains for the entire margin to be covered by the esthetic ceramic material.
19
Figs 4-66 o 4-68 Metal-ceramic restorations with micromargins. The esthetic result is excellent. especially considering that these are porte lain-fused-to-metal crowns with a metal margin.
Figs 4-69 o 4-71 Detail of the gingival margin. evaluated through a stereomicroscope. Note the integration of the restorations and the soft tis sues. as well as the healthy gingival margin.
10
Figs 4-66 o 4-68 Metal-ceramic restorations with micromargins. The esthetic result is excellent. especially considering that these are porte lain-fused-to-metal crowns with a metal margin.
Figs 4-69 o 4-71 Detail of the gingival margin. evaluated through a stereomicroscope. Note the integration of the restorations and the soft tis sues. as well as the healthy gingival margin.
10
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
Fig 4-72 Conical abrasive burs. The conical kit (TO 860. conical version) has burs with the same diameters as in the cylindrical version. but a conicity of 3 degrees: therefore. The 0.14 mm point becomes 0.18 mm at the base of the stem. while the 0.18-mm bur becomes 0.23 mm at the base. The use of these burs must be limited to cases involving the restoration of multiple teeth and particularly those with advanced peri odontal disease. The conicity permits the clinician to establish the proper parallelism.
Figs 4-73 and 4-74 Conical diamond held vertically for a good angle of TOC. The clinician must maintain this slant during the operative stage: the wrong slant would create an undesired angle.
1
133
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
Fig 4-72 Conical abrasive burs. The conical kit (TO 860. conical version) has burs with the same diameters as in the cylindrical version. but a conicity of 3 degrees: therefore. The 0.14 mm point becomes 0.18 mm at the base of the stem. while the 0.18-mm bur becomes 0.23 mm at the base. The use of these burs must be limited to cases involving the restoration of multiple teeth and particularly those with advanced peri odontal disease. The conicity permits the clinician to establish the proper parallelism.
Figs 4-73 and 4-74 Conical diamond held vertically for a good angle of TOC. The clinician must maintain this slant during the operative stage: the wrong slant would create an undesired angle.
1
133
l
Fimsh Line Designs for Complete Crown Prepara
fig 4-75 Clinical case of a patient with advanced periodontal disease. The patient has already undergone periodontal surgery. and the teeth are b11ng prepared. Preservation � f the pulp vitality is a fundamental aspect of treatment. Fig 4-76 Development of the correct axis of the pre.parallon for tak1ng the 1mpres11on and f� r 1nsert1ng the prostheses. The original axis of the tooth 11 marked with a permanent marker to facilitate the reduction The 50-degree bur IS used to separate and create the guide groove. (See also figs 4-48 to 4-59 for more detail on the 1n�trumentat1on.l F1g 4-77 f1nal tooth pre � aralions. f1g 4-78 Occlusal view showing good alignment of the tooth preparations along the 1nsertton path. f1gs 4-79 and 4-80 Master cast 1llustrallng the paralleliSm obta1ned with the use of conical burs. The clinician should evaluate the pmllellsm mesiodistally and palatol1ngually Moreover. the ftn11h line shoulder will offer m1n1mal support area. depending on the length of the tooth preparation and the natural ap1cal narrow1ng of the tooth The chamfer will be quite small. even if 1t 1s made with a modified chamfer bur. and support a metal-ceramic restoration w1th a metallic margin 14
Fig 4-81 Master cast of a preparation for a molar executed with conical b u rs. fig 4-82 to 4-119 Schematic illustrations simulating tooth preparation with a modified chamfer finish line. fig 4-82 Facial view of a maxillary central incisor. The clinician separates the interproximal area using a 0.1 0-mm-diameter bur F19 4-83 Cross section of a sagittal view after separation. fig 4-84 Dental structure must be reduced to the purple line to place a metal- ceramic crown The th1ckness required for each sector is 1ndicated with a millimeter grid. Fig 4-85 Proportional relationship of a 50- degree. 0.16-mm. coarse-grtt bur with a tooth. Ftgs 4-86 to 4-88 Creat1on of guide grooves. With the bur held at about a 45-degree angle. the clin1cian creates a gu1de groove in the labiog1ng1val and palatoging1val margin areas. 135
l
Fimsh Line Designs for Complete Crown Prepara
fig 4-75 Clinical case of a patient with advanced periodontal disease. The patient has already undergone periodontal surgery. and the teeth are b11ng prepared. Preservation � f the pulp vitality is a fundamental aspect of treatment. Fig 4-76 Development of the correct axis of the pre.parallon for tak1ng the 1mpres11on and f� r 1nsert1ng the prostheses. The original axis of the tooth 11 marked with a permanent marker to facilitate the reduction The 50-degree bur IS used to separate and create the guide groove. (See also figs 4-48 to 4-59 for more detail on the 1n�trumentat1on.l F1g 4-77 f1nal tooth pre � aralions. f1g 4-78 Occlusal view showing good alignment of the tooth preparations along the 1nsertton path. f1gs 4-79 and 4-80 Master cast 1llustrallng the paralleliSm obta1ned with the use of conical burs. The clinician should evaluate the pmllellsm mesiodistally and palatol1ngually Moreover. the ftn11h line shoulder will offer m1n1mal support area. depending on the length of the tooth preparation and the natural ap1cal narrow1ng of the tooth The chamfer will be quite small. even if 1t 1s made with a modified chamfer bur. and support a metal-ceramic restoration w1th a metallic margin 14
Fig 4-81 Master cast of a preparation for a molar executed with conical b u rs. fig 4-82 to 4-119 Schematic illustrations simulating tooth preparation with a modified chamfer finish line. fig 4-82 Facial view of a maxillary central incisor. The clinician separates the interproximal area using a 0.1 0-mm-diameter bur F19 4-83 Cross section of a sagittal view after separation. fig 4-84 Dental structure must be reduced to the purple line to place a metal- ceramic crown The th1ckness required for each sector is 1ndicated with a millimeter grid. Fig 4-85 Proportional relationship of a 50- degree. 0.16-mm. coarse-grtt bur with a tooth. Ftgs 4-86 to 4-88 Creat1on of guide grooves. With the bur held at about a 45-degree angle. the clin1cian creates a gu1de groove in the labiog1ng1val and palatoging1val margin areas. 135
CH Pl Fimsh Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
Figs4-8g and 4-go Creation of reduction grooves. With the bur held vertically. the clinician places reduction grooves. measuring half the thick ness of the bur. Fig 4-g 1 Frontal view of reduction grooves. Figs 4- g2 and 4-gJ labial reduction. The clinician reduces the tooth. following the lines and extension defined by the reduction grooves.
Fig 4-4 Palatal reduction. The clinician carries out the same reduction on the palatal side. starting from the guide groove area and keeping the point in constant contact with the tooth surface. Fig 4- g5 and 4-g6 Modified chamfer bur with a 0.16 - mm diameter and coarse grit.
16
Fig 4- g7 Labial rounding. The clinician rounds the labial aspect in keeping with the anatomy and profile of the natural tooth. Fig 4- gs Palatal finish line. The clinician corrects the finish line on the palatal aspect.
Figs 4-Qg and 4-100 Using a 0.14-mm bur with coarse grit. the clinician connects the shoulder or buccal guide groove with the palatal guide groove. Fig4-101 1ncisal edge grooves. The clinician reduces the incisal edge by making two notches with the 0 . 1 6 - m m bur to the incisal finish line. Fig 4-102 Frontal view of incisal reduction grooves.
Fig 4-103 Incisal edge reduction. With the extent of reduction established by the grooves. the clinician reduces the entire incisal edge.
7
CH Pl Fimsh Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
Figs4-8g and 4-go Creation of reduction grooves. With the bur held vertically. the clinician places reduction grooves. measuring half the thick ness of the bur. Fig 4-g 1 Frontal view of reduction grooves. Figs 4- g2 and 4-gJ labial reduction. The clinician reduces the tooth. following the lines and extension defined by the reduction grooves.
Fig 4-4 Palatal reduction. The clinician carries out the same reduction on the palatal side. starting from the guide groove area and keeping the point in constant contact with the tooth surface. Fig 4- g5 and 4-g6 Modified chamfer bur with a 0.16 - mm diameter and coarse grit.
16
Fig 4- g7 Labial rounding. The clinician rounds the labial aspect in keeping with the anatomy and profile of the natural tooth. Fig 4- gs Palatal finish line. The clinician corrects the finish line on the palatal aspect.
Figs 4-Qg and 4-100 Using a 0.14-mm bur with coarse grit. the clinician connects the shoulder or buccal guide groove with the palatal guide groove. Fig4-101 1ncisal edge grooves. The clinician reduces the incisal edge by making two notches with the 0 . 1 6 - m m bur to the incisal finish line. Fig 4-102 Frontal view of incisal reduction grooves.
Fig 4-103 Incisal edge reduction. With the extent of reduction established by the grooves. the clinician reduces the entire incisal edge.
7
Fono1h Line Ouignl for Complete Crown Preparatoon•
1
fog 4 14 and 4 lOS CliniCian rtducu hall ol lht eonuvt surface ol lhe ptlalal aru 11 a hmt. u11ng a loolball·shapad bur fogl 4 16 •nd 4 107 F1n1sh1ng slaga Tht cllnomn uau font grot burs w11h the nmt thape and dlameler at In the reduct1on slage fog 4 108 Plaumanl of lht rtlrtcllon cord Tht aua ol lht cord and the uu and type of lmpregnahng toluhon It choun baud on the pero· odonlal blolypt and lha 1mpreulon malerlll uud fog 4 100 Rtpotlllonlng of lht l1nlsh lint Aflor lht huue is rtlrlcltd. lht el1n1cian uus a bur wllh the ume doamtlor and domension as the ont und prnloualy to rtpo1111on lht 11nlsh lint fog 4 110 Conhnull•on of rtp011l10n1ng Tha cllnomn utabllshu lht ntw gongoval morgon. using 0 1 !-mm oscollallng ullrason1c or tonic lnstrumanlt
Il
fogs 4-111 1o 4 113 Repositioning In the onterproxomal area The elonomn repos1toons the finiSh line on the onlorproximal area. using 0 1 4 - m m nonrolatlng s o n i c or ultrasonic instruments F1gs 4-114 10 4-116 Relining of the shoulder finish lone with a manual rounded ch111l F1g 4-117 Finished preparation li the cllnlelan notices a mln1mal homonlal space between the glng1va and the shoulder lln11h line. or a small area ol lhe tooth not prepared thai is not covered by the retraction cord. the Impression can be made. leaving the llrsl cord 1 n place F1g 4-118 II part of the g1nglval margin 1mpedes the acceu of the 1mpreuoon matenal. a second retraction cord 11 Inserted for homonlol retracilon and 11 removed Immediately before lak1ng the impreu1on F1g 4 119 Once a sullable 1mpren1on has been taken. the ciln1clan removu lht retraction cord The g1ng1va w11t return to lht natural level
Fono1h Line Ouignl for Complete Crown Preparatoon•
1
fog 4 14 and 4 lOS CliniCian rtducu hall ol lht eonuvt surface ol lhe ptlalal aru 11 a hmt. u11ng a loolball·shapad bur fogl 4 16 •nd 4 107 F1n1sh1ng slaga Tht cllnomn uau font grot burs w11h the nmt thape and dlameler at In the reduct1on slage fog 4 108 Plaumanl of lht rtlrtcllon cord Tht aua ol lht cord and the uu and type of lmpregnahng toluhon It choun baud on the pero· odonlal blolypt and lha 1mpreulon malerlll uud fog 4 100 Rtpotlllonlng of lht l1nlsh lint Aflor lht huue is rtlrlcltd. lht el1n1cian uus a bur wllh the ume doamtlor and domension as the ont und prnloualy to rtpo1111on lht 11nlsh lint fog 4 110 Conhnull•on of rtp011l10n1ng Tha cllnomn utabllshu lht ntw gongoval morgon. using 0 1 !-mm oscollallng ullrason1c or tonic lnstrumanlt
Il
fogs 4-111 1o 4 113 Repositioning In the onterproxomal area The elonomn repos1toons the finiSh line on the onlorproximal area. using 0 1 4 - m m nonrolatlng s o n i c or ultrasonic instruments F1gs 4-114 10 4-116 Relining of the shoulder finish lone with a manual rounded ch111l F1g 4-117 Finished preparation li the cllnlelan notices a mln1mal homonlal space between the glng1va and the shoulder lln11h line. or a small area ol lhe tooth not prepared thai is not covered by the retraction cord. the Impression can be made. leaving the llrsl cord 1 n place F1g 4-118 II part of the g1nglval margin 1mpedes the acceu of the 1mpreuoon matenal. a second retraction cord 11 Inserted for homonlol retracilon and 11 removed Immediately before lak1ng the impreu1on F1g 4 119 Once a sullable 1mpren1on has been taken. the ciln1clan removu lht retraction cord The g1ng1va w11t return to lht natural level
J
Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparalion
Fig 4-120 Clinical case of a patient who exhiblh severe bruxism. The initial clinical situation shows severe abrasions in the maxillary and mandibular anterior Ieeth. as well as numerous necrotic Ieeth resulting from the progressive wear of the tooth surfaces. F1g4-121 To reestab lish normal occlusion and incre �se vertical height after orlhognalhic treatment with bile raising. the clinician lengthened the clinical crown . and roconloured the bone and g1ng1val marg1ns. Fig 4-122 Changed anatomy and crown exposure after healing period. Fig 4-123 Tooth prepa ration using cylindrical diamond bur kit. The clinician waited 6 months after the surgery for the tissues to heal. The teeth were separated using a 0.16-mm cylindrical bur with a modified chamfer. ThiS bur can also be used to make the guide grooves. Figs 4-124 and 4-125 Creation of a gu1de groon. The guide groove extends to the g1ngiva. By keeping the groove above the sulcus the clinician maintains the gingival ref erence point F1g 4-126 Amount of reduction Is verified using the diameter of the bur.
10
Fig 4-127 Reduction grooves. Fig 4-128 I ncisal reduction. The clinician reduced the incisal edge minimally because it was necessary to increase the vertical height considerably. Fig 4-129 Once the labial portion of the tooth has been prepared. the clinician connects the labial and palatal surfaces through the interproximal area. Figs 4-130 and 4-131 Reducing half of the tooth at a time. This technique is ideal for cir cumstances that preclude the use of simple grooves. lor surfaces thai are not flat. and lor use with curved burs. With half the canine pre pared. the clinician may compare it with the intact half and evaluate the extent of the reduction. Fig 4-132 Completed tooth reduction. I n a patient who exhibits bruxi sm. tooth preparation is principally aimed at providing resistance and function rather than esthetics. Figs 4-133 and 4-136 Repositioning the gingival margins. The clinician inserts the retraction cord and finishes Ieeth with rotating fine-grit burs.
141
J
Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparalion
Fig 4-120 Clinical case of a patient who exhiblh severe bruxism. The initial clinical situation shows severe abrasions in the maxillary and mandibular anterior Ieeth. as well as numerous necrotic Ieeth resulting from the progressive wear of the tooth surfaces. F1g4-121 To reestab lish normal occlusion and incre �se vertical height after orlhognalhic treatment with bile raising. the clinician lengthened the clinical crown . and roconloured the bone and g1ng1val marg1ns. Fig 4-122 Changed anatomy and crown exposure after healing period. Fig 4-123 Tooth prepa ration using cylindrical diamond bur kit. The clinician waited 6 months after the surgery for the tissues to heal. The teeth were separated using a 0.16-mm cylindrical bur with a modified chamfer. ThiS bur can also be used to make the guide grooves. Figs 4-124 and 4-125 Creation of a gu1de groon. The guide groove extends to the g1ngiva. By keeping the groove above the sulcus the clinician maintains the gingival ref erence point F1g 4-126 Amount of reduction Is verified using the diameter of the bur.
10
Fig 4-127 Reduction grooves. Fig 4-128 I ncisal reduction. The clinician reduced the incisal edge minimally because it was necessary to increase the vertical height considerably. Fig 4-129 Once the labial portion of the tooth has been prepared. the clinician connects the labial and palatal surfaces through the interproximal area. Figs 4-130 and 4-131 Reducing half of the tooth at a time. This technique is ideal for cir cumstances that preclude the use of simple grooves. lor surfaces thai are not flat. and lor use with curved burs. With half the canine pre pared. the clinician may compare it with the intact half and evaluate the extent of the reduction. Fig 4-132 Completed tooth reduction. I n a patient who exhibits bruxi sm. tooth preparation is principally aimed at providing resistance and function rather than esthetics. Figs 4-133 and 4-136 Repositioning the gingival margins. The clinician inserts the retraction cord and finishes Ieeth with rotating fine-grit burs.
141
Fimsh Line Des1gns for Complete Crown Preparations
j
4- 1 3 8
4- 1 4 5
Fig 4- 135 CliniCal v1ew before repositioning the finish line with nonrolating instruments. Fig 4-136 Finish with ultrasonic tip. Because ultra SOniC technology IS not based on rotation, it does not damage the periodontal tissue. Fig 4-137 Anterior teeth alter the first stage of prepara tion f1gs 4-138 and 4- 13g Second-stage promional prostheses on the working cast, alter adaptation and positioning in the patient's mouth. _ not accentuated, but th teeth have been elongated according The anlenor gu1de IS to the clinician's instructions. Fig 4-140 Mock-up of � mandibular p �ostheus The mandibular antenor tnth also needed to be lengthened. and ceramic veneers were planned from canine to can1ne Mandibular prostheses were mocked up according to the pretreatment indications.
142
4- 1 4 6
Fig 4-141 Try-in of mock-up. Fig 4-142 Once adapted, the mock-up became the provisional restoration. permitting normal speech and main taining a normal lip line. Fig 4-143 Posterior mandi bular provisional restorations. Once the posterior height was b e determined. the clinician could proceed to adapt the anterior provisional restorations according to the indications. Fig 4-14 Anterior mandibular provision! restora tions adapted to the height of the posterior restorations. Aller the clinician spot etched the center of the teeth with 37% phosphoric acid for 20 seconds, a film of resin bonding solution was applied both on the surface of the prepared tooth and inside the provisional. and then poly merized with light. Provisional porcelain laminate veneers are never composed of single veneers. When a significant amount of dentin is exposed. it is preferable to use a transparent cement (TempBond Clear. Kerr) instead of the bonding solution. Fig 4-145 Finish line analysis on the master cast. The goat lor the laminate veneer preparation is to save as much tissue as possible. Fig 4-146 Feldspathic porcelain laminate veneers on the cast.
13
Fimsh Line Des1gns for Complete Crown Preparations
j
4- 1 3 8
4- 1 4 5
Fig 4- 135 CliniCal v1ew before repositioning the finish line with nonrolating instruments. Fig 4-136 Finish with ultrasonic tip. Because ultra SOniC technology IS not based on rotation, it does not damage the periodontal tissue. Fig 4-137 Anterior teeth alter the first stage of prepara tion f1gs 4-138 and 4- 13g Second-stage promional prostheses on the working cast, alter adaptation and positioning in the patient's mouth. _ not accentuated, but th teeth have been elongated according The anlenor gu1de IS to the clinician's instructions. Fig 4-140 Mock-up of � mandibular p �ostheus The mandibular antenor tnth also needed to be lengthened. and ceramic veneers were planned from canine to can1ne Mandibular prostheses were mocked up according to the pretreatment indications.
142
4- 1 4 6
Fig 4-141 Try-in of mock-up. Fig 4-142 Once adapted, the mock-up became the provisional restoration. permitting normal speech and main taining a normal lip line. Fig 4-143 Posterior mandi bular provisional restorations. Once the posterior height was b e determined. the clinician could proceed to adapt the anterior provisional restorations according to the indications. Fig 4-14 Anterior mandibular provision! restora tions adapted to the height of the posterior restorations. Aller the clinician spot etched the center of the teeth with 37% phosphoric acid for 20 seconds, a film of resin bonding solution was applied both on the surface of the prepared tooth and inside the provisional. and then poly merized with light. Provisional porcelain laminate veneers are never composed of single veneers. When a significant amount of dentin is exposed. it is preferable to use a transparent cement (TempBond Clear. Kerr) instead of the bonding solution. Fig 4-145 Finish line analysis on the master cast. The goat lor the laminate veneer preparation is to save as much tissue as possible. Fig 4-146 Feldspathic porcelain laminate veneers on the cast.
13
Fimsh --.
Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
I
FiQI 4-147 and 4-148 The area is isolated with rubber dam. and the tooth is etched prior to cementation of the veneer. FiQ 4-149 Natural die preparations immediately prior to cementation.
FIQ 4-150 Where possible, the clinician preserved pulp vitality. a prime objective in every treatment.
FIQ 4-151 Occlusal view of the mandibular arch after cementation of the laminate veneers and metal-ceram1c crowns.
Figs 4-154 and 4-155 Clinical situation before and after comp. lete restoration. with increased vertical height. complete crowns. and porcelain laminate veneers. The clinician decided to restore the mandibular anter�or teeth w1th veneers mstead of With complete crowns because of the resistance of adhesion. even with parafunctional activity. and the difficulty of preparing the mandibular incisors for metal-ceramic crowns.
Figs 4-156 and 4-157 Mandibular anterior teeth before and after restoration with porcelain laminate veneers. Note the increased vertical height.
F1QI 4-152 and 4-153 Maxillary anterior restorations after cementation
14
15
Fimsh --.
Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
I
FiQI 4-147 and 4-148 The area is isolated with rubber dam. and the tooth is etched prior to cementation of the veneer. FiQ 4-149 Natural die preparations immediately prior to cementation.
FIQ 4-150 Where possible, the clinician preserved pulp vitality. a prime objective in every treatment.
FIQ 4-151 Occlusal view of the mandibular arch after cementation of the laminate veneers and metal-ceram1c crowns.
Figs 4-154 and 4-155 Clinical situation before and after comp. lete restoration. with increased vertical height. complete crowns. and porcelain laminate veneers. The clinician decided to restore the mandibular anter�or teeth w1th veneers mstead of With complete crowns because of the resistance of adhesion. even with parafunctional activity. and the difficulty of preparing the mandibular incisors for metal-ceramic crowns.
Figs 4-156 and 4-157 Mandibular anterior teeth before and after restoration with porcelain laminate veneers. Note the increased vertical height.
F1QI 4-152 and 4-153 Maxillary anterior restorations after cementation
14
15
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
. AD DITIONAL G U I D ELI N ES FOR TOOTH PREPARAT I O N
With regard to axial reduction, clinicians general· ly believe it should make possible both the devel opment or normal periodontal borders and ade
Clinicians have always debated t h e relative merits o r
quate resistance and esthetics. For metal restor
different finish lines a n d their application t o a variety
ations, a reduction or 0.5 to o.8 mm in the buccal
of clinical situations. One of the criteria for deter·
and lingual surfaces appears to be suficient, while
mining the choice or a specific finish line design is
for both metal-ceramic and all-ceramic crowns, depths
the type or restorative material used, ie, metal,
or 1.0 to 1.5 mm•' are recommended. Occlusal re
metal-ceramic, or all-ceramic.
duction ranges from 2.0 to 2.5 mm, according to the
Long chamfer finish lines are usually used with
thickness or the posterior teeth and the patient's
cast metal crowns; in this kind or restoration, the
age. For all-ceramic restorations, occlusal reductions
reduction depth must be in the range or 0.3 to 0.5
should be about 2.0 mm to develop proper mor
mm, 29 permitting a minimum overall reduction or
phology without endangering the health or the
the tooth.
pulpal tissue.
For metal-ceramic crowns, clinicians have typi·
The recommended values should not be consid
cally used either chamfer, beveled chamfer, shout·
ered absolute; they are merely indications for guid
der, or beveled shoulder finish lines. A number of
ing the clinician in tooth reduction to create suitable
authorsJ>-JJ found no significant diferences in the
space for the restorative materials. The skill and
marginal adaptation or metal-ceramic restorations
ability or the dental technician, the condition or the
with any or these inish lines. Some studiesJ• show
teeth, and the expectations or the patient all influ
that choosing which finish line to use with metal
ence tooth preparation. The silicone guides on the
ceramic crowns should not be based on marginal
diagnostic waxup or the final restoration. when sec·
adaptation but rather on esthetic preferences, ease
tioned, can be useful to provide the clinician with a
or execution, and type or margin Oe. metal, micro
clear view or the amount or available space.
margin, or ceramic).3'
The authors' opinion is that the preparation
The recommended thickness or the finish lines is
phase is the prologue to obtaining excellence in
1.0 to 1.5 mm, the minimum required for resistance
every restorative phase, but many clinicians lack the
and esthetics and the minimum space required for
guidelines for performing these steps Oe. separa
achieving an ideal emergence profile.'l-35 Clinical
tion, reduction, and finishing).
studies, however, show that these values are rarely achieved in clinical practice.J6. J7
4-168) is a workable system that allows greater ease
The modified chamfer preparation (Figs 4-158 to
For all-ceramic crowns, studies have shown either
in obtaining excellent results at diferent stages and
that the chamfer finish line was far less resistant
with varying levels or concentration. It offers an inno
than the 90-degree shoulder,38- 39 or that no signifi
vative design that permits all types or restorations
cant diference was round after adhesive cementa·
(metal, micromargin, and all-ceramic) and every kind
tion.•0 Nevertheless, there is a general concensus
or connection-in the complete arch, with many
that the optimal recommended depth for successful
connected teeth, and or course, in the case or a sin-
all-ceramic crowns is 1 mm.41
gle-unit esthetic crown with feldspathic ceramics.
Figs 4-158 to 4-168 Clinical case illustrating the esthetics obtained with the modified chamfer technique.
Fig4-158 Preoperative view of a 27-year-old female patient with two metal-ceramic crowns on the maxillary left central a n d lateral incisors. The restorations had been placed 1 year earlier. after a traumatic event. Clinical examination revealed, inadequate esthetic result of the two crowns. resin composite restorations on the right central and lateral incisors. and that the teeth were excessively short for a person her age and in relation to the opposing dentition. Fig 4-15g Removal of the fixed dental prostheses revealed discolored and inadequate tooth preparations.
•
Figs 4-160 After the diagnostic waxup was prepared. the clinician replaced the composite restorations and prepared for two veneers.
Fig 4-161 The nonvital teeth were whitened and reconstructed using fiberglass dowels. The finish line for the all-ceramic restorations was prepared using the modified chamfer technique. Care was taken to leave an adequate support for the planned restoration. Figs 4-162 and 4-163 Occlusal view of clinical situation. before and after treatment.
lU
147
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
. AD DITIONAL G U I D ELI N ES FOR TOOTH PREPARAT I O N
With regard to axial reduction, clinicians general· ly believe it should make possible both the devel opment or normal periodontal borders and ade
Clinicians have always debated t h e relative merits o r
quate resistance and esthetics. For metal restor
different finish lines a n d their application t o a variety
ations, a reduction or 0.5 to o.8 mm in the buccal
of clinical situations. One of the criteria for deter·
and lingual surfaces appears to be suficient, while
mining the choice or a specific finish line design is
for both metal-ceramic and all-ceramic crowns, depths
the type or restorative material used, ie, metal,
or 1.0 to 1.5 mm•' are recommended. Occlusal re
metal-ceramic, or all-ceramic.
duction ranges from 2.0 to 2.5 mm, according to the
Long chamfer finish lines are usually used with
thickness or the posterior teeth and the patient's
cast metal crowns; in this kind or restoration, the
age. For all-ceramic restorations, occlusal reductions
reduction depth must be in the range or 0.3 to 0.5
should be about 2.0 mm to develop proper mor
mm, 29 permitting a minimum overall reduction or
phology without endangering the health or the
the tooth.
pulpal tissue.
For metal-ceramic crowns, clinicians have typi·
The recommended values should not be consid
cally used either chamfer, beveled chamfer, shout·
ered absolute; they are merely indications for guid
der, or beveled shoulder finish lines. A number of
ing the clinician in tooth reduction to create suitable
authorsJ>-JJ found no significant diferences in the
space for the restorative materials. The skill and
marginal adaptation or metal-ceramic restorations
ability or the dental technician, the condition or the
with any or these inish lines. Some studiesJ• show
teeth, and the expectations or the patient all influ
that choosing which finish line to use with metal
ence tooth preparation. The silicone guides on the
ceramic crowns should not be based on marginal
diagnostic waxup or the final restoration. when sec·
adaptation but rather on esthetic preferences, ease
tioned, can be useful to provide the clinician with a
or execution, and type or margin Oe. metal, micro
clear view or the amount or available space.
margin, or ceramic).3'
The authors' opinion is that the preparation
The recommended thickness or the finish lines is
phase is the prologue to obtaining excellence in
1.0 to 1.5 mm, the minimum required for resistance
every restorative phase, but many clinicians lack the
and esthetics and the minimum space required for
guidelines for performing these steps Oe. separa
achieving an ideal emergence profile.'l-35 Clinical
tion, reduction, and finishing).
studies, however, show that these values are rarely achieved in clinical practice.J6. J7
4-168) is a workable system that allows greater ease
The modified chamfer preparation (Figs 4-158 to
For all-ceramic crowns, studies have shown either
in obtaining excellent results at diferent stages and
that the chamfer finish line was far less resistant
with varying levels or concentration. It offers an inno
than the 90-degree shoulder,38- 39 or that no signifi
vative design that permits all types or restorations
cant diference was round after adhesive cementa·
(metal, micromargin, and all-ceramic) and every kind
tion.•0 Nevertheless, there is a general concensus
or connection-in the complete arch, with many
that the optimal recommended depth for successful
connected teeth, and or course, in the case or a sin-
all-ceramic crowns is 1 mm.41
gle-unit esthetic crown with feldspathic ceramics.
Figs 4-158 to 4-168 Clinical case illustrating the esthetics obtained with the modified chamfer technique.
Fig4-158 Preoperative view of a 27-year-old female patient with two metal-ceramic crowns on the maxillary left central a n d lateral incisors. The restorations had been placed 1 year earlier. after a traumatic event. Clinical examination revealed, inadequate esthetic result of the two crowns. resin composite restorations on the right central and lateral incisors. and that the teeth were excessively short for a person her age and in relation to the opposing dentition. Fig 4-15g Removal of the fixed dental prostheses revealed discolored and inadequate tooth preparations.
•
Figs 4-160 After the diagnostic waxup was prepared. the clinician replaced the composite restorations and prepared for two veneers.
Fig 4-161 The nonvital teeth were whitened and reconstructed using fiberglass dowels. The finish line for the all-ceramic restorations was prepared using the modified chamfer technique. Care was taken to leave an adequate support for the planned restoration. Figs 4-162 and 4-163 Occlusal view of clinical situation. before and after treatment.
lU
147
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
Figs 4-14 and 4-165 Close-up views 1 month after cementation. showing excellent esthetic integration. The clinician had placed ceramic restorations on the maxillary left central and lateral incisors and porcelain laminate veneers on the maxillary right central and lateral incisors.
11
Fig 4-166 Patient's smile before treatment. figs 4-167 to 4-168 Patient's smile after treatment. showing improved esthetics in terms of the shape and luminosity of the teeth. as welt as an excellent lip line.
149
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
Figs 4-14 and 4-165 Close-up views 1 month after cementation. showing excellent esthetic integration. The clinician had placed ceramic restorations on the maxillary left central and lateral incisors and porcelain laminate veneers on the maxillary right central and lateral incisors.
11
Fig 4-166 Patient's smile before treatment. figs 4-167 to 4-168 Patient's smile after treatment. showing improved esthetics in terms of the shape and luminosity of the teeth. as welt as an excellent lip line.
149
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
12.
REFERENCES
Kashani HG, Khera SC. Gulker lA. The efects of bevel angulation on marginal integrity.
1.
Castellani 0. La Preparazione dei pilastri per corone in metal-ceramica. Bologna: artina, 1994:207-208.
2.
103:882-885. 13.
and occlusal seat of full crown preparations. Dent 1981;45: 138-145· 14.
Kuwata M. Atlante a colon sulla tecnologia
6.
17.
Panno V. Vahidi F, Gulker I, Ghalili KM. Evaluation or
Ramp MH. McCracken MS. Mazar RB. Tooth structure
28.
1 Prosthet Dent 1986:56:655�61.
Mitchell A. Pintado MR, Douglas WH. Nondestructive,
and Bridge Procedures. Amsterdam: Dental Center for
29.
I
JO.
breaking strength of Dicor crowns. lnt J Prosthodont
Hamaguchi H, Cacciatore A, Tueller VM. Marginal distor·
1993;6:28&-290.
Postgraduate Courses. 1985.
tion of the porcelain-bonded-to-metal complete crown: An SEM study. I Prosthet Dent 1982;47:14&-153·
retention of cemented gold castings. J Prosthet Dent 1961;11:487-502.
Change in marginal it as related to margin design. alloy
Martignoni M, Shonenberger AJ. Precision Fixed Pros·
type, and porcelain proximity in porcelain-fused-to·
thodontics: Clinical and Laboratory Aspects. Chicago:
metal restorations.
31.
32.
I
Belser UC, MacEntee Ml, Richter WA. Fit of three
El Ebrashi MK, Craig RG, Peyton FA. Experimental stress
sign in porcelain-fused-to-metal restorations. J Prosthet
electron microscope study.
analysis of dental restorations. Part Ill. The concept of
Dent 1980;43=149-155·
24-29.
Rosner D. Fundion placement and reproduction of bevels for gold castings. I Prosthet Dent 1963;13:116o.
33·
I
Prosthet Dent 1985;53:
Douglas RD. P/bylska M. Predicting porcelain thick· ness required for dental shade matches. I Prosthet Dent 1999;82:143-149·
41.
Stambaugh RV, Wittrock JW. The relationship of the pulp chamber to the extenal surface of the tooth. Dent 1977;37:537-546.
Prosthet Dent 1988;6o:435-439.
porcelain-fused-to-metal designs in vivo: A scanning
tions for collarless metal-ceramic crowns: Hand-planning
40.
Richter·Snapp K. Aquilino SA, Svare CW, Turner KA.
Faucher RR. Nicholls 11. Distortion related to margin de·
22. Zena RB, Khan Z, von Fraunhofer JA. Shoulder prepara·
Bernal G, Jones RM, Brown DT, Munoz A, Goodacre CJ. The efect of inish line m and luting agent on the
Prosthodontics. ed 2. St Louis: Mosby, 1995:137-138,
tients [in German). Parodontol 1990;1:153-164.
geometry of proximal margins. 1 Prosthet Dent 196g;
39·
17o-173. 184-185, 229.
Kauman EG, Coelho DH, Colin L. Factors inluencing
Quintessence, 1990.
thodont 1990:3:241-248.
Prosthet Dent 1999;82:398-409.
Rosenstiel S. Land MF, Fujimoto J. Contemporary Rxed
duced periodontal support in partially edentulous pa·
21.
Doyle MG, Munoz . Goodacre CJ. Friedlander LD, Moore BK. The efect of tooth preparation design on the
2001;85 : 5 75-584.
20.
38.
breaking strength of Dicor crowns: Part 2. tnt J Pros·
in vitro quantification of crown margins. I Prosthet Dent
19.
thodont 1990;3=159-168.
Moschen I, Berger P. Falk M, Horl R. Horle M, Gausch K.
lelism with the use of four tooth preparation methods.
advanced periodontal disease. J Periodontal 1979;50:
22:333-345·
Friedlander LD, Munoz A. Goodacre CJ, Doyle MG,
Comparison of resin-bonded prosthesis groove paral
18. Pameijer JHN. Periodontal and Occlusal Fadors in Crown
Siegel SC, Driscoll CF, Feldman S. Tooth stabilization
37.
the 45·degree labial bevel with a shoulder preparation.
periodontal and prosthetic treatment of patients with
45-76.
IO
1996;75 =40--411.
45-46. 27.
Seymour K, Zou L, Samarawickrama D. Lynch E. Assess·
1993:6:25-30. 16.
ixed partial dentures. Dent Clin North Am 1999:43:
11.
bonded to metal crown preparations. J Prosthet Dent
Mclean JW. Wilson AD. Butt joint versus beveled gold
36.
breaking strength of Dicor crowns: Part t. lnt J Pros·
and splinting before and ater periodontal therapy with
10.
ment of shoulder dimensions and angles of porcelain
and Techniques. Santa Rosa. A: Alto Books, 1990:
Restaurazione Protesica. Verona: Resch, 1993.
79=491-494·
163-169.
9·
Albers H. Impressions: A Text for Selection of Materials
when using self·limiting burs. I Prosthet Dent 1998;
7· Nyman S. lindhe J. A longitudinal study of combined
De Soever lA. Fixed restorations of a dentition with re·
26.
line geometry on the it of crowns. lnt J Prosthodont
Periodontics Restorative Dent 1985;5:52�2.
8.
Chiche GJ. Pinault A. Esthetics of Anterior Fixed Prostho· dontics. Chicago: Quintessence. 1994:86-91, 102-103.
Moore BK. The efect or tooth preparation design on the
Di Febo G. Canevale G, Sterrantino S. Treatment of a case of advanced periodontitis: Clinical procedures uti .. lizing the .combined preparation technique. tnt J
35·
loss apical to preparations for fixed partial dentures
delle
ricostruzioni ceramo-metalliche. Utet t989;2:2 JS-2SO.
principles. I Prosthet Dent 2001;85:363-376.
15. Syu JZ. Byrne G. Laub LW. Land MF. Influence of finish·
lnt 2001;32:603�10. 5.
tions for complete crowns: An art based on scientific
Menghini P, Battaini P. Metallurgia in odontoiatria. Milan:
Massironi D. Battistelli A, Pascetta R. La Precisione Nella
Prosthet
1980:14:239-250.
34· Goodacre CJ, Campagni W, Aquilino SA. Tooth prepara·
25.
margin in metal-ceramic crowns. J Biomed Mater Res
Peon BK, Smales RJ. Assessment of clinical preparations for single gold and ceramometal crowns. Quintessence
I
Massironi D. Battistelli A. Sistema di preparazione per corone complete. Masson Protech 2000;J:JS-47·
Masson. 1997:38-39.
Gavelis JW. Morency JD. Riley ED. Sozio RB. The efect
sign: A dental school survey. I Prosthet Dent 1991;65:
fessionale odontoiatrica. Milan: Masson. 1990:408-4D9. 4-
24.
of various inish line preparations on the marginal seal
Guastamacchia C. Elementi di ergonomia e pratica pro
23.
Dent Assoc 1981;
Butel EM. Campbell JC. DiFiore PM. Crown margin de·
303-305. 3-
I Am
42.
I
Prosthet
AI·Omari WM. AI·Wahadni AM. Convegence angle, occlu· sal reduction. and finish line depth of full·crown prepa· rations made by dental students. Quintessence tnt 2004; 3 5 :287-293·
Byrne G. Influence of finish-line form on crown cemen· tation. lnt I Prosthodont 1992;5:137-144.
as opposed to rotary instrumentation. J Prosthet Dent 1989;62:273-277.
151
CHAPTER 4 Finish Line Designs for Complete Crown Preparations
12.
REFERENCES
Kashani HG, Khera SC. Gulker lA. The efects of bevel angulation on marginal integrity.
1.
Castellani 0. La Preparazione dei pilastri per corone in metal-ceramica. Bologna: artina, 1994:207-208.
2.
103:882-885. 13.
and occlusal seat of full crown preparations. Dent 1981;45: 138-145· 14.
Kuwata M. Atlante a colon sulla tecnologia
6.
17.
Panno V. Vahidi F, Gulker I, Ghalili KM. Evaluation or
Ramp MH. McCracken MS. Mazar RB. Tooth structure
28.
1 Prosthet Dent 1986:56:655�61.
Mitchell A. Pintado MR, Douglas WH. Nondestructive,
and Bridge Procedures. Amsterdam: Dental Center for
29.
I
JO.
breaking strength of Dicor crowns. lnt J Prosthodont
Hamaguchi H, Cacciatore A, Tueller VM. Marginal distor·
1993;6:28&-290.
Postgraduate Courses. 1985.
tion of the porcelain-bonded-to-metal complete crown: An SEM study. I Prosthet Dent 1982;47:14&-153·
retention of cemented gold castings. J Prosthet Dent 1961;11:487-502.
Change in marginal it as related to margin design. alloy
Martignoni M, Shonenberger AJ. Precision Fixed Pros·
type, and porcelain proximity in porcelain-fused-to·
thodontics: Clinical and Laboratory Aspects. Chicago:
metal restorations.
31.
32.
I
Belser UC, MacEntee Ml, Richter WA. Fit of three
El Ebrashi MK, Craig RG, Peyton FA. Experimental stress
sign in porcelain-fused-to-metal restorations. J Prosthet
electron microscope study.
analysis of dental restorations. Part Ill. The concept of
Dent 1980;43=149-155·
24-29.
Rosner D. Fundion placement and reproduction of bevels for gold castings. I Prosthet Dent 1963;13:116o.
33·
I
Prosthet Dent 1985;53:
Douglas RD. P/bylska M. Predicting porcelain thick· ness required for dental shade matches. I Prosthet Dent 1999;82:143-149·
41.
Stambaugh RV, Wittrock JW. The relationship of the pulp chamber to the extenal surface of the tooth. Dent 1977;37:537-546.
Prosthet Dent 1988;6o:435-439.
porcelain-fused-to-metal designs in vivo: A scanning
tions for collarless metal-ceramic crowns: Hand-planning
40.
Richter·Snapp K. Aquilino SA, Svare CW, Turner KA.
Faucher RR. Nicholls 11. Distortion related to margin de·
22. Zena RB, Khan Z, von Fraunhofer JA. Shoulder prepara·
Bernal G, Jones RM, Brown DT, Munoz A, Goodacre CJ. The efect of inish line m and luting agent on the
Prosthodontics. ed 2. St Louis: Mosby, 1995:137-138,
tients [in German). Parodontol 1990;1:153-164.
geometry of proximal margins. 1 Prosthet Dent 196g;
39·
17o-173. 184-185, 229.
Kauman EG, Coelho DH, Colin L. Factors inluencing
Quintessence, 1990.
thodont 1990:3:241-248.
Prosthet Dent 1999;82:398-409.
Rosenstiel S. Land MF, Fujimoto J. Contemporary Rxed
duced periodontal support in partially edentulous pa·
21.
Doyle MG, Munoz . Goodacre CJ. Friedlander LD, Moore BK. The efect of tooth preparation design on the
2001;85 : 5 75-584.
20.
38.
breaking strength of Dicor crowns: Part 2. tnt J Pros·
in vitro quantification of crown margins. I Prosthet Dent
19.
thodont 1990;3=159-168.
Moschen I, Berger P. Falk M, Horl R. Horle M, Gausch K.
lelism with the use of four tooth preparation methods.
advanced periodontal disease. J Periodontal 1979;50:
22:333-345·
Friedlander LD, Munoz A. Goodacre CJ, Doyle MG,
Comparison of resin-bonded prosthesis groove paral
18. Pameijer JHN. Periodontal and Occlusal Fadors in Crown
Siegel SC, Driscoll CF, Feldman S. Tooth stabilization
37.
the 45·degree labial bevel with a shoulder preparation.
periodontal and prosthetic treatment of patients with
45-76.
IO
1996;75 =40--411.
45-46. 27.
Seymour K, Zou L, Samarawickrama D. Lynch E. Assess·
1993:6:25-30. 16.
ixed partial dentures. Dent Clin North Am 1999:43:
11.
bonded to metal crown preparations. J Prosthet Dent
Mclean JW. Wilson AD. Butt joint versus beveled gold
36.
breaking strength of Dicor crowns: Part t. lnt J Pros·
and splinting before and ater periodontal therapy with
10.
ment of shoulder dimensions and angles of porcelain
and Techniques. Santa Rosa. A: Alto Books, 1990:
Restaurazione Protesica. Verona: Resch, 1993.
79=491-494·
163-169.
9·
Albers H. Impressions: A Text for Selection of Materials
when using self·limiting burs. I Prosthet Dent 1998;
7· Nyman S. lindhe J. A longitudinal study of combined
De Soever lA. Fixed restorations of a dentition with re·
26.
line geometry on the it of crowns. lnt J Prosthodont
Periodontics Restorative Dent 1985;5:52�2.
8.
Chiche GJ. Pinault A. Esthetics of Anterior Fixed Prostho· dontics. Chicago: Quintessence. 1994:86-91, 102-103.
Moore BK. The efect or tooth preparation design on the
Di Febo G. Canevale G, Sterrantino S. Treatment of a case of advanced periodontitis: Clinical procedures uti .. lizing the .combined preparation technique. tnt J
35·
loss apical to preparations for fixed partial dentures
delle
ricostruzioni ceramo-metalliche. Utet t989;2:2 JS-2SO.
principles. I Prosthet Dent 2001;85:363-376.
15. Syu JZ. Byrne G. Laub LW. Land MF. Influence of finish·
lnt 2001;32:603�10. 5.
tions for complete crowns: An art based on scientific
Menghini P, Battaini P. Metallurgia in odontoiatria. Milan:
Massironi D. Battistelli A, Pascetta R. La Precisione Nella
Prosthet
1980:14:239-250.
34· Goodacre CJ, Campagni W, Aquilino SA. Tooth prepara·
25.
margin in metal-ceramic crowns. J Biomed Mater Res
Peon BK, Smales RJ. Assessment of clinical preparations for single gold and ceramometal crowns. Quintessence
I
Massironi D. Battistelli A. Sistema di preparazione per corone complete. Masson Protech 2000;J:JS-47·
Masson. 1997:38-39.
Gavelis JW. Morency JD. Riley ED. Sozio RB. The efect
sign: A dental school survey. I Prosthet Dent 1991;65:
fessionale odontoiatrica. Milan: Masson. 1990:408-4D9. 4-
24.
of various inish line preparations on the marginal seal
Guastamacchia C. Elementi di ergonomia e pratica pro
23.
Dent Assoc 1981;
Butel EM. Campbell JC. DiFiore PM. Crown margin de·
303-305. 3-
I Am
42.
I
Prosthet
AI·Omari WM. AI·Wahadni AM. Convegence angle, occlu· sal reduction. and finish line depth of full·crown prepa· rations made by dental students. Quintessence tnt 2004; 3 5 :287-293·
Byrne G. Influence of finish-line form on crown cemen· tation. lnt I Prosthodont 1992;5:137-144.
as opposed to rotary instrumentation. J Prosthet Dent 1989;62:273-277.
151
C H A P T E R
5
R E P OSITI O NING AN D C O M P LETI NG THE F I NISH L I NE WITH OSC I L LATI NG I NST R U M E NTS
R
epositioning of the finish line is accom
retraction procedures. Traditionally, the finish line is
plished before the definitive impression is
repositioned during the impression-taking stage.
taken and approximately 3 weeks' after the
This involves retracting the gingival tissues in the
preliminay preparation phase has been completed.
prepared areas to accurately assess the intact tooth
The procedure requires the level of the finish line to
structure beyond the inish line.
be adjusted and the preparation to be refined to a more apical position immediately afier gingival de· lection (Fig 5·1). In the initial stage of tooth preparation, a non·
OSC I L LATI N G I N STRUM ENTS
A
N EW
Sonic and ultrasonic instruments may be used to
impregnated retraction cord is placed to retract the
reposition and complete the finish line. Originally
gingival tissues apically, thus making the inish line
developed for finishing the interproximal boxes of
accessible. With this increased accessibility, an exact
inlay preparations.' the instruments were gradually
finish line can be designed and inalized with one of
adopted for the delicate stage of repositioning the
4·
inish line {Figs 5-2 and 5-3) because of the need for
Since placement of a provisional prosthesis with cor
instrument tips that could replace the classic rotating
the preparation techniques described in chapter
FIG 5-1
rect morphology will stimulate the development of
instruments. which many clinicians have dificulty
the gingiva, the deinitive impression is rarely made
controlling near the gingiva. Damage to the sulcular
at this stage. An average of 3 weeks' is recom
and parasulcular gingival tissues often causes bleed·
mended for the development of adequate gingival
ing, reducing the efectiveness of the impression ma·
tissue prior to initiating the various sofi tissue
terials and the precision of impressions in general. .
Fig 5-1 Preparation lor an all-ceramic crown. There is a lack of space. with the finish line and the gingival sulcus in close contact. Making an impression under such conditions would lead to failure. figs 5-2 and 5-3 Images of a coarse-grit bur !stationary and in motion! used with a rotating handpiece lor conventional tooth preparation. II insufficiently controlled during use. the diamond bur can come into contact with the gingiva and cause lesions on the soft tissue. Bleeding impedes proper impression taking of the finish line and of the intact tooth beyond the finish t i ne .
FIG 5-3 152
FIG 5-2
LEVEL FOR THE FINISH LIN E P O S I TI O N
C H A P T E R
5
R E P OSITI O NING AN D C O M P LETI NG THE F I NISH L I NE WITH OSC I L LATI NG I NST R U M E NTS
R
epositioning of the finish line is accom
retraction procedures. Traditionally, the finish line is
plished before the definitive impression is
repositioned during the impression-taking stage.
taken and approximately 3 weeks' after the
This involves retracting the gingival tissues in the
preliminay preparation phase has been completed.
prepared areas to accurately assess the intact tooth
The procedure requires the level of the finish line to
structure beyond the inish line.
be adjusted and the preparation to be refined to a more apical position immediately afier gingival de· lection (Fig 5·1). In the initial stage of tooth preparation, a non·
OSC I L LATI N G I N STRUM ENTS
A
N EW
Sonic and ultrasonic instruments may be used to
impregnated retraction cord is placed to retract the
reposition and complete the finish line. Originally
gingival tissues apically, thus making the inish line
developed for finishing the interproximal boxes of
accessible. With this increased accessibility, an exact
inlay preparations.' the instruments were gradually
finish line can be designed and inalized with one of
adopted for the delicate stage of repositioning the
4·
inish line {Figs 5-2 and 5-3) because of the need for
Since placement of a provisional prosthesis with cor
instrument tips that could replace the classic rotating
the preparation techniques described in chapter
FIG 5-1
rect morphology will stimulate the development of
instruments. which many clinicians have dificulty
the gingiva, the deinitive impression is rarely made
controlling near the gingiva. Damage to the sulcular
at this stage. An average of 3 weeks' is recom
and parasulcular gingival tissues often causes bleed·
mended for the development of adequate gingival
ing, reducing the efectiveness of the impression ma·
tissue prior to initiating the various sofi tissue
terials and the precision of impressions in general. .
Fig 5-1 Preparation lor an all-ceramic crown. There is a lack of space. with the finish line and the gingival sulcus in close contact. Making an impression under such conditions would lead to failure. figs 5-2 and 5-3 Images of a coarse-grit bur !stationary and in motion! used with a rotating handpiece lor conventional tooth preparation. II insufficiently controlled during use. the diamond bur can come into contact with the gingiva and cause lesions on the soft tissue. Bleeding impedes proper impression taking of the finish line and of the intact tooth beyond the finish t i ne .
FIG 5-3 152
FIG 5-2
LEVEL FOR THE FINISH LIN E P O S I TI O N
CHAPTER 5 Repositioning and Completing the Finish Line with Oscillating Instuments
. Furthermore, if the lesions develop on thin peri·
Ultrasonic power is controlled by the amplitude
odontal tissue or are extensive, more serious com·
of oscillation, which is between so and 70 �m (not,
plications could result, threatening the stability of
as some might expect, by the frequency of the
the dentogingival complex and even resulting in
waves emitted, which ranges from 28,ooo to 32.ooo
unattractive gingival recession. To prevent gingival damage, the authors devel·
Hz and cannot be controlled by the operator). The clinician regulates the intensity of oscillation to
oped ultrasonic and sonic diamond-coated tips with
modulate the abrasive effect and expand the range
medium grit that are designed to be mounted on
of application. When an ultrasonic instrument is
piezoelectric and pneumatic grips, respectivelyl Be·
used at maximum oscillation, the tip can abrade
cause ultrasonic and sonic technology work with
dentin with a progressive tissue-removal effect that
oscillating rather than rotating movement, these
can easily be controlled even by an inexperienced
instruments do not damage adjacent gingival tissue
operator. Such a high degree of control thus permits
during preparation.• A kit of ultrasonic instruments
the clinician to reposition the finish line without the
TD 1073A; ISO.IJJ.014 or ISO.IJJ.016, Komet) is
risk of creating lesions on the marginal gingiva (Figs
available with tips duplicating the shape of the
s·7 to s·tO). At the lowest level, the tip can create
modified chamfer' (see chapter 4) for completing
well-polished and well-defined surfaces comparable
the finish line on complete crown preparations (Fig
to those obtained using a medium-grit (about 7S �m)
s-4). When using ultrasonic instruments at the gin·
rotating diamond bur (Fig S·ll).
gival margin, tips should have an average grit of 91 �m and a working surface of 9 mm in length. The
Therefore, ultra-coarse-grit
(ISO· to 180-�m),
medium-grit (107·�m), and fine-grit (Jo-�m) rotating
clinician will also need tip diameters of 0.14 and
diamond burs and a rounded chisel as a manual
0.16 mm (ISO.IJJ.014 and ISO.IJJ.016), compatible
instrument were used. These were compared with
with the bur diameters most frequently used in
oscillating ultrasonic and sonic instruments, the lat·
preparing complete crowns (Figs s·s and s·6).
ter set at three different power levels (high, medium,
Repeated in vitro and clinical tests with proto·
FIG 5-4
and low).
types of these tips demonstrated that they not only
In this study (shown in Table S·l), both average
inish preparations with a high degree of precision,
roughness (which is most important) and maximum
but also reposition the level of the finish line more
roughness values were obtained. The results
apically when necessary.
showed that the ultra-coarse- and medium-grit burs ..
FIG 5-5
Fig 5-4 K i t co �taining oscillating- � onrotating (ultrasonic! margin-positioning and finishing tips (designed by D. Massironi. Italy!. These t1ps have the sam � diameters 10.14 and 0.16 mm) and shape as rotating modified chamfer burs. They serve to _ repos1t1on and complete the finiSh line preparation using oscillation rather than rotating movement. Fig 5-5 Prototype diamo � d tips. Several prototypes. with differently positioned diamond layers and different grits were d � s1gned and tested. Initially. th � tops were sectioned l �ngitudinally. with the flat part to be in contact with the gingival mar gin. The 1neff1c1ent des1gn was d1scarded because the l1ps only worked on one side of the preparation and easily broke. Fig 5-6 Diamond grits from 15 to 125 pm were tested. but the best results were obtained using a 9 1 - pm grit.
14
FIG 5-6
CHAPTER 5 Repositioning and Completing the Finish Line with Oscillating Instuments
. Furthermore, if the lesions develop on thin peri·
Ultrasonic power is controlled by the amplitude
odontal tissue or are extensive, more serious com·
of oscillation, which is between so and 70 �m (not,
plications could result, threatening the stability of
as some might expect, by the frequency of the
the dentogingival complex and even resulting in
waves emitted, which ranges from 28,ooo to 32.ooo
unattractive gingival recession. To prevent gingival damage, the authors devel·
Hz and cannot be controlled by the operator). The clinician regulates the intensity of oscillation to
oped ultrasonic and sonic diamond-coated tips with
modulate the abrasive effect and expand the range
medium grit that are designed to be mounted on
of application. When an ultrasonic instrument is
piezoelectric and pneumatic grips, respectivelyl Be·
used at maximum oscillation, the tip can abrade
cause ultrasonic and sonic technology work with
dentin with a progressive tissue-removal effect that
oscillating rather than rotating movement, these
can easily be controlled even by an inexperienced
instruments do not damage adjacent gingival tissue
operator. Such a high degree of control thus permits
during preparation.• A kit of ultrasonic instruments
the clinician to reposition the finish line without the
TD 1073A; ISO.IJJ.014 or ISO.IJJ.016, Komet) is
risk of creating lesions on the marginal gingiva (Figs
available with tips duplicating the shape of the
s·7 to s·tO). At the lowest level, the tip can create
modified chamfer' (see chapter 4) for completing
well-polished and well-defined surfaces comparable
the finish line on complete crown preparations (Fig
to those obtained using a medium-grit (about 7S �m)
s-4). When using ultrasonic instruments at the gin·
rotating diamond bur (Fig S·ll).
gival margin, tips should have an average grit of 91 �m and a working surface of 9 mm in length. The
Therefore, ultra-coarse-grit
(ISO· to 180-�m),
medium-grit (107·�m), and fine-grit (Jo-�m) rotating
clinician will also need tip diameters of 0.14 and
diamond burs and a rounded chisel as a manual
0.16 mm (ISO.IJJ.014 and ISO.IJJ.016), compatible
instrument were used. These were compared with
with the bur diameters most frequently used in
oscillating ultrasonic and sonic instruments, the lat·
preparing complete crowns (Figs s·s and s·6).
ter set at three different power levels (high, medium,
Repeated in vitro and clinical tests with proto·
FIG 5-4
and low).
types of these tips demonstrated that they not only
In this study (shown in Table S·l), both average
inish preparations with a high degree of precision,
roughness (which is most important) and maximum
but also reposition the level of the finish line more
roughness values were obtained. The results
apically when necessary.
showed that the ultra-coarse- and medium-grit burs ..
FIG 5-5
Fig 5-4 K i t co �taining oscillating- � onrotating (ultrasonic! margin-positioning and finishing tips (designed by D. Massironi. Italy!. These t1ps have the sam � diameters 10.14 and 0.16 mm) and shape as rotating modified chamfer burs. They serve to _ repos1t1on and complete the finiSh line preparation using oscillation rather than rotating movement. Fig 5-5 Prototype diamo � d tips. Several prototypes. with differently positioned diamond layers and different grits were d � s1gned and tested. Initially. th � tops were sectioned l �ngitudinally. with the flat part to be in contact with the gingival mar gin. The 1neff1c1ent des1gn was d1scarded because the l1ps only worked on one side of the preparation and easily broke. Fig 5-6 Diamond grits from 15 to 125 pm were tested. but the best results were obtained using a 9 1 - pm grit.
14
FIG 5-6
CHAPTER 5 Repositioning and Completing the Finish line with Oscillating Instruments
.. and the ultrasonic and sonic instruments performed
perpendicular to the direction of oscillation, the efect
poorly at the maximum working power, while the
is vey much reduced, or even nullified. Wavelength is
sonic instrument at low power achieved a finishing
directly proportional to speed in that shot waves
effect similar to that using fine- and medium-grit
move at high speeds. In the case of ultrasonic waves,
burs, and in some aspects a manual rounded chisel.
it is possible to reach a frequency of 32,000 Hz, but
These results demonstrate how a change in heat
the working area is vey small because the amplitude
intensity alters the effectiveness of the tool. At high
of oscillation (../2) is very small, resulting in a limited
power, the ultrasonic and sonic instruments are per
number of diamond granules working in a single direc
fectly suitable for repositioning the finish line of a
tion. Because the ultrasonic tip works at high oscilla
preparation, but at lower levels their effect is limit·
tions, it produces a surface that does not appear
ed to polishing and finishing.
smooth and uniform, but the tool works very efi
FIG 5-8
FIG 5-7
FIG 5-10
FIG 5-9
ciently if the tip is kept properly oriented. The sonic instrument (Sonicflex, KaVa) uses a
CO M PARING SONIC AND
pneumatic feed and requires insertion of a multi flex
U LTRAS O N I C I N STRUM ENTS
attachment in place of the high-speed air turbine. The multiflex attachment is composed of a hollow
A comparison of sonic and ultrasonic instruments
cylinder with an interior sheath or tube with to lat
highlights the diferent characteristics of each.6 The
eral holes. The cylinder rotates as a result of pres
ultrasonic instrument is electric: An alternating cur
surized air that the operator controls with a pedal
rent produces a series of volumetric contractions in
switch. The oscillation frequency (around 6,ooo Hz)
quart2 cystals, which generate localized propaga
is much lower than that of the ultrasonic instrument
tion waves (peak to peak, between so and
70
�m)
but generates a three-dimensional elliptical move
in a restricted area with bidirectional and linear
ment, with both longitudinal and transversal com
movement. The diamond-coated tips can be used
ponents, that renders the entire tip active. The sonic
only on the ultrasonic tool or grip, which features
tip will abrade the surface of the tooth regardless of
front and rear resonance chambers on either side of
its position relative to the tooth.
the middle cystals. The rear resonance chambers
The amplitude of the oscillation has a peak
are triggered by an activator and transform the wave
to-peak range of 120 to 250 �m. sufficient For a
from longitudinal to transversal. The sound wave
rotational movement on small surfaces. It creates a
thus creates an oscillation in the tip, which is coat
less abrasive efect than ultrasonic instruments and
ed with diamond granules.
Fig 5-7 Although lhe tip is in contact with the gingiva. there are no visible lesions. It i s important to irrigate the tool with a stream of water to avoid overheating the tip and the prepared tooth. or it could result in the formation of a superficial lesion on the soft lis sues.
Fig 5-8 Tooth preparation for a fixed partial denture. The ultrasonic tip is being used to reposition the finish line more apically.
Figs 5-9 and 5-10 Degree of finishing and condition of the gingiva following repositioning. at high magnification. The tissue is free of lesions and bleeding. Fig 5-11 Surface of a tooth prepared using an ultrasonic lip. This image shows the difference i n surface quality obtained with two levels of oscillation intensity. AI higher oscillation, the surface takes on irregularities (large area). w h i le at lower oscillation the surface appears smoothly polished (small area).
FIG 5-11
TABLE 5-1 Degree of roughness obtained with rotating, ultrasonic, and manual instruments Average
allows a greater working area at the tip. With its
Maximum
64-�m-grit diamond layer, pneumatic feed, and grip
Instrument
amplitude /2) between two waves; the smaller the
regulated intensity (Ievet t, range amplitude [raj = 120
Ultra-coarse-grit (t8o-�m) bur
24.3
51.8
diameter of the tip, the closer together the waves are
:
15 �m; level 2, ra
Medium-grit (107-�m) bur
14.2
35.1
and the more the tip oscillates. Because the wave
:
15 �m), the sonic tool can be used effectively to
moves in a linear ashion, the oscillation produces
reposition the finish line and finish the suraces.
=
160
: 15
�m; level 3, ra
=
250
maximum tissue removal when the tip is aligned with
The authors have used various diamond grits (eg,
the direction of wave movement. If t he t i p is orient ed
21, 46, and 91 �m) and have discovered that both ..
Fine-grit (30-�m) bur Ultrasonic instrument (EMS)
roughness* (tm)
roughnesst (Jm)
The abrasive efect of the tip depends on the
8.9
13.1
15.4
23.5
Sonic (Sonicflex) instrument, minimum power
12.6
19.0
Sonic (Sonicflex) instrument, maximum power
16.9
28.3
7.2
15.3
Rounded chisel, manual action
•Average roughness (R7) i s t h e mean value obtained from t h e single roughness values of ive subsequent measuring lengths i n the roughness profile. 'Maximum roughness (R max) is the highest of the five single roughness values. 16
17
CHAPTER 5 Repositioning and Completing the Finish line with Oscillating Instruments
.. and the ultrasonic and sonic instruments performed
perpendicular to the direction of oscillation, the efect
poorly at the maximum working power, while the
is vey much reduced, or even nullified. Wavelength is
sonic instrument at low power achieved a finishing
directly proportional to speed in that shot waves
effect similar to that using fine- and medium-grit
move at high speeds. In the case of ultrasonic waves,
burs, and in some aspects a manual rounded chisel.
it is possible to reach a frequency of 32,000 Hz, but
These results demonstrate how a change in heat
the working area is vey small because the amplitude
intensity alters the effectiveness of the tool. At high
of oscillation (../2) is very small, resulting in a limited
power, the ultrasonic and sonic instruments are per
number of diamond granules working in a single direc
fectly suitable for repositioning the finish line of a
tion. Because the ultrasonic tip works at high oscilla
preparation, but at lower levels their effect is limit·
tions, it produces a surface that does not appear
ed to polishing and finishing.
smooth and uniform, but the tool works very efi
FIG 5-8
FIG 5-7
FIG 5-10
FIG 5-9
ciently if the tip is kept properly oriented. The sonic instrument (Sonicflex, KaVa) uses a
CO M PARING SONIC AND
pneumatic feed and requires insertion of a multi flex
U LTRAS O N I C I N STRUM ENTS
attachment in place of the high-speed air turbine. The multiflex attachment is composed of a hollow
A comparison of sonic and ultrasonic instruments
cylinder with an interior sheath or tube with to lat
highlights the diferent characteristics of each.6 The
eral holes. The cylinder rotates as a result of pres
ultrasonic instrument is electric: An alternating cur
surized air that the operator controls with a pedal
rent produces a series of volumetric contractions in
switch. The oscillation frequency (around 6,ooo Hz)
quart2 cystals, which generate localized propaga
is much lower than that of the ultrasonic instrument
tion waves (peak to peak, between so and
70
�m)
but generates a three-dimensional elliptical move
in a restricted area with bidirectional and linear
ment, with both longitudinal and transversal com
movement. The diamond-coated tips can be used
ponents, that renders the entire tip active. The sonic
only on the ultrasonic tool or grip, which features
tip will abrade the surface of the tooth regardless of
front and rear resonance chambers on either side of
its position relative to the tooth.
the middle cystals. The rear resonance chambers
The amplitude of the oscillation has a peak
are triggered by an activator and transform the wave
to-peak range of 120 to 250 �m. sufficient For a
from longitudinal to transversal. The sound wave
rotational movement on small surfaces. It creates a
thus creates an oscillation in the tip, which is coat
less abrasive efect than ultrasonic instruments and
ed with diamond granules.
Fig 5-7 Although lhe tip is in contact with the gingiva. there are no visible lesions. It i s important to irrigate the tool with a stream of water to avoid overheating the tip and the prepared tooth. or it could result in the formation of a superficial lesion on the soft lis sues.
Fig 5-8 Tooth preparation for a fixed partial denture. The ultrasonic tip is being used to reposition the finish line more apically.
Figs 5-9 and 5-10 Degree of finishing and condition of the gingiva following repositioning. at high magnification. The tissue is free of lesions and bleeding. Fig 5-11 Surface of a tooth prepared using an ultrasonic lip. This image shows the difference i n surface quality obtained with two levels of oscillation intensity. AI higher oscillation, the surface takes on irregularities (large area). w h i le at lower oscillation the surface appears smoothly polished (small area).
FIG 5-11
TABLE 5-1 Degree of roughness obtained with rotating, ultrasonic, and manual instruments Average
allows a greater working area at the tip. With its
Maximum
64-�m-grit diamond layer, pneumatic feed, and grip
Instrument
amplitude /2) between two waves; the smaller the
regulated intensity (Ievet t, range amplitude [raj = 120
Ultra-coarse-grit (t8o-�m) bur
24.3
51.8
diameter of the tip, the closer together the waves are
:
15 �m; level 2, ra
Medium-grit (107-�m) bur
14.2
35.1
and the more the tip oscillates. Because the wave
:
15 �m), the sonic tool can be used effectively to
moves in a linear ashion, the oscillation produces
reposition the finish line and finish the suraces.
=
160
: 15
�m; level 3, ra
=
250
maximum tissue removal when the tip is aligned with
The authors have used various diamond grits (eg,
the direction of wave movement. If t he t i p is orient ed
21, 46, and 91 �m) and have discovered that both ..
Fine-grit (30-�m) bur Ultrasonic instrument (EMS)
roughness* (tm)
roughnesst (Jm)
The abrasive efect of the tip depends on the
8.9
13.1
15.4
23.5
Sonic (Sonicflex) instrument, minimum power
12.6
19.0
Sonic (Sonicflex) instrument, maximum power
16.9
28.3
7.2
15.3
Rounded chisel, manual action
•Average roughness (R7) i s t h e mean value obtained from t h e single roughness values of ive subsequent measuring lengths i n the roughness profile. 'Maximum roughness (R max) is the highest of the five single roughness values. 16
17
CHAPTER 5 Repositioning and Completing the Finish Line with Oscillating Instruments
�
larger and smaller grits can be used effectively for
case, a gingival lesion and subsequent blood now
the removal of dentin, as well as for simple polish
would jeopardize the outcome of the impression.
finish line. The lack of rotation is the instruments'
mond granules eventually fall of (Fig 5-25) . Such
most important feature, permitting ideal control. With
problems are not unique to sonic and ultrasonic
ing. The production of tips with diferent grits and
From years of experimentation to improve sonic
the possibility of modulating the oscillation intensity
instruments, since breaks also occur in scaling in·
diameters is expected so that a full range of oscillat
and ultrasonic instruments, the authors have had
of the instrument, the clinician is able to reposition
struments (Fig 5-26). However, these instruments
ing implements will be available (Figs 5-12 to 5-21).
ample opportunity to determine their optimal use.
and complete the finish line without causing even
should be examined fai rly regularly under magnifica
minimal lesions in the marginal gingiva.
tion and replaced when they start to show signs of
The choice between an ultrasonic or sonic system
The first requirement of sonic and ultrasonic instru
is often dictated more by the type of system cur
ments is internal irrigation to prevent overheating
The surface obtained by using the sonic instru
rently available in an oice, rather than by marked
that may damage dentin and pulp and to avoid
ments is irregular, with a pockmarked appearance
number of teeth prepared but far less than the com
preference or understanding of operational differ
breaking the diamond tips. The sonic and ultrasonic
(Figs 5-22 and 5-23), unlike the circular little grooves
parable wear of rotating tips. In the authors' experi
ences. A sonic tool will vibrate constantly, regardless
tools need about 15 and 30 ml/min of water respec
that are produced by a rotating diamond bur. In
ence, the instruments need to be replaced, on aver
of the operating pressure, producing a good efect
tively for cooling.8·9 The presence of water between
theory, such a surface should provide better adhe
age, two or three times per year. In clinical practice, a retraction cord is inserted to obtain the vertical displacement of the gingival tis
wear. The degree of wear is proportional to the
that removes dentinal tissue during the repositioning
the tip and the tooth surface can result in an unde
sion by permitting the cement to cover more area.
of the finish line. The ultrasonic tool, with its bi
sirable hydroplaning effect. similar to the situation
According to the literature,'0 the ideal degree of pol
directional oscillation, works optimally only when
that occurs between a car tire and a wet road. The
ishing of dental preparations, which can be mea
sue, and the sonic or ultrasonic instrument is used
the operator matches the working direction to that
liquid layer nullifies the oscillating effect of the
sured with a roughness profilometer, is between 5
in combination with a stereomicroscope, initially in
of the wave. The preparation of a surface through
instrument, and the dental assistant must aim inter
and 10 �m. Below this value, the cement adheres
direct view of the buccal area and then in indi rect
widespread removal of tissue yields a better result
mittent jets of air at the prepared tooth to restore
less efectively to the surfaces of the prepared tooth,
view of the palatal area and interproximal relation
when sonic instruments are used. Moreover, because
normal functioning.
while above 12 �m the cement does not spread
ships of all the teeth involved (Figs 5-27 and 5-28).
evenly, leaving uncemented spots."
The exceptional control provided by oscillating instru
the elliptical movement is more convenient and the
Another requirement for ideal functioning of an
intensity of the sonic instrument can be easily regu
ultrasonic instrument is the proper difusion and
Diamond tips used with sonic and ultrasonic
ments prevents damage to the paramarginal gingiva
lated to create uniform and well-polished surfaces,
direction of the ultrasonic waves that are generated
instruments have greater longevity than diamond
and thus provides a more accessible finish line dur ing the inishing and i mpression stages (Figs 5-29 to
the sonic system is easier for the clinician to master'
11
�
in the handle by the quartz crystals, which oscillate
burs used with rotating instruments. Oscillation of
in response to the piezoelectric stimulation. These
the tips keeps wear to a minimum by avoiding the
5-37). Taking the impression will also be made eas-
waves pass through the grip and the cuvature of the
stress of high-speed rotation and limiting the stress
ier by the absence of gingival lesions. I n addition,
OPTI MAL USE OF OSCI LLATI NG
stem to the tip, where their intensity is at its peak,
to the abrasion of the tooth surface.
I N STRUM ENTS
with the exception of the two linear areas distal and
These instruments can break if used improperly
mesial to the tip. If the instrument is positioned
or without water (Fig 5-24). and, as is true for all
In addition to the versatility of oscillating instru
curve on nat. it will have the least effect because
instruments with an abrasive diamond layer, the dia-
ments, their greatest advantage is lack of rotation,
that area of the tip is free of waves. If the tip is sim
which permits absolute control during the most del
ply rotated a few degrees, it will function perfectly,
icate stages of preparation and reduces the risk of
although its best efect will still be above and below
gingival lesions. This also benefits impression mak
the point of the wave's maximum peak.
ing because it eliminates the need to remove blood
In the author's opinion, the use of sonic and ultra
from the area before making an impression. Oscillat·
sonic instruments constitutes an innovative system of
ing instruments are particularly useful when nonim
preparation. While they do not replace rotating instru
pregnated retraction cords are used, resulting in
ments in the preparation stage, these instruments can
minimal vertical retraction of the gingiva; in such a
be of great value in repositioning and completing the .
the continuous irrigation with intermittent water and air spray results, in most cases, in the need for only one retraction cord, with obvious benefits for the ac
curacy of the planned finish line (Figs 5-38 to 5-47). •
159
CHAPTER 5 Repositioning and Completing the Finish Line with Oscillating Instruments
�
larger and smaller grits can be used effectively for
case, a gingival lesion and subsequent blood now
the removal of dentin, as well as for simple polish
would jeopardize the outcome of the impression.
finish line. The lack of rotation is the instruments'
mond granules eventually fall of (Fig 5-25) . Such
most important feature, permitting ideal control. With
problems are not unique to sonic and ultrasonic
ing. The production of tips with diferent grits and
From years of experimentation to improve sonic
the possibility of modulating the oscillation intensity
instruments, since breaks also occur in scaling in·
diameters is expected so that a full range of oscillat
and ultrasonic instruments, the authors have had
of the instrument, the clinician is able to reposition
struments (Fig 5-26). However, these instruments
ing implements will be available (Figs 5-12 to 5-21).
ample opportunity to determine their optimal use.
and complete the finish line without causing even
should be examined fai rly regularly under magnifica
minimal lesions in the marginal gingiva.
tion and replaced when they start to show signs of
The choice between an ultrasonic or sonic system
The first requirement of sonic and ultrasonic instru
is often dictated more by the type of system cur
ments is internal irrigation to prevent overheating
The surface obtained by using the sonic instru
rently available in an oice, rather than by marked
that may damage dentin and pulp and to avoid
ments is irregular, with a pockmarked appearance
number of teeth prepared but far less than the com
preference or understanding of operational differ
breaking the diamond tips. The sonic and ultrasonic
(Figs 5-22 and 5-23), unlike the circular little grooves
parable wear of rotating tips. In the authors' experi
ences. A sonic tool will vibrate constantly, regardless
tools need about 15 and 30 ml/min of water respec
that are produced by a rotating diamond bur. In
ence, the instruments need to be replaced, on aver
of the operating pressure, producing a good efect
tively for cooling.8·9 The presence of water between
theory, such a surface should provide better adhe
age, two or three times per year. In clinical practice, a retraction cord is inserted to obtain the vertical displacement of the gingival tis
wear. The degree of wear is proportional to the
that removes dentinal tissue during the repositioning
the tip and the tooth surface can result in an unde
sion by permitting the cement to cover more area.
of the finish line. The ultrasonic tool, with its bi
sirable hydroplaning effect. similar to the situation
According to the literature,'0 the ideal degree of pol
directional oscillation, works optimally only when
that occurs between a car tire and a wet road. The
ishing of dental preparations, which can be mea
sue, and the sonic or ultrasonic instrument is used
the operator matches the working direction to that
liquid layer nullifies the oscillating effect of the
sured with a roughness profilometer, is between 5
in combination with a stereomicroscope, initially in
of the wave. The preparation of a surface through
instrument, and the dental assistant must aim inter
and 10 �m. Below this value, the cement adheres
direct view of the buccal area and then in indi rect
widespread removal of tissue yields a better result
mittent jets of air at the prepared tooth to restore
less efectively to the surfaces of the prepared tooth,
view of the palatal area and interproximal relation
when sonic instruments are used. Moreover, because
normal functioning.
while above 12 �m the cement does not spread
ships of all the teeth involved (Figs 5-27 and 5-28).
evenly, leaving uncemented spots."
The exceptional control provided by oscillating instru
the elliptical movement is more convenient and the
Another requirement for ideal functioning of an
intensity of the sonic instrument can be easily regu
ultrasonic instrument is the proper difusion and
Diamond tips used with sonic and ultrasonic
ments prevents damage to the paramarginal gingiva
lated to create uniform and well-polished surfaces,
direction of the ultrasonic waves that are generated
instruments have greater longevity than diamond
and thus provides a more accessible finish line dur ing the inishing and i mpression stages (Figs 5-29 to
the sonic system is easier for the clinician to master'
11
�
in the handle by the quartz crystals, which oscillate
burs used with rotating instruments. Oscillation of
in response to the piezoelectric stimulation. These
the tips keeps wear to a minimum by avoiding the
5-37). Taking the impression will also be made eas-
waves pass through the grip and the cuvature of the
stress of high-speed rotation and limiting the stress
ier by the absence of gingival lesions. I n addition,
OPTI MAL USE OF OSCI LLATI NG
stem to the tip, where their intensity is at its peak,
to the abrasion of the tooth surface.
I N STRUM ENTS
with the exception of the two linear areas distal and
These instruments can break if used improperly
mesial to the tip. If the instrument is positioned
or without water (Fig 5-24). and, as is true for all
In addition to the versatility of oscillating instru
curve on nat. it will have the least effect because
instruments with an abrasive diamond layer, the dia-
ments, their greatest advantage is lack of rotation,
that area of the tip is free of waves. If the tip is sim
which permits absolute control during the most del
ply rotated a few degrees, it will function perfectly,
icate stages of preparation and reduces the risk of
although its best efect will still be above and below
gingival lesions. This also benefits impression mak
the point of the wave's maximum peak.
ing because it eliminates the need to remove blood
In the author's opinion, the use of sonic and ultra
from the area before making an impression. Oscillat·
sonic instruments constitutes an innovative system of
ing instruments are particularly useful when nonim
preparation. While they do not replace rotating instru
pregnated retraction cords are used, resulting in
ments in the preparation stage, these instruments can
minimal vertical retraction of the gingiva; in such a
be of great value in repositioning and completing the .
the continuous irrigation with intermittent water and air spray results, in most cases, in the need for only one retraction cord, with obvious benefits for the ac
curacy of the planned finish line (Figs 5-38 to 5-47). •
159
C IAIT R Repositioning and Completing the Finish Line with Oscillating Instruments
F1g 5-12 Sonic grip and tips. The sonic instrument usu pneumatic power and elliptical low-frequency. 6-MHz waves to produce good finish linu. Tips are available in diameters of 0.14 and 0.16 mm !Sf 919.000.014 and Sf 919.000.016. Kamel).
Fig 5-13 Prototype sonic lips with varying stem curvature radii. The straight stem (not available) transmits greater vibration and oscillation than the curved stem and causes more discomfort for the patient.
fig 5-16 Use of sonic instrument prior to the positioning of a retraction cord. fig 5-17 Healthy gingiva. after placement of the vertical retraction cord and during the apical repositioning of the finish line.
f1gs 5-14 1nd 5-15 Sonic lip poSitioned along the long axis of the tooth. The advantage of the sonic tool is thai it works e q ually well in all posi tions and direc11ons. unlike the ullruonlt Instrument.
lG
111
C IAIT R Repositioning and Completing the Finish Line with Oscillating Instruments
F1g 5-12 Sonic grip and tips. The sonic instrument usu pneumatic power and elliptical low-frequency. 6-MHz waves to produce good finish linu. Tips are available in diameters of 0.14 and 0.16 mm !Sf 919.000.014 and Sf 919.000.016. Kamel).
Fig 5-13 Prototype sonic lips with varying stem curvature radii. The straight stem (not available) transmits greater vibration and oscillation than the curved stem and causes more discomfort for the patient.
fig 5-16 Use of sonic instrument prior to the positioning of a retraction cord. fig 5-17 Healthy gingiva. after placement of the vertical retraction cord and during the apical repositioning of the finish line.
f1gs 5-14 1nd 5-15 Sonic lip poSitioned along the long axis of the tooth. The advantage of the sonic tool is thai it works e q ually well in all posi tions and direc11ons. unlike the ullruonlt Instrument.
lG
111
CHA . . Repositioning and Completing the Finish Line with Oscillating Instuments
Figs 5-18 and 5-1 g Stereomicroscope views of finish line before and after apical repositioning with the pneumatic sonic instrument (magnifi cation X 25).
112
Figs 5-20 and 5-21 New position of the finish line achieved easily and without trauma using the sonic tool following placement of only one impregnated retraction cord !magnification x 2 5).
CHA . . Repositioning and Completing the Finish Line with Oscillating Instuments
Figs 5-18 and 5-1 g Stereomicroscope views of finish line before and after apical repositioning with the pneumatic sonic instrument (magnifi cation X 25).
112
Figs 5-20 and 5-21 New position of the finish line achieved easily and without trauma using the sonic tool following placement of only one impregnated retraction cord !magnification x 2 5).
CHAPTER 5 Repositioning and Completing the Finish Line with Oscillating Instruments
Figs 5-22 and 5-23 Two polyether impressions of the same molar. The surface of the first impression has the regular. horizontal lines from treat ment with a rotating bur. In the second impression. the irregular. pockmarked surface and absence of horizontal lines results from the oscil lation of an ultrasonic instrument. Fig 5-24 Broken stem of an ultrasonic instrument. after use. Fig 5-25 Ultrasonic tip showing wear i n the dia mond grit. Oscillating tips are subject to less wear than traditional burs. because there is no rotation impact. Fig 5-16 Broken tools used to remove calcified tartar and plaque. Figs 5-27 and 5-28 Correct repositioning and completion of finish line using an ultrasonic instrument. with placement of one retraction cord. The finish line has shifted apically without evident alteration at the gingival level. Fig 5-29 Clinical case involving the removal of an inadequate metal-ceramic restoration. A well-integrated provisional prosthesis has been placed for finishing and taking the impression. 14
15
CHAPTER 5 Repositioning and Completing the Finish Line with Oscillating Instruments
Figs 5-22 and 5-23 Two polyether impressions of the same molar. The surface of the first impression has the regular. horizontal lines from treat ment with a rotating bur. In the second impression. the irregular. pockmarked surface and absence of horizontal lines results from the oscil lation of an ultrasonic instrument. Fig 5-24 Broken stem of an ultrasonic instrument. after use. Fig 5-25 Ultrasonic tip showing wear i n the dia mond grit. Oscillating tips are subject to less wear than traditional burs. because there is no rotation impact. Fig 5-16 Broken tools used to remove calcified tartar and plaque. Figs 5-27 and 5-28 Correct repositioning and completion of finish line using an ultrasonic instrument. with placement of one retraction cord. The finish line has shifted apically without evident alteration at the gingival level. Fig 5-29 Clinical case involving the removal of an inadequate metal-ceramic restoration. A well-integrated provisional prosthesis has been placed for finishing and taking the impression. 14
15
CHAPTER 5 Repositioning and Completing the Finish Line with Oscillating Instuments
5·3 1
fig 5-30 Prepared tooth after the first preparation. prior to adaptation of the provisional.
fig 5-31 Frontal view through the stereomicroscope. Note the healthy gingiva prior to placement of the retraction cord.
Fig 5-32 Position of the gingiva and its close contact with the finish tine would compromise the impression without adequate retraction.
fig 5-33 Displacement of the gingival tissue (Gingi-Aid Z-Twist no. 00. Gingi Paki.The retraction cord vertically deflects the gingiva. The clin ician can easily measure the extent of this displacement in relation to the level of the finish line before retraction to calculate the juxta gingival placement of the prosthetic margin during repositioning.
fig 5-4 Note the horizontal displacement caused by the retraction cord and the vertical distance between the cord and the finish line.
14
167
CHAPTER 5 Repositioning and Completing the Finish Line with Oscillating Instuments
5·3 1
fig 5-30 Prepared tooth after the first preparation. prior to adaptation of the provisional.
fig 5-31 Frontal view through the stereomicroscope. Note the healthy gingiva prior to placement of the retraction cord.
Fig 5-32 Position of the gingiva and its close contact with the finish tine would compromise the impression without adequate retraction.
fig 5-33 Displacement of the gingival tissue (Gingi-Aid Z-Twist no. 00. Gingi Paki.The retraction cord vertically deflects the gingiva. The clin ician can easily measure the extent of this displacement in relation to the level of the finish line before retraction to calculate the juxta gingival placement of the prosthetic margin during repositioning.
fig 5-4 Note the horizontal displacement caused by the retraction cord and the vertical distance between the cord and the finish line.
14
167
CHAPTER \ Repositioning and Completing the Finish Line with Oscillating Instruments
Fig 5-35 Oscillating tip during apical repositioning of the finish line. The lack of rotation permits precise control. and the soft tissue shows no sign of damage. Figs 5-36 and 5-37 Manual chisel during the finishing stage. High magnification shows the dentinal debris removed during polishing.
11
Figs 5-38 and 5-39 B u ccal and palatal views of working cast in epoxy resin. before epoxy die trimming. The horizontal space delineated by the retraction cord allows the clinician to easily evaluate the finish line. without doubts about extension.
Fig 5-0 Captek metal structure (leach
&
Dillon) realized on the master cast.
169
CHAPTER \ Repositioning and Completing the Finish Line with Oscillating Instruments
Fig 5-35 Oscillating tip during apical repositioning of the finish line. The lack of rotation permits precise control. and the soft tissue shows no sign of damage. Figs 5-36 and 5-37 Manual chisel during the finishing stage. High magnification shows the dentinal debris removed during polishing.
11
Figs 5-38 and 5-39 B u ccal and palatal views of working cast in epoxy resin. before epoxy die trimming. The horizontal space delineated by the retraction cord allows the clinician to easily evaluate the finish line. without doubts about extension.
Fig 5-0 Captek metal structure (leach
&
Dillon) realized on the master cast.
169
Repoa1tlonmg
nd Completing the
Flm
h Line w1lh
0
clllalmg Instruments
]
5·43
F1g � 41 Captek metal structure tluch & 011tonl. trlld In the pat11nt's mouth f1g I 42 Cond111on al the g1ng1va during the try-1n 1nd1talt1 the clinician's rupect lor the tluuu In adaplltlon of the provisional and in the t1k1ng of the lmprtulon
170
Fig 5-43 Preoperative view o f clinical case.
flgs S-4 Definitive metal-ceramic crown with integrated g1ngival marg1n
171
Repoa1tlonmg
nd Completing the
Flm
h Line w1lh
0
clllalmg Instruments
]
5·43
F1g � 41 Captek metal structure tluch & 011tonl. trlld In the pat11nt's mouth f1g I 42 Cond111on al the g1ng1va during the try-1n 1nd1talt1 the clinician's rupect lor the tluuu In adaplltlon of the provisional and in the t1k1ng of the lmprtulon
170
Fig 5-43 Preoperative view o f clinical case.
flgs S-4 Definitive metal-ceramic crown with integrated g1ngival marg1n
171
CHAPTER 5 Repositioning and Completing the Finish Line with Oscillating Instruments
REFERENCES
7. Schmidlin PR, Beuchat M, Busslinger A, Lehmann 8, lutz F. Tooth substance loss resulting from mechanical. sonic and ultrasonic root instrumentation assessed by
1. Wilson RD. Maynard G. lntracrevicular restorative den tistry. lnt J Periodontics Restorative Dent t98t;t:J4-49-
liquid scintillation. I Clin Periodontal 2001;28:1058-1o66.
2. Krejci I, Lutz F, Krejci D. Schall· ultraschallbetriebene
8. Zesewitz H. Klaiber 8, Hot2 P, Hugo B. Heat propagation
diamantierte lnstrumente zur Kavitatenpraparation. zum
in dentin during cavity preparation in vitro with oscil·
Konturieren und zum Rnieren. ZWR t995:to4:78t-786.
lating instruments [in Germani. Schweiiz Monatsschr
3· Kocher
.
Zahnmed 2005;115:536-541.
Plagmann HC. The diamond-coated sonic
scaler tip. Part II: loss of substance and alteration of
9· Kocher T, Plagmann HC. Heat propagation in dentin
root surface texture after diferent scaling modalities. lnt
during instrumentation with diferent sonic scaler tips.
I Periodontics Restorative Dent 1997:17:484-493.
Quintessence lnt 1996;27:259-264.
4- Massironi 0. 'utilizzo di strumenti diamantati non
10. Gilde H. Lenz P, Richter U. Experimentelle und statis ·
rotanti a funzionamento ultrasonico. Teamwork 2001;3:
tiche Untersuchungen zur Pr�parationsmethodik. Otsch
26-34·
Zahnarztl z 1984:39:798-800.
s- Massironi D. Banistelli A Sistema di preparazione per
corone complete. Masson Protech 2000;J :JS-476. Drisko CL, Cochran DL, Blieden T, et al. Postion paper:
n.
Wegmann U. Quality of ground enamel suraces and preparation margins [in German). Dtsch Zahnarztl Z 1985:40=472-478.
Sonic and ultrasonic scalers in periodontics. Research, Science and Therapy Committee of the American Academy of Periodontology. I Periodontal 2000;71: 1792-1801.
Figs 5-45 and 5-46 Excellent integration ol the metal-ceramic restoration with the gingiva alter cementation.
Fig 5-47 Lateral view of clinical adaptation of the restoration margin through the stereomicroscope.
172
173
CHAPTER 5 Repositioning and Completing the Finish Line with Oscillating Instruments
REFERENCES
7. Schmidlin PR, Beuchat M, Busslinger A, Lehmann 8, lutz F. Tooth substance loss resulting from mechanical. sonic and ultrasonic root instrumentation assessed by
1. Wilson RD. Maynard G. lntracrevicular restorative den tistry. lnt J Periodontics Restorative Dent t98t;t:J4-49-
liquid scintillation. I Clin Periodontal 2001;28:1058-1o66.
2. Krejci I, Lutz F, Krejci D. Schall· ultraschallbetriebene
8. Zesewitz H. Klaiber 8, Hot2 P, Hugo B. Heat propagation
diamantierte lnstrumente zur Kavitatenpraparation. zum
in dentin during cavity preparation in vitro with oscil·
Konturieren und zum Rnieren. ZWR t995:to4:78t-786.
lating instruments [in Germani. Schweiiz Monatsschr
3· Kocher
.
Zahnmed 2005;115:536-541.
Plagmann HC. The diamond-coated sonic
scaler tip. Part II: loss of substance and alteration of
9· Kocher T, Plagmann HC. Heat propagation in dentin
root surface texture after diferent scaling modalities. lnt
during instrumentation with diferent sonic scaler tips.
I Periodontics Restorative Dent 1997:17:484-493.
Quintessence lnt 1996;27:259-264.
4- Massironi 0. 'utilizzo di strumenti diamantati non
10. Gilde H. Lenz P, Richter U. Experimentelle und statis ·
rotanti a funzionamento ultrasonico. Teamwork 2001;3:
tiche Untersuchungen zur Pr�parationsmethodik. Otsch
26-34·
Zahnarztl z 1984:39:798-800.
s- Massironi D. Banistelli A Sistema di preparazione per
corone complete. Masson Protech 2000;J :JS-476. Drisko CL, Cochran DL, Blieden T, et al. Postion paper:
n.
Wegmann U. Quality of ground enamel suraces and preparation margins [in German). Dtsch Zahnarztl Z 1985:40=472-478.
Sonic and ultrasonic scalers in periodontics. Research, Science and Therapy Committee of the American Academy of Periodontology. I Periodontal 2000;71: 1792-1801.
Figs 5-45 and 5-46 Excellent integration ol the metal-ceramic restoration with the gingiva alter cementation.
Fig 5-47 Lateral view of clinical adaptation of the restoration margin through the stereomicroscope.
172
173
C H A P T E R
6
T E C H N I C A L C O N S I D E R AT I O N S F O R S O FT T I S S U E R ET RACT I O N
6-2
G
ingival retraction requires healthy periodontal
Supragingival restoration margins are considered
tissue that is free of pathology and inflam
to be most favorable for oral health, in part because
mation (Figs 6-1 to 6-3). Accurate analysis of
of their greater accessibility.' The supragingival posi
the periodontal tissue should be performed during
tion provides access during all stages of treatment:
the diagnostic stage to identify periodontal disease.
tooth preparation, finishing, impression taking, try·
anomalies, or insufficient supporting tissue (Figs 6·4
in, and cementation. Despite the advantage of greater
and 6-5). Gingival probing is essential for evaluating
access, the supragingival restoration margin offers
periodontal health and deciding whether surgery is
poor esthetics; it is generally indicated for the lingual
necessary. Prosthetic restoration can begin only after
aspect of prepared teeth.
the clinical condition of the gingiva has been identi
A finish line in a juxtagingival position is more
fied and phase one treatment has been completed.
esthetic but lies closer to the gingival tissue. The
When taking impressions, the clinician should verify
juxtagingival restoration margin is used for the buc
the gingival biotype to determine how to proceed
cal aspect of mandibular molars and premolars.
with the gingival displacement (Figs 6-6 to 6-9).
The intracrevicular position is best for addressing esthetic concerns or for the following indications2: a need for greater retention and resistance because of
DETERM I N I N G THE POSITION O F
i ncreased height and surface area of the restoration;
THE RESTORATION MARGIN
presence of caries or old restorations at the margin,
Fin ish line positions
ture; or the problem of an accentuated radicular sen
requiring an apical shift to find healthy dental struc
174
6·5
sitivity in prepared teeth.
Restoration margins can be placed in one of three
In the past, the position of a restoration margin
areas of the gingiva: supragingival, iuxtagingival, or
was thought to be the cause of periodontal lesions
intracrevicular.
and other problems, but today the influence of the ..
Fig 6-1 Healthy periodontium is indispensable for successful gingival retraction. figs 6-2 and 6-3 Gingival margin with natural dentition !at 24 x and 50 X magnification). Figs 6-4 and 6-5 Periodontal probing and analysis of the keratinized tissue help to classify the gingival biotype and to ensure stability and integrity of the restoration margin over lime.
C H A P T E R
6
T E C H N I C A L C O N S I D E R AT I O N S F O R S O FT T I S S U E R ET RACT I O N
6-2
G
ingival retraction requires healthy periodontal
Supragingival restoration margins are considered
tissue that is free of pathology and inflam
to be most favorable for oral health, in part because
mation (Figs 6-1 to 6-3). Accurate analysis of
of their greater accessibility.' The supragingival posi
the periodontal tissue should be performed during
tion provides access during all stages of treatment:
the diagnostic stage to identify periodontal disease.
tooth preparation, finishing, impression taking, try·
anomalies, or insufficient supporting tissue (Figs 6·4
in, and cementation. Despite the advantage of greater
and 6-5). Gingival probing is essential for evaluating
access, the supragingival restoration margin offers
periodontal health and deciding whether surgery is
poor esthetics; it is generally indicated for the lingual
necessary. Prosthetic restoration can begin only after
aspect of prepared teeth.
the clinical condition of the gingiva has been identi
A finish line in a juxtagingival position is more
fied and phase one treatment has been completed.
esthetic but lies closer to the gingival tissue. The
When taking impressions, the clinician should verify
juxtagingival restoration margin is used for the buc
the gingival biotype to determine how to proceed
cal aspect of mandibular molars and premolars.
with the gingival displacement (Figs 6-6 to 6-9).
The intracrevicular position is best for addressing esthetic concerns or for the following indications2: a need for greater retention and resistance because of
DETERM I N I N G THE POSITION O F
i ncreased height and surface area of the restoration;
THE RESTORATION MARGIN
presence of caries or old restorations at the margin,
Fin ish line positions
ture; or the problem of an accentuated radicular sen
requiring an apical shift to find healthy dental struc
174
6·5
sitivity in prepared teeth.
Restoration margins can be placed in one of three
In the past, the position of a restoration margin
areas of the gingiva: supragingival, iuxtagingival, or
was thought to be the cause of periodontal lesions
intracrevicular.
and other problems, but today the influence of the ..
Fig 6-1 Healthy periodontium is indispensable for successful gingival retraction. figs 6-2 and 6-3 Gingival margin with natural dentition !at 24 x and 50 X magnification). Figs 6-4 and 6-5 Periodontal probing and analysis of the keratinized tissue help to classify the gingival biotype and to ensure stability and integrity of the restoration margin over lime.
CHAPTER
6
Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
. position is regarded as secondary. As Richter-Snapp
Analyzing the dento g i n g ival complex
et al J concluded, "the adaptation, the precision, and the quality of the restoration margin can be of
The term biologic width was coined in 1962,4 but the
greater significance in terms of gingival health. than
first studies to measure its components were com·
the position of the margin itself."
pleted by Gargiulo et aJS in 1961 and taken up 20
Today, margin positioning is influenced to a large
years later by Dragoo and Williams 6·7 These re
extent by patients' demand for esthetics. Clinicians
searchers established the mean dimensions of peri·
execute intracrevicular margins for maxillary and man·
odontal tissue as follows: gingival sulcus. o.69 mm;
dlbular anterior segments and sometimes for restora
junctional epithelium. 0.97 mm; and connective tis·
tions as distal as second premolars. while juxtagin
sue. 1.07 mm. The mean dimension of the biologic
glval margins are reserved for the lingual surfaces of
width is 2.04 mm (0.97
all prepared teeth. However, when finalizing a pros·
ions diverge, most clinicians agree that biologic
thesis for a patient who has been treated for ad·
width is an inviolable gingival limit.
+
Polemics continue. however, over which gingival
gival recession. practical considerations outweigh
components are included in the biologic width and
esthetics. and the margins must be positioned supra·
their mean dimensions. Vacek et ai8 conducted a study
When the patient has insufficient keratinized tis
FIG 6-7
FIG 6-8
FIG 6-9
1.07 mm). Although opin·
vanced periodontal disease or has considerable gin·
gingivally.
FIG 6-6
of 10 cadaveric arches to measure the connective tis sue. the epithelium. and the related loss and depth
sue. and related complications prohibit surgery, the
of the sulcus. Their results showed that the connec·
clinician must alter the finish line design. By working
tive tissue had a mean thickness of o.n
at the buccal aspect with a 90-degree rounded shout·
t h e junctional epithelium. 1 . 1 4
+
:
0.32 m m ;
0-49 mm; a n d t h e
der or a modified chamfer preparation. the clinician
gingival sulcus. 1 . 3 4
can complete the restoration with a collarless pros·
the biologic width is often intruded upon. especially
thesis (Fig 6-10). When a patient requires intracrevic
in the interproximal and buccal areas. and less fre·
ular margins, the clinician should be able to deter
quently in the palatal region, whether by mistake or
+
o.84 mm. I n daily practice,
mine its feasibility during the diagnostic stage by
due to carelessness. Violation of the biologic width
classifying the periodontal biotype and evaluating the
generally causes inflammation of the circular fibers.
clinical situation (Figs 6-u to 6-14).
even in areas not adjacent to the site of damage.
..
Fig 6-6 Absence of kerati � ized tiss � e around a � andibular right canine. � n this case. intrasulcular positioning of the finish l1ne is impossi . ble. F1gs 6 - 7to 6-9 Analysis of kerat1n1zed tissue 1n a pat10nt With a ceramic crown on the mmllary right central incisor. The periodontal bio type is thick. wh1ch is evident under high magnification and espemlly in a lateral v1ew.
171
m
CHAPTER
6
Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
. position is regarded as secondary. As Richter-Snapp
Analyzing the dento g i n g ival complex
et al J concluded, "the adaptation, the precision, and the quality of the restoration margin can be of
The term biologic width was coined in 1962,4 but the
greater significance in terms of gingival health. than
first studies to measure its components were com·
the position of the margin itself."
pleted by Gargiulo et aJS in 1961 and taken up 20
Today, margin positioning is influenced to a large
years later by Dragoo and Williams 6·7 These re
extent by patients' demand for esthetics. Clinicians
searchers established the mean dimensions of peri·
execute intracrevicular margins for maxillary and man·
odontal tissue as follows: gingival sulcus. o.69 mm;
dlbular anterior segments and sometimes for restora
junctional epithelium. 0.97 mm; and connective tis·
tions as distal as second premolars. while juxtagin
sue. 1.07 mm. The mean dimension of the biologic
glval margins are reserved for the lingual surfaces of
width is 2.04 mm (0.97
all prepared teeth. However, when finalizing a pros·
ions diverge, most clinicians agree that biologic
thesis for a patient who has been treated for ad·
width is an inviolable gingival limit.
+
Polemics continue. however, over which gingival
gival recession. practical considerations outweigh
components are included in the biologic width and
esthetics. and the margins must be positioned supra·
their mean dimensions. Vacek et ai8 conducted a study
When the patient has insufficient keratinized tis
FIG 6-7
FIG 6-8
FIG 6-9
1.07 mm). Although opin·
vanced periodontal disease or has considerable gin·
gingivally.
FIG 6-6
of 10 cadaveric arches to measure the connective tis sue. the epithelium. and the related loss and depth
sue. and related complications prohibit surgery, the
of the sulcus. Their results showed that the connec·
clinician must alter the finish line design. By working
tive tissue had a mean thickness of o.n
at the buccal aspect with a 90-degree rounded shout·
t h e junctional epithelium. 1 . 1 4
+
:
0.32 m m ;
0-49 mm; a n d t h e
der or a modified chamfer preparation. the clinician
gingival sulcus. 1 . 3 4
can complete the restoration with a collarless pros·
the biologic width is often intruded upon. especially
thesis (Fig 6-10). When a patient requires intracrevic
in the interproximal and buccal areas. and less fre·
ular margins, the clinician should be able to deter
quently in the palatal region, whether by mistake or
+
o.84 mm. I n daily practice,
mine its feasibility during the diagnostic stage by
due to carelessness. Violation of the biologic width
classifying the periodontal biotype and evaluating the
generally causes inflammation of the circular fibers.
clinical situation (Figs 6-u to 6-14).
even in areas not adjacent to the site of damage.
..
Fig 6-6 Absence of kerati � ized tiss � e around a � andibular right canine. � n this case. intrasulcular positioning of the finish l1ne is impossi . ble. F1gs 6 - 7to 6-9 Analysis of kerat1n1zed tissue 1n a pat10nt With a ceramic crown on the mmllary right central incisor. The periodontal bio type is thick. wh1ch is evident under high magnification and espemlly in a lateral v1ew.
171
m
CHAPTER 6 Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
..
An article by Kois9 has become a standard refer
In a study by Tarnow et al.'0 the finish lines in two
ence for the study and analysis of the relationship be
patients were positioned halfway between the bone
tween the bone crest and the gingival margin. Kois's
crest and the gingival margin. The researchers noted
bone-sounding technique involves anesthetizing a
gingival recession ranging between 0-4 and 1.2 mm
gingival area before inserting a thin periodontal probe
after 2 weeks and 1.2 mm or more after 8 weeks.
to the bone crest. The buccal and interproximal mea
These results demonstrate histologically that reces
surements thus obtained define the ridge type and
sion phenomena were activated in the first 7 days;
its relationship to the gingiva. This procedure has
the junctional epithelium and connective tissue then
been used to distinguish three types of gingiva-bone
re-formed apical to the finish line. This study indi
crest structure.9 A normal crest, found in 85% of
cates that the natural mechanisms that repair inva
patients, is defined as having probing depths of
sive damage to the biologic width result in gingival
3 mm in buccal areas and 4-5 mm in interproximal
recession, with all or its obvious functional and
areas. A high crest. found in 2% of patients, has
esthetic drawbacks.
probing depths of less than 3 mm in both the buccal
Although they never use the bone-sounding tech
and interproximal areas. A /ow crest, present in 13%
nique, the authors of this text adhere to the Kois
of patients, has probing depths of greater than 3 mm
classification9 of ridge type. By analyzing the clinical
in the buccal area and greater than 5 mm in the inter
results or normal periodontal probing, intraoral radio
proximal regions.
graphs, and clinical examination, a clinician can detect
Different gingiva-bone crest structures require dif
many conditions, including gingival recession, insufi
ferent approaches to gingival retraction. With a high
cient keratinized gingiva, incomplete tooth eruption,
ridge, the clinician will have difficulty inserting retrac
and edentulous areas. Depending on the patient
tion cords and runs the risk of intruding on the bio
ridge type, the authors adopt different materials and
logic width. With a low ridge and unstable periodon
techniques. whenever possible, to perform periodon
tal tissue, gingival retraction can lead to gingival
tal interventions aimed at restoring the proper bio
recession (Figs 6-15 and 6-16).
logic width so as to allow for intracrevicular margins" (Figs 6-17 to 6-30).
Fig 6-10 Collarless metal-ceramic crown. This restoration technique is often proposed in cases in which gingival tissue is lack1ng and the restoration margin must be positioned supra- or juxtagingivally.
.
6- 1 3
Figs 6-11 o 6- 14 Details of a restoratiOn !Figs 6 - l l and 6-121 and a natural tooth !Figs 6-13 and 6-141 1profile views were pho _ _ tographed Without a flash). The anatomy of the g•ng1val sulcus and its relationship with the restoration is evident. Note the appearance of the sulcus under the stereomicroscope. as well as the emergence profile of the crown and tooth. The frontal v11ws illustrate the health of the gingival tissue for each.
171 179
CHAPTER 6 Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
..
An article by Kois9 has become a standard refer
In a study by Tarnow et al.'0 the finish lines in two
ence for the study and analysis of the relationship be
patients were positioned halfway between the bone
tween the bone crest and the gingival margin. Kois's
crest and the gingival margin. The researchers noted
bone-sounding technique involves anesthetizing a
gingival recession ranging between 0-4 and 1.2 mm
gingival area before inserting a thin periodontal probe
after 2 weeks and 1.2 mm or more after 8 weeks.
to the bone crest. The buccal and interproximal mea
These results demonstrate histologically that reces
surements thus obtained define the ridge type and
sion phenomena were activated in the first 7 days;
its relationship to the gingiva. This procedure has
the junctional epithelium and connective tissue then
been used to distinguish three types of gingiva-bone
re-formed apical to the finish line. This study indi
crest structure.9 A normal crest, found in 85% of
cates that the natural mechanisms that repair inva
patients, is defined as having probing depths of
sive damage to the biologic width result in gingival
3 mm in buccal areas and 4-5 mm in interproximal
recession, with all or its obvious functional and
areas. A high crest. found in 2% of patients, has
esthetic drawbacks.
probing depths of less than 3 mm in both the buccal
Although they never use the bone-sounding tech
and interproximal areas. A /ow crest, present in 13%
nique, the authors of this text adhere to the Kois
of patients, has probing depths of greater than 3 mm
classification9 of ridge type. By analyzing the clinical
in the buccal area and greater than 5 mm in the inter
results or normal periodontal probing, intraoral radio
proximal regions.
graphs, and clinical examination, a clinician can detect
Different gingiva-bone crest structures require dif
many conditions, including gingival recession, insufi
ferent approaches to gingival retraction. With a high
cient keratinized gingiva, incomplete tooth eruption,
ridge, the clinician will have difficulty inserting retrac
and edentulous areas. Depending on the patient
tion cords and runs the risk of intruding on the bio
ridge type, the authors adopt different materials and
logic width. With a low ridge and unstable periodon
techniques. whenever possible, to perform periodon
tal tissue, gingival retraction can lead to gingival
tal interventions aimed at restoring the proper bio
recession (Figs 6-15 and 6-16).
logic width so as to allow for intracrevicular margins" (Figs 6-17 to 6-30).
Fig 6-10 Collarless metal-ceramic crown. This restoration technique is often proposed in cases in which gingival tissue is lack1ng and the restoration margin must be positioned supra- or juxtagingivally.
.
6- 1 3
Figs 6-11 o 6- 14 Details of a restoratiOn !Figs 6 - l l and 6-121 and a natural tooth !Figs 6-13 and 6-141 1profile views were pho _ _ tographed Without a flash). The anatomy of the g•ng1val sulcus and its relationship with the restoration is evident. Note the appearance of the sulcus under the stereomicroscope. as well as the emergence profile of the crown and tooth. The frontal v11ws illustrate the health of the gingival tissue for each.
171 179
CHAPTER 6 Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
E V A L U AT I O N
0 F
P E R I O D O N TA L
B I OT Y P E
F1gs 6-lSand6-l6 Gingival recession w1th metal-ceramic restorations resulting from improper treatment of the gingiva.
lG
Fig 6·17 Prov1s1onal restoration in place after removal of the metal-ceramic crowns The dental techniciiR created leteral 1nd untral incisors with different shapes to accommodate uneven gingival contours. resulting in a lack of harmony and an unnatural appnrance. Fig 6-18 Residual tooth structure. Restoral1on w1ll require periodontal surgery. involving clinical crown lengthening 1nd formation of the cor rect bone and gingival contours F1gs 6-19 o 6-11 Surgical crown lengthening A gingival flap was made with 1 paramarginal incision and repositioned at the level of the bone crest. us1ng the measunng lip of a bur i H207 314 012. Komet). Two notches are made to mark the dis tance created between the bone crest and the finish line Figs 6-22 and 6-13 Mattress-style vertical sutures anchored to the periosteu m .
CHAPTER 6 Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
E V A L U AT I O N
0 F
P E R I O D O N TA L
B I OT Y P E
F1gs 6-lSand6-l6 Gingival recession w1th metal-ceramic restorations resulting from improper treatment of the gingiva.
lG
Fig 6·17 Prov1s1onal restoration in place after removal of the metal-ceramic crowns The dental techniciiR created leteral 1nd untral incisors with different shapes to accommodate uneven gingival contours. resulting in a lack of harmony and an unnatural appnrance. Fig 6-18 Residual tooth structure. Restoral1on w1ll require periodontal surgery. involving clinical crown lengthening 1nd formation of the cor rect bone and gingival contours F1gs 6-19 o 6-11 Surgical crown lengthening A gingival flap was made with 1 paramarginal incision and repositioned at the level of the bone crest. us1ng the measunng lip of a bur i H207 314 012. Komet). Two notches are made to mark the dis tance created between the bone crest and the finish line Figs 6-22 and 6-13 Mattress-style vertical sutures anchored to the periosteu m .
[l· I Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
Figs 6-24 and 6-25 Clinical case presenting with four metal-ceramic crowns lhal are incongruous in form and gingival contour. The palienl sought a new restoration because of significant gingival recession of I he central and lateral incisors. Figs 6-26 and 6-27 Presurgical views show1ng lhe residual Ieeth before and after loolh whitening with the walking bleach procedure. using sodium perborale and hydrogen peroxide.
112
Figs 6-28 and 6-2g Surgical stage with an apically positioned gingival flap. The views show lhe new contours of remodeled bone and lhe treat ment to lhe palatal area. Fig 6-30 Cornick"s - baslinf sutures.
18J
[l· I Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
Figs 6-24 and 6-25 Clinical case presenting with four metal-ceramic crowns lhal are incongruous in form and gingival contour. The palienl sought a new restoration because of significant gingival recession of I he central and lateral incisors. Figs 6-26 and 6-27 Presurgical views show1ng lhe residual Ieeth before and after loolh whitening with the walking bleach procedure. using sodium perborale and hydrogen peroxide.
112
Figs 6-28 and 6-2g Surgical stage with an apically positioned gingival flap. The views show lhe new contours of remodeled bone and lhe treat ment to lhe palatal area. Fig 6-30 Cornick"s - baslinf sutures.
18J
CHAPTER 6 Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
.. G I N G IVAL RETRACTION
minum sulfate, and ferrous sulfate and their various combinations (Fig 6·38 to 6·40).
T h e need t o retract gingiva for taking impressions i s
Surgical techniques involve rotary curettage or
universally acknowledged, »-t4 although clinicians
electrosurgery to remove the epithelial layer of the
disagree as to technique. The complexity of the pro·
sulcular tissue.
cedure arises from a need to provide adequate hor· izontal space for the impression materials. Laufer et
periodontal tissue that has not been damaged or innamed during tooth preparation. The selection of
0.2
and 0-4 mm, so that when the re·
horizontal displacement and a significant undercut 6-3 1
a retraction technique depends on the operator's ex·
traction cord is removed, the clinician can compen·
perience, the periodontal biotype, and, in the authors'
sate for the substantial undercut of the final prepa
view, the principle of choosing the least invasive
ration (Figs 6-31 to 6·34). Gingival retraction during
technique that will produce the most effective re·
any stage of restoration, no matter the technique,
suits. Based on these criteria, mechanical or mechan·
may cause a lesion to form on the periodontal tis·
icochemical methods can be used, but surgery,
sue.'6 Periodontal tissue with normal healing capac·
whether with a rotating instrument or electric scalpel,
ity will repair itself.'7-'B
exists between a m i n i mum
The use of any retraction system requires healthy
at'S have determined that the horizontal space must be between
A di rect relationship usually
should not be considered because of the clinical dif· ficulties and the uncertainty of outcome.
Gingival retraction techniques
Gingival retraction is divided into two stages, namely vertical and horizontal. During vertical de·
Techniques for gingival retraction are traditionally
nection, the clinician can position and complete the
classiied as mechanical, mechanicochemical, and sur·
finish line, while horizontal denection facilitates im·
gicat. Mechanical techniques are manifold and in·
pression taking and the subsequent removal of the
elude the use of silk or cotton cords, silicone-based
impression material.
substances, copper rings, and compressive displace·
Traditionally, these two stages are accomplished
ment.'9 These techniques are sometimes insuficient
through the use of a double retraction cord," along
for obtaining the required retraction for refining prep
with a small-diameter thread to create vertical dis·
arations and taking impressions 20 In the authors'
placement as well as a larger- diameter thread for
view, some of these methods can even be harmful
horizontal denection. The larger-diameter thread is
(Figs 6·35 to 6-37).
removed immediately before the application of the
Mechanicochemical techniques combine mechan·
impression materials, whereas the small-diameter
ical and chemical interventions. The term often refers
thread remains i n place during the impression. Clini
to the use of retraction cords impregnated with solu·
cians must understand the characteristics of diferent
tions that have hemostatic or vasoconstricting
retraction cords and their compatibility with the
effects, such as epinephrine, aluminum chloride, alu·
impression materials.
Fig 6-31 Design far intact tooth structure beyond the finish line. which represents the largest undercut possible. in relation to the quantity of material needed for the impression because of the need to keep horizontal retraction to a minimum and thus make the positioning of the marg1n reliable. Much also depends on the type of tooth being prepared. because a triangular tooth that tapers toward the root w1ll have greater undercut than a square tooth with a very large root. Figs 6-32 and 6-33 Tooth prepared for a ceramic complete crown The limited space between the epithelium and the finish line can be seen. In this sit uation it would be futile to allempt to take an impress1on without a retraction cord in place. Fig 6-4 Silvered master cast _ and the area reveals the f1n1sh line of 1ntact tooth structure beyond it. 14
..
CHAPTER 6 Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
.. G I N G IVAL RETRACTION
minum sulfate, and ferrous sulfate and their various combinations (Fig 6·38 to 6·40).
T h e need t o retract gingiva for taking impressions i s
Surgical techniques involve rotary curettage or
universally acknowledged, »-t4 although clinicians
electrosurgery to remove the epithelial layer of the
disagree as to technique. The complexity of the pro·
sulcular tissue.
cedure arises from a need to provide adequate hor· izontal space for the impression materials. Laufer et
periodontal tissue that has not been damaged or innamed during tooth preparation. The selection of
0.2
and 0-4 mm, so that when the re·
horizontal displacement and a significant undercut 6-3 1
a retraction technique depends on the operator's ex·
traction cord is removed, the clinician can compen·
perience, the periodontal biotype, and, in the authors'
sate for the substantial undercut of the final prepa
view, the principle of choosing the least invasive
ration (Figs 6-31 to 6·34). Gingival retraction during
technique that will produce the most effective re·
any stage of restoration, no matter the technique,
suits. Based on these criteria, mechanical or mechan·
may cause a lesion to form on the periodontal tis·
icochemical methods can be used, but surgery,
sue.'6 Periodontal tissue with normal healing capac·
whether with a rotating instrument or electric scalpel,
ity will repair itself.'7-'B
exists between a m i n i mum
The use of any retraction system requires healthy
at'S have determined that the horizontal space must be between
A di rect relationship usually
should not be considered because of the clinical dif· ficulties and the uncertainty of outcome.
Gingival retraction techniques
Gingival retraction is divided into two stages, namely vertical and horizontal. During vertical de·
Techniques for gingival retraction are traditionally
nection, the clinician can position and complete the
classiied as mechanical, mechanicochemical, and sur·
finish line, while horizontal denection facilitates im·
gicat. Mechanical techniques are manifold and in·
pression taking and the subsequent removal of the
elude the use of silk or cotton cords, silicone-based
impression material.
substances, copper rings, and compressive displace·
Traditionally, these two stages are accomplished
ment.'9 These techniques are sometimes insuficient
through the use of a double retraction cord," along
for obtaining the required retraction for refining prep
with a small-diameter thread to create vertical dis·
arations and taking impressions 20 In the authors'
placement as well as a larger- diameter thread for
view, some of these methods can even be harmful
horizontal denection. The larger-diameter thread is
(Figs 6·35 to 6-37).
removed immediately before the application of the
Mechanicochemical techniques combine mechan·
impression materials, whereas the small-diameter
ical and chemical interventions. The term often refers
thread remains i n place during the impression. Clini
to the use of retraction cords impregnated with solu·
cians must understand the characteristics of diferent
tions that have hemostatic or vasoconstricting
retraction cords and their compatibility with the
effects, such as epinephrine, aluminum chloride, alu·
impression materials.
Fig 6-31 Design far intact tooth structure beyond the finish line. which represents the largest undercut possible. in relation to the quantity of material needed for the impression because of the need to keep horizontal retraction to a minimum and thus make the positioning of the marg1n reliable. Much also depends on the type of tooth being prepared. because a triangular tooth that tapers toward the root w1ll have greater undercut than a square tooth with a very large root. Figs 6-32 and 6-33 Tooth prepared for a ceramic complete crown The limited space between the epithelium and the finish line can be seen. In this sit uation it would be futile to allempt to take an impress1on without a retraction cord in place. Fig 6-4 Silvered master cast _ and the area reveals the f1n1sh line of 1ntact tooth structure beyond it. 14
..
chnical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
f1g a 3S N1tural preparad tooth follow�ng removal of th1 frtcturod porcol11n lam1nato Yeneer
f1g a 3a Following proper ra-propor1t1on of th1 tooth, 1 non impregnated silk cord 11 pos11ioned 1n tho sulcus for m1n1mal vertical deflection r1g 8-7 In 1n occluul vltw the cord c1nnot be sun around th1 1nt1r1 buccal aspect, a 11gn of insuff1c1enl deflection
Figs 6-39 and 6-0 Cementation phase of the restoratiOn, w1th the veneer 1n place after removal of rubber dam Note the perfect volumetm pro portiOns and the marginal adaptatiOn
f1g & 31 S1m1 tooth 1fler the non1mpregn1ted 11lk cord hu bun removed and repl1ced w1th a br11ded cord Impregnated w1th alum1num sui fall, providing grntor vert1c1l and homontal g1ng1v11 defl1clion
Ill
117
chnical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
f1g a 3S N1tural preparad tooth follow�ng removal of th1 frtcturod porcol11n lam1nato Yeneer
f1g a 3a Following proper ra-propor1t1on of th1 tooth, 1 non impregnated silk cord 11 pos11ioned 1n tho sulcus for m1n1mal vertical deflection r1g 8-7 In 1n occluul vltw the cord c1nnot be sun around th1 1nt1r1 buccal aspect, a 11gn of insuff1c1enl deflection
Figs 6-39 and 6-0 Cementation phase of the restoratiOn, w1th the veneer 1n place after removal of rubber dam Note the perfect volumetm pro portiOns and the marginal adaptatiOn
f1g & 31 S1m1 tooth 1fler the non1mpregn1ted 11lk cord hu bun removed and repl1ced w1th a br11ded cord Impregnated w1th alum1num sui fall, providing grntor vert1c1l and homontal g1ng1v11 defl1clion
Ill
117
CHAPTER 6 Technical Considerations for Sot Tissue Retraction
.. Retraction cords
break, hold the chemical solutions 2.5 times longer than other kinds of cords, and do not get tangled in
In prosthodontics, retraction cords are the most
rotating diamond burs during preparation. However,
common method used to displace tissue for impres·
they are easily cut during preparation and, because
sion taking, and many different types of cords and
they are more easily compressed, offer less gingival
chemical solutions are available (Fig 6·41). Most
retraction.
cords are made of various textile blends of wool, silk, cotton, and synthetic fibers, which are twisted, braided, or knitted together'9 (Fig 6-42). Cords also can be distinguished as either soft or compact. Sot
For mechanicochemical techniques, retraction cords
cords are easy to position and have a high capacity
are i mpregnated with chemical solutions that aug
for absorbing gingival fluids or chemical solutions,
ment the effect of retraction and hemostasis. How
but they can break easily during positioning and
ever, animal studies using dogs21 have shown that
removal and disintegrate when in contact with re·
chemical solutions cause a certain amount of inflam
traction fluids. Compact cords provide better hori·
mation of the connective tissue. Among the most
zontal displacement, exhibit minimal degeneration
frequently used solutions are epinephrine; various
from retraction fluids, and are less prone to break
astringents, such as aluminum chloride, aluminum
ing, but they are difficult to position and absorb min
sulfate, and ferrous sulfate; and combinations of
imal gingival or retraction luids.
these compounds.22
Twisted cords are the oldest type of cord used
Epinephrine is frequently used because it offers
in dentistry; these are composed of two or three
excellent vasoconstriction, provides considerable tis
threads twisted together. Twisted cords are easy to
sue retraction, and results in minimal postoperative
insert, and larger cords can be separated into two
tissue loss.'B One study,'J however, found no signif
smaller ones. However, the threads come apart eas
icant difference compared with aluminum sulfate.
ily during positioning and can get tangled in the
Epinephrine should never be used in patients whose
rotating bur during preparation. The braided cords are woven so tightly that it is
Fig 6-41 Different types of retraction cord. There are many types of cords and Impregnating substances.
Fig 6-42 Basic types ol retraction cord: (left to righ) braided. twisted. and knitted.
Fig 6-43 Result of taking an impression after using a retraction cord impregnated with aluminum chloride. The impression material. in this case polyether. cannot polymerize correctly in the presence of aluminum chloride. The same situation applies to aluminum sulfate and polyvinyl siloxane.
gingiva has been damaged during preparation or for patients with hyperthyroid conditions, cardiovascular
impossible to separate the threads. These cords are
pathologies, or hypersensitivity. The latter conditions
vey stable, remain intact during positioning, do not
may lead to cardiovascular reactions, such as an
get tangled or torn by rotating diamond burs, and
i ncrease in blood pressure, tachycardia, accelerated
come in two varieties: solid core and hollow core.
respiration, or headache.
. However, it can be used on damaged tissues with only moderate tissue loss after healing. The impregnating solutions can inhibit the poly
necessary to carefully clean the surfa ce of the cord with cotton pellets and water spray to reduce or eliminate the polymerization interference.
merization of impression material when they come in
Aluminum sulate ofers good gingival retraction
and eicient working time. Some authors27 believe
Cords with a solid core exhibit greater volume and
Aluminum chloride is a commonly used astringent
contact; a similar phenomena has been found when
more horizontal retraction, but they are stiffer and
that causes no adverse systemic effects and only a
latex gloves are used with polyvinyl siloxanes.'6
this chemical is toxic to tissues and, because of the
more difficult to inset. Cords with hollow cores have
few undesired localized effects. 24 It is usually found
Aluminum chloride is compatible with polyvinyl silox
sulfur, can interfere with the polymerization of poly
anes, but it inhibits the reaction of the polyether
greater flexibility and are easier to position, but they
marketed as a 14% solution. The hemostasis and
are less voluminous and exhibit less horizontal dis
retraction that are provided by aluminum chloride
placement. The knitted cords are knitted together without a central thread. They are easily compressed, do not
11
I m pregnating chem icals
vinyl siloxanes'8 i f the cord is not rinsed thoroughly
chains, and if they remain in contact, the impression
before impression. On the other hand, aluminum sul
are inferior to those of epinephrine; moreover, if
material loses its contours and detail and will appear
fate shows excellent compatibility with polyethers in
used at high concentrations, this chemical can cause
melted (Fig 6-43). Many clinicians continue to use
general, and it is recommended for use with these
significant postoperative paramarginal tissue loss.'S .
aluminum chloride as a hemostatic agent, making it
impression materials.
..
CHAPTER 6 Technical Considerations for Sot Tissue Retraction
.. Retraction cords
break, hold the chemical solutions 2.5 times longer than other kinds of cords, and do not get tangled in
In prosthodontics, retraction cords are the most
rotating diamond burs during preparation. However,
common method used to displace tissue for impres·
they are easily cut during preparation and, because
sion taking, and many different types of cords and
they are more easily compressed, offer less gingival
chemical solutions are available (Fig 6·41). Most
retraction.
cords are made of various textile blends of wool, silk, cotton, and synthetic fibers, which are twisted, braided, or knitted together'9 (Fig 6-42). Cords also can be distinguished as either soft or compact. Sot
For mechanicochemical techniques, retraction cords
cords are easy to position and have a high capacity
are i mpregnated with chemical solutions that aug
for absorbing gingival fluids or chemical solutions,
ment the effect of retraction and hemostasis. How
but they can break easily during positioning and
ever, animal studies using dogs21 have shown that
removal and disintegrate when in contact with re·
chemical solutions cause a certain amount of inflam
traction fluids. Compact cords provide better hori·
mation of the connective tissue. Among the most
zontal displacement, exhibit minimal degeneration
frequently used solutions are epinephrine; various
from retraction fluids, and are less prone to break
astringents, such as aluminum chloride, aluminum
ing, but they are difficult to position and absorb min
sulfate, and ferrous sulfate; and combinations of
imal gingival or retraction luids.
these compounds.22
Twisted cords are the oldest type of cord used
Epinephrine is frequently used because it offers
in dentistry; these are composed of two or three
excellent vasoconstriction, provides considerable tis
threads twisted together. Twisted cords are easy to
sue retraction, and results in minimal postoperative
insert, and larger cords can be separated into two
tissue loss.'B One study,'J however, found no signif
smaller ones. However, the threads come apart eas
icant difference compared with aluminum sulfate.
ily during positioning and can get tangled in the
Epinephrine should never be used in patients whose
rotating bur during preparation. The braided cords are woven so tightly that it is
Fig 6-41 Different types of retraction cord. There are many types of cords and Impregnating substances.
Fig 6-42 Basic types ol retraction cord: (left to righ) braided. twisted. and knitted.
Fig 6-43 Result of taking an impression after using a retraction cord impregnated with aluminum chloride. The impression material. in this case polyether. cannot polymerize correctly in the presence of aluminum chloride. The same situation applies to aluminum sulfate and polyvinyl siloxane.
gingiva has been damaged during preparation or for patients with hyperthyroid conditions, cardiovascular
impossible to separate the threads. These cords are
pathologies, or hypersensitivity. The latter conditions
vey stable, remain intact during positioning, do not
may lead to cardiovascular reactions, such as an
get tangled or torn by rotating diamond burs, and
i ncrease in blood pressure, tachycardia, accelerated
come in two varieties: solid core and hollow core.
respiration, or headache.
. However, it can be used on damaged tissues with only moderate tissue loss after healing. The impregnating solutions can inhibit the poly
necessary to carefully clean the surfa ce of the cord with cotton pellets and water spray to reduce or eliminate the polymerization interference.
merization of impression material when they come in
Aluminum sulate ofers good gingival retraction
and eicient working time. Some authors27 believe
Cords with a solid core exhibit greater volume and
Aluminum chloride is a commonly used astringent
contact; a similar phenomena has been found when
more horizontal retraction, but they are stiffer and
that causes no adverse systemic effects and only a
latex gloves are used with polyvinyl siloxanes.'6
this chemical is toxic to tissues and, because of the
more difficult to inset. Cords with hollow cores have
few undesired localized effects. 24 It is usually found
Aluminum chloride is compatible with polyvinyl silox
sulfur, can interfere with the polymerization of poly
anes, but it inhibits the reaction of the polyether
greater flexibility and are easier to position, but they
marketed as a 14% solution. The hemostasis and
are less voluminous and exhibit less horizontal dis
retraction that are provided by aluminum chloride
placement. The knitted cords are knitted together without a central thread. They are easily compressed, do not
11
I m pregnating chem icals
vinyl siloxanes'8 i f the cord is not rinsed thoroughly
chains, and if they remain in contact, the impression
before impression. On the other hand, aluminum sul
are inferior to those of epinephrine; moreover, if
material loses its contours and detail and will appear
fate shows excellent compatibility with polyethers in
used at high concentrations, this chemical can cause
melted (Fig 6-43). Many clinicians continue to use
general, and it is recommended for use with these
significant postoperative paramarginal tissue loss.'S .
aluminum chloride as a hemostatic agent, making it
impression materials.
..
CHAPTER 6 Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
.
Ferrous sulfate is commonly used as an astrin
ment with a thickness to suit the cord type (twisted,
gent because of its excellent hemostasis and negli
braided, or knitted). In the authors' view, cord place
gible tissue loss. However, this chemical provides
ment can be accomplished using a composite spat
minimal retraction and stains the gingival tissues.
ula or other tool and does not require the purchase
The precipitate that forms on the cord is difficult to
of expensive, specially designed instruments.
eliminate before taking impressions, and since fer
Using an instrument compatible with the cord
rous sulfate is incompatible with polyethers, clini
type, the clinician begins by gently inseting the cord
cians must use hydrocolloidal impression material.
in the interproximal zone. The greater quantity of
In the authors' view, the use of this chemical and its
gingival tissue found in the interproximal zone
associated impression technique are obsolete. Various combinations of astringents can also be
makes it more favorable than the buccal area for starting cord placement. The cord is inserted using
used for retraction. The combination of aluminum
a single spatula or two spatulas at the same time
sulfate and aluminum chloride seems to provide bet
(the bimanual technique) (Figs 6-44 to 6-47). The
ter results than either of the two used in combina
clinician must not push too hard, as this could result
tion with epinephrine.
in placing the cord too deep. After the first part of the cord is positioned, the clinician must work along
R ETRACTION PROCEDURES Mechanical a n d mechanicochemical techniq ues
the buccal zone. toward the initial point of insertion. If the clinician begins working away from the initial point of insertion, the portion of the cord already in place tends to shift (Fig 6-48). After inserting the cord along the buccal zone, the ends should be
Although the cord-positioning procedure is the same
inserted in the palatal area, where overlaps are bet
regardless of cord type or technique, retraction cords
ter tolerated.
can be used in single-cord, selective double-cord, or double-cord approaches. The single-cord technique generally requires a
Some authors29 recommend that. when using the single-cord technique, the cord be removed immedi ately before taking the impression. This technique,
cord of the smallest diameter (no. ooo or oo). For
however, should be avoided, because once the cord
cord insertion, the clinician uses a manual instru-
is removed, the sulcus tends to close immediately, .
Figs 6-4 and 6-45 Placement of retraction cord, preVIOusly cut to the size of the tooth. Insertion beg�ns '" the �nterprox1mal area and leaves the two loose ends to be overlapped '" the palatal area.
Fig 6-46 Bimanual technique. The cliniCian may use two Instruments simultaneously. one to hold lhe retract1on cord in posi tion and the second to insert 1t Fig 6-47 Effects of g�ng1val retraction. Before insert1on of the retraction cord. the finiSh l1ne was at the same level as the gin gival marg1n
X 6-4BA
6-488
Fig 6-48 insertlon technique Working away from the initial po1nt of Insertion /a) i s ineffective The cliniCian must work toward the IRII1al po1nt of insert1on fbi. starling at a po1nt a good diStance from the Initial point
110
lfl
CHAPTER 6 Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
.
Ferrous sulfate is commonly used as an astrin
ment with a thickness to suit the cord type (twisted,
gent because of its excellent hemostasis and negli
braided, or knitted). In the authors' view, cord place
gible tissue loss. However, this chemical provides
ment can be accomplished using a composite spat
minimal retraction and stains the gingival tissues.
ula or other tool and does not require the purchase
The precipitate that forms on the cord is difficult to
of expensive, specially designed instruments.
eliminate before taking impressions, and since fer
Using an instrument compatible with the cord
rous sulfate is incompatible with polyethers, clini
type, the clinician begins by gently inseting the cord
cians must use hydrocolloidal impression material.
in the interproximal zone. The greater quantity of
In the authors' view, the use of this chemical and its
gingival tissue found in the interproximal zone
associated impression technique are obsolete. Various combinations of astringents can also be
makes it more favorable than the buccal area for starting cord placement. The cord is inserted using
used for retraction. The combination of aluminum
a single spatula or two spatulas at the same time
sulfate and aluminum chloride seems to provide bet
(the bimanual technique) (Figs 6-44 to 6-47). The
ter results than either of the two used in combina
clinician must not push too hard, as this could result
tion with epinephrine.
in placing the cord too deep. After the first part of the cord is positioned, the clinician must work along
R ETRACTION PROCEDURES Mechanical a n d mechanicochemical techniq ues
the buccal zone. toward the initial point of insertion. If the clinician begins working away from the initial point of insertion, the portion of the cord already in place tends to shift (Fig 6-48). After inserting the cord along the buccal zone, the ends should be
Although the cord-positioning procedure is the same
inserted in the palatal area, where overlaps are bet
regardless of cord type or technique, retraction cords
ter tolerated.
can be used in single-cord, selective double-cord, or double-cord approaches. The single-cord technique generally requires a
Some authors29 recommend that. when using the single-cord technique, the cord be removed immedi ately before taking the impression. This technique,
cord of the smallest diameter (no. ooo or oo). For
however, should be avoided, because once the cord
cord insertion, the clinician uses a manual instru-
is removed, the sulcus tends to close immediately, .
Figs 6-4 and 6-45 Placement of retraction cord, preVIOusly cut to the size of the tooth. Insertion beg�ns '" the �nterprox1mal area and leaves the two loose ends to be overlapped '" the palatal area.
Fig 6-46 Bimanual technique. The cliniCian may use two Instruments simultaneously. one to hold lhe retract1on cord in posi tion and the second to insert 1t Fig 6-47 Effects of g�ng1val retraction. Before insert1on of the retraction cord. the finiSh l1ne was at the same level as the gin gival marg1n
X 6-4BA
6-488
Fig 6-48 insertlon technique Working away from the initial po1nt of Insertion /a) i s ineffective The cliniCian must work toward the IRII1al po1nt of insert1on fbi. starling at a po1nt a good diStance from the Initial point
110
lfl
CHAPTER 6 Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
. preventing penetration of the impression material.
drawback of using a second cord is the inevitable
. deflection using a compound of kaolin and aluminum
sive contact of the electrode with the tissues even at
Cord removal also can result in bleeding. The clini
compression and apical repositioning of the first
chloride (Expasyl, Pierre Rolland) which has a d ilat
low frequencyB can cause high temperatures from lateral heat, which also can result in tissue necrosis.
cian must keep the cord in place throughout the
cord, which makes cord positioning difficult to con·
ing effect (Figs 6-64 to 6-66). The product comes in
operative stages, from repositioning and completing
trol and healing from the gingival displacement
convenient capsules and can be injected while it is
For this reason, researchers and m a n u facturers
the finish line to taking the impression.
unpredictable.
still malleable directly into the sulcus with a small
have developed electrosurgery instruments that use
The cord must retract the gingiva enough to ex
However, i n the authors' experience, a second re
gauge syringe. Expasyl expands and hardens upon
small-diameter electrodes. These instruments, which
pose a portion of the unprepared tooth lying beyond
traction cord must never be used during tooth prepar
contact with the fluids in the sulcus. Because of the
have a filtered current that produces less lateral
the finish line, without i nterference from the soft tis
ation and positioning of the finish line because of
aluminum chloride, the clinician must rinse the area
heat, are more appropriately called radioscalpels and
sue. If the gingiva is not retracted suficiently, the
the serious risk of gingival recession. Thus, choosing
copiously before taking an im pression, especially if
their technique, radiosurgery. A radioscalpel works
impression material will not properly record the fin
a technique depends on which instruments are used
polyether material is being used. Expasyl is very
with ultrahigh-frequency radio waves to make a
ish line preparation and intact tooth (Figs 6-49 to
for the finish line positioning and which impression
effective when used in combination with a single
clean cut without necrosing the gingival tissues. In
6-53).
materials are used.
The selective double-cord technique involves insert
cord, but in the authors' opinion its use alone pro
addition to high frequency (27 MHz) and a small
vides insufficient retraction for taking an impression.
diameter electrode, an important distinction between
lose the points of reference, especially of the gingi
Moreover, if Expasyl is used without a retraction
the radioscalpel and the electroscalpel concerns the
or 2) in the interproximal area directly over
val margin, always proceeding according to the stages
cord, the clinician cannot position a subgingival
absence or presence of a grounding plate; the pres
the irst cord, to further displace the papillae (Figs
outlined in chapter 5- When using rotating instru
restoration margin without damaging the gingiva; it
ence of a large grounding plate causes anxiety i n
6-54 to 6-6o). This method of selective horizontal
ments for primary tooth reduction, the clinician must
does not provide the same amount of space that can
some patients. For these reasons, t h e use of a radio
displacement facilitates impression taking without
avoid accidentally touching or damaging the gingiva
be obtained by using a cord.
involving the delicate buccal tissues. The pieces of
in order to keep the tissue intact and free of bleed
ing small pieces of cord of equal or greater diameter (no. o,
1,
cord must be removed immediately before taking the
ing. Above all, the retraction cords must be placed,
impression.
no matter how temporarily, only after the guide
The double-cord technique requires the insertion
2
During tooth preparation, the clinician must never
groove and finish line position have been defined.
scalpel (Odontosurge, Odonto-Wave) is recommended. The clinician must a lways maintain visibility of the
Surg ical tech n i q ues
cut, which can be achieved by using magnifying instru
Sometimes, after vertical retraction with a single cord
The radioscalpel can be used only in the interproxi
ments such as a stereomicroscope in indirect vision.
of a second cord of equal or greater diameter (no. o,
If the clinician repositions the finish line with
and the completing of the finish line with oscillating
mal and palatal areas, and never in the buccal areas
1, or 2) directly over the first cord to obtain the hor
oscillating instruments to minimize gingival damage,
instruments, gingiva may still block access for the
(Figs 6-68 to 6-71). When it has been used to remove
izontal retraction for the entire ci rcumference of the
and if a continuous jet of water and air is used to
impression material. I n such cases, the clinician may
small bits of excess tissue, the point must be cleaned
prepared tooth1 2 ·3° (Figs 6-61 to 6-63). The second
prevent overheating, the ideal horizontal displace
need to remove gingival tissue using a surgical tech
after each cut, both with a gauze pad soaked in alco hol and with a medium-grit refinishing disk.
cord is removed just before the impression is taken,
ment can be obtained mechanically. Impression mate
nique (Fig 6-67). The traditional surgical procedure is
while the first cord is left in place. In the first 20 sec
rial can subsequently be injected in the sulcus with
electrosurgery, which uses high-frequency waves to
The authors believe the radioscalpel must be
onds after cord removal, the horizontal displacement
out requiring a second retraction cord. If, after repo
induce an electric current that cuts the gingival tis
used only in combination with a retraction cord and
of the soft tissue is reduced by 35%, and in the sub·
sitioning and completing the finish line with round
sue and coagulates the wounds. Most electroscalpels
is appropriate only for removing limited quantities of
sequent 20 seconds, another 18% of the displacement
ed chisels, the first retraction cord (which was posi
have two main components: a working point that is
gingival tissue. Clinicians are strongly discouraged from using the electroscalpel or the radioscalpel as
space is lostY The speed at which the impression
tioned 0.2 or 0.3 mm apical to the finish line) is not
an electrode and a metal dispersion box to ground
material is inserted after the second retraction cord
visible, the clinician may need additional horizontal
the current with a frequency of about 3 MHz.3'
is removed is therefore critical.
displacement. Localized displacement can be accom
The greatest d rawback to using electrosurgey is
the sole means of retraction because it is i mpossible to adequately control the depth of the cut.
Selecting a retraction technique depends on vari
plished manually by retracting the gingival tissue
the risk of producing high temperatures. Temperature
ous clinical factors and the type of cord used. For
with the spatula used to position the cords im
control requires using the electrical current at the
instance, the clinician would be well advised to use
mediately prior to inserting the impression material.
correct intensity; if it is too high, the electrode can
the double-cord technique for a patient with thick
When the gingiva obscures the retraction cord in
carbonize the tissue, whereas insuficient intensity
In clinical practice, diferent types of retraction cord
periodontal tissue and/or slight inflammation. The
several areas, the clinician can complete horizontal ..
will cause the tissue to adhere to the electrode. Exces-
are used depending on the periodontal biotype, the ..
A D D ITIONAL G U I D E LI N ES
193
CHAPTER 6 Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
. preventing penetration of the impression material.
drawback of using a second cord is the inevitable
. deflection using a compound of kaolin and aluminum
sive contact of the electrode with the tissues even at
Cord removal also can result in bleeding. The clini
compression and apical repositioning of the first
chloride (Expasyl, Pierre Rolland) which has a d ilat
low frequencyB can cause high temperatures from lateral heat, which also can result in tissue necrosis.
cian must keep the cord in place throughout the
cord, which makes cord positioning difficult to con·
ing effect (Figs 6-64 to 6-66). The product comes in
operative stages, from repositioning and completing
trol and healing from the gingival displacement
convenient capsules and can be injected while it is
For this reason, researchers and m a n u facturers
the finish line to taking the impression.
unpredictable.
still malleable directly into the sulcus with a small
have developed electrosurgery instruments that use
The cord must retract the gingiva enough to ex
However, i n the authors' experience, a second re
gauge syringe. Expasyl expands and hardens upon
small-diameter electrodes. These instruments, which
pose a portion of the unprepared tooth lying beyond
traction cord must never be used during tooth prepar
contact with the fluids in the sulcus. Because of the
have a filtered current that produces less lateral
the finish line, without i nterference from the soft tis
ation and positioning of the finish line because of
aluminum chloride, the clinician must rinse the area
heat, are more appropriately called radioscalpels and
sue. If the gingiva is not retracted suficiently, the
the serious risk of gingival recession. Thus, choosing
copiously before taking an im pression, especially if
their technique, radiosurgery. A radioscalpel works
impression material will not properly record the fin
a technique depends on which instruments are used
polyether material is being used. Expasyl is very
with ultrahigh-frequency radio waves to make a
ish line preparation and intact tooth (Figs 6-49 to
for the finish line positioning and which impression
effective when used in combination with a single
clean cut without necrosing the gingival tissues. In
6-53).
materials are used.
The selective double-cord technique involves insert
cord, but in the authors' opinion its use alone pro
addition to high frequency (27 MHz) and a small
vides insufficient retraction for taking an impression.
diameter electrode, an important distinction between
lose the points of reference, especially of the gingi
Moreover, if Expasyl is used without a retraction
the radioscalpel and the electroscalpel concerns the
or 2) in the interproximal area directly over
val margin, always proceeding according to the stages
cord, the clinician cannot position a subgingival
absence or presence of a grounding plate; the pres
the irst cord, to further displace the papillae (Figs
outlined in chapter 5- When using rotating instru
restoration margin without damaging the gingiva; it
ence of a large grounding plate causes anxiety i n
6-54 to 6-6o). This method of selective horizontal
ments for primary tooth reduction, the clinician must
does not provide the same amount of space that can
some patients. For these reasons, t h e use of a radio
displacement facilitates impression taking without
avoid accidentally touching or damaging the gingiva
be obtained by using a cord.
involving the delicate buccal tissues. The pieces of
in order to keep the tissue intact and free of bleed
ing small pieces of cord of equal or greater diameter (no. o,
1,
cord must be removed immediately before taking the
ing. Above all, the retraction cords must be placed,
impression.
no matter how temporarily, only after the guide
The double-cord technique requires the insertion
2
During tooth preparation, the clinician must never
groove and finish line position have been defined.
scalpel (Odontosurge, Odonto-Wave) is recommended. The clinician must a lways maintain visibility of the
Surg ical tech n i q ues
cut, which can be achieved by using magnifying instru
Sometimes, after vertical retraction with a single cord
The radioscalpel can be used only in the interproxi
ments such as a stereomicroscope in indirect vision.
of a second cord of equal or greater diameter (no. o,
If the clinician repositions the finish line with
and the completing of the finish line with oscillating
mal and palatal areas, and never in the buccal areas
1, or 2) directly over the first cord to obtain the hor
oscillating instruments to minimize gingival damage,
instruments, gingiva may still block access for the
(Figs 6-68 to 6-71). When it has been used to remove
izontal retraction for the entire ci rcumference of the
and if a continuous jet of water and air is used to
impression material. I n such cases, the clinician may
small bits of excess tissue, the point must be cleaned
prepared tooth1 2 ·3° (Figs 6-61 to 6-63). The second
prevent overheating, the ideal horizontal displace
need to remove gingival tissue using a surgical tech
after each cut, both with a gauze pad soaked in alco hol and with a medium-grit refinishing disk.
cord is removed just before the impression is taken,
ment can be obtained mechanically. Impression mate
nique (Fig 6-67). The traditional surgical procedure is
while the first cord is left in place. In the first 20 sec
rial can subsequently be injected in the sulcus with
electrosurgery, which uses high-frequency waves to
The authors believe the radioscalpel must be
onds after cord removal, the horizontal displacement
out requiring a second retraction cord. If, after repo
induce an electric current that cuts the gingival tis
used only in combination with a retraction cord and
of the soft tissue is reduced by 35%, and in the sub·
sitioning and completing the finish line with round
sue and coagulates the wounds. Most electroscalpels
is appropriate only for removing limited quantities of
sequent 20 seconds, another 18% of the displacement
ed chisels, the first retraction cord (which was posi
have two main components: a working point that is
gingival tissue. Clinicians are strongly discouraged from using the electroscalpel or the radioscalpel as
space is lostY The speed at which the impression
tioned 0.2 or 0.3 mm apical to the finish line) is not
an electrode and a metal dispersion box to ground
material is inserted after the second retraction cord
visible, the clinician may need additional horizontal
the current with a frequency of about 3 MHz.3'
is removed is therefore critical.
displacement. Localized displacement can be accom
The greatest d rawback to using electrosurgey is
the sole means of retraction because it is i mpossible to adequately control the depth of the cut.
Selecting a retraction technique depends on vari
plished manually by retracting the gingival tissue
the risk of producing high temperatures. Temperature
ous clinical factors and the type of cord used. For
with the spatula used to position the cords im
control requires using the electrical current at the
instance, the clinician would be well advised to use
mediately prior to inserting the impression material.
correct intensity; if it is too high, the electrode can
the double-cord technique for a patient with thick
When the gingiva obscures the retraction cord in
carbonize the tissue, whereas insuficient intensity
In clinical practice, diferent types of retraction cord
periodontal tissue and/or slight inflammation. The
several areas, the clinician can complete horizontal ..
will cause the tissue to adhere to the electrode. Exces-
are used depending on the periodontal biotype, the ..
A D D ITIONAL G U I D E LI N ES
193
CHAPTtR 6 Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
6-50
Figs 6-4g and 6-50 Distance between the finish line and the vertical retraction cord. a s well as the relationship with the paramarginal tissues. as viewed through the microscope.
194
Fig 6-51 In the occlusal view. the retraction cords are visible after the finish line has been completed. There is no evidence of bleeding or damaged soft tissue. Figs 6-52 and 6-53 Removal of a metal crown from a vital tooth. After the tooth has been re-prepared. the retraction cord is perfectly visible immediately before the impression is taken.
195
CHAPTtR 6 Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
6-50
Figs 6-4g and 6-50 Distance between the finish line and the vertical retraction cord. a s well as the relationship with the paramarginal tissues. as viewed through the microscope.
194
Fig 6-51 In the occlusal view. the retraction cords are visible after the finish line has been completed. There is no evidence of bleeding or damaged soft tissue. Figs 6-52 and 6-53 Removal of a metal crown from a vital tooth. After the tooth has been re-prepared. the retraction cord is perfectly visible immediately before the impression is taken.
195
Fig 6-54 Occlusal view of a loath after a single retraction cord has been positioned. Gingiva obscures the cord around a significant part of the tooth. Figs 6-55 and 6-56 Selective double-cord technique. Portions of cord are inserted in the areas where gingiva requires additional retraction. The pieces of cord are removed immediately prior to laking lhe impression. Fig 6-57 Impression of the tooth. Figs 6-58 to 6-60 Ceramic crown with a pressed ceramic core offers high resistance. great precision. and excellent esthetics. Figs 6-61 and 6-62 Double- cord technique. Note lhe lwo loose ends provided for fast removal immediately before insertion of the impression material into the sulcus. Fig 6-63 Impression accurately records lhe finish line. The thickness of the material at the margin of the impression indi cates the horizontal displacement created by the double cords. Figs 6-64 to 6-66 Expansion material in the syringe and cartridge with single-use gauge to insert material direclly mto the sulcus. Expasyt. a combination of kaolin and aluminum chloride. provides good horizontal retraction. is slightly hemostatic. and works optimally in combination with a single vertical retraction cord. In the authors experien ce. Expasyl is useful i n cases lacking vertical retraction. such as those showing excess or slightly damaged tissue after the insertion of the first cord.
Fig 6-54 Occlusal view of a loath after a single retraction cord has been positioned. Gingiva obscures the cord around a significant part of the tooth. Figs 6-55 and 6-56 Selective double-cord technique. Portions of cord are inserted in the areas where gingiva requires additional retraction. The pieces of cord are removed immediately prior to laking lhe impression. Fig 6-57 Impression of the tooth. Figs 6-58 to 6-60 Ceramic crown with a pressed ceramic core offers high resistance. great precision. and excellent esthetics. Figs 6-61 and 6-62 Double- cord technique. Note lhe lwo loose ends provided for fast removal immediately before insertion of the impression material into the sulcus. Fig 6-63 Impression accurately records lhe finish line. The thickness of the material at the margin of the impression indi cates the horizontal displacement created by the double cords. Figs 6-64 to 6-66 Expansion material in the syringe and cartridge with single-use gauge to insert material direclly mto the sulcus. Expasyt. a combination of kaolin and aluminum chloride. provides good horizontal retraction. is slightly hemostatic. and works optimally in combination with a single vertical retraction cord. In the authors experien ce. Expasyl is useful i n cases lacking vertical retraction. such as those showing excess or slightly damaged tissue after the insertion of the first cord.
M I N I M A L
H O R I Z O N TA L
D E F L E C T I O N
Fig 6-67 Occlusal view of partially obscured retraction cords around two maxillary right t .. th after repositioning and com pleting the finish line. The radiosurgery technique removes minimal amounts of gingival tissue with a radioscalpel to leave the finish line visible and ready for impression material. Fig 6-68 Point of the radioscalpet used to remove excess tissue. A plastic (noncondu ctive) mirror and a medium-grit disk soaked in alcohol are also used in radiosurgery. Figs 6-69 and 6-70 Cut progression of the working point. as s"n through the stereomicroscope in indirect vision. Radiosurgery is never used on the buccal aspect of the tooth. The small tip of a high-frequency radioscalpel is very precise. and the presence of the first retraction cord helps the clinician to avoid errors of depth or direction. Fig 6-71 View of same tooth after removal of a thin band of gingival tissue that obscured the retraction cord. The sulcus shows no signs of bl .. ding after the radiosurgery. Fig 6-72 Polyether impression showing minimum thickness and height indicates that retraction was obtained using a single impregnated cord and radiosurgery.
.. various clinical stages, and the health of the gingiva.
patibility between the polyether material and the alu
In the presence of thin periodontium that is already
m inum chloride. Horizontal displacement can be
at risk of gingival recession, the authors recommend
achieved with a second retraction cord, xpasyl, or
nonimpregnated, compact no. ooo cords (Uitrapak
radiosurgey.
Knitted Cord, Ultradent) or 2/o silk sutures for verti
Though the literature specifies the quantity of
cal retraction. Horizontal retraction should be ob
required horizontal displacement as o.s mm for im t
tained using mechanical or mechanicochemical means
pressions using elastomeric materials and
(eg, xpasyl), but in most cases the use of a second
impressions using irreversible hydrocolloids,>B these
cord should be avoided.
values are too high to be considered noninvasive.
m m for
For thick periodontium, where the risk of subse
Modern elastomeric materials have such a high de
quent gingival recession is minimized, a twisted no.
gree of tear strength resistance that they can record
oo cord impregnated with aluminum sulfate (Gingi
the finish line and the intact tooth structure beyond
Aid Z-Twist), or a nonimpregnated compact no. ooo
the fi nish line using a thickness level below litera
cord (Uitrapak) soaked in aluminum chloride (Hemo
ture recommendations. Because hydrocolloid i mpres
dent, Premier) can be used. If polyether impression
sion materials require invasive horizontal retraction,
material is used, the area should be rinsed copious
the authors do not use them (Fig 6-72).
ly before the impression is taken to prevent incom-
..
M I N I M A L
H O R I Z O N TA L
D E F L E C T I O N
Fig 6-67 Occlusal view of partially obscured retraction cords around two maxillary right t .. th after repositioning and com pleting the finish line. The radiosurgery technique removes minimal amounts of gingival tissue with a radioscalpel to leave the finish line visible and ready for impression material. Fig 6-68 Point of the radioscalpet used to remove excess tissue. A plastic (noncondu ctive) mirror and a medium-grit disk soaked in alcohol are also used in radiosurgery. Figs 6-69 and 6-70 Cut progression of the working point. as s"n through the stereomicroscope in indirect vision. Radiosurgery is never used on the buccal aspect of the tooth. The small tip of a high-frequency radioscalpel is very precise. and the presence of the first retraction cord helps the clinician to avoid errors of depth or direction. Fig 6-71 View of same tooth after removal of a thin band of gingival tissue that obscured the retraction cord. The sulcus shows no signs of bl .. ding after the radiosurgery. Fig 6-72 Polyether impression showing minimum thickness and height indicates that retraction was obtained using a single impregnated cord and radiosurgery.
.. various clinical stages, and the health of the gingiva.
patibility between the polyether material and the alu
In the presence of thin periodontium that is already
m inum chloride. Horizontal displacement can be
at risk of gingival recession, the authors recommend
achieved with a second retraction cord, xpasyl, or
nonimpregnated, compact no. ooo cords (Uitrapak
radiosurgey.
Knitted Cord, Ultradent) or 2/o silk sutures for verti
Though the literature specifies the quantity of
cal retraction. Horizontal retraction should be ob
required horizontal displacement as o.s mm for im t
tained using mechanical or mechanicochemical means
pressions using elastomeric materials and
(eg, xpasyl), but in most cases the use of a second
impressions using irreversible hydrocolloids,>B these
cord should be avoided.
values are too high to be considered noninvasive.
m m for
For thick periodontium, where the risk of subse
Modern elastomeric materials have such a high de
quent gingival recession is minimized, a twisted no.
gree of tear strength resistance that they can record
oo cord impregnated with aluminum sulfate (Gingi
the finish line and the intact tooth structure beyond
Aid Z-Twist), or a nonimpregnated compact no. ooo
the fi nish line using a thickness level below litera
cord (Uitrapak) soaked in aluminum chloride (Hemo
ture recommendations. Because hydrocolloid i mpres
dent, Premier) can be used. If polyether impression
sion materials require invasive horizontal retraction,
material is used, the area should be rinsed copious
the authors do not use them (Fig 6-72).
ly before the impression is taken to prevent incom-
..
Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
.
Figs 6-73 and 6-74 Clinical case of a 30-year-old woman who requested the restoration of the metal-ceramic crown on the maxillary left cen tral incisor. After the crown has been removed. an inadequate preparation is revealed. with a post and core of dubious function. Fig 6-75 Diagnostic waxup The planned restoration of the left central incisor and the porcelain laminate veneer for the right central in cisor wilt give the central incisors new length and luminosity Fig 6-76 Removal of the dowel and bleaching of the nonvital tooth provided a suitable tooth preparation for a feldspathic ceramic crown. Fi g 6-77 After whitening. the tooth was reconstructed with a fiberglass dowel, and a no. DO retraction cord was placed. Fig 6-78 Apical retraction as viewed through the stereomicroscope. Fig 6-79 Finish line is repositioned with ultra sonic tools and finished with a rounded chisei iDeppeler D M l l .
00
T h e authors' philosophy regarding restorative
nique, preferring instead methods of retraction that
work is to favor techniques that cause the least trau
accomplish the minimum amount of horizontal dis 0.2
ma to tooth structure and gingiva; the authors rec
placement-about
ommend the s i ng le-co rd technique, the selective
cord and the restoration margin3•-required for
m m between the retraction
double-cord technique, the use of a single cord com
modern elastomeric i mpression materials.3S Such
bined with xpasyl, or even radiosurgery to remove
techniques enable the clinician to accomplish pre
small amounts of tissue (figs 6·73 to 6·88). The
cise repositioning of the restoration margin without
authors discourage the use of the double-cord tech-
risking the stability of the gingival tissue.
•
111
Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
.
Figs 6-73 and 6-74 Clinical case of a 30-year-old woman who requested the restoration of the metal-ceramic crown on the maxillary left cen tral incisor. After the crown has been removed. an inadequate preparation is revealed. with a post and core of dubious function. Fig 6-75 Diagnostic waxup The planned restoration of the left central incisor and the porcelain laminate veneer for the right central in cisor wilt give the central incisors new length and luminosity Fig 6-76 Removal of the dowel and bleaching of the nonvital tooth provided a suitable tooth preparation for a feldspathic ceramic crown. Fi g 6-77 After whitening. the tooth was reconstructed with a fiberglass dowel, and a no. DO retraction cord was placed. Fig 6-78 Apical retraction as viewed through the stereomicroscope. Fig 6-79 Finish line is repositioned with ultra sonic tools and finished with a rounded chisei iDeppeler D M l l .
00
T h e authors' philosophy regarding restorative
nique, preferring instead methods of retraction that
work is to favor techniques that cause the least trau
accomplish the minimum amount of horizontal dis 0.2
ma to tooth structure and gingiva; the authors rec
placement-about
ommend the s i ng le-co rd technique, the selective
cord and the restoration margin3•-required for
m m between the retraction
double-cord technique, the use of a single cord com
modern elastomeric i mpression materials.3S Such
bined with xpasyl, or even radiosurgery to remove
techniques enable the clinician to accomplish pre
small amounts of tissue (figs 6·73 to 6·88). The
cise repositioning of the restoration margin without
authors discourage the use of the double-cord tech-
risking the stability of the gingival tissue.
•
111
Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
Fig 6-80 Use of kaolin and aluminum chloride IExpasyt) allows for greater control of the interproximal tissue and increased horizontal retraction. Fig 6-81 Effect of Expasyt at the moment of impression taking.
Fig 6-81 Detail of the impression. Note the distinct and detailed finish line with the proper linearity.
Fig 6-83 Feldspathic ceramic crown and porcelain laminate veneer on the master cast.
Fig 6-84 Patient's smile 15 days alter cementation.
Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
Fig 6-80 Use of kaolin and aluminum chloride IExpasyt) allows for greater control of the interproximal tissue and increased horizontal retraction. Fig 6-81 Effect of Expasyt at the moment of impression taking.
Fig 6-81 Detail of the impression. Note the distinct and detailed finish line with the proper linearity.
Fig 6-83 Feldspathic ceramic crown and porcelain laminate veneer on the master cast.
Fig 6-84 Patient's smile 15 days alter cementation.
Fig 6-85 Complete smile.
Fig 6-86 Overall appearance of restorations in relation to the form and esthetics of the adjacent natural dentition.
Figs 6-87 and 6-88 lateral appearance of the restoration under the stereomicroscope. further illustrating its harmony with the natural denti tion in terms both of color and shape. The emergence profile of the restorations from the gingival sulcus is particularly effective.
Fig 6-85 Complete smile.
Fig 6-86 Overall appearance of restorations in relation to the form and esthetics of the adjacent natural dentition.
Figs 6-87 and 6-88 lateral appearance of the restoration under the stereomicroscope. further illustrating its harmony with the natural denti tion in terms both of color and shape. The emergence profile of the restorations from the gingival sulcus is particularly effective.
CHAPTER 6 Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
9· Kois JC. Altering gingival levels: The restorative connec·
REFEREN CES 1. Nevins M. Skurow HM. The intracrevicular restorative
10. Tarnow D. Stahl SS. Magner A. Zamzok ). Human gingi·
margin, the biologic width, and the maintenance of the
val attachment responses to subgingival crown place
gingival margin. lnt J Periodontics Restorative Dent
ment. Marginal remodelling. J Clin Periodontal 1986;13:
1984:4:3>-49·
563-569.
2.
18. A2Zi R, Tsao TF. Carranza FA. Kenney EB. Comparative
11on. Part 1: Biologic variables. J Esthet Dent 1994;6:3-9.
Reiman MS. Exposure of subgingival margins by non·
11. Walie GN, van der Weijden FA. Spanauf AJ. de Quincey
surgical gingival displacement. J Prosthet Dent 1976:36:
GN. Lengthening clinical crowns: A solution for specific
64�54·
periodontal, restorative and esthetic problems. Quintes·
3. Richter·Snapp K. Aquilino SA. Svare W. Turner A. Change in marginal it as related to margin design. alloy
12.
restorations. I Prosthet Dent 1988:6o:435-439·
hemorrhage. J Prosthet Dent 1984:51:647-651.
concept in periodontics and restorative dentistry. Alpha Omegan 1977;70:62-65.
13. Loe H, Silness 1. Tissue reactions to string packs used in ixed restorations. J Prosthet Dent 1963;13:318-323.
4 · Magne P. Magne M. Belser U. Impressions and esthetic
gival retraction medicaments on human gingival ibro· blasts [abstract 1411t J Dent Res 1987;66(spec issue) :283. 28. Albers HF. Impressions: A Text for Selection of Materials and Techniques. Santa Rosa. A: Alto Books, 199>:45-46.
crowns. J Prosthet Dent 1986:55:21-23. 20.
Runyan DA. Reddy TG Jr. Shimada LM. Auid absorbency of retraction cords after soaking in aluminum chloride solution. J Prosthet Dent 1988;6o:676678.
21.
Phillips RW. Skinne(s Science of Dental aterials. ed 9· Philadelphia: Saunders. 1991:45-46.
30. agne P. Belser U. Bonded Porcelain Restorations in the Anterior Dentition: A Biomimetic Approach. Berlin: Quin·
sponse induced by chemical retraction agents in beagle
tessence. 202:244-247.
dogs. tnt J Prosthodont 2002;15:14-19. 22.
29.
Kopac I, Cvetko E, arion L. Gingival inlammatoy re·
31. Laufer BZ. Saharav H. Langer H. Cardash S. The closure
Shaw DH. Krejci RF. Gingival retraction preference of
of the gingival crevice following gingival retraction for
dentists in general practice. Quintessence lnt 1986;17:
impression making. J Oral Rehabil 1997;24:62�35.
277-280. 23. Jokstad A. Clinical trial of gingival retraction cords. J Prosthet Dent 1999:81:258-261.
5· Gargiulo A. Wenz FM. Orban B). Dimensions and rela·
rehabilitation: The preparatory work, clinical procedures
24. Benson BW. Bamberg TJ. Hatch RA. Homan W )r. Tissue
tion of the dentogingival junction in humans. J Peri
and materials (in French and German]. Schweiz Monats·
displacement methods in ixed prosthodontics. I Prosthet
odontal 1961:32: 261-267.
schr Zahnmed 1995:105:1302-1316.
Dent 1986:55:175-181.
6. Dragoo MR. Williams GB. Periodontal tissue reactions to
27. Bata JP. Fe1gal R), Colman HL. Cytotoxic efects of gin·
Prosthet Dent
19. Tebrock OC. issue retraction for esthetic ceramometal
Nemez H, Donovan T, Landesman H. Exposing the gin· gival margin: A systematic approach for the control of
1
1983:50:561-565.
sence lnt 1994:25:81-88.
type, and porcelain proximity in porcelain·fused-to·metal
4. Ingber )S. Rose LF. Coslet )G. The "biologic width": A
study of gingival retraction methods.
32. Sherman JA. Electrosurgical accessories: New advance· ments. Oral Health 1986;76:37-39. 33· Kalkwaf KL. Krejci RF. Shaw DH. Edison AR. Histologic evaluation of gingival response to an electrosurgical blade. J Oral axilloac Surg 1987:45:671-674. 34· Lauer BZ, Saharav H . Cardash HS. The linear accuracy
15. Laufer BZ. Saharav H, Ganor Y. Cardash HS. The efect
25. Shaw DH, Krejci RF. Cohen OM. Retraction cords with
of impressions and stone dies as aected by the thick·
eriodontics Restorative
of marginal thickness on the distortion of diferent im·
aluminum chloride. Efect on the gingiva. Oper Dent
ness of the impression margin. lnt J Prosthodont 1994;
7. Dragoo MR. Williams GB. Periodontal tissue reactions to
16. Rue! ). Schuessler PJ. Malament K. Mori D. Efect of re·
26. de Camargo LM. Chee W, Donovan TE. Inhibition of
restorative procedures, part II. lnt I Periodontics Restor·
traction procedures on the periodontium in humans. J
polymerization of polvinyl siloxanes by medicaments
eect of sulcular width on the linear accuracy of impres
alive Dent 1982;2:34-45.
Prosthet Dent 1980:44:5o8-515.
used on gingival retraction cords. I Prosthet Dent 1993:
sion materials in the presence of an undercut. lnt J
70:114-117.
Prosthodont 2004;17:585-589.
restorative procedures. lnt Dent 1981:1:8-23.
I
pression materials. J Prosthet Dent 1996:76:466-471.
8. acek JS. Gher ME, Assad DA, Richardson AC, Giam·
17. de Gennaro GG, Landesman HM. Calhoun )E. Martinol
barresi ll. The dimensions of the human dentogingival
I. A comparison of gingival inlammation related to
junction. lnt J Periodontics Restorative Dent 1994;14:
retraction cords. J Prosthet Dent 1982;47:384-386.
1980;5:138-144·
7:247-252. 35· Saharav H. Kupeshmidt I. Laufer BZ. Cardash HS. The
154-165.
207
CHAPTER 6 Technical Considerations for Soft Tissue Retraction
9· Kois JC. Altering gingival levels: The restorative connec·
REFEREN CES 1. Nevins M. Skurow HM. The intracrevicular restorative
10. Tarnow D. Stahl SS. Magner A. Zamzok ). Human gingi·
margin, the biologic width, and the maintenance of the
val attachment responses to subgingival crown place
gingival margin. lnt J Periodontics Restorative Dent
ment. Marginal remodelling. J Clin Periodontal 1986;13:
1984:4:3>-49·
563-569.
2.
18. A2Zi R, Tsao TF. Carranza FA. Kenney EB. Comparative
11on. Part 1: Biologic variables. J Esthet Dent 1994;6:3-9.
Reiman MS. Exposure of subgingival margins by non·
11. Walie GN, van der Weijden FA. Spanauf AJ. de Quincey
surgical gingival displacement. J Prosthet Dent 1976:36:
GN. Lengthening clinical crowns: A solution for specific
64�54·
periodontal, restorative and esthetic problems. Quintes·
3. Richter·Snapp K. Aquilino SA. Svare W. Turner A. Change in marginal it as related to margin design. alloy
12.
restorations. I Prosthet Dent 1988:6o:435-439·
hemorrhage. J Prosthet Dent 1984:51:647-651.
concept in periodontics and restorative dentistry. Alpha Omegan 1977;70:62-65.
13. Loe H, Silness 1. Tissue reactions to string packs used in ixed restorations. J Prosthet Dent 1963;13:318-323.
4 · Magne P. Magne M. Belser U. Impressions and esthetic
gival retraction medicaments on human gingival ibro· blasts [abstract 1411t J Dent Res 1987;66(spec issue) :283. 28. Albers HF. Impressions: A Text for Selection of Materials and Techniques. Santa Rosa. A: Alto Books, 199>:45-46.
crowns. J Prosthet Dent 1986:55:21-23. 20.
Runyan DA. Reddy TG Jr. Shimada LM. Auid absorbency of retraction cords after soaking in aluminum chloride solution. J Prosthet Dent 1988;6o:676678.
21.
Phillips RW. Skinne(s Science of Dental aterials. ed 9· Philadelphia: Saunders. 1991:45-46.
30. agne P. Belser U. Bonded Porcelain Restorations in the Anterior Dentition: A Biomimetic Approach. Berlin: Quin·
sponse induced by chemical retraction agents in beagle
tessence. 202:244-247.
dogs. tnt J Prosthodont 2002;15:14-19. 22.
29.
Kopac I, Cvetko E, arion L. Gingival inlammatoy re·
31. Laufer BZ. Saharav H. Langer H. Cardash S. The closure
Shaw DH. Krejci RF. Gingival retraction preference of
of the gingival crevice following gingival retraction for
dentists in general practice. Quintessence lnt 1986;17:
impression making. J Oral Rehabil 1997;24:62�35.
277-280. 23. Jokstad A. Clinical trial of gingival retraction cords. J Prosthet Dent 1999:81:258-261.
5· Gargiulo A. Wenz FM. Orban B). Dimensions and rela·
rehabilitation: The preparatory work, clinical procedures
24. Benson BW. Bamberg TJ. Hatch RA. Homan W )r. Tissue
tion of the dentogingival junction in humans. J Peri
and materials (in French and German]. Schweiz Monats·
displacement methods in ixed prosthodontics. I Prosthet
odontal 1961:32: 261-267.
schr Zahnmed 1995:105:1302-1316.
Dent 1986:55:175-181.
6. Dragoo MR. Williams GB. Periodontal tissue reactions to
27. Bata JP. Fe1gal R), Colman HL. Cytotoxic efects of gin·
Prosthet Dent
19. Tebrock OC. issue retraction for esthetic ceramometal
Nemez H, Donovan T, Landesman H. Exposing the gin· gival margin: A systematic approach for the control of
1
1983:50:561-565.
sence lnt 1994:25:81-88.
type, and porcelain proximity in porcelain·fused-to·metal
4. Ingber )S. Rose LF. Coslet )G. The "biologic width": A
study of gingival retraction methods.
32. Sherman JA. Electrosurgical accessories: New advance· ments. Oral Health 1986;76:37-39. 33· Kalkwaf KL. Krejci RF. Shaw DH. Edison AR. Histologic evaluation of gingival response to an electrosurgical blade. J Oral axilloac Surg 1987:45:671-674. 34· Lauer BZ, Saharav H . Cardash HS. The linear accuracy
15. Laufer BZ. Saharav H, Ganor Y. Cardash HS. The efect
25. Shaw DH, Krejci RF. Cohen OM. Retraction cords with
of impressions and stone dies as aected by the thick·
eriodontics Restorative
of marginal thickness on the distortion of diferent im·
aluminum chloride. Efect on the gingiva. Oper Dent
ness of the impression margin. lnt J Prosthodont 1994;
7. Dragoo MR. Williams GB. Periodontal tissue reactions to
16. Rue! ). Schuessler PJ. Malament K. Mori D. Efect of re·
26. de Camargo LM. Chee W, Donovan TE. Inhibition of
restorative procedures, part II. lnt I Periodontics Restor·
traction procedures on the periodontium in humans. J
polymerization of polvinyl siloxanes by medicaments
eect of sulcular width on the linear accuracy of impres
alive Dent 1982;2:34-45.
Prosthet Dent 1980:44:5o8-515.
used on gingival retraction cords. I Prosthet Dent 1993:
sion materials in the presence of an undercut. lnt J
70:114-117.
Prosthodont 2004;17:585-589.
restorative procedures. lnt Dent 1981:1:8-23.
I
pression materials. J Prosthet Dent 1996:76:466-471.
8. acek JS. Gher ME, Assad DA, Richardson AC, Giam·
17. de Gennaro GG, Landesman HM. Calhoun )E. Martinol
barresi ll. The dimensions of the human dentogingival
I. A comparison of gingival inlammation related to
junction. lnt J Periodontics Restorative Dent 1994;14:
retraction cords. J Prosthet Dent 1982;47:384-386.
1980;5:138-144·
7:247-252. 35· Saharav H. Kupeshmidt I. Laufer BZ. Cardash HS. The
154-165.
207
C H A P T E R
7
C L I N I C AL C O N S I D ERAT I O N S F O R P R O V I S I O NAL P R O S T H E SES
P
rovisional prosthodontic procedures are fun damental to realizing a prosthetic restoration, whether involving a single tooth or multiple
teeth. Most clinicians now recognize the importance of minimizing the damage caused during impression taking. We also now understand the need to support the tissues with provisionals that are anatomically suitable in terms of shape, size, and length and that have perfectly polished margins in order to promote
•
Provide protection for the pulpal organ
•
Allow function in occlusion
•
FIG 7-1
FIG 7-2
FIG 7-3
FIG 7-4
FIG 7-5
FIG 7-6
Ensure a good fit and stable position
•
Permit easy access for hygiene
•
Safeguard the health of the periodontal margin
•
Guarantee acceptable esthetics
•
Exhibit good strength and retention
A broad range of technologies and materials are
satisfactory healing after the impression phase.'-3 In
available for fabricating provisionals that meet these
complex cases, in addition to conditioning and di
standards. With respect to how long they are expect
recting the gingival tissues, the provisional restora
ed to last, provisional prostheses are classified as
tion is essential diagnostically and therapeutically in
either short term or long term.
the initial stage of treatment. In simpler cases, it
Short-term provisional prostheses are further
promotes correct maturation and integration of the
subclassified as irst, second, or third-generation, de
soft tissues while performing its essential function,
pending on their purpose:
which is to protect the pulp and preserve the spatial relationship with adjacent and opposing teeth (Figs 7-1 to 7-6).
1.
First-generation provisional a. Preformed direct provisional prosthesis b. Provisional prosthesis with a thermoplastic or
CHARACTERISTICS A N D CLASS I FI CATI O N O F PROVI S I O NAL RESTORATIONS T h e ideal qualities of a provisional prosthetic res toration, as described by Shillingburg et al,4 are as follows:
8
silicone index c. Provisional based on a diagnostic waxup before preparation of the teeth 2. Second-generation
provisional
3- Third-generation provisional
..
Fig 7-1 A 44-year-old man presented for emergency treatment as a result of the decementation of the maxillary right lateral incisor restora tion. There was also secondary infiltration of lhe crowns on lhe right canine and left lateral incisor. The restored canine had a n artificial root. which was needed because the tooth showed marked recession. The crowns were replaced with two immediate provisional restorations. using direct preformed shells. Fig 7-2 Hole the initial adaptation of the provisional prosthesis on the canine and the residual lateral i n cisor. '•g '-3 Root canal treatment was redone. and lhe teeth were re-prepared for reconstruction with alumina core ceramic crowns. : , Replacement of the direcl provisional crowns w1th two second-generation provisionals. fabricated after the teeth were prepared and a polyether impres sion made. Fig• 7-5 and 7-6 Before and after cementation of the permanent crowns. respectively.
C H A P T E R
7
C L I N I C AL C O N S I D ERAT I O N S F O R P R O V I S I O NAL P R O S T H E SES
P
rovisional prosthodontic procedures are fun damental to realizing a prosthetic restoration, whether involving a single tooth or multiple
teeth. Most clinicians now recognize the importance of minimizing the damage caused during impression taking. We also now understand the need to support the tissues with provisionals that are anatomically suitable in terms of shape, size, and length and that have perfectly polished margins in order to promote
•
Provide protection for the pulpal organ
•
Allow function in occlusion
•
FIG 7-1
FIG 7-2
FIG 7-3
FIG 7-4
FIG 7-5
FIG 7-6
Ensure a good fit and stable position
•
Permit easy access for hygiene
•
Safeguard the health of the periodontal margin
•
Guarantee acceptable esthetics
•
Exhibit good strength and retention
A broad range of technologies and materials are
satisfactory healing after the impression phase.'-3 In
available for fabricating provisionals that meet these
complex cases, in addition to conditioning and di
standards. With respect to how long they are expect
recting the gingival tissues, the provisional restora
ed to last, provisional prostheses are classified as
tion is essential diagnostically and therapeutically in
either short term or long term.
the initial stage of treatment. In simpler cases, it
Short-term provisional prostheses are further
promotes correct maturation and integration of the
subclassified as irst, second, or third-generation, de
soft tissues while performing its essential function,
pending on their purpose:
which is to protect the pulp and preserve the spatial relationship with adjacent and opposing teeth (Figs 7-1 to 7-6).
1.
First-generation provisional a. Preformed direct provisional prosthesis b. Provisional prosthesis with a thermoplastic or
CHARACTERISTICS A N D CLASS I FI CATI O N O F PROVI S I O NAL RESTORATIONS T h e ideal qualities of a provisional prosthetic res toration, as described by Shillingburg et al,4 are as follows:
8
silicone index c. Provisional based on a diagnostic waxup before preparation of the teeth 2. Second-generation
provisional
3- Third-generation provisional
..
Fig 7-1 A 44-year-old man presented for emergency treatment as a result of the decementation of the maxillary right lateral incisor restora tion. There was also secondary infiltration of lhe crowns on lhe right canine and left lateral incisor. The restored canine had a n artificial root. which was needed because the tooth showed marked recession. The crowns were replaced with two immediate provisional restorations. using direct preformed shells. Fig 7-2 Hole the initial adaptation of the provisional prosthesis on the canine and the residual lateral i n cisor. '•g '-3 Root canal treatment was redone. and lhe teeth were re-prepared for reconstruction with alumina core ceramic crowns. : , Replacement of the direcl provisional crowns w1th two second-generation provisionals. fabricated after the teeth were prepared and a polyether impres sion made. Fig• 7-5 and 7-6 Before and after cementation of the permanent crowns. respectively.
CHAPTER 1 Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
.. Long-term provisional prostheses have a metal
more marginal discrepancies than composite based
frame with a base that can be filled to provide good
on bisphenol glycidyl methacrylate (bis-GMA) or
stabilization and resistance in occlusion.
polyethyl methacrylate and vinylethyl methacrylate,
Various techniques can be used for fabricating a
which had similar values.8 The latter materials are
provisional restoration, each one developed to meet
among the most frequently used for provisional
RESTORAT I O N S
tends to be difficult to work with and forms bubbles that impede satisfactory adhesion to the thermo plastic shell (Figs 7-7 and 7-8).
Short-term provis ionals
The authors are convinced that adhering to the treatment plan, fabricating the provisional prosthe
restorations. Christensen9 lists polyethyl methacry
First generation
sis in the laboratory, and scrupulously monitoring
late, bis-GMA, and the last-generation materials
The direct provisional restoration is generally made
the operating times will guarantee an optimal func
Clinical consi derations and p roced u res
described in chapter 9 as suitable for this purpose.
only in emergencies using a preformed shell (ION,
tional and esthetic outcome. Conversely, a lack of
In a study comparing the effect of six resin materi
3M Espe). Made of polycarbonate, these shells are
adequate planning will result i n unnecessary loss of
The different techniques for fabricating a provision
als,'0 Tjan et al" showed that various materials of
classified by type and size/shape rather than func
time and energy, while direct preformed and ther
al restoration should be considered in clinical situa
similar chemical composition may exhibit wide dif
tion or color, which are largely determined by the
moplastic shells will need to be replaced after a few
tions that require a provisional with specific charac
ferences in precision at the margin.
acrylic resin material used for filling them. The shells
days since they cannot sustain masticatory loads for
Another important feature for the clinician is the
are preformed for different tooth shapes (ie, incisors,
even a short period.
second or third generation should be based at least
amount of heat generated during hardening of both
canines, premolars, and molars) and must be re
A more suitable solution, in terms of function and
in part on how long it is planned to remain in the
the relining materials and the materials used to make
placed with laboratory-fabricated provisionals within
esthetics, is to prefill the shell or use shell provi
oral cavity. If it is to be used over a relatively long
the provisionals with a direct technique. When a tra
1
period, the provisional restoration should have a
ditional self-curing acrylic resin is used, intrapulpal
more precise margin and the capacity to resist
temperatures can rise by 0-42°C to 7.21°C during fill
theses are made by molding a shell of thermoplas
to simulate the ideal preparation. These shells act as
greater masticatory loads.
ing. According to a scientific study of the phenome
tic material (Erkopress, Erkodent), which is pressure
a support for the acrylic resin, which is baked in the
the demands of speciic clinical situations.
teristics. Selection of a provisional restoration of the
In addition to the risk of marginal infiltration,
week. In the non-emergency setting, provisional pros
non, 12 polyethyl methacrylate generated the most
sionals that are fabricated in the lab after the diag nostic stone cast or its duplicate has been modified
shaped after the disk has been preheated to 50°C to
lab and can be made by following the indications
teeth that have been prepared and provisionally
heat. When using materials that generate a consid
6o°C on the plaster cast. The existing parameters
provided by the diagnostic waxup, depending on the
are not modified in this stage.
restored tend to exhibit inflammation of the peri
erable degree of heat, it is advisable to apply con
odontal margin. Studies have shown that more
tinuous jets of air-water spray while the material is
plaque accumulates on the surface of provisional
hardening to counteract the heat as much as possi
index from an impression using extrahard (85
cone and poured in plaster, it can provide support
restorations than on the cervical surfaces of adja
ble. When selecting a material for intraoral filling, the
shores) silicone (Zetalabor, Zhermack). The acrylic
for the fabrication of the provisional restoration, act
cent natural teeth.S Therefore, the operator must be
potential increase in temperature is an important
resin is applied to the silicone index and pressed
ing as a mold for the resin, which is cured and then
precise in closing the marginal borders and defining
concern for minimizing damage to the pulp chamber.
over the preparations until curing is complete. This
finished in the laboratory.
the emergence profiles to prevent potential compli cations such as gingival recession_6.7
A variation of this technique is to make a silicone
The margins of provisional restorations are fin
results in immediate realization of a provisional
ished in resin. Because the resin inevitably deforms
restoration.
complexity and requirements of the treatment plane. Once the waxup is duplicated using the proper sili
To assist the clinician in controlling the position of the provisional prosthesis during filling, the labo
The material used to reproduce the finish line of
and fractures under stress,'3·'• provisional prosthe
The pressed-shell technique produces a provi
ratory technician makes an index in extrahard sili
the provisional prosthetic margin has a significant
ses must be used for a limited period or checked
sional that has the advantage of being very thin and
cone (85 shores) that is applied directly to the fin
effect on its precision. A study comparing diferent
and replaced frequently.
materials found that epimine presents considerably
210
.. PROCEDU RES FOR PROVI S I O NAL
..
thus adapts well to the shape of the preparations
ished provisional, forming occlusal stops on the
and the interproximal spaces. Moreover, once the
adjacent natural teeth for added stability. The provi
resin curing is finished, it becomes the surface of
sional prosthesis is then inserted into the silicone
the provisional restoration. Although the technique
index, which facilitates proper positioning on the
adapts readily to the clinical setting, it poses the
preparations in terms of axis and d i rection, thus
problem of using a fairly large amount of acrylic
eliminating the danger of excessive lengthening or
resin in the office as a support material. Acrylic resin
repositioning (Figs 7-9 to 7-13).
..
211
CHAPTER 1 Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
.. Long-term provisional prostheses have a metal
more marginal discrepancies than composite based
frame with a base that can be filled to provide good
on bisphenol glycidyl methacrylate (bis-GMA) or
stabilization and resistance in occlusion.
polyethyl methacrylate and vinylethyl methacrylate,
Various techniques can be used for fabricating a
which had similar values.8 The latter materials are
provisional restoration, each one developed to meet
among the most frequently used for provisional
RESTORAT I O N S
tends to be difficult to work with and forms bubbles that impede satisfactory adhesion to the thermo plastic shell (Figs 7-7 and 7-8).
Short-term provis ionals
The authors are convinced that adhering to the treatment plan, fabricating the provisional prosthe
restorations. Christensen9 lists polyethyl methacry
First generation
sis in the laboratory, and scrupulously monitoring
late, bis-GMA, and the last-generation materials
The direct provisional restoration is generally made
the operating times will guarantee an optimal func
Clinical consi derations and p roced u res
described in chapter 9 as suitable for this purpose.
only in emergencies using a preformed shell (ION,
tional and esthetic outcome. Conversely, a lack of
In a study comparing the effect of six resin materi
3M Espe). Made of polycarbonate, these shells are
adequate planning will result i n unnecessary loss of
The different techniques for fabricating a provision
als,'0 Tjan et al" showed that various materials of
classified by type and size/shape rather than func
time and energy, while direct preformed and ther
al restoration should be considered in clinical situa
similar chemical composition may exhibit wide dif
tion or color, which are largely determined by the
moplastic shells will need to be replaced after a few
tions that require a provisional with specific charac
ferences in precision at the margin.
acrylic resin material used for filling them. The shells
days since they cannot sustain masticatory loads for
Another important feature for the clinician is the
are preformed for different tooth shapes (ie, incisors,
even a short period.
second or third generation should be based at least
amount of heat generated during hardening of both
canines, premolars, and molars) and must be re
A more suitable solution, in terms of function and
in part on how long it is planned to remain in the
the relining materials and the materials used to make
placed with laboratory-fabricated provisionals within
esthetics, is to prefill the shell or use shell provi
oral cavity. If it is to be used over a relatively long
the provisionals with a direct technique. When a tra
1
period, the provisional restoration should have a
ditional self-curing acrylic resin is used, intrapulpal
more precise margin and the capacity to resist
temperatures can rise by 0-42°C to 7.21°C during fill
theses are made by molding a shell of thermoplas
to simulate the ideal preparation. These shells act as
greater masticatory loads.
ing. According to a scientific study of the phenome
tic material (Erkopress, Erkodent), which is pressure
a support for the acrylic resin, which is baked in the
the demands of speciic clinical situations.
teristics. Selection of a provisional restoration of the
In addition to the risk of marginal infiltration,
week. In the non-emergency setting, provisional pros
non, 12 polyethyl methacrylate generated the most
sionals that are fabricated in the lab after the diag nostic stone cast or its duplicate has been modified
shaped after the disk has been preheated to 50°C to
lab and can be made by following the indications
teeth that have been prepared and provisionally
heat. When using materials that generate a consid
6o°C on the plaster cast. The existing parameters
provided by the diagnostic waxup, depending on the
are not modified in this stage.
restored tend to exhibit inflammation of the peri
erable degree of heat, it is advisable to apply con
odontal margin. Studies have shown that more
tinuous jets of air-water spray while the material is
plaque accumulates on the surface of provisional
hardening to counteract the heat as much as possi
index from an impression using extrahard (85
cone and poured in plaster, it can provide support
restorations than on the cervical surfaces of adja
ble. When selecting a material for intraoral filling, the
shores) silicone (Zetalabor, Zhermack). The acrylic
for the fabrication of the provisional restoration, act
cent natural teeth.S Therefore, the operator must be
potential increase in temperature is an important
resin is applied to the silicone index and pressed
ing as a mold for the resin, which is cured and then
precise in closing the marginal borders and defining
concern for minimizing damage to the pulp chamber.
over the preparations until curing is complete. This
finished in the laboratory.
the emergence profiles to prevent potential compli cations such as gingival recession_6.7
A variation of this technique is to make a silicone
The margins of provisional restorations are fin
results in immediate realization of a provisional
ished in resin. Because the resin inevitably deforms
restoration.
complexity and requirements of the treatment plane. Once the waxup is duplicated using the proper sili
To assist the clinician in controlling the position of the provisional prosthesis during filling, the labo
The material used to reproduce the finish line of
and fractures under stress,'3·'• provisional prosthe
The pressed-shell technique produces a provi
ratory technician makes an index in extrahard sili
the provisional prosthetic margin has a significant
ses must be used for a limited period or checked
sional that has the advantage of being very thin and
cone (85 shores) that is applied directly to the fin
effect on its precision. A study comparing diferent
and replaced frequently.
materials found that epimine presents considerably
210
.. PROCEDU RES FOR PROVI S I O NAL
..
thus adapts well to the shape of the preparations
ished provisional, forming occlusal stops on the
and the interproximal spaces. Moreover, once the
adjacent natural teeth for added stability. The provi
resin curing is finished, it becomes the surface of
sional prosthesis is then inserted into the silicone
the provisional restoration. Although the technique
index, which facilitates proper positioning on the
adapts readily to the clinical setting, it poses the
preparations in terms of axis and d i rection, thus
problem of using a fairly large amount of acrylic
eliminating the danger of excessive lengthening or
resin in the office as a support material. Acrylic resin
repositioning (Figs 7-9 to 7-13).
..
211
Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
P R O V I S I O N A L S I N
S H A P E .
A N A T O M I C A L L Y
V O L U M E .
A N D
C O R R E C T
E X T E N S I O N
F1g 7-7 8011ng of the stone cast and molded thermoplastic disk. Fig 7-8 The self-curing resin then is applied directly on the prepared tooth until it flits the shell. The advantage of this system is the immediate adaptation because the thickness of the old restoration leaves ample space for fitting in the material. Fig 7-g The provisional restoration of both first and second generations fabricated in the lab is used with an ultrahard silicone index 185 shores! that functions as a guide during positioning and relining. Fig 1-10 The provisional is supported by the index and adapts correctly in terms of position and length because the silicone index has occlusal stops that ensure proper repositioning.
212
M A I N T A I N
P R O P E R
P R O P O R T I O N S
R E L A T I O N S
A C H I E V E D
I N
A N D L A B
Fig 7-11 The silicone guide also makes it easier to obtain the correct axis during filling. Figs 7-12 and 7-13 Clinical case illustrating excellent adaptation of the provisional restoration in the maxillary right and left anterior segments and good maturation of the interproximal tissues.
213
Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
P R O V I S I O N A L S I N
S H A P E .
A N A T O M I C A L L Y
V O L U M E .
A N D
C O R R E C T
E X T E N S I O N
F1g 7-7 8011ng of the stone cast and molded thermoplastic disk. Fig 7-8 The self-curing resin then is applied directly on the prepared tooth until it flits the shell. The advantage of this system is the immediate adaptation because the thickness of the old restoration leaves ample space for fitting in the material. Fig 7-g The provisional restoration of both first and second generations fabricated in the lab is used with an ultrahard silicone index 185 shores! that functions as a guide during positioning and relining. Fig 1-10 The provisional is supported by the index and adapts correctly in terms of position and length because the silicone index has occlusal stops that ensure proper repositioning.
212
M A I N T A I N
P R O P E R
P R O P O R T I O N S
R E L A T I O N S
A C H I E V E D
I N
A N D L A B
Fig 7-11 The silicone guide also makes it easier to obtain the correct axis during filling. Figs 7-12 and 7-13 Clinical case illustrating excellent adaptation of the provisional restoration in the maxillary right and left anterior segments and good maturation of the interproximal tissues.
213
CHAPTER 7 Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
. Second generation
Second-generation provisionals are fabricated after
in irreversible hydrocolloid material, so that the
Filling can be immediate (the traditional type) or
A uniform mixture of acrylic resin is applied inside
laboratory is advised of all of the variations in
delayed. Immediate filling is generally performed
the prepared resin shell, and care is then taken to
elastomeric impressions are taken. A nonimpregnat
shape, color, and so forth desired by the patient and
directly on the preparations just after the impression
position and adapt it correctly in the mouth. Once
ed retraction cord is placed in the gingival sulcus for
clinician.
is taken, when it is not easy to achieve a satisfac
positioned in the mouth, the provisional must be
tory level of precision.
delicately removed during self-curing via a gentle
vetical and horizontal displacement of the tissues and after the finish line of the right depth and design has been finished. Apical repositioning of the finish
Long-term p rovisionals
To obtain more accurate margins, it is possible to
back-and-forth movement over about 2 mm. This
execute a second, delayed filling known as precision
prevents adhesion to the prepared tooth and unde
line has not been carried out at this point. This repo
When it becomes necessay for therapeutic reasons
illing. This is executed on the master cast, after the
sired retention in the undercut areas of the adjacent
sitioning of the inish line may be performed imme
to prolong the use of a provisional restoration in the
final impression has been taken during a subse
teeth. It is also advisable to cool the tooth and the
diately or later, during the session when the defini
oral cavity, it is advisable to make the prosthesis
quent stage, and again after the provisional (which
provisional with water. l -'7-•B
tive impression is taken (in which case another refill
using acylic resin with a reinforcing metal frame,
has already been filled during the initial stage) has
In this initial filling, the goal is to make an incisal
ing of the provisional will be necessary).
which increases its resistance to functional and mas
been decemented. The provisional prosthesis is
stop internal to the provisional and again perform
Generally, a provisional prosthesis made in this
ticatory loads. This reinforcing structure is made in
roughened internally with a bur and relined with
initial adaptation of the resin to the surfaces of the
fashion does not need additional refilling or modifi
a single-casting monoblock, creating adequate oc
composite resin directly on the master cast, thus
prepared teeth. The clinician should not pay undue
cation, except perhaps for some isolated areas; this
clusal supports and reinforcing connections. It can
avoiding errors caused by excess soft tissue and
attention to the precision of the prosthetic margins;
is why it is called a precision provisional prosthesis.
also be useful in conditioning the sot tissues after
oral fluids.
eforts should be directed at ensuring that the resin
However, this is possible only if the impression does
surgery. For this reason, the provisional prosthesis
There are many diferent filling techniques. Among
material moistened with monomer adheres well to
not present major distortions (Figs 7-14 to 7-22).
can be made so that it can be filled. •s In fact, when
these are two that appear similar but actually involve
the inish line using a Heidemann spatula. Once the
using provisionals with a metal frame, it is prefer
diferent approaches, results, and fabrication times.
resin has cured, the provisional is removed from the
Third generation
able that the marginal seal be made in resin, so that
The first technique, which has been in common use
mouth and placed in a pressure pot to accelerate
Finally, there are the third-generation provisionals,
if necessary the clinician can execute further refilling
for some time, consists of executing successive fill
polymerization.
so called because they typically replace the second
and adaptation following postsurgical healing or for
ings with unheated acrylic resin and waiting for them
Once polymerization is complete, another re-illing
generation provisionals. The third-generation provi
other situations (Figs 7-40 and 7-41).
to harden completely before making any further
is needed to define the margin with precision. This
sional is thus fabricated after the definitive impres
modifications to the material. In order to accelerate
is done ater the excess resin at the margin and the
sion has been taken and the master cast poured.
the hardening process and reduce the formation of
thin layer that has hardened on the internal axial
This type of provisional prosthesis is used in
C L I N I CAL CO N S I D ERATI O N S FOR
air bubbles (and thus obtain an ideal compact con
surfaces and marginal area has been removed using
THE WORKI NG STAGES
sistency), the unpolymerized provisional can be
tungsten carbide burs. Care should be taken not to
dontic team an opportunity to analyze and confirm
immersed in lukewarm water (3o•C)•6 or in a pres
remove the resin at the level of the occlusal and
each of the functional and esthetic parameters that
Filling
sure pot at 4 bars for 10 minutes.
palatal internal stops (Fig 7-45).
Filling involves brushing a layer of petroleum jelly
For the second illing, a more liquid form of resin
For most types of provisional prostheses made of
directly on the preparations to isolate them and pre
is placed in the provisional shell. It is important to
be used to reproduce the desired effect after the
acrylic resin, the filling and finishing of the pros
vent adhesion of the two surfaces as well as over
spread and adapt the resin to the margin as accu
patient approves the design (Figs 7-23 to 7-39).
thetic margin are critical steps because these proce
heating (Figs 7-42 to 7-44). The authors prefer to use
rately as possible, using a thin Heidemann spatula
Clin ically, it is possible to use the seco nd
dures make it possible to obtain precise restorations
a layer of liquid soap to isolate the prepared tooth;
coated with monomer (Figs 7-46 and 7-47). The same
generation provisional as a guide for modifications
that simulate the emergence profile and support the
since soap reduces surface tension more than does
procedures used to obtain polymerization in the first
made directly in white wax. After the patient's ap
soft tissues (in the same manner as the definitive
petroleum jelly, this improves the density of the resin,
stage are carried out.
proval, an impression of these modiications is made
ceramic restoration).
complex cases; it ofers the patient and the prostho
were previously proposed and then applied in the diagnostic waxup. The final restorative materials will
.
reducing the risk of creating adaptation defects or air bubbles.
214
The authors prefer the second technique for intra oral filling because it is simple and fast. It consists .
215
CHAPTER 7 Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
. Second generation
Second-generation provisionals are fabricated after
in irreversible hydrocolloid material, so that the
Filling can be immediate (the traditional type) or
A uniform mixture of acrylic resin is applied inside
laboratory is advised of all of the variations in
delayed. Immediate filling is generally performed
the prepared resin shell, and care is then taken to
elastomeric impressions are taken. A nonimpregnat
shape, color, and so forth desired by the patient and
directly on the preparations just after the impression
position and adapt it correctly in the mouth. Once
ed retraction cord is placed in the gingival sulcus for
clinician.
is taken, when it is not easy to achieve a satisfac
positioned in the mouth, the provisional must be
tory level of precision.
delicately removed during self-curing via a gentle
vetical and horizontal displacement of the tissues and after the finish line of the right depth and design has been finished. Apical repositioning of the finish
Long-term p rovisionals
To obtain more accurate margins, it is possible to
back-and-forth movement over about 2 mm. This
execute a second, delayed filling known as precision
prevents adhesion to the prepared tooth and unde
line has not been carried out at this point. This repo
When it becomes necessay for therapeutic reasons
illing. This is executed on the master cast, after the
sired retention in the undercut areas of the adjacent
sitioning of the inish line may be performed imme
to prolong the use of a provisional restoration in the
final impression has been taken during a subse
teeth. It is also advisable to cool the tooth and the
diately or later, during the session when the defini
oral cavity, it is advisable to make the prosthesis
quent stage, and again after the provisional (which
provisional with water. l -'7-•B
tive impression is taken (in which case another refill
using acylic resin with a reinforcing metal frame,
has already been filled during the initial stage) has
In this initial filling, the goal is to make an incisal
ing of the provisional will be necessary).
which increases its resistance to functional and mas
been decemented. The provisional prosthesis is
stop internal to the provisional and again perform
Generally, a provisional prosthesis made in this
ticatory loads. This reinforcing structure is made in
roughened internally with a bur and relined with
initial adaptation of the resin to the surfaces of the
fashion does not need additional refilling or modifi
a single-casting monoblock, creating adequate oc
composite resin directly on the master cast, thus
prepared teeth. The clinician should not pay undue
cation, except perhaps for some isolated areas; this
clusal supports and reinforcing connections. It can
avoiding errors caused by excess soft tissue and
attention to the precision of the prosthetic margins;
is why it is called a precision provisional prosthesis.
also be useful in conditioning the sot tissues after
oral fluids.
eforts should be directed at ensuring that the resin
However, this is possible only if the impression does
surgery. For this reason, the provisional prosthesis
There are many diferent filling techniques. Among
material moistened with monomer adheres well to
not present major distortions (Figs 7-14 to 7-22).
can be made so that it can be filled. •s In fact, when
these are two that appear similar but actually involve
the inish line using a Heidemann spatula. Once the
using provisionals with a metal frame, it is prefer
diferent approaches, results, and fabrication times.
resin has cured, the provisional is removed from the
Third generation
able that the marginal seal be made in resin, so that
The first technique, which has been in common use
mouth and placed in a pressure pot to accelerate
Finally, there are the third-generation provisionals,
if necessary the clinician can execute further refilling
for some time, consists of executing successive fill
polymerization.
so called because they typically replace the second
and adaptation following postsurgical healing or for
ings with unheated acrylic resin and waiting for them
Once polymerization is complete, another re-illing
generation provisionals. The third-generation provi
other situations (Figs 7-40 and 7-41).
to harden completely before making any further
is needed to define the margin with precision. This
sional is thus fabricated after the definitive impres
modifications to the material. In order to accelerate
is done ater the excess resin at the margin and the
sion has been taken and the master cast poured.
the hardening process and reduce the formation of
thin layer that has hardened on the internal axial
This type of provisional prosthesis is used in
C L I N I CAL CO N S I D ERATI O N S FOR
air bubbles (and thus obtain an ideal compact con
surfaces and marginal area has been removed using
THE WORKI NG STAGES
sistency), the unpolymerized provisional can be
tungsten carbide burs. Care should be taken not to
dontic team an opportunity to analyze and confirm
immersed in lukewarm water (3o•C)•6 or in a pres
remove the resin at the level of the occlusal and
each of the functional and esthetic parameters that
Filling
sure pot at 4 bars for 10 minutes.
palatal internal stops (Fig 7-45).
Filling involves brushing a layer of petroleum jelly
For the second illing, a more liquid form of resin
For most types of provisional prostheses made of
directly on the preparations to isolate them and pre
is placed in the provisional shell. It is important to
be used to reproduce the desired effect after the
acrylic resin, the filling and finishing of the pros
vent adhesion of the two surfaces as well as over
spread and adapt the resin to the margin as accu
patient approves the design (Figs 7-23 to 7-39).
thetic margin are critical steps because these proce
heating (Figs 7-42 to 7-44). The authors prefer to use
rately as possible, using a thin Heidemann spatula
Clin ically, it is possible to use the seco nd
dures make it possible to obtain precise restorations
a layer of liquid soap to isolate the prepared tooth;
coated with monomer (Figs 7-46 and 7-47). The same
generation provisional as a guide for modifications
that simulate the emergence profile and support the
since soap reduces surface tension more than does
procedures used to obtain polymerization in the first
made directly in white wax. After the patient's ap
soft tissues (in the same manner as the definitive
petroleum jelly, this improves the density of the resin,
stage are carried out.
proval, an impression of these modiications is made
ceramic restoration).
complex cases; it ofers the patient and the prostho
were previously proposed and then applied in the diagnostic waxup. The final restorative materials will
.
reducing the risk of creating adaptation defects or air bubbles.
214
The authors prefer the second technique for intra oral filling because it is simple and fast. It consists .
215
CHAPT£H 7 Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
7-20
Figs 7-14 and 7-15 Clinical case of a maxillary rehabilitation showing serious gingival recession and secondary caries and decementatio n of the maxillary left central incisor. Figs 7-16and7-17 After the inotial provisoonal shell !first generation! was made and the prepared teeth were reconstructed. and after a poly ether Impression was made with a nonimpregnated retraction cord in place. the stone cast with sectioned dies was used to make the new. second-generation provisional.
Figs 7-1 g and 7-20 Restoration in feldspathic ceramic. cemented with a n adhesive technique. Note the esthetics a n d functional relationships.
Figs 7-21 and 7-22 Proper management of the provisional permitted control over esthetic and functional aspects. resulting in a natural smile.
Fog 7-18 The cemen ted provisoonal after clonical ontegration. compared woth the final restoratoon !Fig 7-191. The shape and esthetic parame _ accordance wolh the ondocaloons furnoshed ters were altered on by the provisional and the diagnosloc waxup.
217
CHAPT£H 7 Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
7-20
Figs 7-14 and 7-15 Clinical case of a maxillary rehabilitation showing serious gingival recession and secondary caries and decementatio n of the maxillary left central incisor. Figs 7-16and7-17 After the inotial provisoonal shell !first generation! was made and the prepared teeth were reconstructed. and after a poly ether Impression was made with a nonimpregnated retraction cord in place. the stone cast with sectioned dies was used to make the new. second-generation provisional.
Figs 7-1 g and 7-20 Restoration in feldspathic ceramic. cemented with a n adhesive technique. Note the esthetics a n d functional relationships.
Figs 7-21 and 7-22 Proper management of the provisional permitted control over esthetic and functional aspects. resulting in a natural smile.
Fog 7-18 The cemen ted provisoonal after clonical ontegration. compared woth the final restoratoon !Fig 7-191. The shape and esthetic parame _ accordance wolh the ondocaloons furnoshed ters were altered on by the provisional and the diagnosloc waxup.
217
Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fog 7 23 In complex cases. for example. in thos 40-year-old female patoent who presented following contusion of the maxillary central incisors and right lateral oncosor. it may be advisable to follow the fabricatoon step by step usong a doagnostic waxup.
Fog 7 4 The clonical case presents considerable crowdong. and the treatment plan included possoble orthodontic ontervention. periodontal surgery woth omplants. and prosthetoc restoratoon The lack of space made it necessary to design a specofoc clinocal example that could be shown to the patoent to obtain informed consent for the planned treatment. fogs 7·25 a J 7-26 Two dofferent wax models were proposed, the first made wothout considering orthodontic treatment and the second reflect ong a comprehensove treatment plan. onvolvong seroal tooth extractoons and redostrobution of space. Because the central incisors and the right lateral were orreparably lost and there was very loltte peroodontal support. on addition to overcrowdong. the selectoon of the type of rehaboli tatoon to propose and then clonocally realoze depended on the optoons chosen in the prelimonary orthodontoc and periodontal plans.
211
Fig 7-27 The clinical orthodontic examination proposed serial extraction of the first premolars to reduce the overcrowding. followed by ortho dontic treatment and prosthetic rehabilitation to treat the new spaces. or prosthetic treatment alone. The feasibility of both treatment plans. however. was based on the prosthetic restoration. so the initial clinical diagnosis and the choice of treatment was delayed untol the two pros thetic options could be evaluated in the waxups. The difference on the space avaolable in the two options. because of the extractions. provid ed the opportunity to create different forms. Fogs 7-28 and 7-2g The lack of periodontal support and the short radicular length steered the choice of treatment toward a more conservative procedure. without additional extractions. The option was for a slower. progressive orthodontic extrusion of the compromised teeth. to pro vide more bone and periodontal support for the area afler the extractions. During the stages of slow extrusion. the length of the teeth must be reduced.
Fog 7-30 The compromised teeth were extracted. and the two canines and the lateral incisor were prepared for a prosthesis. After the com bined orthodontic and periodontal treatment. the provisional stage was managed using three subsequent provisionals to condition the tissues during the various stages of treatment. using different modalities and procedures. The first provisional was made in the lab. relying on the forms and dimensions represented in the diagnostic waxup. The goal was to restore the esthetics and function of the extracted teeth and con dition the tissues in the areas of extraction. Fig 7-31 After allowing an adequate period for healing (about 3 months). during which the condition of the tissues in the extraction areas was controlled and modified several times. a precision polyether impression was taken after positioning a nonimpregnated retraction cord (Ullrapak 000. Ullradent) and completing the finish lines of the preparations to define a reg ular. smooth line. A diamond -grit ball bur was used to redefine the edentulous areas anatomically and esthetically. (A scalpel may also be used.) The new provisional was made using the successive layering of dentin and enamel. creating a resin shell simolar to dentin. cast on a silicone ondex. and fonished woth a bur to give it a natural shape with mamelons. The provisional. properly finished and polished. has been fitted and adapted in the oral cavity. and the esthetic. functional. and phonetic characteristics have been checked.
219
Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fog 7 23 In complex cases. for example. in thos 40-year-old female patoent who presented following contusion of the maxillary central incisors and right lateral oncosor. it may be advisable to follow the fabricatoon step by step usong a doagnostic waxup.
Fog 7 4 The clonical case presents considerable crowdong. and the treatment plan included possoble orthodontic ontervention. periodontal surgery woth omplants. and prosthetoc restoratoon The lack of space made it necessary to design a specofoc clinocal example that could be shown to the patoent to obtain informed consent for the planned treatment. fogs 7·25 a J 7-26 Two dofferent wax models were proposed, the first made wothout considering orthodontic treatment and the second reflect ong a comprehensove treatment plan. onvolvong seroal tooth extractoons and redostrobution of space. Because the central incisors and the right lateral were orreparably lost and there was very loltte peroodontal support. on addition to overcrowdong. the selectoon of the type of rehaboli tatoon to propose and then clonocally realoze depended on the optoons chosen in the prelimonary orthodontoc and periodontal plans.
211
Fig 7-27 The clinical orthodontic examination proposed serial extraction of the first premolars to reduce the overcrowding. followed by ortho dontic treatment and prosthetic rehabilitation to treat the new spaces. or prosthetic treatment alone. The feasibility of both treatment plans. however. was based on the prosthetic restoration. so the initial clinical diagnosis and the choice of treatment was delayed untol the two pros thetic options could be evaluated in the waxups. The difference on the space avaolable in the two options. because of the extractions. provid ed the opportunity to create different forms. Fogs 7-28 and 7-2g The lack of periodontal support and the short radicular length steered the choice of treatment toward a more conservative procedure. without additional extractions. The option was for a slower. progressive orthodontic extrusion of the compromised teeth. to pro vide more bone and periodontal support for the area afler the extractions. During the stages of slow extrusion. the length of the teeth must be reduced.
Fog 7-30 The compromised teeth were extracted. and the two canines and the lateral incisor were prepared for a prosthesis. After the com bined orthodontic and periodontal treatment. the provisional stage was managed using three subsequent provisionals to condition the tissues during the various stages of treatment. using different modalities and procedures. The first provisional was made in the lab. relying on the forms and dimensions represented in the diagnostic waxup. The goal was to restore the esthetics and function of the extracted teeth and con dition the tissues in the areas of extraction. Fig 7-31 After allowing an adequate period for healing (about 3 months). during which the condition of the tissues in the extraction areas was controlled and modified several times. a precision polyether impression was taken after positioning a nonimpregnated retraction cord (Ullrapak 000. Ullradent) and completing the finish lines of the preparations to define a reg ular. smooth line. A diamond -grit ball bur was used to redefine the edentulous areas anatomically and esthetically. (A scalpel may also be used.) The new provisional was made using the successive layering of dentin and enamel. creating a resin shell simolar to dentin. cast on a silicone ondex. and fonished woth a bur to give it a natural shape with mamelons. The provisional. properly finished and polished. has been fitted and adapted in the oral cavity. and the esthetic. functional. and phonetic characteristics have been checked.
219
Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Figs 7-32 and 7-33 This second-generation provisional. although quite close to the final shape. shows some imperfections that can be easily corrected using white wax directly in the patient's mouth and sending the modifications to the lab after having taken an impression in irre versible hydrocolloid.
Figs 7-36 o 7-3g Views before !Figs 7-36 and 7-38) and after !Figs 7-37 and 7-3 g ) treatment. The esthetic outcome of this complex treatment is very goad.
F1g 7-34 Only at this stage should the clinician proceed to finish the tooth preparations. positioning the finish lines at the desired level. and take the impression with elastomerit material.
Fig 7-35 It is important to fabri cate a third-generation provisional that wilt exactly replicate the appearance of the final restoration. This last provisional. once fitted � nd cemented. allows. the patient to check .the esthetic result directly and allows the clinical team to verify all the parameters and the stability of the marg�nal tiSsues. Further mod1f1tallons can be made if necessary. The final restoration in this case was done using a porcelain-fused-to- metal crown. involving a metal support structure made in a single casting. No metal is visible at the mar gin because of the use of the collarless technique. wh1th requires a ceramic shoulder margin.
11
21
Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Figs 7-32 and 7-33 This second-generation provisional. although quite close to the final shape. shows some imperfections that can be easily corrected using white wax directly in the patient's mouth and sending the modifications to the lab after having taken an impression in irre versible hydrocolloid.
Figs 7-36 o 7-3g Views before !Figs 7-36 and 7-38) and after !Figs 7-37 and 7-3 g ) treatment. The esthetic outcome of this complex treatment is very goad.
F1g 7-34 Only at this stage should the clinician proceed to finish the tooth preparations. positioning the finish lines at the desired level. and take the impression with elastomerit material.
Fig 7-35 It is important to fabri cate a third-generation provisional that wilt exactly replicate the appearance of the final restoration. This last provisional. once fitted � nd cemented. allows. the patient to check .the esthetic result directly and allows the clinical team to verify all the parameters and the stability of the marg�nal tiSsues. Further mod1f1tallons can be made if necessary. The final restoration in this case was done using a porcelain-fused-to- metal crown. involving a metal support structure made in a single casting. No metal is visible at the mar gin because of the use of the collarless technique. wh1th requires a ceramic shoulder margin.
11
21
CHAPTER 7 Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
• of removing the provisional prosthesis during the
Using impressions taken in the office (ie, the clas·
first stage, while the resin is still malleable, and care·
sic prefilled·type provisional shells) and those fabri·
fully eliminating excess material using abrasive disks
cated from precision impressions with elastomeric
(eg, from Moore) and part of the interior material
material and usually the aid of a nonimpregnated
using tungsten carbide burs, so that more nuid mate·
denection cord, the authors use the dentin-enamel
rial can be added and the margins can be defined
molding technique. This sandwich technique, which
with precision. By not waiting for the resin to hard·
can be performed both in the office and in the lab,
en completely, the second filling is made easier.
involves two successive pressings. The first uses a
Moreover, the possibility of causing occlusal lifting,
dentin resin, which, after roughing up and reducing
which often results from the alternative technique, is
the shape of the shell, effectively simulates the
eliminated.
properties of natural dentin, with mamelons and
When faced with small defects of marginal or sur·
ridges. The second pressing is done directly over the
face adaptation that require slight repairs, it is
dentin shell, using a very nuid resin mixture com·
advisable to use a dual-curing resin (Unifast, GC},
posed of 70% enamel and 30% transparent resin to
which is ideal for small amounts of material that are
achieve the effect of the incisal characteristics.
then polymerized under blue light. This material has good dimensional stability under stress.'9
Two types of acrylic resin are used in this direct technique. For provisionals made in the laboratory,
The self-curing resin the authors use most often
New Outline resin (Anax Dent) is preferred because
for filling provisionals is Sintodent (Welltrade}, which
of its great versatility and superior esthetic quality,
has many important characteristics, as well as
especially for incisal and translucent effects. Difer·
antibacterial properties20•2 1 provided by the presence
ent color inserts and photopolymerizable transpar·
of benzalkonium chloride, increased hardness, resis·
ent inserts are often interposed between the two
tance to wear, and suitability for polishing. 22 A special
layers (Creative, Kerr Hawe).
eyedropper included with the product is used to mix
Another type of precision provisional involves
the monomer, which is calibrated and produced
making the final prosthesis directly on the definitive
specifically to avoid contamination from the external
impression. To assist the healing and maturation of
environment. The powder and liquid are blended in
the soft tissues after taking the impression, it is
rubber containers, with the liquid added to the pow·
important to achieve precision and good seating of
der rather than vice versa, in quantities 20% less than
the provisional. However, in this stage it is difficult
those used in normal procedures. Mixing time is gen·
to obtain the marginal seal in resin on the prepara·
erally about
t
minute (the material must be mixed
slowly}; the resin mixture is then allowed to sit for about
1.5
minutes until the material achieves ideal
consistency and an opaque, fibrous appearance.
tion immediately after the impression is made. This
7-44
7-45
obstacle can be avoided by using third-generation provisionals made from the definitive impression. Second-generation provisionals are made on a
This resin is also used in procedures involving the
stone cast developed from an elastomeric Impression
pressing of the thermoplastic and silicone Indices, in
created after vertically retracting the soft tissues with
which a considerable amount of resin is used. For this
a nonimpregnated denection cord (Uitrapak ooo}, using
reason, the work is performed in the clinician's office.
the sandwich technique. After the fitting, however, it ..
F , 7-40 and 7-41 Construction of a long-term provisional restoration using a g o l d reinforcing structure that includes s o m e occlusal support points to stabilize occlusion and prevent breakage under masticatory loads.
f1g 7-42 first-generation provisional or shell with a silicone index for positioning in the oral cavity. shown on the stone cast. fig 7-43 After the tooth is prepared. it is Immediately isolated with a film of liquid soap before f illi n g .
�,g 7·4 Provisional filling. The acrylic resin is overflowing after insertion and must still be adapted optimally to the f1nish line
Hg 7· 5 First rough1ng of the resin. us1ng a tungsten carbide bur. after the Initial filling. tak1ng care to remove only the inter�or of the walls and the excess marginal material.
223
CHAPTER 7 Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
• of removing the provisional prosthesis during the
Using impressions taken in the office (ie, the clas·
first stage, while the resin is still malleable, and care·
sic prefilled·type provisional shells) and those fabri·
fully eliminating excess material using abrasive disks
cated from precision impressions with elastomeric
(eg, from Moore) and part of the interior material
material and usually the aid of a nonimpregnated
using tungsten carbide burs, so that more nuid mate·
denection cord, the authors use the dentin-enamel
rial can be added and the margins can be defined
molding technique. This sandwich technique, which
with precision. By not waiting for the resin to hard·
can be performed both in the office and in the lab,
en completely, the second filling is made easier.
involves two successive pressings. The first uses a
Moreover, the possibility of causing occlusal lifting,
dentin resin, which, after roughing up and reducing
which often results from the alternative technique, is
the shape of the shell, effectively simulates the
eliminated.
properties of natural dentin, with mamelons and
When faced with small defects of marginal or sur·
ridges. The second pressing is done directly over the
face adaptation that require slight repairs, it is
dentin shell, using a very nuid resin mixture com·
advisable to use a dual-curing resin (Unifast, GC},
posed of 70% enamel and 30% transparent resin to
which is ideal for small amounts of material that are
achieve the effect of the incisal characteristics.
then polymerized under blue light. This material has good dimensional stability under stress.'9
Two types of acrylic resin are used in this direct technique. For provisionals made in the laboratory,
The self-curing resin the authors use most often
New Outline resin (Anax Dent) is preferred because
for filling provisionals is Sintodent (Welltrade}, which
of its great versatility and superior esthetic quality,
has many important characteristics, as well as
especially for incisal and translucent effects. Difer·
antibacterial properties20•2 1 provided by the presence
ent color inserts and photopolymerizable transpar·
of benzalkonium chloride, increased hardness, resis·
ent inserts are often interposed between the two
tance to wear, and suitability for polishing. 22 A special
layers (Creative, Kerr Hawe).
eyedropper included with the product is used to mix
Another type of precision provisional involves
the monomer, which is calibrated and produced
making the final prosthesis directly on the definitive
specifically to avoid contamination from the external
impression. To assist the healing and maturation of
environment. The powder and liquid are blended in
the soft tissues after taking the impression, it is
rubber containers, with the liquid added to the pow·
important to achieve precision and good seating of
der rather than vice versa, in quantities 20% less than
the provisional. However, in this stage it is difficult
those used in normal procedures. Mixing time is gen·
to obtain the marginal seal in resin on the prepara·
erally about
t
minute (the material must be mixed
slowly}; the resin mixture is then allowed to sit for about
1.5
minutes until the material achieves ideal
consistency and an opaque, fibrous appearance.
tion immediately after the impression is made. This
7-44
7-45
obstacle can be avoided by using third-generation provisionals made from the definitive impression. Second-generation provisionals are made on a
This resin is also used in procedures involving the
stone cast developed from an elastomeric Impression
pressing of the thermoplastic and silicone Indices, in
created after vertically retracting the soft tissues with
which a considerable amount of resin is used. For this
a nonimpregnated denection cord (Uitrapak ooo}, using
reason, the work is performed in the clinician's office.
the sandwich technique. After the fitting, however, it ..
F , 7-40 and 7-41 Construction of a long-term provisional restoration using a g o l d reinforcing structure that includes s o m e occlusal support points to stabilize occlusion and prevent breakage under masticatory loads.
f1g 7-42 first-generation provisional or shell with a silicone index for positioning in the oral cavity. shown on the stone cast. fig 7-43 After the tooth is prepared. it is Immediately isolated with a film of liquid soap before f illi n g .
�,g 7·4 Provisional filling. The acrylic resin is overflowing after insertion and must still be adapted optimally to the f1nish line
Hg 7· 5 First rough1ng of the resin. us1ng a tungsten carbide bur. after the Initial filling. tak1ng care to remove only the inter�or of the walls and the excess marginal material.
223
CHAPTER 7 Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
�
may be necessary to fill up one or more prepared
The provisional prosthesis serves an im portant
teeth to improve adaptation of the prosthesis and
role in the conditioning of the soft tissues. It also
ensure its stability. This is principally due to the resin
provides
shrinkage. This provisional, which replaced the first
esthetics. The clinician must fully exploit the oppor
information
regarding
occlusion
and
provisional or shell provisional in an intermediate
tunities provided by the provisional restoration to
stage of treatment, must be filled after the impres
achieve the final objective (Figs 7-6o to 7-82).
sion has been taken if the marginal level is to be
A provisional prosthesis represents a great
deepened or modified.
opportunity for conditioning and supporting the gin
Finishing
whether after surgery or after preparation. Shaping
gival tissues. It also permits proper maturation, and modiying the tissues without surgery in an
To finish the provisional prosthesis, tungsten car
atraumatic manner can be accomplished for small
bide burs are used for progressive roughening of the
modifications, such as shaping and positioning the
margins and the elimination of excess material (Figs
gingival contour, by using provisional prostheses
7-48 to 7-53), assisted by an abrasive disk or an
that have been properly conditioned on the plaster
intercalary cut bur in the interproximal areas.
cast by the dental technician (Fig 7-83).
For polishing, silicone rubber points and wheels
Therefore, tissue conditioning may involve one or
are used first (Fig 7-54), followed by goat-hair brush
more edentulous areas to create a natural prosthe
es dipped in powdered pumice and a wool brush
sis with ovate panties.
soaked in polishing paste (Figs 7-55 and 7-56).
Achieving this result in an edentulous area is pos
Polishing is always completed by a pass with a
sible only through proper conditioning of the gingi
mechanical polisher (Figs 7-57 to 7-59).
val tissue, which is prepared using a rotating hand piece with a round diamond bur or a radioscalpel with a lozenge-shaped tip (Figs 7-84 to 7-88) .
TISSUE CON DITI O N I N G WITH THE PROVISIONAL PROSTH ESIS
When this procedure is carried out, at least
2
mm
of gingival tissue must remain between the most apical point of the prepared tissue and the bone
Provisional restorations have various time and
crest to avoid unwanted compression and decubitis
modality constraints, depending on the functions
lesions, which would threaten the health of the tis
and goals of the treatment, that is, whether it is pri
sue and could result in chronic bone innammation
marily an esthetic rehabilitation or a postsurgical,
and possible osteolysis.
..
functional operation.
Figs 7-46 and 7-47 Second filling with more liquid resin. keeping the provisional inside the index. The besl technique is to not wait for the resin to harden completely. but to reinsert i t while it is still malleable in order to avoid the occlusal lifting phenomenon. Removal before it is fully hardened prevents close adhesion to the prepared tooth and the consequent difficult detachment. Fig 7 ll The finishing stage begins with the removal of the excess material accumulated at the margin. using a straight handpiece and a tab oratory tungsten carbide bur IH13HF.104.023 and H l J g _ F$0.023. Komell Fl1• 7-4� id 7 iO The next step is a pass with the longest bur IH261.EF.104.023). which is more practical in the profile area.
F; 7- 1 nc 7· 52 Having removed the extra resin after filling. a wax crayon is used to highlight where the resin border will contact the finish line in the intrasulcular zone. The prosthetic margin will have to be carefully poliShed and finished.
m
CHAPTER 7 Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
�
may be necessary to fill up one or more prepared
The provisional prosthesis serves an im portant
teeth to improve adaptation of the prosthesis and
role in the conditioning of the soft tissues. It also
ensure its stability. This is principally due to the resin
provides
shrinkage. This provisional, which replaced the first
esthetics. The clinician must fully exploit the oppor
information
regarding
occlusion
and
provisional or shell provisional in an intermediate
tunities provided by the provisional restoration to
stage of treatment, must be filled after the impres
achieve the final objective (Figs 7-6o to 7-82).
sion has been taken if the marginal level is to be
A provisional prosthesis represents a great
deepened or modified.
opportunity for conditioning and supporting the gin
Finishing
whether after surgery or after preparation. Shaping
gival tissues. It also permits proper maturation, and modiying the tissues without surgery in an
To finish the provisional prosthesis, tungsten car
atraumatic manner can be accomplished for small
bide burs are used for progressive roughening of the
modifications, such as shaping and positioning the
margins and the elimination of excess material (Figs
gingival contour, by using provisional prostheses
7-48 to 7-53), assisted by an abrasive disk or an
that have been properly conditioned on the plaster
intercalary cut bur in the interproximal areas.
cast by the dental technician (Fig 7-83).
For polishing, silicone rubber points and wheels
Therefore, tissue conditioning may involve one or
are used first (Fig 7-54), followed by goat-hair brush
more edentulous areas to create a natural prosthe
es dipped in powdered pumice and a wool brush
sis with ovate panties.
soaked in polishing paste (Figs 7-55 and 7-56).
Achieving this result in an edentulous area is pos
Polishing is always completed by a pass with a
sible only through proper conditioning of the gingi
mechanical polisher (Figs 7-57 to 7-59).
val tissue, which is prepared using a rotating hand piece with a round diamond bur or a radioscalpel with a lozenge-shaped tip (Figs 7-84 to 7-88) .
TISSUE CON DITI O N I N G WITH THE PROVISIONAL PROSTH ESIS
When this procedure is carried out, at least
2
mm
of gingival tissue must remain between the most apical point of the prepared tissue and the bone
Provisional restorations have various time and
crest to avoid unwanted compression and decubitis
modality constraints, depending on the functions
lesions, which would threaten the health of the tis
and goals of the treatment, that is, whether it is pri
sue and could result in chronic bone innammation
marily an esthetic rehabilitation or a postsurgical,
and possible osteolysis.
..
functional operation.
Figs 7-46 and 7-47 Second filling with more liquid resin. keeping the provisional inside the index. The besl technique is to not wait for the resin to harden completely. but to reinsert i t while it is still malleable in order to avoid the occlusal lifting phenomenon. Removal before it is fully hardened prevents close adhesion to the prepared tooth and the consequent difficult detachment. Fig 7 ll The finishing stage begins with the removal of the excess material accumulated at the margin. using a straight handpiece and a tab oratory tungsten carbide bur IH13HF.104.023 and H l J g _ F$0.023. Komell Fl1• 7-4� id 7 iO The next step is a pass with the longest bur IH261.EF.104.023). which is more practical in the profile area.
F; 7- 1 nc 7· 52 Having removed the extra resin after filling. a wax crayon is used to highlight where the resin border will contact the finish line in the intrasulcular zone. The prosthetic margin will have to be carefully poliShed and finished.
m
CHAPTER 7 Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
..
The presence of the papillae is fundamental to the simulation of a natural prosthesis, and this is
the papillae rather than letting the soft tissues con tract to close the gap.
possible only if the embrasures are modified with
The length of the ovate pontic should be about
several applications of acrylic resin in order to sup
2.5 mm so that the correct amount is positioned in
port the soft tissue (Rgs 7-89 to 7-91). The ideal
the interproximal area. This length is necessary to
shape of the papillae can be achieved only with the
provide sufficient support for the papillae.
proper provisional, which should have an interprox
Yet another procedure to improve the appearance
imal point of contact as far apical as possible. It is
of the tissue is closing the interproximal black trian
only when the distance between this point and the
gles. The papillae can be stimulated using tools like
bone crest is equal to or less than
5
mm that the
the scaler (M23, Hu-Friedy) approximately every 15
Another method for achieving proper tissue con
point of contact and the bone crest within the limits
outcome can be reliably predicted. 'l ditioning is to insert a false root made of acrylic
FIG 7-53
FIG 7-54
FIG 7-56
FIG 7-57
FIG 7-55
days, making sure to keep the distance between the recommended by Tarnow et al'l (Rgs 7-92 to 7-99). •
resin immediately into the extraction site to guide
M A X I M U M F O R
O F
L E V E L
P R O V I S I O N A L
R E S T O R A T I O N S
fig 7-5J The smaU tungsten carbide bur IH7HF.014. Komel) enables the technician to get closer to the margin because of its smaller d1mens1ons and greater control. wh1ch are ideal characteristics for finishing this delicate area. fig 7-4 The polishing stage begins with a self-polishing silicone rubber tip (No. g 557, Komel). Figs 7-55 and 7-iiA goat-hair brush soaked in powdered pumice paste and the wool brush soaked in polishing liquid. fig 7-57 The margin shown at low magnification. properly finished and polished.
Figs 7-58 and 7-� In these two high- magnification images. the excellent finishing of the margin of the provisional restoration ca n be seen. as can the detail created in the shoulder. Also note the compactness and adaptation of the provisional and its . fa1thful reproduction of the charactenshcs of the preparation.
1
FIG 7-58
P R E C I S I O N
FIG 7-59
CHAPTER 7 Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
..
The presence of the papillae is fundamental to the simulation of a natural prosthesis, and this is
the papillae rather than letting the soft tissues con tract to close the gap.
possible only if the embrasures are modified with
The length of the ovate pontic should be about
several applications of acrylic resin in order to sup
2.5 mm so that the correct amount is positioned in
port the soft tissue (Rgs 7-89 to 7-91). The ideal
the interproximal area. This length is necessary to
shape of the papillae can be achieved only with the
provide sufficient support for the papillae.
proper provisional, which should have an interprox
Yet another procedure to improve the appearance
imal point of contact as far apical as possible. It is
of the tissue is closing the interproximal black trian
only when the distance between this point and the
gles. The papillae can be stimulated using tools like
bone crest is equal to or less than
5
mm that the
the scaler (M23, Hu-Friedy) approximately every 15
Another method for achieving proper tissue con
point of contact and the bone crest within the limits
outcome can be reliably predicted. 'l ditioning is to insert a false root made of acrylic
FIG 7-53
FIG 7-54
FIG 7-56
FIG 7-57
FIG 7-55
days, making sure to keep the distance between the recommended by Tarnow et al'l (Rgs 7-92 to 7-99). •
resin immediately into the extraction site to guide
M A X I M U M F O R
O F
L E V E L
P R O V I S I O N A L
R E S T O R A T I O N S
fig 7-5J The smaU tungsten carbide bur IH7HF.014. Komel) enables the technician to get closer to the margin because of its smaller d1mens1ons and greater control. wh1ch are ideal characteristics for finishing this delicate area. fig 7-4 The polishing stage begins with a self-polishing silicone rubber tip (No. g 557, Komel). Figs 7-55 and 7-iiA goat-hair brush soaked in powdered pumice paste and the wool brush soaked in polishing liquid. fig 7-57 The margin shown at low magnification. properly finished and polished.
Figs 7-58 and 7-� In these two high- magnification images. the excellent finishing of the margin of the provisional restoration ca n be seen. as can the detail created in the shoulder. Also note the compactness and adaptation of the provisional and its . fa1thful reproduction of the charactenshcs of the preparation.
1
FIG 7-58
P R E C I S I O N
FIG 7-59
i tl,·l
I
Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fig 7 60 Clinical case of a 34-year-old male patient who was greatly dissatisfied with his provisional. which was made in another clinic. and wanted to recover the function and esthetics lost following the extraction of the maxillary right central incisor for endodontic reasons. F1g 7-61 and 7·62 The clinical and radiologic examinations of the teeth. already reduced for prosthetic purposes. showed a false path on the right lateral 1ncisor. the presence of an incongruous restoration on the left central incisor. and a carbon fiber post on the left lateral incisor. The in1t1al approach involved the endodontic aspect. with resolutiOn of the false path of the right lateral inCISor and the re-treatment of the left central incisor. F1g 7-63 The provisional presented obvious esthetic defects and is clearly unatlractive because of the gross mismatch in the gingival levels.
1
F1g 7·64 Removal of the provisional reveals even more clearly the asymmetry in the positioning of the restorative teeth. The inadequacy of the forms and height of the prepared teeth can be observed. F1gs 7-65 and 7-66 Initial waxup on the plaster cast. used to formulate a realistic surgical-prosthetic treatment plan.
F1gs 7-67 and 7-68 Preproslhelic surgery reshapes I he bone contours and lhe mucogin � ival defect in lhe edentulous area in a single stage. This resull is obtained with a crown-lengthening procedure and a subepithelial connective t1ssue graft drawn from the palate. F1gs 7-6g and 7·70 Occlusal views of pre- and postoperative conditions.
F1g 7·71 SuccesSIVe preproslhetiC reconstructiOn wilh compoSite res1n.
i tl,·l
I
Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fig 7 60 Clinical case of a 34-year-old male patient who was greatly dissatisfied with his provisional. which was made in another clinic. and wanted to recover the function and esthetics lost following the extraction of the maxillary right central incisor for endodontic reasons. F1g 7-61 and 7·62 The clinical and radiologic examinations of the teeth. already reduced for prosthetic purposes. showed a false path on the right lateral 1ncisor. the presence of an incongruous restoration on the left central incisor. and a carbon fiber post on the left lateral incisor. The in1t1al approach involved the endodontic aspect. with resolutiOn of the false path of the right lateral inCISor and the re-treatment of the left central incisor. F1g 7-63 The provisional presented obvious esthetic defects and is clearly unatlractive because of the gross mismatch in the gingival levels.
1
F1g 7·64 Removal of the provisional reveals even more clearly the asymmetry in the positioning of the restorative teeth. The inadequacy of the forms and height of the prepared teeth can be observed. F1gs 7-65 and 7-66 Initial waxup on the plaster cast. used to formulate a realistic surgical-prosthetic treatment plan.
F1gs 7-67 and 7-68 Preproslhelic surgery reshapes I he bone contours and lhe mucogin � ival defect in lhe edentulous area in a single stage. This resull is obtained with a crown-lengthening procedure and a subepithelial connective t1ssue graft drawn from the palate. F1gs 7-6g and 7·70 Occlusal views of pre- and postoperative conditions.
F1g 7·71 SuccesSIVe preproslhetiC reconstructiOn wilh compoSite res1n.
CHAIII' ! Climcal Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Figs 7-72 and 7-73 Comparison of the initial situation and that after the endodontic. periodontal. and restorative stages. showing the excellent clinical result achieved. Fo.g 1·74 Two months later. it was. possible to make a new. second-generatoon provisional based on the modified anatomy. The change in the gongoval and dental parameters os evodent. on terms of the wodth-length ratios (the ideal ratio for central incisors is 0.75-0.80). Fog 7-75 Provisional and maturong toss � es The papillae must continue to adapt in relation to the provisional The excellent esthetics achieved . •n the promoonal and good communiCation were fundamental on obta1n1ng the patient's informed consent. especially considering the new tooth lengths
Figs 7-78 and 7-79 O cclusal and palatal views of the provisional . showing resolution of the gingival defect in relation to the right central incisor and excellent integration with the tissue. even in the palatal area. Figs 7-80 and 7-81 Condition of the case with the initial provisional and 6 months after surgical treatment and maturation of the soft tissues. guided by a new provisional prosthesis
Fog 7-82 Control radiograph after placement of the final prosthesis Ia zirconium !lava. J M Espel fixed dental prosthesis). showing clinical healing from endodontic treatment.
Fogs 7·76 ao d 7-77 Details of the provisional In the lateral mws
20
231
CHAIII' ! Climcal Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Figs 7-72 and 7-73 Comparison of the initial situation and that after the endodontic. periodontal. and restorative stages. showing the excellent clinical result achieved. Fo.g 1·74 Two months later. it was. possible to make a new. second-generatoon provisional based on the modified anatomy. The change in the gongoval and dental parameters os evodent. on terms of the wodth-length ratios (the ideal ratio for central incisors is 0.75-0.80). Fog 7-75 Provisional and maturong toss � es The papillae must continue to adapt in relation to the provisional The excellent esthetics achieved . •n the promoonal and good communiCation were fundamental on obta1n1ng the patient's informed consent. especially considering the new tooth lengths
Figs 7-78 and 7-79 O cclusal and palatal views of the provisional . showing resolution of the gingival defect in relation to the right central incisor and excellent integration with the tissue. even in the palatal area. Figs 7-80 and 7-81 Condition of the case with the initial provisional and 6 months after surgical treatment and maturation of the soft tissues. guided by a new provisional prosthesis
Fog 7-82 Control radiograph after placement of the final prosthesis Ia zirconium !lava. J M Espel fixed dental prosthesis). showing clinical healing from endodontic treatment.
Fogs 7·76 ao d 7-77 Details of the provisional In the lateral mws
20
231
Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
f1g 7 83 The prov isional may act as a guid � to modify the profile and the relationship with the gingival tissue. for example. in the shifting of _ _ wh1ch. when moved d1stally. confers a more natural appearance. To achieve this. the dental technician must remove the the g1ng1val zenlth. portion o'. ging1val ti�sue involved from the plaster cut. This will be replaced by the resin of the provisional restoration. thus effecting a _ compression and a sltght 1schem1a of the t1ssues. wh1ch w1ll mature and adapt to the new situation. flg> 7-4ald 7-85 The edentulous aru occupied. by the prosthetic restoration must be well adapted to the mucosal tissue lie. an ovate pontic). favorable adaptalton can be obtatned only 1f the area 1s prepared with a bur. or with other techniques and instruments such as the _ presents an ovate shape at the point where it contacts the gingiva. rad1oscalpet. and 1f the prov1s1onal
figs 7-89 and 7-90 The same clinical case during different phases of treatment. Embrasures are evident between three teeth that will be sub sequently restored with ceramic restorations. The provisional is made using a direct technique with preformed shells and will later be replaced with a second-generation provisional. made by means of a polyether precision impression with horizontal displacement established by a nonimpre 9 nated retraction cord. Closure of the embrasures between the provisionals is achieved with a direct technique. by adding dual-curing acrylic resin IU nifast) lfig 7-901. f1g 7-91 Note the full maturation of the papillae following cementation of the feldspathic ceramic crowns.
F11 s 7·86 a 1d 7-87 The edentulous portion that Will be 1n contact w1th the provisional must be usy to clean and accessible with Superfloss !Oral BJ. ftg 7· The area. properly conditioned. tan stmulate the presence of a root and mask the absence of the natural tooth.
23
Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
f1g 7 83 The prov isional may act as a guid � to modify the profile and the relationship with the gingival tissue. for example. in the shifting of _ _ wh1ch. when moved d1stally. confers a more natural appearance. To achieve this. the dental technician must remove the the g1ng1val zenlth. portion o'. ging1val ti�sue involved from the plaster cut. This will be replaced by the resin of the provisional restoration. thus effecting a _ compression and a sltght 1schem1a of the t1ssues. wh1ch w1ll mature and adapt to the new situation. flg> 7-4ald 7-85 The edentulous aru occupied. by the prosthetic restoration must be well adapted to the mucosal tissue lie. an ovate pontic). favorable adaptalton can be obtatned only 1f the area 1s prepared with a bur. or with other techniques and instruments such as the _ presents an ovate shape at the point where it contacts the gingiva. rad1oscalpet. and 1f the prov1s1onal
figs 7-89 and 7-90 The same clinical case during different phases of treatment. Embrasures are evident between three teeth that will be sub sequently restored with ceramic restorations. The provisional is made using a direct technique with preformed shells and will later be replaced with a second-generation provisional. made by means of a polyether precision impression with horizontal displacement established by a nonimpre 9 nated retraction cord. Closure of the embrasures between the provisionals is achieved with a direct technique. by adding dual-curing acrylic resin IU nifast) lfig 7-901. f1g 7-91 Note the full maturation of the papillae following cementation of the feldspathic ceramic crowns.
F11 s 7·86 a 1d 7-87 The edentulous portion that Will be 1n contact w1th the provisional must be usy to clean and accessible with Superfloss !Oral BJ. ftg 7· The area. properly conditioned. tan stmulate the presence of a root and mask the absence of the natural tooth.
23
Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
7- 9 8
Fig 7-92 The papillae must be stimulated because thw maturatiOn is not yet complete, this can be done mechanically using a scaler IM231 in the area of the papillae in contact with the provisional prosthesis igs 7-3 and 7-4 Mechanical stimulation of papillae
Figs 7-98 and 7- g9 Magnification of the final restorations i n the same patient.
Fig 7-95 Clinical aspect immediately following mechanical stimulallon
F1gs 7 96 a•d 7-97 The f1nal restorations '" the same pat�ent. after penodontal-prosthet1c treatment
lJS
Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
7- 9 8
Fig 7-92 The papillae must be stimulated because thw maturatiOn is not yet complete, this can be done mechanically using a scaler IM231 in the area of the papillae in contact with the provisional prosthesis igs 7-3 and 7-4 Mechanical stimulation of papillae
Figs 7-98 and 7- g9 Magnification of the final restorations i n the same patient.
Fig 7-95 Clinical aspect immediately following mechanical stimulallon
F1gs 7 96 a•d 7-97 The f1nal restorations '" the same pat�ent. after penodontal-prosthet1c treatment
lJS
CHAPTER 7 Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
8. Tjan AH. Tjan AH, Grant BE. Marginal accuracy of ten·
REFEREN CES t. Harrison JD. Efect of retraction materials on the gingi val sulcus epithelium. J Prosthet Dent t96t;11:514. 2. loe H, Silness 1. Tissue reactions to string packs used in fixed restorations. I Prosthet Dent 1963:t):)t8. 3- Dragoo MR, Williams GB. Periodontal tissue reactions to restorative procedures. Part II. lnt 1 Periodontics Restor ative Dent 1982;2:34-45.
SE. Fundamentals of Rxed Prosthodontics, ed 3. Chi· cage: Quintessence, 1997-
417-421.
Assoc 1998;26:121-127.
9· Christensen Gl. Provisional restorations for fixed prosth· odontics. l Am Dent Assoc 1996;127:249-252. to. Moulding MB. Teplitsky PE. lntrapulpal temperature dur· ing direct fabrication of provisional restorations. tnt I Prosthodont 1990:3:299-304.
crowns fabricated from six proprietary provisional mate rials.
performance and periodontal outcome of temporary crowns and ixed partial dentures: A randomized clinical trial. J Prosthet Dent 2000;83:32-39. 6. Donaldson D. Gingival recession associated with tem porary coverage. J Periodontal 1973:44:691�6. 7. Donaldson 0. The etioloy of gingival recession associ
l Periodontol t974:45:46B.
I
Cal Dent
t6. Ogawa . Aizawa S, Tanaka M. Matsuya S, Hasegawa A, Koyano K. Efect of water temperature on the fit of
l Prosthet Dent 1997;77:482-485.
the pulp chamber during abrication of provisional crowns. J Prosthet Dent 19B9;62:622�26.
R. Antibacterial activity of a resin: A qualitative study. J
17. Yuodelis RA, Faucher R. Provisional restorations: An
22. Albergo G, Sampalmieri F, Mattioli Belmonte M, Andre·
integrated approach to periodontics and restorative
ana S. Mechanical performance of some dental acrylic
dentisty. Dent Clin North Am t980;24:285-303.
niques on intrapulpal temperature during direct abrica·
tance from the contact point to the crest of bone on the presence or absence of the interproximal dental papil
I
Prosthodont 1991;
4:332-336.
Efects of occlusal loading and thermocycling on the
14. Hung CM, Weiner S. Dastane A, Vaidyanathan TK. Efects
ized resin provisional crowns. J Prosthet Dent 1999;
of thermocycling and occlusal force on the margins of provisional acrylic
resin
crowns.
1
Prosthet
resin. J Dent Res t997:76(s):1103. 23. Tarnow DP, Magner AW, Fletcher P. The efect of the dis·
tion of provisional restorations. lnt
I
Prosthet Dent 1991;65:642�46.
1997:76(special issue):279. 21. (apelli M, Albergo G, Casolari L, Sampalmieri F, Bedini
Dent Res 1998:77:1389.
19. Dubois R), Kyriakakis P, Weiner S, Vaidyanathan TK.
on the margins of transitional acrylic resin crowns.
S. Efect of antimicrobical ingredients on mechanical performance in acrylic resin !abstract 2128]. J Dent Res
Prosthet Dent 1999:82:658661.
1. Weiner S, Berendsen P. Efects of thermocyc\ing
13. Blum
20. Albergo G, Accarisi E, Sampalmieri F, Bedini R, Andreana
provisional crown margins during polymerization. I
t8. Moulding MB, Loney RW. The efect of cooling tech·
12. Tjan AH, Grant BE, Godfrey MF Jrd. Temperature rise in
5· Luthardt RG, Stossel M, Hinz M, Volland! R. Clinical
ated with temporay crowns.
with bonded porcelain laminate veneers.
tt. Tjan AH, Castelnuovo ). Shiatsu G. Marginal fidelity of
4. Shillingburg HT, Hobo S. Whitsett LD, Jacobi R, Brackett
15. Cho GC, Donovan TE, Chee WWL. Clinical experiences
porary composite crowns. J Prosthet Dent 1987;58:
la.
l Periodontal 1992;63:995996.
marginal gaps of light-polymerized and autopolymer·
82:t6t-t66.
Dent
1993:69:573-577·
21
237
CHAPTER 7 Clinical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
8. Tjan AH. Tjan AH, Grant BE. Marginal accuracy of ten·
REFEREN CES t. Harrison JD. Efect of retraction materials on the gingi val sulcus epithelium. J Prosthet Dent t96t;11:514. 2. loe H, Silness 1. Tissue reactions to string packs used in fixed restorations. I Prosthet Dent 1963:t):)t8. 3- Dragoo MR, Williams GB. Periodontal tissue reactions to restorative procedures. Part II. lnt 1 Periodontics Restor ative Dent 1982;2:34-45.
SE. Fundamentals of Rxed Prosthodontics, ed 3. Chi· cage: Quintessence, 1997-
417-421.
Assoc 1998;26:121-127.
9· Christensen Gl. Provisional restorations for fixed prosth· odontics. l Am Dent Assoc 1996;127:249-252. to. Moulding MB. Teplitsky PE. lntrapulpal temperature dur· ing direct fabrication of provisional restorations. tnt I Prosthodont 1990:3:299-304.
crowns fabricated from six proprietary provisional mate rials.
performance and periodontal outcome of temporary crowns and ixed partial dentures: A randomized clinical trial. J Prosthet Dent 2000;83:32-39. 6. Donaldson D. Gingival recession associated with tem porary coverage. J Periodontal 1973:44:691�6. 7. Donaldson 0. The etioloy of gingival recession associ
l Periodontol t974:45:46B.
I
Cal Dent
t6. Ogawa . Aizawa S, Tanaka M. Matsuya S, Hasegawa A, Koyano K. Efect of water temperature on the fit of
l Prosthet Dent 1997;77:482-485.
the pulp chamber during abrication of provisional crowns. J Prosthet Dent 19B9;62:622�26.
R. Antibacterial activity of a resin: A qualitative study. J
17. Yuodelis RA, Faucher R. Provisional restorations: An
22. Albergo G, Sampalmieri F, Mattioli Belmonte M, Andre·
integrated approach to periodontics and restorative
ana S. Mechanical performance of some dental acrylic
dentisty. Dent Clin North Am t980;24:285-303.
niques on intrapulpal temperature during direct abrica·
tance from the contact point to the crest of bone on the presence or absence of the interproximal dental papil
I
Prosthodont 1991;
4:332-336.
Efects of occlusal loading and thermocycling on the
14. Hung CM, Weiner S. Dastane A, Vaidyanathan TK. Efects
ized resin provisional crowns. J Prosthet Dent 1999;
of thermocycling and occlusal force on the margins of provisional acrylic
resin
crowns.
1
Prosthet
resin. J Dent Res t997:76(s):1103. 23. Tarnow DP, Magner AW, Fletcher P. The efect of the dis·
tion of provisional restorations. lnt
I
Prosthet Dent 1991;65:642�46.
1997:76(special issue):279. 21. (apelli M, Albergo G, Casolari L, Sampalmieri F, Bedini
Dent Res 1998:77:1389.
19. Dubois R), Kyriakakis P, Weiner S, Vaidyanathan TK.
on the margins of transitional acrylic resin crowns.
S. Efect of antimicrobical ingredients on mechanical performance in acrylic resin !abstract 2128]. J Dent Res
Prosthet Dent 1999:82:658661.
1. Weiner S, Berendsen P. Efects of thermocyc\ing
13. Blum
20. Albergo G, Accarisi E, Sampalmieri F, Bedini R, Andreana
provisional crown margins during polymerization. I
t8. Moulding MB, Loney RW. The efect of cooling tech·
12. Tjan AH, Grant BE, Godfrey MF Jrd. Temperature rise in
5· Luthardt RG, Stossel M, Hinz M, Volland! R. Clinical
ated with temporay crowns.
with bonded porcelain laminate veneers.
tt. Tjan AH, Castelnuovo ). Shiatsu G. Marginal fidelity of
4. Shillingburg HT, Hobo S. Whitsett LD, Jacobi R, Brackett
15. Cho GC, Donovan TE, Chee WWL. Clinical experiences
porary composite crowns. J Prosthet Dent 1987;58:
la.
l Periodontal 1992;63:995996.
marginal gaps of light-polymerized and autopolymer·
82:t6t-t66.
Dent
1993:69:573-577·
21
237
C H A P T E R
8
TE C H N I C AL C O N S I D ERAT I O N S F O R P R O V I S I O NAL P R O S T H E S E S
D IAGNOSITIC PROVISIO NAL
and with the patient's unique individual features,
ELEMENTS
such as the smile, face, and personality. Modern treatment abandons the traditional concept
The provisional prosthesis plays a fundamental part
preparing a provisional prosthesis of mediocre or
in various phases of the prosthetic rehabilitation
poor quality and later replacing it with an improved
treatment, particularly when many teeth are involved
ceramic prosthesis. Treatment must address the ini
and the patient's occlusal scheme requires dramatic
tial clinical situation in propotion to its complexity,
change.
starting with a diagnostic waxup, which leads to fab
A patient may feel uncomfortable with the func
rication of a provisional restoration that incorporates
tion of a provisional prosthesis, with the esthetics,
function and esthetics. Both of these requirements
or both. However, provisionalization constitutes a
transmit essential diagnostic information for the
crucial phase in the overall treatment, and the clini
definitive restoration.
cian must try to make the patient as comfortable
The diagnostic waxup may be converted initially
with it as possible. All members of the prosthetic
into an acrylic resin provisional prosthesis that is
team should approach this early phase of treatment
used to analyze and verify the proposed parameters
as an opportunity to establish and strengthen a
and determine necessary changes in shape or color
mutually positive relationship with the patient.'
Flu 8-1
FIG 8-2
of
TEC H N I CAL
D IAG NO STIC
A N D
before the ceramic restoration is fabricated. This vey
Complex esthetic restorations require a precise
crucial phase requires cooperation among all mem
therapeutic approach to ensure that the definitive
bers of the prosthetic team to synthesize what they
restoration harmonizes with the surrounding tissues
know of the patient's character and communicate this .
Fig 8-1 Provisional diagnostic mock-up constructed directly in the patient's mouth. The teeth are isolated by the clinician using liquid glycerin or normal liquid soap to ensure the resin can be more readily detached from the prepared teeth.
Fig 8-2 Silicone matrix filled with acrylic rem in the plastic phase. The clinician uses the silicone index implemented on the diagnostic waxup as a matrix to mold the diagnostic mock-up on the teeth for which the provisional restorations are being prepared. Fig 8-3 Immediate appearance of the resin after direct polymerization and subsequent extraction of the silicone matrix. The acrylic material will be detached later using hand tools. Fig 8-4 Slack demarcations Indicating corrections to improve the anatomy of the mock-up teeth.
1
FIG 8-3
FIG 8-4
ESTH ETI C
APPROACH
C H A P T E R
8
TE C H N I C AL C O N S I D ERAT I O N S F O R P R O V I S I O NAL P R O S T H E S E S
D IAGNOSITIC PROVISIO NAL
and with the patient's unique individual features,
ELEMENTS
such as the smile, face, and personality. Modern treatment abandons the traditional concept
The provisional prosthesis plays a fundamental part
preparing a provisional prosthesis of mediocre or
in various phases of the prosthetic rehabilitation
poor quality and later replacing it with an improved
treatment, particularly when many teeth are involved
ceramic prosthesis. Treatment must address the ini
and the patient's occlusal scheme requires dramatic
tial clinical situation in propotion to its complexity,
change.
starting with a diagnostic waxup, which leads to fab
A patient may feel uncomfortable with the func
rication of a provisional restoration that incorporates
tion of a provisional prosthesis, with the esthetics,
function and esthetics. Both of these requirements
or both. However, provisionalization constitutes a
transmit essential diagnostic information for the
crucial phase in the overall treatment, and the clini
definitive restoration.
cian must try to make the patient as comfortable
The diagnostic waxup may be converted initially
with it as possible. All members of the prosthetic
into an acrylic resin provisional prosthesis that is
team should approach this early phase of treatment
used to analyze and verify the proposed parameters
as an opportunity to establish and strengthen a
and determine necessary changes in shape or color
mutually positive relationship with the patient.'
Flu 8-1
FIG 8-2
of
TEC H N I CAL
D IAG NO STIC
A N D
before the ceramic restoration is fabricated. This vey
Complex esthetic restorations require a precise
crucial phase requires cooperation among all mem
therapeutic approach to ensure that the definitive
bers of the prosthetic team to synthesize what they
restoration harmonizes with the surrounding tissues
know of the patient's character and communicate this .
Fig 8-1 Provisional diagnostic mock-up constructed directly in the patient's mouth. The teeth are isolated by the clinician using liquid glycerin or normal liquid soap to ensure the resin can be more readily detached from the prepared teeth.
Fig 8-2 Silicone matrix filled with acrylic rem in the plastic phase. The clinician uses the silicone index implemented on the diagnostic waxup as a matrix to mold the diagnostic mock-up on the teeth for which the provisional restorations are being prepared. Fig 8-3 Immediate appearance of the resin after direct polymerization and subsequent extraction of the silicone matrix. The acrylic material will be detached later using hand tools. Fig 8-4 Slack demarcations Indicating corrections to improve the anatomy of the mock-up teeth.
1
FIG 8-3
FIG 8-4
ESTH ETI C
APPROACH
CHAPTER 8 Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
.. information to the dental technician to use in defin ing the tooth shape of the provisional restoration. In the authors' practice, a distinction is made be tween different types of provisional elements: • •
The technique consists of adapting the wax
uncomfortable with the look and feel of the new
which have been isolated using either petroleum jelly
veneers (obtained from the silicone casting molded
tooth dimensions when the diagnostic mock-up is
or liquid soap (Figs 8·1 to 8-4). The contours of the
on the waxup) on a new cast duplicated from the
inserted for the first time. This reaction is both nor
resin mock-up are trimmed of all excess material, and
master cast. A silicone index, molded on the new wax
mal and understandable since the patient's dental
then it is given to the patient to evaluate at home.
veneers, is filled with resin and pressed onto anoth·
expression and tooth shape developed gradually over
directly over the teeth involved in the restoration,
er cast duplicated from the master cast to obtain the
many years. Therefore, it is better to make small pro
orthodontic mock-up (Figs 8-10 to 8-16).
gressive corrections to the length and shape of the
laboratory using two study casts, one made of stone
Crown diagnostic mock-up
stress, which can lead to a refusal to continue with
and the other of silicone duplication material (Elite
A crown-lengthening mock-up renects the planned
the treatment.
Double, Zhermack). The diagnostic waxup is applied
dimensions of the restored teeth, which can be espe
Sometimes the patient's first impression is nega
to the first (stone) cast, which is then used by the
cially valuable for cases in which a design for reshap
tive. When this happens, the clinician must try to understand the patient's reaction and then proceed
Mock-up
•
First-generation shell or prosthesis
I n direct or technical mock-up
Second-generation or adapted prosthesis
The indirect mock-up technique is undertaken in the
Mock-up By t h e term mock-up w e refer to a very t h i n clinical
.
teeth in order to minimize the patient's anxiety and
aid that is generally made of acrylic resin and that
dental technician to fabricate a mold using extra
ing and lengthening the teeth must be completed
incorporates each of the new clinical parameters
hard (85 shores) silicone (Zetalabor). This silicone
before tooth preparation, then the provisional restora
to make the necessay adjustments without showing
established by the diagnostic waxup. In practice, this
index is later filled with acylic resin and placed
tion is immediately executed (Figs 8-17 to 8-20).
this to the patient. Above all, the patient should not
negative copy of the diagnostic waxup also serves as
directly on the second (silicone) cast, thus producing
The acrylic resin mock-up is inserted in the mouth
be given the mock-up for in-home analysis until the
the mock-up. Inert wax (Schuler Dental) is applied to
over the teeth involved in the prosthetic restoration
appropriate changes have been made. Through each
an accurate reproduction of it, thus offering the great advantage of showing the rehabilitation treatment
the teeth involved in the restoration to facilitate
to allow the clinician to check the occlusion, which
phase of treatment, the patient must be informed
integrated in the overall esthetic and functional con
removal of the acrylic mock-up. The entire site
would have been modified in the previous phase of
about all changes that are made, and the clinician
text directly on the patient. The mock-up can serve
involved in the provisional restoration with the
treatment (Fig 8-21). When occlusal adjustments are
must be aware that subjective esthetic evaluation
acrylic resin must be further isolated with a plaster
necessay to optimize the relation between the arch
requires an extended clinical and in-home trial over a
patients who want veneers or other esthetic restora
resin material (Unifol, Perident). The isolating mater
es, they can be made on the mock-up. The clinician
tive treatment, when new shapes and sizes and a
ial must be applied to the sites not involved in the
can also use the mock-up to assess the shapes of the
the patient after 1 week, by which time the patient
new volume of the teeth must be designed and
fabrication of the mock-up as well, to facilitate its
teeth and the patient's expression, as well as the
should have become more accustomed to the new
approved by the patient.>6 The patient's input is
extraction without damaging the plaster cast.
occlusion, before initiating treatment in the oral cav
smile and dental
ity (Figs 8·22 to 8-25).
should not be initiated until after the patient has
as an important means of analysis and testing in
important to avoid any misunderstandings if small
Finally, the series of casts representing the initial
changes are needed based on the information ob
case, the waxup, and the mock-up are forwarded to
tained from the diagnostic mock-up. Two implementation techniques to prepare the mock-up are described: a clinical or direct mock-up,
Tooth preparation
given approval.
the clinician (Figs 8-s to 8-7) for use in explaining to the patient the various stages that have been com
An acrylic resin mock-up that lengthens the crowns
pleted (Figs 8·8 and 8-9).
and modifies the gingival contours can be used for
a tooth (eg, when correcting tooth position without
cases in which treatment requires the alignment and
performing orthodontic treatment). Such preparation
Orthodontic mock-up
optimal positioning of the gingival contours. With the
creates the minimum amount of space needed to intro duce the mock-up, which thereafter will also act as the irst provisional restoration once it has been aligned.
An orthodontic mock-up can be placed directly i n the
mock-up inserted in the oral cavity, the clinician can
A silicone index is molded via condensation directly
patient's mouth with the teeth in their original posi
use an indelible marker to mark the modifications on
on the diagnostic waxup (Zetalabor, Zermack) and
tion, prior to any orthodontic displacement. It allows
the gingival potion of the cast, thus making the mock·
then immediately transferred to the dental office. The
the patient to understand the restorative treatment
up useful for intra-operative surgery (see Fig 8-21).
clinician fills the silicone index with autopolymerizing
that is planned and appreciate the importance of the
resin and then positions it inside the patient's mouth
expression.
Surgical mock-up
and a technical or indirect mock-up. Direct or clinical diagnostic mock-up
number of days. The changes can be discussed with
preprosthetic orthodontic treatment.
In general, the diagnostic mock-up enables the
Preliminay tooth preparation for the mock-up is sometimes necessay to reduce the original volume of
Esthetically, however, the appearance of a diag nostic mock-up is inadequate when compared with a stratified
provisional restoration that offers the
patient to evaluate the proposed restorative treat·
patient a clearer idea of the definitive restoration and
ment over a period of time. Patients frequently are
is distinctly more comfortable in terms of both func- .
241
CHAPTER 8 Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
.. information to the dental technician to use in defin ing the tooth shape of the provisional restoration. In the authors' practice, a distinction is made be tween different types of provisional elements: • •
The technique consists of adapting the wax
uncomfortable with the look and feel of the new
which have been isolated using either petroleum jelly
veneers (obtained from the silicone casting molded
tooth dimensions when the diagnostic mock-up is
or liquid soap (Figs 8·1 to 8-4). The contours of the
on the waxup) on a new cast duplicated from the
inserted for the first time. This reaction is both nor
resin mock-up are trimmed of all excess material, and
master cast. A silicone index, molded on the new wax
mal and understandable since the patient's dental
then it is given to the patient to evaluate at home.
veneers, is filled with resin and pressed onto anoth·
expression and tooth shape developed gradually over
directly over the teeth involved in the restoration,
er cast duplicated from the master cast to obtain the
many years. Therefore, it is better to make small pro
orthodontic mock-up (Figs 8-10 to 8-16).
gressive corrections to the length and shape of the
laboratory using two study casts, one made of stone
Crown diagnostic mock-up
stress, which can lead to a refusal to continue with
and the other of silicone duplication material (Elite
A crown-lengthening mock-up renects the planned
the treatment.
Double, Zhermack). The diagnostic waxup is applied
dimensions of the restored teeth, which can be espe
Sometimes the patient's first impression is nega
to the first (stone) cast, which is then used by the
cially valuable for cases in which a design for reshap
tive. When this happens, the clinician must try to understand the patient's reaction and then proceed
Mock-up
•
First-generation shell or prosthesis
I n direct or technical mock-up
Second-generation or adapted prosthesis
The indirect mock-up technique is undertaken in the
Mock-up By t h e term mock-up w e refer to a very t h i n clinical
.
teeth in order to minimize the patient's anxiety and
aid that is generally made of acrylic resin and that
dental technician to fabricate a mold using extra
ing and lengthening the teeth must be completed
incorporates each of the new clinical parameters
hard (85 shores) silicone (Zetalabor). This silicone
before tooth preparation, then the provisional restora
to make the necessay adjustments without showing
established by the diagnostic waxup. In practice, this
index is later filled with acylic resin and placed
tion is immediately executed (Figs 8-17 to 8-20).
this to the patient. Above all, the patient should not
negative copy of the diagnostic waxup also serves as
directly on the second (silicone) cast, thus producing
The acrylic resin mock-up is inserted in the mouth
be given the mock-up for in-home analysis until the
the mock-up. Inert wax (Schuler Dental) is applied to
over the teeth involved in the prosthetic restoration
appropriate changes have been made. Through each
an accurate reproduction of it, thus offering the great advantage of showing the rehabilitation treatment
the teeth involved in the restoration to facilitate
to allow the clinician to check the occlusion, which
phase of treatment, the patient must be informed
integrated in the overall esthetic and functional con
removal of the acrylic mock-up. The entire site
would have been modified in the previous phase of
about all changes that are made, and the clinician
text directly on the patient. The mock-up can serve
involved in the provisional restoration with the
treatment (Fig 8-21). When occlusal adjustments are
must be aware that subjective esthetic evaluation
acrylic resin must be further isolated with a plaster
necessay to optimize the relation between the arch
requires an extended clinical and in-home trial over a
patients who want veneers or other esthetic restora
resin material (Unifol, Perident). The isolating mater
es, they can be made on the mock-up. The clinician
tive treatment, when new shapes and sizes and a
ial must be applied to the sites not involved in the
can also use the mock-up to assess the shapes of the
the patient after 1 week, by which time the patient
new volume of the teeth must be designed and
fabrication of the mock-up as well, to facilitate its
teeth and the patient's expression, as well as the
should have become more accustomed to the new
approved by the patient.>6 The patient's input is
extraction without damaging the plaster cast.
occlusion, before initiating treatment in the oral cav
smile and dental
ity (Figs 8·22 to 8-25).
should not be initiated until after the patient has
as an important means of analysis and testing in
important to avoid any misunderstandings if small
Finally, the series of casts representing the initial
changes are needed based on the information ob
case, the waxup, and the mock-up are forwarded to
tained from the diagnostic mock-up. Two implementation techniques to prepare the mock-up are described: a clinical or direct mock-up,
Tooth preparation
given approval.
the clinician (Figs 8-s to 8-7) for use in explaining to the patient the various stages that have been com
An acrylic resin mock-up that lengthens the crowns
pleted (Figs 8·8 and 8-9).
and modifies the gingival contours can be used for
a tooth (eg, when correcting tooth position without
cases in which treatment requires the alignment and
performing orthodontic treatment). Such preparation
Orthodontic mock-up
optimal positioning of the gingival contours. With the
creates the minimum amount of space needed to intro duce the mock-up, which thereafter will also act as the irst provisional restoration once it has been aligned.
An orthodontic mock-up can be placed directly i n the
mock-up inserted in the oral cavity, the clinician can
A silicone index is molded via condensation directly
patient's mouth with the teeth in their original posi
use an indelible marker to mark the modifications on
on the diagnostic waxup (Zetalabor, Zermack) and
tion, prior to any orthodontic displacement. It allows
the gingival potion of the cast, thus making the mock·
then immediately transferred to the dental office. The
the patient to understand the restorative treatment
up useful for intra-operative surgery (see Fig 8-21).
clinician fills the silicone index with autopolymerizing
that is planned and appreciate the importance of the
resin and then positions it inside the patient's mouth
expression.
Surgical mock-up
and a technical or indirect mock-up. Direct or clinical diagnostic mock-up
number of days. The changes can be discussed with
preprosthetic orthodontic treatment.
In general, the diagnostic mock-up enables the
Preliminay tooth preparation for the mock-up is sometimes necessay to reduce the original volume of
Esthetically, however, the appearance of a diag nostic mock-up is inadequate when compared with a stratified
provisional restoration that offers the
patient to evaluate the proposed restorative treat·
patient a clearer idea of the definitive restoration and
ment over a period of time. Patients frequently are
is distinctly more comfortable in terms of both func- .
241
CHr i :£ Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fig 8-5 Study cast of the initial situation created using the technique described in chapter l. This cast provides the technician with a clear and immediate view of the treatment result. Fig 8-6 Diagnostic waxup an the duplicate study cast. It is important to consider bath the preoperative anatomy of the case and various treatment options. Fig 8-7 Technical diagnostic mack-up an the second cast obtained from the study cast dupli cate. With the indirect technique. the laboratory has the opportunity to use the duplicates of the master study cast and provide the clinician with the fi01shed mack-up an a new cast. Fig 8-8 Patient's smile before treatment. Fig 8 - 9 The mack-up. implemented in the laboratory on the diag nostic waxup. is inserted directly an the natural dentition to evaluate the parameters established in the planning phase before any procedures are begun. The changed dental anatomy and dentagingival relationship that would be achieved by the planned treatment can be easily assessed '" this way. Fig 8-10 Initial clinical case in wh1ch the teeth need to be shifted to the left in order to achieve mare optimal spacing.
2
Fig 8-11 Wax up showing new anatomy and positioning. It is important to plan the correct spacing of teeth to achieve satisfactory integration of the restorative treatment in complex esthetic cases. Fig 8-12 Wax up placed directly an the duplicate cast used to create the acrylic resin mock-up. This phase is crucial far determining the patient's acceptance of the treatment plan and above all the esthetic success of the pro visional. Fig 8-13 Orthodontic diagnostic mack-up finished and polished by hand and ready to be inserted in the oral cavity. Fig 8-14 Mack-up inserted in the patient's mouth. This step demonstrates to the patient the need far and benefits of orthodontic treatment. Fig 8-15 Patient's smile before treatment. The significant dental asymmetry in relation to the midline of the face is evident. Fig 8-16 Smile after insertion of the acrylic resin mock-up aver the existing prosthetic restoration.
CHr i :£ Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fig 8-5 Study cast of the initial situation created using the technique described in chapter l. This cast provides the technician with a clear and immediate view of the treatment result. Fig 8-6 Diagnostic waxup an the duplicate study cast. It is important to consider bath the preoperative anatomy of the case and various treatment options. Fig 8-7 Technical diagnostic mack-up an the second cast obtained from the study cast dupli cate. With the indirect technique. the laboratory has the opportunity to use the duplicates of the master study cast and provide the clinician with the fi01shed mack-up an a new cast. Fig 8-8 Patient's smile before treatment. Fig 8 - 9 The mack-up. implemented in the laboratory on the diag nostic waxup. is inserted directly an the natural dentition to evaluate the parameters established in the planning phase before any procedures are begun. The changed dental anatomy and dentagingival relationship that would be achieved by the planned treatment can be easily assessed '" this way. Fig 8-10 Initial clinical case in wh1ch the teeth need to be shifted to the left in order to achieve mare optimal spacing.
2
Fig 8-11 Wax up showing new anatomy and positioning. It is important to plan the correct spacing of teeth to achieve satisfactory integration of the restorative treatment in complex esthetic cases. Fig 8-12 Wax up placed directly an the duplicate cast used to create the acrylic resin mock-up. This phase is crucial far determining the patient's acceptance of the treatment plan and above all the esthetic success of the pro visional. Fig 8-13 Orthodontic diagnostic mack-up finished and polished by hand and ready to be inserted in the oral cavity. Fig 8-14 Mack-up inserted in the patient's mouth. This step demonstrates to the patient the need far and benefits of orthodontic treatment. Fig 8-15 Patient's smile before treatment. The significant dental asymmetry in relation to the midline of the face is evident. Fig 8-16 Smile after insertion of the acrylic resin mock-up aver the existing prosthetic restoration.
C1 , · Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fig 8-17 Clinical case requiring crown lengthening to treat the worn natural dentition of a bruxing patient Fig 8-18 Casts on an articulator showing the required vertical dimension. based on the occlusal record provided by the clinician. Fig 8-1 g Maxillary and mandibular waxups on an articulator. Treatment is focused on the redefinition of the tooth anatomy and function, especially in terms of occlusal guidance and disclusion in protrusion and right and left lateral movements. Fig 8-20 Maxillary and mandibular mock-ups on the casts. It is sound practice also to work on the master cast duplicates in order to obtain these removable provisional elements again at a later time. Fig 8-21 Mock-up inserted in the oral cavity. At this point it is possible to evaluate the established parameters and the occlusal record by performi n g phonetic and esthetic tests. Fig 8-22 Patient's smile before treatment Note the significant loss of vertical height with the marked wear of the o cclusal surfaces and the resulting shape and composition of the dental anatomy. Fig 8-23 Patient's smile with the mock-up placed in the oral cavity. It is advisable to take photographs to allow re-evaluation of the case in regards to esthetic appearance without the patient being present Fig 8-24 Appearance of perioral structures before treatment Fig 8-25 Change in perioral structures with the mock-up inserted.
25
C1 , · Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fig 8-17 Clinical case requiring crown lengthening to treat the worn natural dentition of a bruxing patient Fig 8-18 Casts on an articulator showing the required vertical dimension. based on the occlusal record provided by the clinician. Fig 8-1 g Maxillary and mandibular waxups on an articulator. Treatment is focused on the redefinition of the tooth anatomy and function, especially in terms of occlusal guidance and disclusion in protrusion and right and left lateral movements. Fig 8-20 Maxillary and mandibular mock-ups on the casts. It is sound practice also to work on the master cast duplicates in order to obtain these removable provisional elements again at a later time. Fig 8-21 Mock-up inserted in the oral cavity. At this point it is possible to evaluate the established parameters and the occlusal record by performi n g phonetic and esthetic tests. Fig 8-22 Patient's smile before treatment Note the significant loss of vertical height with the marked wear of the o cclusal surfaces and the resulting shape and composition of the dental anatomy. Fig 8-23 Patient's smile with the mock-up placed in the oral cavity. It is advisable to take photographs to allow re-evaluation of the case in regards to esthetic appearance without the patient being present Fig 8-24 Appearance of perioral structures before treatment Fig 8-25 Change in perioral structures with the mock-up inserted.
25
CHAPTER 8 Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
. tion and esthetics. Conversely, the mock-up repre·
preparation, and the third will be used as a matrix for
.
The dental technician pours the acrylic resin
The indirect technique can strengthen cooperation between the clinician and the technician. Indeed, with
sents the most conservative solution with regard to
molding the acrylic resin over the tooth preparations.
inside the silicone matrix and applies it directly to
the patient's health and the most efective means of
The provisional restoration is monochromatic if
the duplicate cast. After it is removed, the dentin
this technique the technician provides the diagnostic
communicating the new parameters of the restora·
dentin materials alone are used (Fig 8·26). and strat·
material is applied at a pressure of 4 bars and poly
support of a positional silicone index (Fig 8-40),
tion, since it is positioned directly over the existing
ified if the dentin-enamel technique is adopted. In
dental situation.
the latter case, the clinician fabricates a shell using
3 to s min utes'-9 while the silicone index is held in
The diagnostic commitment of making a stratified
dentin-type acrylic resin on teeth isolated with petro·
position using elastic bands.
provisional prosthesis as well may initially appear
leum jelly or liquid soap. After allowing adequate
merized at a temperature between so0( and 6o0( for
A new silicone index is now made with the dentin
which is useful to avoid damaging work executed in the laboratory and as a clinical reference point for positioning the provisional prosthesis. This technique also prevents shape-related distortions of the provi
excessive, but it offers numerous advantages: It pro·
time for complete
the clinician
layer in place and sectioned horizontally to monitor
sional prosthesis or incorrect positioning during the
vides the best guarantee for the outcome of the
removes the prosthesis from the mouth and roughs
the reduction of the dentin material so as to ensure
alignment process (Figs 8-41 to 8·46).
polymerization,
treatment, reconfirms the patient's trust, avoids mis
out the incisal, buccal, and palatal surfaces so as to
adequate space for molding the enamel-type resin. A
understandings, and prevents the unpleasant conse·
allow room for a second application, this time using
photopolymerizing adhesive (Connector) is applied to
Indirect technique on the s i licone index
quences of inadequate treatment.
enamel-type resin (Figs 8-27 and 8-28).
the reduced dentin layer, and setting material can be
As with the other procedures for creating provisional
The prepared dentin provisional restoration is
introduced at the incisal edge and then polymerized
restorations, the starting point is the diagnostic
First-generation provisional restoration
then repositioned in the oral cavity, and a silicone
with a special halogen lamp or light-curing unit for 2
waxup, which ensures that the treatment plan meets the patient's requests.
matrix, this time with an enamel-type resin mixture
minutes, to imitate the incisal efects (Fig 8·38).
The shell-fabricated prosthesis is a first-generation
consisting of So% enamel and 20% transparent
Surface characterizations are not necessary on the
The silicone index made from the waxup acts as a
provisional restoration that is adapted and intro
material, is molded to the dentin layer (Figs 8·29 to
middle and cervical third, since this provisional pros·
matrix for the dentin-type acrylic resin. It is filled with
duced into the oral cavity immediately after the old
8·31). Ater the dentin-enamel provisional restoration
thesis will be handled by the clinician and is subject
resin and polymerized to create a small resin cast
restoration is removed and preliminary tooth prepa
has hardened, it is removed from the oral cavity and
to alignment adjustment and other modifications.
(Fig 8-47). This resin cast is then used to make a new
ration has been completed. The first-generation pro
trimmed using suitable disks and burs (Figs 8·32 to
Finally, the enamel mixture is molded directly on the
silicone index, which is sectioned for monitoring the
hardened dentin at a pressure of 4 bars and poly·
reduction of the incisal edges and buccal surfaces of
visional enhances the patient's oral esthetics, pro
8-34). To improve precision, the clinician must some·
vides the clinician with diagnostic information, and
times roughen the inside surface around the cevical
merized at a temperature between so°C and 6o°C for
the dentin-type material (Fig 8·48). Intermediate pho
conditions the soft tissues. It can be developed
margin, moisten this surface with a photopolymeriz
s minutes, using the same silicone matrix that was
topolymerizing shade modifiers (Artglass (reactive,
using a direct technique in the oral cavity, an indirect
ing adhesive (Connector, Heraeus Kulzer), and realign
used for the dentin layer.
Heraeus Kulzer) can be added once the surface has
technique on the plaster cast, or an indirect tech·
the provisional restoration using auto- and pho·
nique on the silicone index.
The provisional prosthesis is removed from the
been covered with a specific adhesive. The enamel
topolymerizing resins (Unifast, GC).
plaster cast and fitted on the master cast, which has
type layer is molded onto the dentin-type layer, again
Direct technique in the oral cavtty
Indirect technique on the stone cast
(Fig 8-39). A new silicone index is made with the
The laboratoy prepares a master cast, which is later
The indirect technique is performed in the laboratory,
occlusal stops on the adjacent teeth to verify that
The cast is roughed out using laboratory burs
duplicated for the diagnostic waxup (see chapter 1).
and all of the procedures are executed using a sili·
the alignment in the oral cavity corresponds to the
after polymerization has been completed, removing
been previously prepared by the dental technician
using the same silicone matrix used previously (Figs
8·49 and B· so).
After the waxup has been completed, a number of
cone matrix. After completing the diagnostic waxup,
same position on the plaster cast. If the alignment is
the adjacent teeth and leaving intact only the teeth
silicone indices are prepared at a pressure of 4 bars
the dental technician undertakes the preliminary
not identical, the clinician needs to adjust the pre
involved in the restoration. The provisional restora
to ensure the highest possible accuracy in reproduc
tooth preparation on the plaster cast. The preparation
pared tooth inside the mouth or reduce the provi
ing the details of the waxup.
is monitored using a horizontally sectioned silicone
sional prosthesis at points of friction or in areas of
The clinician eventually receives the study cast. a
index. This cast with prepared teeth is then duplicat-
tissue compression in edentulous sites. The provi
duplicate cast on which the diagnostic waxup has
ed to create a new plaster cast on which the provi
sional shell must maintain the same position and
been made, and at least three silicone indices. Two of
sional prosthesis can be created (Figs 8·3s to 8-37). .
the indices will be sectioned for use during tooth
parameters when it is transferred from the plaster cast to the intraoral site.
tion is then trimmed and polished (Fig B· s 1). Because
it is repositioned inside the mold, the small resin
cast can be hollowed out without damaging the cer
vical limits (Figs B-s2 and B· s3).
The silicone matrix originally used to cast the resin is sectioned horizontally, and the provisional .
247
CHAPTER 8 Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
. tion and esthetics. Conversely, the mock-up repre·
preparation, and the third will be used as a matrix for
.
The dental technician pours the acrylic resin
The indirect technique can strengthen cooperation between the clinician and the technician. Indeed, with
sents the most conservative solution with regard to
molding the acrylic resin over the tooth preparations.
inside the silicone matrix and applies it directly to
the patient's health and the most efective means of
The provisional restoration is monochromatic if
the duplicate cast. After it is removed, the dentin
this technique the technician provides the diagnostic
communicating the new parameters of the restora·
dentin materials alone are used (Fig 8·26). and strat·
material is applied at a pressure of 4 bars and poly
support of a positional silicone index (Fig 8-40),
tion, since it is positioned directly over the existing
ified if the dentin-enamel technique is adopted. In
dental situation.
the latter case, the clinician fabricates a shell using
3 to s min utes'-9 while the silicone index is held in
The diagnostic commitment of making a stratified
dentin-type acrylic resin on teeth isolated with petro·
position using elastic bands.
provisional prosthesis as well may initially appear
leum jelly or liquid soap. After allowing adequate
merized at a temperature between so0( and 6o0( for
A new silicone index is now made with the dentin
which is useful to avoid damaging work executed in the laboratory and as a clinical reference point for positioning the provisional prosthesis. This technique also prevents shape-related distortions of the provi
excessive, but it offers numerous advantages: It pro·
time for complete
the clinician
layer in place and sectioned horizontally to monitor
sional prosthesis or incorrect positioning during the
vides the best guarantee for the outcome of the
removes the prosthesis from the mouth and roughs
the reduction of the dentin material so as to ensure
alignment process (Figs 8-41 to 8·46).
polymerization,
treatment, reconfirms the patient's trust, avoids mis
out the incisal, buccal, and palatal surfaces so as to
adequate space for molding the enamel-type resin. A
understandings, and prevents the unpleasant conse·
allow room for a second application, this time using
photopolymerizing adhesive (Connector) is applied to
Indirect technique on the s i licone index
quences of inadequate treatment.
enamel-type resin (Figs 8-27 and 8-28).
the reduced dentin layer, and setting material can be
As with the other procedures for creating provisional
The prepared dentin provisional restoration is
introduced at the incisal edge and then polymerized
restorations, the starting point is the diagnostic
First-generation provisional restoration
then repositioned in the oral cavity, and a silicone
with a special halogen lamp or light-curing unit for 2
waxup, which ensures that the treatment plan meets the patient's requests.
matrix, this time with an enamel-type resin mixture
minutes, to imitate the incisal efects (Fig 8·38).
The shell-fabricated prosthesis is a first-generation
consisting of So% enamel and 20% transparent
Surface characterizations are not necessary on the
The silicone index made from the waxup acts as a
provisional restoration that is adapted and intro
material, is molded to the dentin layer (Figs 8·29 to
middle and cervical third, since this provisional pros·
matrix for the dentin-type acrylic resin. It is filled with
duced into the oral cavity immediately after the old
8·31). Ater the dentin-enamel provisional restoration
thesis will be handled by the clinician and is subject
resin and polymerized to create a small resin cast
restoration is removed and preliminary tooth prepa
has hardened, it is removed from the oral cavity and
to alignment adjustment and other modifications.
(Fig 8-47). This resin cast is then used to make a new
ration has been completed. The first-generation pro
trimmed using suitable disks and burs (Figs 8·32 to
Finally, the enamel mixture is molded directly on the
silicone index, which is sectioned for monitoring the
hardened dentin at a pressure of 4 bars and poly·
reduction of the incisal edges and buccal surfaces of
visional enhances the patient's oral esthetics, pro
8-34). To improve precision, the clinician must some·
vides the clinician with diagnostic information, and
times roughen the inside surface around the cevical
merized at a temperature between so°C and 6o°C for
the dentin-type material (Fig 8·48). Intermediate pho
conditions the soft tissues. It can be developed
margin, moisten this surface with a photopolymeriz
s minutes, using the same silicone matrix that was
topolymerizing shade modifiers (Artglass (reactive,
using a direct technique in the oral cavity, an indirect
ing adhesive (Connector, Heraeus Kulzer), and realign
used for the dentin layer.
Heraeus Kulzer) can be added once the surface has
technique on the plaster cast, or an indirect tech·
the provisional restoration using auto- and pho·
nique on the silicone index.
The provisional prosthesis is removed from the
been covered with a specific adhesive. The enamel
topolymerizing resins (Unifast, GC).
plaster cast and fitted on the master cast, which has
type layer is molded onto the dentin-type layer, again
Direct technique in the oral cavtty
Indirect technique on the stone cast
(Fig 8-39). A new silicone index is made with the
The laboratoy prepares a master cast, which is later
The indirect technique is performed in the laboratory,
occlusal stops on the adjacent teeth to verify that
The cast is roughed out using laboratory burs
duplicated for the diagnostic waxup (see chapter 1).
and all of the procedures are executed using a sili·
the alignment in the oral cavity corresponds to the
after polymerization has been completed, removing
been previously prepared by the dental technician
using the same silicone matrix used previously (Figs
8·49 and B· so).
After the waxup has been completed, a number of
cone matrix. After completing the diagnostic waxup,
same position on the plaster cast. If the alignment is
the adjacent teeth and leaving intact only the teeth
silicone indices are prepared at a pressure of 4 bars
the dental technician undertakes the preliminary
not identical, the clinician needs to adjust the pre
involved in the restoration. The provisional restora
to ensure the highest possible accuracy in reproduc
tooth preparation on the plaster cast. The preparation
pared tooth inside the mouth or reduce the provi
ing the details of the waxup.
is monitored using a horizontally sectioned silicone
sional prosthesis at points of friction or in areas of
The clinician eventually receives the study cast. a
index. This cast with prepared teeth is then duplicat-
tissue compression in edentulous sites. The provi
duplicate cast on which the diagnostic waxup has
ed to create a new plaster cast on which the provi
sional shell must maintain the same position and
been made, and at least three silicone indices. Two of
sional prosthesis can be created (Figs 8·3s to 8-37). .
the indices will be sectioned for use during tooth
parameters when it is transferred from the plaster cast to the intraoral site.
tion is then trimmed and polished (Fig B· s 1). Because
it is repositioned inside the mold, the small resin
cast can be hollowed out without damaging the cer
vical limits (Figs B-s2 and B· s3).
The silicone matrix originally used to cast the resin is sectioned horizontally, and the provisional .
247
CH Pll R S Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fig 8-26 Prepared dentin provisional reslorat1on placed in the oral cavity. At this point the provisional can be trimmed and polished imme diately for a monochromatic result if the esthetic needs and expectations of the case are not high. Fig 8-27 For cases in which esthetics are important. it is necessary to continue the treatment by reducing the dentin layer to create spate for the enamel resin and photo polymeriZing colors. when applicable. Here. the dentin has been prepared to recreate the mamelons and other dentinal structures and reduced to a thin layer in the incisal third to a thieve the optimal value. Fig 8-28 The spate available for the enamel resin and photopoly meming colors is checked. Fig 8-2g The incisal gel is plated 1n preparation for the introduction of chromatic characterizations.
Fig 8-30 The clinician has plated the chromatic characterizations on the dentin surface. The colors are polymerized with a special halogen light-emitting lamp. Fig 8-31 Molding phase of enamel-type acrylic resin. Fig 8-32 The provisional has been finished. This phase is always completed using diamond or tungsten carbide burs. Fig 8-33 Polishing has been completed and lhe acrylic resin provisional cemented in the mouth. Fig 8-34 Profile view of the provisional at high magnification under the stereomicroscope.
249
CH Pll R S Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fig 8-26 Prepared dentin provisional reslorat1on placed in the oral cavity. At this point the provisional can be trimmed and polished imme diately for a monochromatic result if the esthetic needs and expectations of the case are not high. Fig 8-27 For cases in which esthetics are important. it is necessary to continue the treatment by reducing the dentin layer to create spate for the enamel resin and photo polymeriZing colors. when applicable. Here. the dentin has been prepared to recreate the mamelons and other dentinal structures and reduced to a thin layer in the incisal third to a thieve the optimal value. Fig 8-28 The spate available for the enamel resin and photopoly meming colors is checked. Fig 8-2g The incisal gel is plated 1n preparation for the introduction of chromatic characterizations.
Fig 8-30 The clinician has plated the chromatic characterizations on the dentin surface. The colors are polymerized with a special halogen light-emitting lamp. Fig 8-31 Molding phase of enamel-type acrylic resin. Fig 8-32 The provisional has been finished. This phase is always completed using diamond or tungsten carbide burs. Fig 8-33 Polishing has been completed and lhe acrylic resin provisional cemented in the mouth. Fig 8-34 Profile view of the provisional at high magnification under the stereomicroscope.
249
Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fig 8-35 Formalton of several l -mm-deep grooves on the plasler cast Ftg 8-36 The available space for acrylic resin is checked using a sec tioned siltcone index obtained from the dtagnostic waxup Fig 8-37 Preliminary tooth preparation is completed on the study cast duplicate. whtch IS ready to be reduplicated The proviSional prosthesis will then be created on this new plaster cast. Fig 8-38 The incisal photopolymer iztng colors have been added over the dentin material. Fig 8-3g Promional finished and positioned on the cast. An extra-hard silicone index will be implemented on the provisional while posittoned on the plaster cast. providing occlusal stops on the posterior sector. This will enable the cltntctan to transfer the provistonal to the patient's mouth white maintaining the same positiOn as on the plaster cast. Fig 8-40 Provisional tnserted tn the mouth ustng the siltcone index
Fig 8-41 Preoperattve view of a clintcal case tn which the existtng metal-ceramtc crowns on the central tncisors are dtSproporttonate to the adjacent teeth. Fig 8-42 The provisional prosthesis was implemented ustng the indirect techntque and then aligned in the oral cavity using the silicone index. Fig 8-43 Smtle before treatment. Fig 8-44 Smtle with provisional tn place The central incisors are now in harmony with the adjacent teeth. Fig 8-45 Full-face pretreatment view of pattent. Fig 8-46 Patient's appearance following cementation of the provisional.
251
Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fig 8-35 Formalton of several l -mm-deep grooves on the plasler cast Ftg 8-36 The available space for acrylic resin is checked using a sec tioned siltcone index obtained from the dtagnostic waxup Fig 8-37 Preliminary tooth preparation is completed on the study cast duplicate. whtch IS ready to be reduplicated The proviSional prosthesis will then be created on this new plaster cast. Fig 8-38 The incisal photopolymer iztng colors have been added over the dentin material. Fig 8-3g Promional finished and positioned on the cast. An extra-hard silicone index will be implemented on the provisional while posittoned on the plaster cast. providing occlusal stops on the posterior sector. This will enable the cltntctan to transfer the provistonal to the patient's mouth white maintaining the same positiOn as on the plaster cast. Fig 8-40 Provisional tnserted tn the mouth ustng the siltcone index
Fig 8-41 Preoperattve view of a clintcal case tn which the existtng metal-ceramtc crowns on the central tncisors are dtSproporttonate to the adjacent teeth. Fig 8-42 The provisional prosthesis was implemented ustng the indirect techntque and then aligned in the oral cavity using the silicone index. Fig 8-43 Smtle before treatment. Fig 8-44 Smtle with provisional tn place The central incisors are now in harmony with the adjacent teeth. Fig 8-45 Full-face pretreatment view of pattent. Fig 8-46 Patient's appearance following cementation of the provisional.
251
CHAPTER 8 Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
. prosthesis is introduced into the mouth. By using the actual matrix, the clinician can more easily determine
removable dies and the gingiva.
. then evaluated using the silicone index on the sec
Another silicone index is created so that the
ond stone cast that was fabricated especially for this
reduction of the dentin layer can be carefully moni tored (Figs 8-70 to 8-72). The buccolingual thickness
the exact position of the provisional prosthesis
The duplicate dies are treated with a setting solu
purpose (Figs 8-6o and 8-61). The dies are bonded
when it is positioned in the oral cavity (Figs 8·54
tion (Margidur, Benzer Dental) that penetrates the
at the cervical margin of the cast using adhesive
of the dentin layer must have an incisal edge that is
and 8-55).
porous plaster without increasing in thickness. After
wax, which is also used to bond the silicone index
significantly though not completely reduced, as this
their exterior surfaces are treated with soft wax. the
to the dies. The surfaces of the dies protruding from
would greatly compromise the value of the final
dies are reintroduced into the impression with a lit
the upper part of the cast are isolated with a very
result (Fig 8-73). A bonding adhesive (Connector) is
Second-generation provisional prosthesis
tle pressure. Cyanoacrylate is added to the head of
thin layer of inert wax, and then a larger quantity of
applied to ensure an enhanced bond with the pho
each die, and the dies are then bonded.
inert wax is applied to the base of the dies to iden
topolymerizing colors (Artglass (reactive) added to the surface (Fig 8·74). The second silicone index is
Modern practitioners have long abandoned the tra·
The dies are bonded at the cervical margin with
tify where they are located during the squaring oper
ditional practice of using a mediocre provisional
adhesive wax (Kiebewachs, Gebdi), which cements
ation. The two parts previously moistened are then
used to ensure that suficient space is left for the
prosthesis to be replaced with an improved perma·
them during casting (Fig 8-58) and enables them to
fixated with plaster and, once set, excess portions
enamel-type material to be added and polymerized.
nent ceramic prosthesis. '0
be removed once the plaster has set and the bond
are trimmed to square the entire cast. The sealant
Once the enamel-type material is molded using
The stratified provisional prosthesis involves the
ed dies have been reintroduced inside the impres
wax is removed from the base using a heat-generat
the same matrix, the restoration is detached from
application of a technique similar to that used to
sion. For optimal results, this plaster should be in a
ing machine so that the dies can be removed (Figs
the plaster cast, which can be discarded, and adapt·
8-62 to 8-66).
ed to the working cast with the aid of contact·
create
indirect first-generation provisional
slightly more liquified form than usual to allow
restoration, requiring either a stone or resin cast,
the
slight vibrations to be applied during the casting
except that the pigmentation also is applied to the
process.
With its removable dies, this cast provides the
detecting powder (Figs 8-75 to 8-78). The result is
means to condition the soft tissues and assess the
a stratified provisional restoration that can be
For this phase, the technician has two options for
tooth morphology, since the gingival information is
mechanically trimmed and polished without loss of
producing the master cast: The cast can be poured
included. A duplicate of this cast will be needed for
its color characteristics. It can be used to evaluate
Stone casts
as a single process, thus instantly creating the base,
molding the resin.
the shape, length, position, and characterizations
The essential diferences in this procedure compared
or a double-pouring process can be used, requiring
middle and cervical third of the restorations.
with the techniques described earlier are ) the
In summary, the sequence is as follows:
(chroma, value, and color) of the restoration, as well as for gingival conditioning (Figs 8-79 to 8-82).
two separate pours. The latter technique involves a
teeth have already been prepared, and (2) the soft
first pour to cover the dies and a second pour to
•
Master dies
tissues, which for several weeks supported the first
create a cast in a rubber base. Both casts are
•
Master dies duplicated using silicone
is reconfirmed in vivo with the provisional prosthesis
generation provisional prosthesis, have adapted to
removed from the im pression after the plaster has
•
Duplicated dies
that reproduces the shape of the waxup, or some
the new situation.
set (about 45 minutes) and squared separately
•
Fixed dies used to prepare a control silicone key
detail of the dental anatomy is changed by examin
Dies originating from the duplication inserted in
ing the slides and a plaster model originating from
the impression for the Geller model
the first provisional prosthesis (Figs 8-83 to 8·86).
For complex cases and others that the clinician
252
rations during the cast construction phase with the
using the cast-squaring tool.
deems appropriate, a second-generation provisional
The dies are removed individually with the use of
restoration should be prepared in the laboratoy on
hot steam produced by a steam generator to melt
a precise elastomeric impression obtained ater gin
the adhesive wax sealant. The technician must take
gival retraction. The impression should have perfect
•
•
Geller cast
The diagnostic commitment of the prosthetic team
The second-generation provisional prosthesis is a conversion of the monochromatic waxup in poly
care to clean the die channels before any subse
A new waxup is prepared on the duplicate work
ly discernible cervical margins and be cast using
quent use to optimize the positioning of the remov
ing cast using the silicone index of the study cast
this represents the most important diagnostic stage,
class IV plaster to obtain the master tooth prepara
able dies. Care should also be taken to highlight the
waxup as a guide (Figs 8-67 and 8-68). A silicone
and, though it is provisional, it conditions the soft
tions. These are trimmed to give them a carrot-like
perimeter of the arch and the channel position when
matrix is molded on the new waxup, set under a
tissues and demonstrates esthetic quality similar
shape and subsequently duplicated (Figs 8·56 and
the casts are matched, so that holes can later be
pressure of 3 to 4 bars (Zeta labor), and used to adapt
to that of the definitive restorative treatment"-'5
8-57). The same elastomeric impression is used to
prepared to accommodate the protruding parts of
the dentin-type material (New Outline, Anaxdent) on
(Figs 8-87 to 8-92). Additionally, this prosthesis gives
prepare another cast; the silicone index made on this
the dies (Fig 8-59). The dies will be reinserted into
the duplicate stone cast. The dentin layer is then
the patient tangible evidence of the prosthetic team's
cast is used to check the position of the tooth prepa-
the cast and then positioned; their exact position is .
fired on the stone cast at 6o0U-9 (Fig 8-69).
commitment to the work involved in the restorative .
chromatic resin. For major restorative treatments,
CHAPTER 8 Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
. prosthesis is introduced into the mouth. By using the actual matrix, the clinician can more easily determine
removable dies and the gingiva.
. then evaluated using the silicone index on the sec
Another silicone index is created so that the
ond stone cast that was fabricated especially for this
reduction of the dentin layer can be carefully moni tored (Figs 8-70 to 8-72). The buccolingual thickness
the exact position of the provisional prosthesis
The duplicate dies are treated with a setting solu
purpose (Figs 8-6o and 8-61). The dies are bonded
when it is positioned in the oral cavity (Figs 8·54
tion (Margidur, Benzer Dental) that penetrates the
at the cervical margin of the cast using adhesive
of the dentin layer must have an incisal edge that is
and 8-55).
porous plaster without increasing in thickness. After
wax, which is also used to bond the silicone index
significantly though not completely reduced, as this
their exterior surfaces are treated with soft wax. the
to the dies. The surfaces of the dies protruding from
would greatly compromise the value of the final
dies are reintroduced into the impression with a lit
the upper part of the cast are isolated with a very
result (Fig 8-73). A bonding adhesive (Connector) is
Second-generation provisional prosthesis
tle pressure. Cyanoacrylate is added to the head of
thin layer of inert wax, and then a larger quantity of
applied to ensure an enhanced bond with the pho
each die, and the dies are then bonded.
inert wax is applied to the base of the dies to iden
topolymerizing colors (Artglass (reactive) added to the surface (Fig 8·74). The second silicone index is
Modern practitioners have long abandoned the tra·
The dies are bonded at the cervical margin with
tify where they are located during the squaring oper
ditional practice of using a mediocre provisional
adhesive wax (Kiebewachs, Gebdi), which cements
ation. The two parts previously moistened are then
used to ensure that suficient space is left for the
prosthesis to be replaced with an improved perma·
them during casting (Fig 8-58) and enables them to
fixated with plaster and, once set, excess portions
enamel-type material to be added and polymerized.
nent ceramic prosthesis. '0
be removed once the plaster has set and the bond
are trimmed to square the entire cast. The sealant
Once the enamel-type material is molded using
The stratified provisional prosthesis involves the
ed dies have been reintroduced inside the impres
wax is removed from the base using a heat-generat
the same matrix, the restoration is detached from
application of a technique similar to that used to
sion. For optimal results, this plaster should be in a
ing machine so that the dies can be removed (Figs
the plaster cast, which can be discarded, and adapt·
8-62 to 8-66).
ed to the working cast with the aid of contact·
create
indirect first-generation provisional
slightly more liquified form than usual to allow
restoration, requiring either a stone or resin cast,
the
slight vibrations to be applied during the casting
except that the pigmentation also is applied to the
process.
With its removable dies, this cast provides the
detecting powder (Figs 8-75 to 8-78). The result is
means to condition the soft tissues and assess the
a stratified provisional restoration that can be
For this phase, the technician has two options for
tooth morphology, since the gingival information is
mechanically trimmed and polished without loss of
producing the master cast: The cast can be poured
included. A duplicate of this cast will be needed for
its color characteristics. It can be used to evaluate
Stone casts
as a single process, thus instantly creating the base,
molding the resin.
the shape, length, position, and characterizations
The essential diferences in this procedure compared
or a double-pouring process can be used, requiring
middle and cervical third of the restorations.
with the techniques described earlier are ) the
In summary, the sequence is as follows:
(chroma, value, and color) of the restoration, as well as for gingival conditioning (Figs 8-79 to 8-82).
two separate pours. The latter technique involves a
teeth have already been prepared, and (2) the soft
first pour to cover the dies and a second pour to
•
Master dies
tissues, which for several weeks supported the first
create a cast in a rubber base. Both casts are
•
Master dies duplicated using silicone
is reconfirmed in vivo with the provisional prosthesis
generation provisional prosthesis, have adapted to
removed from the im pression after the plaster has
•
Duplicated dies
that reproduces the shape of the waxup, or some
the new situation.
set (about 45 minutes) and squared separately
•
Fixed dies used to prepare a control silicone key
detail of the dental anatomy is changed by examin
Dies originating from the duplication inserted in
ing the slides and a plaster model originating from
the impression for the Geller model
the first provisional prosthesis (Figs 8-83 to 8·86).
For complex cases and others that the clinician
252
rations during the cast construction phase with the
using the cast-squaring tool.
deems appropriate, a second-generation provisional
The dies are removed individually with the use of
restoration should be prepared in the laboratoy on
hot steam produced by a steam generator to melt
a precise elastomeric impression obtained ater gin
the adhesive wax sealant. The technician must take
gival retraction. The impression should have perfect
•
•
Geller cast
The diagnostic commitment of the prosthetic team
The second-generation provisional prosthesis is a conversion of the monochromatic waxup in poly
care to clean the die channels before any subse
A new waxup is prepared on the duplicate work
ly discernible cervical margins and be cast using
quent use to optimize the positioning of the remov
ing cast using the silicone index of the study cast
this represents the most important diagnostic stage,
class IV plaster to obtain the master tooth prepara
able dies. Care should also be taken to highlight the
waxup as a guide (Figs 8-67 and 8-68). A silicone
and, though it is provisional, it conditions the soft
tions. These are trimmed to give them a carrot-like
perimeter of the arch and the channel position when
matrix is molded on the new waxup, set under a
tissues and demonstrates esthetic quality similar
shape and subsequently duplicated (Figs 8·56 and
the casts are matched, so that holes can later be
pressure of 3 to 4 bars (Zeta labor), and used to adapt
to that of the definitive restorative treatment"-'5
8-57). The same elastomeric impression is used to
prepared to accommodate the protruding parts of
the dentin-type material (New Outline, Anaxdent) on
(Figs 8-87 to 8-92). Additionally, this prosthesis gives
prepare another cast; the silicone index made on this
the dies (Fig 8-59). The dies will be reinserted into
the duplicate stone cast. The dentin layer is then
the patient tangible evidence of the prosthetic team's
cast is used to check the position of the tooth prepa-
the cast and then positioned; their exact position is .
fired on the stone cast at 6o0U-9 (Fig 8-69).
commitment to the work involved in the restorative .
chromatic resin. For major restorative treatments,
Fig 8-47 Acrylic resin polymerized inside the silicone matrix and implemented on the diagnostic waxup. The acrylic material is baked at a tem perature of 6o·c and at a pressure of 4 bars. Fig 8-48 Sectioned silicone index used to evaluate the space available for the enamel-type resin as the surface of the dentin-type resin is reduced. Fig 8-49 Dentin characterizations implemented using photopolymerizing colors. Fig 8-50 Enamel-type acrylic resin molded on the dentin base and subsequently polymerized at a pressure of 4 bars. Fig 8-51 Provisional after polish ing on the buccal surfaces. Polishing is achieved using a number of micromotor-operated brushes or a laboratory cleaning machine. Fig 8-52 Provisional following rough1ng out of the internal portion using tungsten carbide burs of different diameters and shapes.
Fig 8-53 Provisional inserted in the silicone index. It is advisable to section the silicone index horizontally to enable easy transfer of the pro visional to the mouth for the alignment phase. Fig 8-54 Clinical try-in of the provisional with the help of the silicone index. Fig 8-55 Provisional aligned and cemented in the oral cavity.
255
Fig 8-47 Acrylic resin polymerized inside the silicone matrix and implemented on the diagnostic waxup. The acrylic material is baked at a tem perature of 6o·c and at a pressure of 4 bars. Fig 8-48 Sectioned silicone index used to evaluate the space available for the enamel-type resin as the surface of the dentin-type resin is reduced. Fig 8-49 Dentin characterizations implemented using photopolymerizing colors. Fig 8-50 Enamel-type acrylic resin molded on the dentin base and subsequently polymerized at a pressure of 4 bars. Fig 8-51 Provisional after polish ing on the buccal surfaces. Polishing is achieved using a number of micromotor-operated brushes or a laboratory cleaning machine. Fig 8-52 Provisional following rough1ng out of the internal portion using tungsten carbide burs of different diameters and shapes.
Fig 8-53 Provisional inserted in the silicone index. It is advisable to section the silicone index horizontally to enable easy transfer of the pro visional to the mouth for the alignment phase. Fig 8-54 Clinical try-in of the provisional with the help of the silicone index. Fig 8-55 Provisional aligned and cemented in the oral cavity.
255
Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fig 8-56 Master tooth preparations created using a precise elastomeric impression and white class IV plaster. Fig 8-57 The master tooth preparations are duplicated using 1,1 ratio dupliCation silicone. Both the silicone and plaster are treated using a vacuum at a pressure of 4 bars. Fig 8-58 Removable dies with special notches and grooves to guide reinsertion. These dies. which require a slightly tapered shape. are inserted inside the impression to be again subjected to casting. Fig 8-59 Dies reinserted in the cast. The base of the cast has a large trough to house the terminal projections of the removable dies. Retention grooves have been prepared on the adjoining parts. Fig 8-60 Silicone index positioned on the second stone cast. Fig 8-61 Silicone index transferred to the removable-die cast to check positioning.
Fig 8-62 The final section of dies is suitably waxed. and plaster is added over the entire surface. Fig 8-63 Plaster is then poured inside the base trough and on all the retention grooves implemented on the surface. Fig 8-64 Contact positioning of the two parts using the same class IV plaster but with a more liquid consistency. Fig 8-65 Frontal view of the finished and squared cast. Fig 8-66 O cclusal view of a sectioned cast detailing re. -insertion channels of the removable dies. Fig 8-6.7 Frontal view .of a Geller cast of the case. This type of sectioned cast highlights the anatomiC charactenst1cs of the g1ng1val margm and prov1des a better VIeW of the dental anatomy and the dentogingival relationship. It is very difficult to create ceramic restorations without having the gingival tissues for reference.
27
Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fig 8-56 Master tooth preparations created using a precise elastomeric impression and white class IV plaster. Fig 8-57 The master tooth preparations are duplicated using 1,1 ratio dupliCation silicone. Both the silicone and plaster are treated using a vacuum at a pressure of 4 bars. Fig 8-58 Removable dies with special notches and grooves to guide reinsertion. These dies. which require a slightly tapered shape. are inserted inside the impression to be again subjected to casting. Fig 8-59 Dies reinserted in the cast. The base of the cast has a large trough to house the terminal projections of the removable dies. Retention grooves have been prepared on the adjoining parts. Fig 8-60 Silicone index positioned on the second stone cast. Fig 8-61 Silicone index transferred to the removable-die cast to check positioning.
Fig 8-62 The final section of dies is suitably waxed. and plaster is added over the entire surface. Fig 8-63 Plaster is then poured inside the base trough and on all the retention grooves implemented on the surface. Fig 8-64 Contact positioning of the two parts using the same class IV plaster but with a more liquid consistency. Fig 8-65 Frontal view of the finished and squared cast. Fig 8-66 O cclusal view of a sectioned cast detailing re. -insertion channels of the removable dies. Fig 8-6.7 Frontal view .of a Geller cast of the case. This type of sectioned cast highlights the anatomiC charactenst1cs of the g1ng1val margm and prov1des a better VIeW of the dental anatomy and the dentogingival relationship. It is very difficult to create ceramic restorations without having the gingival tissues for reference.
27
CHAPTER 8 Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
.. treatment. Based on this high-quality provisional,
•
Patient satisfaction
the patient can establish an opinion of the treat
•
Appearance of the restoration in relation to the face and smile
ment before the definitive restoration is completed (since a minimum of 10 days is needed before the
•
These impressions of the provisional prosthesis in
•
Emergence of the buccal surfaces of the teeth in
•
Shape of the prosthetic teeth due to wear or the
relation to the lip profile
the mouth are used, along with slides of the inter mediate situation, to make only minor changes re
presence of composite restorations
lated to shape and soft tissue integration.
In situ eva luation
•
Condition of the soft tissues and maturity of the
•
Integration of the provisional restoration with
interdental papillae adjacent teeth
An objective evaluation of the provisional restora tion or diagnostic mock-up in situ cannot be con ducted in a single appointment, since the restora
Position of the incisal edge relative to the contour of the lower lip and of the labial commissure
final impressions can be taken) (Figs 8-93 to 8-95).
•
Occlusion
tion generally proposes a significant change. ••-20
Each parameter should be photographed to give
The preoperative situation frequently results from a
the clinician and dental technician the opportunity
slow progressive deterioration of the volume and
to assess the overall situation in the laboratory dur
shape of the teeth or the previous restoration. The
ing the next phase of the ceramic preparation and
patient is unlikely to immediately adapt to the new
determine the corrections, if any, to be made. If sig
prosthesis because the new restorative parameters differ significantly from the pretreatment situation.
to prepare a new provisional prosthesis; the authors
In general, the prosthetic team should avoid adjust·
generally prefer to prepare the wax corrections direct-
ing the restoration in the first visit to allow the
ly on the provisional prosthesis and then ix the whole
patient the necessary time to grow accustomed to
prosthesis in an irreversible hydrocolloid impression.
the provisional restoration.
When minor changes are required, the corrections
The provisional prosthesis is evaluated through assessment of the following parameters:
B-70
nificant changes are required, it may be necessary
can be executed di rectly on the definitive ceramic work and evaluated during the bisque-bake try-in.
•
B-72
Figs 8-68 to 8-75 Provisional stratification. Fig 8-68 Suitably adapted diagnostic waxup. Fig 8-6g Molding phase o f dentin-type acrylic resin obtained from the silicone matrix. Figs 8-70 and 8-71 Silicone index showing the space available on the labial surfaces as the dentin material is reduced. Fig 8-72 Silicone index in place after sectioning in the sagittal direction. Fig 8-73 Dentin reduction completed with the incisal edge significantly reduced.
1
259
CHAPTER 8 Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
.. treatment. Based on this high-quality provisional,
•
Patient satisfaction
the patient can establish an opinion of the treat
•
Appearance of the restoration in relation to the face and smile
ment before the definitive restoration is completed (since a minimum of 10 days is needed before the
•
These impressions of the provisional prosthesis in
•
Emergence of the buccal surfaces of the teeth in
•
Shape of the prosthetic teeth due to wear or the
relation to the lip profile
the mouth are used, along with slides of the inter mediate situation, to make only minor changes re
presence of composite restorations
lated to shape and soft tissue integration.
In situ eva luation
•
Condition of the soft tissues and maturity of the
•
Integration of the provisional restoration with
interdental papillae adjacent teeth
An objective evaluation of the provisional restora tion or diagnostic mock-up in situ cannot be con ducted in a single appointment, since the restora
Position of the incisal edge relative to the contour of the lower lip and of the labial commissure
final impressions can be taken) (Figs 8-93 to 8-95).
•
Occlusion
tion generally proposes a significant change. ••-20
Each parameter should be photographed to give
The preoperative situation frequently results from a
the clinician and dental technician the opportunity
slow progressive deterioration of the volume and
to assess the overall situation in the laboratory dur
shape of the teeth or the previous restoration. The
ing the next phase of the ceramic preparation and
patient is unlikely to immediately adapt to the new
determine the corrections, if any, to be made. If sig
prosthesis because the new restorative parameters differ significantly from the pretreatment situation.
to prepare a new provisional prosthesis; the authors
In general, the prosthetic team should avoid adjust·
generally prefer to prepare the wax corrections direct-
ing the restoration in the first visit to allow the
ly on the provisional prosthesis and then ix the whole
patient the necessary time to grow accustomed to
prosthesis in an irreversible hydrocolloid impression.
the provisional restoration.
When minor changes are required, the corrections
The provisional prosthesis is evaluated through assessment of the following parameters:
B-70
nificant changes are required, it may be necessary
can be executed di rectly on the definitive ceramic work and evaluated during the bisque-bake try-in.
•
B-72
Figs 8-68 to 8-75 Provisional stratification. Fig 8-68 Suitably adapted diagnostic waxup. Fig 8-6g Molding phase o f dentin-type acrylic resin obtained from the silicone matrix. Figs 8-70 and 8-71 Silicone index showing the space available on the labial surfaces as the dentin material is reduced. Fig 8-72 Silicone index in place after sectioning in the sagittal direction. Fig 8-73 Dentin reduction completed with the incisal edge significantly reduced.
1
259
CIAPl ER Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fig 8-74 Photopotymerizing colors applied over the dentin layer. Fig 8-75 Molding phase of the enamel-type acrylic resin. Figs 8-76 to 8-78 Lines c � e ated using contact-detecting powder are useful for defining the shape of the restorations during the finishing phase. Figs 8-7g to 8-81 . FiniShed and polished prom1onal restorahons. Note the emergence profiles shown in the lateral views.
ZG
Fig 8-82 Provisional before insertion in the mouth. The reconstruction of the clinical case involves veneers on the central i n cisors and crowns on the lateral incisors. Fig 8-83 First provisional on 2.1 and 2.2 for whitening . The patient requested improvement i n the shape and brilliance of the teeth. Fig 8-84 Provisional in situ. The diagnostic planning done in the laboratory is evaluated direclly i n the mouth with the help of the provisional. Fig 8-85 View of the right maxillary incisors showing the anatomy of the restorations. Fig 8-86 View of the left max illary incisor. Note that the cervical area is no longer gray. as it was i n the previous restorative treatment.
261
CIAPl ER Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fig 8-74 Photopotymerizing colors applied over the dentin layer. Fig 8-75 Molding phase of the enamel-type acrylic resin. Figs 8-76 to 8-78 Lines c � e ated using contact-detecting powder are useful for defining the shape of the restorations during the finishing phase. Figs 8-7g to 8-81 . FiniShed and polished prom1onal restorahons. Note the emergence profiles shown in the lateral views.
ZG
Fig 8-82 Provisional before insertion in the mouth. The reconstruction of the clinical case involves veneers on the central i n cisors and crowns on the lateral incisors. Fig 8-83 First provisional on 2.1 and 2.2 for whitening . The patient requested improvement i n the shape and brilliance of the teeth. Fig 8-84 Provisional in situ. The diagnostic planning done in the laboratory is evaluated direclly i n the mouth with the help of the provisional. Fig 8-85 View of the right maxillary incisors showing the anatomy of the restorations. Fig 8-86 View of the left max illary incisor. Note that the cervical area is no longer gray. as it was i n the previous restorative treatment.
261
Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fig 8-87 Pre operative view of clinical case. Fig 8-88 Following the diagnostic wax up in the laboratory. distalization of the papilla between the _ _ mmllary nght c ! ntral and lateral 1nc1 sors was planned. Fig 8-8g Preparation for tissue conditioning is achieved by removing plaster from _ the Internal g1ng1val port1on """g a sphemal bur. resulting in the fabrication of a larger provisional in relation to the existing gingival _ g tiSsues. Fig 8- o Prom1onal 1n the mouth shows a tiSsue ISChemia corresponding to the area where plaster was removed from the cast.
Ul
Fig 8- gl Provisional now perfectly adapted to the oral cavity following tissue conditioning. Fig 8- g2 Detail of the provisional after tissue con ditioning. Fig 8- gJ Cast showing plans for tissue conditioning for a pontic. Fig 8-4 Edentulous site following tissue conditioning. Fig 8-gs Pontic in place. perfectly adapted to give the esthetic appearance of a good emergence profile. even though the restoration does not extend sub gingivally.
23
Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
Fig 8-87 Pre operative view of clinical case. Fig 8-88 Following the diagnostic wax up in the laboratory. distalization of the papilla between the _ _ mmllary nght c ! ntral and lateral 1nc1 sors was planned. Fig 8-8g Preparation for tissue conditioning is achieved by removing plaster from _ the Internal g1ng1val port1on """g a sphemal bur. resulting in the fabrication of a larger provisional in relation to the existing gingival _ g tiSsues. Fig 8- o Prom1onal 1n the mouth shows a tiSsue ISChemia corresponding to the area where plaster was removed from the cast.
Ul
Fig 8- gl Provisional now perfectly adapted to the oral cavity following tissue conditioning. Fig 8- g2 Detail of the provisional after tissue con ditioning. Fig 8- gJ Cast showing plans for tissue conditioning for a pontic. Fig 8-4 Edentulous site following tissue conditioning. Fig 8-gs Pontic in place. perfectly adapted to give the esthetic appearance of a good emergence profile. even though the restoration does not extend sub gingivally.
23
CHAPTER 8 Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
REFEREN CES
7.
Brisman S. Esthetics: A comparison of dentists' and
13.
patients' concepts. J Am Dent Assoc t98o:too:345-352. 1.
2.
Levinson NLA. Psychologic acets of esthetic dental
8. Albino JE. Tedesco LA. Conny DJ. Patient perceptions of
care: A developmental perspective. J Prosthet Dent
dental-facial esthetics: Shared concerns in orthodontics
1990:64:486-491.
and prosthodontics. J Prosthet Dent 1984:5 2:9-13.
Ellmann ). Compression formed plaster shells for tem
3-
concetto
Krug RS. Multiple use of plastic template in fixed prosthodontics. J Prosthet Dent 1973:30:745-748.
s.
14.
trattamento estetico.
Dent
integrated approach to periodontics and restorative
G,
Sampalmieri
F, Mattioli
Belmonte
dentistry. Dent Clin North Am t98o:24:285-303.
Liu Cl. Use of a modiied ovate pontic in areas of ridge
Dialogue
15.
isher D, Shillingburg HT Jr. Dewhirst RB. Indirect tem
16.
tion of provisional restorations. lnt
Miller MB. Ovate pontics: The natural tooth replacement.
4:33 2-336. 20.
Pract Periodontics Aesthet Dent 1996:8:140.
porary restorations. J Am Dent Assoc 1971;82: 16o-t63. 11. Albergo G. Accarisi E. Sampalmieri F, Bedini R. Andreana
Emtiaz S, Tarnow DP. Processed acrylic resin provision
marginal gaps of light-polymerized and autopolymer·
Ogawa T, Ai2awa S, Tanaka M, atsuya S, Hasegawa A.
82: 16!-!66.
Koyano K. Efect of water temperature on the it of pro
1997:76(special issue):279·
visional
Capelli M, Albergo G, Casolari L, Sampalmieri F, Bedini
tions in restorative dentistry: The blueprint for success.
R. Antibacterial activity of a resin: A qualitative study. J
J Can Dent Assoc 1999:65:272-275-
Dent Res 1998:77:1389.
Dubois R). Kyriakakis P, Weiner S, Vaidyanathan TK. Efects of occlusal loading and thermocycling on the
ized resin provisional crowns. I Prosthet Dent 1999;
performance in acrylic resin (abstract 2128). J Dent Res
12.
Prosthodont 1991;
Prosthet Dent 1998:79:484-488.
5. Efect of antimicrobical ingredients on mechanical
Assoc 1998:26:t21-127.
I
al restoration with lingual cast metal ramewor.. J
Cho GC, Donovan TE. Chee NL. Clinical experiences
17.
Moulding MB, Loney RW. The efect of cooling tech niques on intrapulpal temperature during direct abrica
2004;16:273-2Bt: discussion 282-283.
with bonded porcelain laminate veneers. J Cal Dent
6. Donovan TE, Cho GC. Diagnostic provisional restora·
19.
defects: A repon of two cases. J Esthet Restor Dent
200t;5:44o-453· 10.
4- Preston JD. A systematic approach to the control of
esthetic form. J Prosthet Dent 1976:35 :393-402.
del
18. Youdelis RA, Faucher R. Provisional restorations: An
Albergo
acrylic resin. J Dent Res t997:76:11o3.
9- Romeo G. II prowisorio diagnostico per comprendere it
porary splints. Dent Dig 1971:77:334-339·
M,
Andreana S. echanical performance of some dental
crown
margins
during
polymerization.
I
Prosthet Dent 1999:B2:6sH61.
25
CHAPTER 8 Technical Considerations for Provisional Prostheses
REFEREN CES
7.
Brisman S. Esthetics: A comparison of dentists' and
13.
patients' concepts. J Am Dent Assoc t98o:too:345-352. 1.
2.
Levinson NLA. Psychologic acets of esthetic dental
8. Albino JE. Tedesco LA. Conny DJ. Patient perceptions of
care: A developmental perspective. J Prosthet Dent
dental-facial esthetics: Shared concerns in orthodontics
1990:64:486-491.
and prosthodontics. J Prosthet Dent 1984:5 2:9-13.
Ellmann ). Compression formed plaster shells for tem
3-
concetto
Krug RS. Multiple use of plastic template in fixed prosthodontics. J Prosthet Dent 1973:30:745-748.
s.
14.
trattamento estetico.
Dent
integrated approach to periodontics and restorative
G,
Sampalmieri
F, Mattioli
Belmonte
dentistry. Dent Clin North Am t98o:24:285-303.
Liu Cl. Use of a modiied ovate pontic in areas of ridge
Dialogue
15.
isher D, Shillingburg HT Jr. Dewhirst RB. Indirect tem
16.
tion of provisional restorations. lnt
Miller MB. Ovate pontics: The natural tooth replacement.
4:33 2-336. 20.
Pract Periodontics Aesthet Dent 1996:8:140.
porary restorations. J Am Dent Assoc 1971;82: 16o-t63. 11. Albergo G. Accarisi E. Sampalmieri F, Bedini R. Andreana
Emtiaz S, Tarnow DP. Processed acrylic resin provision
marginal gaps of light-polymerized and autopolymer·
Ogawa T, Ai2awa S, Tanaka M, atsuya S, Hasegawa A.
82: 16!-!66.
Koyano K. Efect of water temperature on the it of pro
1997:76(special issue):279·
visional
Capelli M, Albergo G, Casolari L, Sampalmieri F, Bedini
tions in restorative dentistry: The blueprint for success.
R. Antibacterial activity of a resin: A qualitative study. J
J Can Dent Assoc 1999:65:272-275-
Dent Res 1998:77:1389.
Dubois R). Kyriakakis P, Weiner S, Vaidyanathan TK. Efects of occlusal loading and thermocycling on the
ized resin provisional crowns. I Prosthet Dent 1999;
performance in acrylic resin (abstract 2128). J Dent Res
12.
Prosthodont 1991;
Prosthet Dent 1998:79:484-488.
5. Efect of antimicrobical ingredients on mechanical
Assoc 1998:26:t21-127.
I
al restoration with lingual cast metal ramewor.. J
Cho GC, Donovan TE. Chee NL. Clinical experiences
17.
Moulding MB, Loney RW. The efect of cooling tech niques on intrapulpal temperature during direct abrica
2004;16:273-2Bt: discussion 282-283.
with bonded porcelain laminate veneers. J Cal Dent
6. Donovan TE, Cho GC. Diagnostic provisional restora·
19.
defects: A repon of two cases. J Esthet Restor Dent
200t;5:44o-453· 10.
4- Preston JD. A systematic approach to the control of
esthetic form. J Prosthet Dent 1976:35 :393-402.
del
18. Youdelis RA, Faucher R. Provisional restorations: An
Albergo
acrylic resin. J Dent Res t997:76:11o3.
9- Romeo G. II prowisorio diagnostico per comprendere it
porary splints. Dent Dig 1971:77:334-339·
M,
Andreana S. echanical performance of some dental
crown
margins
during
polymerization.
I
Prosthet Dent 1999:B2:6sH61.
25
C H A P T E R
9
C U S T O M IM P RESS I O N TRAY S A N D IM P RESS I O N MATER IAL S FIG 9-1
I
n dental prosthetics, the impression is essential
sizes to accommodate almost every clinical situa
for fabricating a restoration. If the proper proce
tion, eg, polystyrene, plastic, aluminum, or steel;
dures are not followed, the clinician may intro
perforated or nonperforated; etc (Figs 9-1 to 9-3).
duce errors or distortions that cannot be eliminated
During setting, the chemical reaction of the paste
or corrected in subsequent stages. The impression
and catalyst can lead to shrinkage, which alters the
communicates the clinical condition of the patient's
shape and dimension and compromises the preci
mouth
to the dental technician; therefore, an
sion of the impression. To minimize shrinkage, the
impression that faithfully records the details of a
thickness of impression material should be ade
dental arch leads to a well-adapted restoration. A
quate to accurately record every stressed clinical sit
precise impression can be made using several dif
uation (natural undercuts, convex, natural tooth),
ferent types of materials and impression trays. The
but no thickerJ·•
FIG 9-2
FIG 9-3
clinician must understand the techniques and fac tors that ensure an accurate impression. The follow ing general overview details the procedures typical
Custom i m p ression trays
ly used by the authors.
Clinicians can regulate the thickness of an impres
I M PRES S I O N TRAYS
photopolymerizable resin. By molding a 3-mm-thick
sion by making custom impression trays out of
An impression material generally consists of a paste
zu
sheet of soft wax around the dental arch on a diag nostic cast before molding the resin, the clinician
and a catalyst that gradually harden when mixed
can create the ideal thickness for the impression
together. Once the paste and catalyst come in con
material (Fig 9-4). Some authorsS-6 do not agree that
tact, the impression material begins to increase in
custom trays are necessary for precise impressions,
viscosity and slowly develops elasticity. This gradual
believing that the degree of shrinkage of impression
hardening permits the clinician to position the mate
materials is clinically insignificant. However, custom
rial while it is still in an plastic state (working stage)
trays can mitigate another important phenomenon
before it hardens into a elastic state. '·2
distortion caused by undercuts.
While it is in a plastic state, the impression mate
In the authors' opinion, one of the greatest
rial is placed in a suitable tray for the arch being
stresses on impression materials is the presence of
impressed. Manufacturers fabricate impression trays
undercuts, for example, found in the natural anato
out of different materials and in various shapes and
my of intact maxillary teeth. Apical to the initial pro- ..
FIG 9-4
FIG 9-5
Figs g-1 to g -3 Stock trays. Fig g -1 Polystyrene tray. These trays are very flexible and are unsuitable for precision impressions. ' However. they can be used to make a full plaster impression of implants because they can be cut easily afler casting. Fig g -2 Perforated aluminum tray. Perforated trays. including those in steel. are unsuitable for impression taking because the perforations can create anomalies in the impres sion.1 Fig g-3 Solid steel tray. These trays must be boxed in with wax to ensure good adaptation. Fig g _4 Sheet of spacing wax that is molded direclly on top of the diagnostic cast. Its thickness !generally 3 mml creates the ideal space for the impression material. Fig g_s Tooth prepa ration for a complete crown. The horizontal retraction creates a pronounced undercut formed by the natural taper of the root.
217
C H A P T E R
9
C U S T O M IM P RESS I O N TRAY S A N D IM P RESS I O N MATER IAL S FIG 9-1
I
n dental prosthetics, the impression is essential
sizes to accommodate almost every clinical situa
for fabricating a restoration. If the proper proce
tion, eg, polystyrene, plastic, aluminum, or steel;
dures are not followed, the clinician may intro
perforated or nonperforated; etc (Figs 9-1 to 9-3).
duce errors or distortions that cannot be eliminated
During setting, the chemical reaction of the paste
or corrected in subsequent stages. The impression
and catalyst can lead to shrinkage, which alters the
communicates the clinical condition of the patient's
shape and dimension and compromises the preci
mouth
to the dental technician; therefore, an
sion of the impression. To minimize shrinkage, the
impression that faithfully records the details of a
thickness of impression material should be ade
dental arch leads to a well-adapted restoration. A
quate to accurately record every stressed clinical sit
precise impression can be made using several dif
uation (natural undercuts, convex, natural tooth),
ferent types of materials and impression trays. The
but no thickerJ·•
FIG 9-2
FIG 9-3
clinician must understand the techniques and fac tors that ensure an accurate impression. The follow ing general overview details the procedures typical
Custom i m p ression trays
ly used by the authors.
Clinicians can regulate the thickness of an impres
I M PRES S I O N TRAYS
photopolymerizable resin. By molding a 3-mm-thick
sion by making custom impression trays out of
An impression material generally consists of a paste
zu
sheet of soft wax around the dental arch on a diag nostic cast before molding the resin, the clinician
and a catalyst that gradually harden when mixed
can create the ideal thickness for the impression
together. Once the paste and catalyst come in con
material (Fig 9-4). Some authorsS-6 do not agree that
tact, the impression material begins to increase in
custom trays are necessary for precise impressions,
viscosity and slowly develops elasticity. This gradual
believing that the degree of shrinkage of impression
hardening permits the clinician to position the mate
materials is clinically insignificant. However, custom
rial while it is still in an plastic state (working stage)
trays can mitigate another important phenomenon
before it hardens into a elastic state. '·2
distortion caused by undercuts.
While it is in a plastic state, the impression mate
In the authors' opinion, one of the greatest
rial is placed in a suitable tray for the arch being
stresses on impression materials is the presence of
impressed. Manufacturers fabricate impression trays
undercuts, for example, found in the natural anato
out of different materials and in various shapes and
my of intact maxillary teeth. Apical to the initial pro- ..
FIG 9-4
FIG 9-5
Figs g-1 to g -3 Stock trays. Fig g -1 Polystyrene tray. These trays are very flexible and are unsuitable for precision impressions. ' However. they can be used to make a full plaster impression of implants because they can be cut easily afler casting. Fig g -2 Perforated aluminum tray. Perforated trays. including those in steel. are unsuitable for impression taking because the perforations can create anomalies in the impres sion.1 Fig g-3 Solid steel tray. These trays must be boxed in with wax to ensure good adaptation. Fig g _4 Sheet of spacing wax that is molded direclly on top of the diagnostic cast. Its thickness !generally 3 mml creates the ideal space for the impression material. Fig g_s Tooth prepa ration for a complete crown. The horizontal retraction creates a pronounced undercut formed by the natural taper of the root.
217
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
.. trusion of the tooth in the area of the dental alve
around the vestibular fornix to delimit the edge of
oli, there is a depression of varying extent in the
the tray (Figs 9-8 to 9-10). Occlusal stops are made
area of the vestibular fornix; clinical treatment to
by creating small depressions, with adequate exten
modify the shape and length of the clinical crown
sions, in the anterior hard palate and edentulous
can reveal natural undercuts (Fig 9-5). Undercuts can
areas. A sufficient number of well-positioned stops
also be erroneously created during tooth prepara
are needed to provide tripod-like stability; if there
tion, a risk that is often underestimated as a poten
are no edentulous areas, additional stops can be
tial cause of the impression distotion that leads to
made against the palatal mucosa at the level of the
poor adaptation of the restoration. The clinician
maxillary first molars. If this is not possible for ana
must be aware of all undercuts while preparing the
tomic reasons (eg, a lack of edentulous areas in the
custom tray and block out those areas with addi
mandible or the presence of an accentuated palate),
tional spacing wax. By leaving more room in the cus
the cusps of teeth in noncritical areas {ie, those not
tom tray for a thicker application of material to the
afecting functional movements, such as the buccal
undercuts, the impression should be able to with
cusps of maxillay teeth and the lingual cusps of man
stand the force required to remove it from the oral
dibular teeth) can be used as support for the tripod.
cavity without laceration or stretching. For these rea
Light-curing resin (MultiTray, 3M ESPE) is used to
sons, the clinician should use custom trays to obtain
make the tray. The stops and detachment wings are
a suitable impression.'
prepared first by placing small amounts of resin in
FIG 9-6
FIG 9-7
FIG 9-8
FIG 9-9
FIG 9-10
FIG 9-11
the wax depressions that are then polymerized for 5 Fabrication of the custom i m p ression tray
ESPE) (Fig 9-11) so they will adhere to the rest of the
ing the stone cast, which will be marked according
resin.
to the planned form and dimension of the custom
The main sheet of resin is applied over the wax
tray and to prevent material from locking into the
and the prepolymerized stops and carefully adapted
marked undercuts. Using a graphite pencil or wax
to the design of the tray. Once the central handle
crayon, the clinician traces the limits of the tray's
and the detachment wings are shaped, the custom
apical extension taking care to avoid the involve
made tray, prepared on the plaster model, is placed
ment of the vestibular fornix and to include the area 2
m m apical to the inish line (Figs 9-6 and 9-7).
i n the light-curing unit for 5 minutes (Figs 9-12 to
9-14). The tray undergoes two polymerizations of s
To obtain ideal thickness. a 3-mm wax sheet is
minutes each, first for the exterior and then for the
heated to 40°C and then molded to the diagnostic
interior, without removing the spacing wax. The spac
cast, following the guide marks. Additional wax is
ing wax is finally removed, and the tray is placed in
adapted to areas of pronounced natural undercuts so
the light-polymerizing unit for another 5 minutes to
that the tray will withstand the extra stress in these
cure the interior surface (Fig 9-15).
areas. Thus, the custom impression tray will not be of uniform thickness but of controlled thickness.
21
to 10 seconds in a light-curing unit (Multilight, 3M
To make a custom impression tray, stat by evaluat
Once the polymerization is finished, the tray must be evaluated on the cast to ensure that the stops
Once the wax sheet has been adapted to the
make proper contact with the desired areas (Figs
plaster cast, the clinician uses a laboratory knife to
9-16 and 9-17) and the detachment wings and the
trim excess wax from the cast according to plan and
han dle are correctly positioned (Fig 9-18). Using t u n g- �
Fi gs 9-6 and 9-7 Graphite pencil or a wax crayon is used to mark the placement of occlusal slops and the borders of the custom lny that extend 2 mm apical to the finish line. However. in areas of the mouth thai are not involved in the restoration. the impression should not exlend beyond the finish line to minimize the number of natural undercuts in the impression. Fig 9-8 and 9-9 A laboratory scalpel is used to cut the spacing wax at the tray limits marked in graphite and in the areas for occlusal stops. Fig g -10 Cut-out areas are filled in with pieces of light-curing resin to ereale lhe occlusal stops for sealing lhe impression. Fig 9-ll lighl-curing unit. The occlusal stops are polymerized for a few sec onds so that the partially hardened resin will adhere to the main sheet of resin.
2"
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
.. trusion of the tooth in the area of the dental alve
around the vestibular fornix to delimit the edge of
oli, there is a depression of varying extent in the
the tray (Figs 9-8 to 9-10). Occlusal stops are made
area of the vestibular fornix; clinical treatment to
by creating small depressions, with adequate exten
modify the shape and length of the clinical crown
sions, in the anterior hard palate and edentulous
can reveal natural undercuts (Fig 9-5). Undercuts can
areas. A sufficient number of well-positioned stops
also be erroneously created during tooth prepara
are needed to provide tripod-like stability; if there
tion, a risk that is often underestimated as a poten
are no edentulous areas, additional stops can be
tial cause of the impression distotion that leads to
made against the palatal mucosa at the level of the
poor adaptation of the restoration. The clinician
maxillary first molars. If this is not possible for ana
must be aware of all undercuts while preparing the
tomic reasons (eg, a lack of edentulous areas in the
custom tray and block out those areas with addi
mandible or the presence of an accentuated palate),
tional spacing wax. By leaving more room in the cus
the cusps of teeth in noncritical areas {ie, those not
tom tray for a thicker application of material to the
afecting functional movements, such as the buccal
undercuts, the impression should be able to with
cusps of maxillay teeth and the lingual cusps of man
stand the force required to remove it from the oral
dibular teeth) can be used as support for the tripod.
cavity without laceration or stretching. For these rea
Light-curing resin (MultiTray, 3M ESPE) is used to
sons, the clinician should use custom trays to obtain
make the tray. The stops and detachment wings are
a suitable impression.'
prepared first by placing small amounts of resin in
FIG 9-6
FIG 9-7
FIG 9-8
FIG 9-9
FIG 9-10
FIG 9-11
the wax depressions that are then polymerized for 5 Fabrication of the custom i m p ression tray
ESPE) (Fig 9-11) so they will adhere to the rest of the
ing the stone cast, which will be marked according
resin.
to the planned form and dimension of the custom
The main sheet of resin is applied over the wax
tray and to prevent material from locking into the
and the prepolymerized stops and carefully adapted
marked undercuts. Using a graphite pencil or wax
to the design of the tray. Once the central handle
crayon, the clinician traces the limits of the tray's
and the detachment wings are shaped, the custom
apical extension taking care to avoid the involve
made tray, prepared on the plaster model, is placed
ment of the vestibular fornix and to include the area 2
m m apical to the inish line (Figs 9-6 and 9-7).
i n the light-curing unit for 5 minutes (Figs 9-12 to
9-14). The tray undergoes two polymerizations of s
To obtain ideal thickness. a 3-mm wax sheet is
minutes each, first for the exterior and then for the
heated to 40°C and then molded to the diagnostic
interior, without removing the spacing wax. The spac
cast, following the guide marks. Additional wax is
ing wax is finally removed, and the tray is placed in
adapted to areas of pronounced natural undercuts so
the light-polymerizing unit for another 5 minutes to
that the tray will withstand the extra stress in these
cure the interior surface (Fig 9-15).
areas. Thus, the custom impression tray will not be of uniform thickness but of controlled thickness.
21
to 10 seconds in a light-curing unit (Multilight, 3M
To make a custom impression tray, stat by evaluat
Once the polymerization is finished, the tray must be evaluated on the cast to ensure that the stops
Once the wax sheet has been adapted to the
make proper contact with the desired areas (Figs
plaster cast, the clinician uses a laboratory knife to
9-16 and 9-17) and the detachment wings and the
trim excess wax from the cast according to plan and
han dle are correctly positioned (Fig 9-18). Using t u n g- �
Fi gs 9-6 and 9-7 Graphite pencil or a wax crayon is used to mark the placement of occlusal slops and the borders of the custom lny that extend 2 mm apical to the finish line. However. in areas of the mouth thai are not involved in the restoration. the impression should not exlend beyond the finish line to minimize the number of natural undercuts in the impression. Fig 9-8 and 9-9 A laboratory scalpel is used to cut the spacing wax at the tray limits marked in graphite and in the areas for occlusal stops. Fig g -10 Cut-out areas are filled in with pieces of light-curing resin to ereale lhe occlusal stops for sealing lhe impression. Fig 9-ll lighl-curing unit. The occlusal stops are polymerized for a few sec onds so that the partially hardened resin will adhere to the main sheet of resin.
2"
HI Custom Impression Trays and Impression Materials
. sten carbide burs with a crossover cut (no. H77 EF,
When necessary (eg, in cases with pronounced under
H79 EF, H351 EF; Komet), the rough tray is finished
cuts), a wax net designed to make metallic supports
by removing the excess material and smoothing the
for prosthetic frames can be placed over the wax
sharp edges and irregularities. The internal surface
foundation to enhance microretention (Figs 9-20 to
of the tray is carefully washed with a grease-cutting
9-22). When pressed onto the sheet of spacing wax,
product (eg, rectified benzine) to remove the oily
this wax-net layer creates small raised bumps that
residue left by the wax.
will be transferred to the interior surface of the tray
Elastomer adhesion is a constant problem in im
(Fig 9-23).
pression taking because impression materials with
The tray must be tested in the patient's mouth.
strong internal cohesion, such as addition silicones
At least 30 minutes before the impression is taken,
and polyethers, do not adhere well to the resin sur
an adhesive that is compatible with the impression
face of the tray.8 To improve the adhesion when
material must be applied to the tray. A minimum of
using polyethers. a groove can be made with a
15 minutes is needed to ensure that the adhesive is
small-diameter tungsten carbide bur on the interior
completely dry9; if it is wet, the adhesive will insu
surface directly below the edge of the tray (Fig 9-19).
late rather than bond (Fig 9-24).
Ftgs g.12 and g.13 Moldtng of the sheet of restn dtroctly on the spacing wax and the partially polymerized stops. Ftg g-14 After lha handle and detachment wings are made. the top and bottom surfaces of the tray are polymerized for 5 minutes each with out removtng lhe spacing wax . Ftg 9-15 After removal of the spacing wax. the interior surface of the hardened impression tray is cured for an addthonal 5 mtnulu Figs 9·16 and 9-17 Fintshad custom tray Sealed on tho cast. the principal occlusal stops
..
rest on the soft tissue. It is preferable to establish occlusal stops on the mucous areas of the palate or tn edentulous Sites. rather than on the surface of teeth. Fig g. 18 Internal surface of the custom tray after cleaning with rectified benz1nt and finishing the margins and borders. fig g-19 Mechanical retention groove for the impression material. Fig 9-20 Sheet of wax netting normally used in fabricallon of metallic frames for removable partial prostheses. Figs 9-21 and g-22 The wax net pattern increases microretenlion between elastomer tmpression materials and the resin material of the custom tray Elastomers have high cohesion and therefore adhere poorly to many surfaces Ftg g.23 High-magntftealion shows the close mechanical adaptation between an elastomer impresSion material and the reSin of the custom tray The liquid adhesive layer between the elastomer and resin increases adhesion Fig g-24 Polyelher-compallble adhesive The adhesive is applied with a brush to the internal surface of the custom tray to facilitate adheSion of the impression matenal lo the light-curing resin 211
HI Custom Impression Trays and Impression Materials
. sten carbide burs with a crossover cut (no. H77 EF,
When necessary (eg, in cases with pronounced under
H79 EF, H351 EF; Komet), the rough tray is finished
cuts), a wax net designed to make metallic supports
by removing the excess material and smoothing the
for prosthetic frames can be placed over the wax
sharp edges and irregularities. The internal surface
foundation to enhance microretention (Figs 9-20 to
of the tray is carefully washed with a grease-cutting
9-22). When pressed onto the sheet of spacing wax,
product (eg, rectified benzine) to remove the oily
this wax-net layer creates small raised bumps that
residue left by the wax.
will be transferred to the interior surface of the tray
Elastomer adhesion is a constant problem in im
(Fig 9-23).
pression taking because impression materials with
The tray must be tested in the patient's mouth.
strong internal cohesion, such as addition silicones
At least 30 minutes before the impression is taken,
and polyethers, do not adhere well to the resin sur
an adhesive that is compatible with the impression
face of the tray.8 To improve the adhesion when
material must be applied to the tray. A minimum of
using polyethers. a groove can be made with a
15 minutes is needed to ensure that the adhesive is
small-diameter tungsten carbide bur on the interior
completely dry9; if it is wet, the adhesive will insu
surface directly below the edge of the tray (Fig 9-19).
late rather than bond (Fig 9-24).
Ftgs g.12 and g.13 Moldtng of the sheet of restn dtroctly on the spacing wax and the partially polymerized stops. Ftg g-14 After lha handle and detachment wings are made. the top and bottom surfaces of the tray are polymerized for 5 minutes each with out removtng lhe spacing wax . Ftg 9-15 After removal of the spacing wax. the interior surface of the hardened impression tray is cured for an addthonal 5 mtnulu Figs 9·16 and 9-17 Fintshad custom tray Sealed on tho cast. the principal occlusal stops
..
rest on the soft tissue. It is preferable to establish occlusal stops on the mucous areas of the palate or tn edentulous Sites. rather than on the surface of teeth. Fig g. 18 Internal surface of the custom tray after cleaning with rectified benz1nt and finishing the margins and borders. fig g-19 Mechanical retention groove for the impression material. Fig 9-20 Sheet of wax netting normally used in fabricallon of metallic frames for removable partial prostheses. Figs 9-21 and g-22 The wax net pattern increases microretenlion between elastomer tmpression materials and the resin material of the custom tray Elastomers have high cohesion and therefore adhere poorly to many surfaces Ftg g.23 High-magntftealion shows the close mechanical adaptation between an elastomer impresSion material and the reSin of the custom tray The liquid adhesive layer between the elastomer and resin increases adhesion Fig g-24 Polyelher-compallble adhesive The adhesive is applied with a brush to the internal surface of the custom tray to facilitate adheSion of the impression matenal lo the light-curing resin 211
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
• CHARACTER I STICS OF I M PRESSION
M ATER IALS FOR FIXED
• Flu i d ity and viscosity
does not alter their precision or accurate reproduc tion of the details. Many authors have recognized
polyvinyl siloxanes and polyesters have greater co· hesion than adhesion (ie, poor wetting), while hydro
the need to disi nfect impressions as a precaution to
Fluidity measures a material's capacity to insinuate
remove any pathogens that may have been present
itself into the minute spaces of an object and there
good wetting). This means that when polyvinyl silox
i n the oral cavity.•6·'' A number of scientific studies
by faithfully reproduce its smallest details. Fluidity is
anes and polyesters are used, the clinician should
The impression communicates all the parameters
have been performed to evaluate the effect of vari
a characteristic found primarily in detail materials,
add an adhesive to ensure that the material will
and details needed by the dental technician to cor
ous disinfectants on impression materials. In a sur
which are generally used directly in the dentogingi
adhere to the impression tray. Most manufacturers
RESTORATI O N S
colloids have greater adhesion than cohesion (ie,
rectly execute a fixed restoration. In practical terms,
vey of im pression disinfection in 400 US dental lab
val sulcus to reproduce the finish line and the intact
add substances to impression materials to reduce
the impression is a negative or inverse form of the
oratories, Kugel et al'8 found that only 44% of
tooth structure beyond. Conversely, support materi
surface tension. Wettability is affected by disinfec
prepared tooth. The impression must be a faithful
impressions were disinfected directly by clinicians.
als are classified according to their viscosity (high,
tion 2 1·30-3' but the effed is not clinically significant.
reproduction of the preparation and clinical situa
Of these, the modality was undocumented in 23%
medium, and low) and function to suppot and
tion, free from alterations, which are often imper
and the time of immersion was undocumented in
guide the low-viscosity detail materials. The viscos
ceptible and frequently caused by distortion of the
47°/o. The effects of the various disinfectant modali
ity of support materials is determined by placing 0.5
i mpression materials'0 (Figs 9-25 and 9-26).
Elastic me mory
ties on different impression materials are well docu
ml of the material on two flat plates (ISO 4823). Ten
Elastic memory refers to a material's capacity to
Some clinicians and dental technicians subscribe
mented.'9-2S Following disinfection, in solutions con
seconds after extrusion, the plates are subjected to
recover its original shape after it has
to the belief that impression materials are distotion
taining 2% glutaraldehyde (glyoxal glutaraldehyde,
1.5 N for 30 seconds. High- and very high-viscosity
deformed. The greater the degree of deformity, the
proof. The literature is illed with in vitro studies"-'3
phenol glutaraldehyde) or 5 - 25°/o sodium hypochlo
materials yield a diameter of less than 35 mm,
more time that should pass before pouring the
demonstrating that polyethers and especially poly
rite for periods ranging from 10 to 30 minutes,26 for
medium-viscosity materials yield a diameter of 31 to
stone impression. There is no codified system to
vinyl siloxanes are stable, provide accurate surface
example, impression materials generally maintain
41 mm, and low-viscosity materials yield a diameter
define the degree and type of impression deforma
details, and resist deformation. Without disputing
their clinical acceptability and the precision of the
of more than 36 mm.
tion or the period of time to wait for the material to
their validity, the authors believe such studies do
impression. However, Johnson et al27 evaluated the
Viscosity correlates with accuracy, resistance to
recover its original shape before pouring a stone
not take into account the diferent situations that
dimensions of various materials after disinfection
deformation, dimensional stability, and tear resis
cast. However, for materials that have a suitable
arise in clinical practice. In vivo, the elasticity limit
and found that irreversible hydrocolloids expanded
tance but is unfavorable for detail precision and
dimensional stability, manuadurers have empha
of impression materials is often exceeded,' thus
1.4 to 1.7 �m buccolingually, polyvinyl siloxanes ex
ease of handling.8 Hardness, commonly expressed in
sized precise minimum and maximum time periods
shore units, varies over time, increasing after 15
minutes, 1 hour, and 24 hours (see the section on
that must elapse before a cast is poured.'
16 �m.
polyethers later in this chapter). This property influ
deformation: that is, a material with minimal elastic
compromising the original dimensions.
Detail reproduction and disi nfection
panded 6 to 8 �m. and polyethers expanded 11 to For purposes of clinical evaluation, impression ma
ences dimensional stability.
terials are classified as either elastic or nonelastic.'8
The American Dental Association (ADA) defines a
Elastic materials include reversible hydrocolloid (agar);
material as precise when it can reproduce the form
i rreversible hydrocolloid (alginate); and synthetics
of a 20-�m triangular sulcus (method for the preci
such as polysulfide, condensation silicone, polyvinyl
sion verification according to DIN 13913)-4 (Figs 9-27
siloxanes, and polyether. Nonelastic materials include
been
Elastic memory is inversely related to permanent memoy will produce an impression with a signifi cant capacity for permanent deformation. To devel
Wetta bility
op completely, elastic memory of an i mpression
Wettability, or low surface tension, describes how a
proportion to the size of the undercuts (Fig 9-30).
material requires a length of time that is in dired
and 9-28). Elastomers are generally able to repro
plaster, thermoplastic pastes, zinc oxide-eugenol
material adapts to a contact surface. Wettability is
The elastic limit of elastomers is easily exceeded;
duce details the size of a few microns, and exact
pastes, and waxes. The requisite characteristics8 of
determined by the contact angle formed (theta)
even minimal tension or stress to the material while
reproduction of details requires a material to repro
an impression material can be evaluated on the
when a given quantity of paste is positioned on a
taking the impression (eg, using force to remove the
�m. and in some cases,
basis of fluidity and viscosity, wettability, elastic
surface with a film of water: the smaller the angle of
impression from undercuts) will prevent the materi
memory, thixotropy, dimensional stability, tear
contact, the better the material will adapt to the sur
al from returning to its original shape and condition.
To prevent the transmission of infection, impres
strength, hydrophilic behavior, thermal expansion,
ace to be impressed (Fig 9-29). The balance between
The ADA sets 2.5% as the limit of acceptability for
cohesion and adhesion is an impotant factor i n
permanent deformation'4 (Fig 9-31).
duce features as small as
2
even under 1 �m.•s sions must be disinfected using a treatment that
and application range.
.
.
determining a material's wettability. For example,
2
3
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
• CHARACTER I STICS OF I M PRESSION
M ATER IALS FOR FIXED
• Flu i d ity and viscosity
does not alter their precision or accurate reproduc tion of the details. Many authors have recognized
polyvinyl siloxanes and polyesters have greater co· hesion than adhesion (ie, poor wetting), while hydro
the need to disi nfect impressions as a precaution to
Fluidity measures a material's capacity to insinuate
remove any pathogens that may have been present
itself into the minute spaces of an object and there
good wetting). This means that when polyvinyl silox
i n the oral cavity.•6·'' A number of scientific studies
by faithfully reproduce its smallest details. Fluidity is
anes and polyesters are used, the clinician should
The impression communicates all the parameters
have been performed to evaluate the effect of vari
a characteristic found primarily in detail materials,
add an adhesive to ensure that the material will
and details needed by the dental technician to cor
ous disinfectants on impression materials. In a sur
which are generally used directly in the dentogingi
adhere to the impression tray. Most manufacturers
RESTORATI O N S
colloids have greater adhesion than cohesion (ie,
rectly execute a fixed restoration. In practical terms,
vey of im pression disinfection in 400 US dental lab
val sulcus to reproduce the finish line and the intact
add substances to impression materials to reduce
the impression is a negative or inverse form of the
oratories, Kugel et al'8 found that only 44% of
tooth structure beyond. Conversely, support materi
surface tension. Wettability is affected by disinfec
prepared tooth. The impression must be a faithful
impressions were disinfected directly by clinicians.
als are classified according to their viscosity (high,
tion 2 1·30-3' but the effed is not clinically significant.
reproduction of the preparation and clinical situa
Of these, the modality was undocumented in 23%
medium, and low) and function to suppot and
tion, free from alterations, which are often imper
and the time of immersion was undocumented in
guide the low-viscosity detail materials. The viscos
ceptible and frequently caused by distortion of the
47°/o. The effects of the various disinfectant modali
ity of support materials is determined by placing 0.5
i mpression materials'0 (Figs 9-25 and 9-26).
Elastic me mory
ties on different impression materials are well docu
ml of the material on two flat plates (ISO 4823). Ten
Elastic memory refers to a material's capacity to
Some clinicians and dental technicians subscribe
mented.'9-2S Following disinfection, in solutions con
seconds after extrusion, the plates are subjected to
recover its original shape after it has
to the belief that impression materials are distotion
taining 2% glutaraldehyde (glyoxal glutaraldehyde,
1.5 N for 30 seconds. High- and very high-viscosity
deformed. The greater the degree of deformity, the
proof. The literature is illed with in vitro studies"-'3
phenol glutaraldehyde) or 5 - 25°/o sodium hypochlo
materials yield a diameter of less than 35 mm,
more time that should pass before pouring the
demonstrating that polyethers and especially poly
rite for periods ranging from 10 to 30 minutes,26 for
medium-viscosity materials yield a diameter of 31 to
stone impression. There is no codified system to
vinyl siloxanes are stable, provide accurate surface
example, impression materials generally maintain
41 mm, and low-viscosity materials yield a diameter
define the degree and type of impression deforma
details, and resist deformation. Without disputing
their clinical acceptability and the precision of the
of more than 36 mm.
tion or the period of time to wait for the material to
their validity, the authors believe such studies do
impression. However, Johnson et al27 evaluated the
Viscosity correlates with accuracy, resistance to
recover its original shape before pouring a stone
not take into account the diferent situations that
dimensions of various materials after disinfection
deformation, dimensional stability, and tear resis
cast. However, for materials that have a suitable
arise in clinical practice. In vivo, the elasticity limit
and found that irreversible hydrocolloids expanded
tance but is unfavorable for detail precision and
dimensional stability, manuadurers have empha
of impression materials is often exceeded,' thus
1.4 to 1.7 �m buccolingually, polyvinyl siloxanes ex
ease of handling.8 Hardness, commonly expressed in
sized precise minimum and maximum time periods
shore units, varies over time, increasing after 15
minutes, 1 hour, and 24 hours (see the section on
that must elapse before a cast is poured.'
16 �m.
polyethers later in this chapter). This property influ
deformation: that is, a material with minimal elastic
compromising the original dimensions.
Detail reproduction and disi nfection
panded 6 to 8 �m. and polyethers expanded 11 to For purposes of clinical evaluation, impression ma
ences dimensional stability.
terials are classified as either elastic or nonelastic.'8
The American Dental Association (ADA) defines a
Elastic materials include reversible hydrocolloid (agar);
material as precise when it can reproduce the form
i rreversible hydrocolloid (alginate); and synthetics
of a 20-�m triangular sulcus (method for the preci
such as polysulfide, condensation silicone, polyvinyl
sion verification according to DIN 13913)-4 (Figs 9-27
siloxanes, and polyether. Nonelastic materials include
been
Elastic memory is inversely related to permanent memoy will produce an impression with a signifi cant capacity for permanent deformation. To devel
Wetta bility
op completely, elastic memory of an i mpression
Wettability, or low surface tension, describes how a
proportion to the size of the undercuts (Fig 9-30).
material requires a length of time that is in dired
and 9-28). Elastomers are generally able to repro
plaster, thermoplastic pastes, zinc oxide-eugenol
material adapts to a contact surface. Wettability is
The elastic limit of elastomers is easily exceeded;
duce details the size of a few microns, and exact
pastes, and waxes. The requisite characteristics8 of
determined by the contact angle formed (theta)
even minimal tension or stress to the material while
reproduction of details requires a material to repro
an impression material can be evaluated on the
when a given quantity of paste is positioned on a
taking the impression (eg, using force to remove the
�m. and in some cases,
basis of fluidity and viscosity, wettability, elastic
surface with a film of water: the smaller the angle of
impression from undercuts) will prevent the materi
memory, thixotropy, dimensional stability, tear
contact, the better the material will adapt to the sur
al from returning to its original shape and condition.
To prevent the transmission of infection, impres
strength, hydrophilic behavior, thermal expansion,
ace to be impressed (Fig 9-29). The balance between
The ADA sets 2.5% as the limit of acceptability for
cohesion and adhesion is an impotant factor i n
permanent deformation'4 (Fig 9-31).
duce features as small as
2
even under 1 �m.•s sions must be disinfected using a treatment that
and application range.
.
.
determining a material's wettability. For example,
2
3
CHAP1' I Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
a
b
c
� Deformation 2.5%
c 9-3 1
Figs 9-25 and 9-26 Comparison of a tooth preparation and its cast developed from an accurate impression. Clinicians are generally convinced that
an impression is a perfect copy of the prepared tooth. The impression material reproduces tooth preparations as accurately as possible, and stone or epoxy resin casts have many clinical characteristics of the originaL However. it is impossible to obtain two identical impressions of the same tooth. Fig 9-27 Polyether impression of a groove photographed at 50 x magnification. Fig 9-28 Impression of a preparation involving a gold inlay at 24 < . The external and internal bevels demonstrate the precision of detail reproduction of the impression materials. Fig g_2g Different angles of wettability for three polyethers with different viscosities, /let to righ) low. medium, and high. Fig 9-30 Silver-plated master
die showing a divergence between the buccal and palatal walls (total occlusal convergence (TOC] angle) that resulted from an error during preparation. Given the shape of the preparation. the restoration will be distorted because the elastic limit has been exceeded. Furthermore. because the anatomic shape of the canine has not been Ia ken 1nlo consideration in the design of this preparation. the dental technician wilt be unable to create a restoration that simulates the natural canine shape. Fig 9-31 Illustration of the 2.5% deformation accepted by the ADA. After intense stress lie. removal from the oral cavity). the impression material has difficulty returning to its original shape.
CHAP1' I Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
a
b
c
� Deformation 2.5%
c 9-3 1
Figs 9-25 and 9-26 Comparison of a tooth preparation and its cast developed from an accurate impression. Clinicians are generally convinced that
an impression is a perfect copy of the prepared tooth. The impression material reproduces tooth preparations as accurately as possible, and stone or epoxy resin casts have many clinical characteristics of the originaL However. it is impossible to obtain two identical impressions of the same tooth. Fig 9-27 Polyether impression of a groove photographed at 50 x magnification. Fig 9-28 Impression of a preparation involving a gold inlay at 24 < . The external and internal bevels demonstrate the precision of detail reproduction of the impression materials. Fig g_2g Different angles of wettability for three polyethers with different viscosities, /let to righ) low. medium, and high. Fig 9-30 Silver-plated master
die showing a divergence between the buccal and palatal walls (total occlusal convergence (TOC] angle) that resulted from an error during preparation. Given the shape of the preparation. the restoration will be distorted because the elastic limit has been exceeded. Furthermore. because the anatomic shape of the canine has not been Ia ken 1nlo consideration in the design of this preparation. the dental technician wilt be unable to create a restoration that simulates the natural canine shape. Fig 9-31 Illustration of the 2.5% deformation accepted by the ADA. After intense stress lie. removal from the oral cavity). the impression material has difficulty returning to its original shape.
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
.
. er the lear strength will be. However, flexibility also increases the capacity for a material to permanently
the greater likelihood of undercuts during tooth
for impression preservation, and especially the max
ment should be avoided because they provide less
deform (Fig 9-32). The material must be flexible
preparation and I he elasticity of the gingival tissue.
imum time limit for pouring an impression. However,
dimensional stability. Immediate investment com
enough to maintain its shape during removal and
the authors believe it is equally important that the
promises the elastic memory and leads to more fre
sufficiently viscose to accurately reproduce impres
clinician avoid pouring the stone impression too
quent internal distortions and deformations of the
sion details.
early. Waiting the necessary time before producing a
stone cast.
stone cast, even a few days, allows the elastic mem ory to develop fully.'B
Thixotropy
memory of the impression
Periodontal hemorrhage (which should
never
occur in this stage) also reduces tear strength. Blood compromises the impression material's polymeriza
An operator can detect a low degree of tear
tion since it fills up the space created for the impres sion material. Another aspect that can cause tears is
Stability continues to be an important focus of
strength by using a microscope (see chapter 2) with
research on impression materials'•: studies have
a good depth of field to look for any imperfections
sharp edges, especially of rough preparations (Figs
demonstrated the stability of impression materials
or alterations in the impression (Fig 9-33).
9-47 and 9-48).
in relation to the time elapsed before investing the
Stress from impression removal from undercuts
In clinical terms, tear strength depends mostly on
impression with stoneJ • or with respect to disinfec
can create a distortion wave in the impression and
the thickness of the material i n the area of the
Thixotropy refers to a material's capacity to become
tion techniques.'J Piwowarczyk et al3' studied six
alter the shape and dimensions of the preparation.
preparation and the finish line, as well as the type
more fluid when subjected to mechanical stimula
silicones and two polyethers, using in vitro tests
While some undercuts exist naturally in the mouth,
of preparation. According to some authors,8·34 the
tion, such as compression when an impression is
and a steel model. The dimensional stability among
during tooth preparation clinicians must not create
tear strength for impression materials can be classi
being taken. This property, which is common to
the i mpression materials ranged from 11 to 19 �m
additional undercuts that could afect the precision
fied in the following descending order: polysulfides,
polyethers and few other materials, manifests each
over a complete dental arch, demonstrating high
of the restoration (Figs 9-34 to 9-37). An impression
polyvinyl siloxanes, polyethers, and hydrocolloids.
of a perfect tooth preparation can therefore be com
time the low-viscosity detail materials placed along
precision. Stability often depends on such condi
the gingival sulcus are pressed by the high-viscosity
tions as the amount of cross bonding that occurs
promised by the presence of any undercuts in the
support materials during tray positioning. The
during the chemical reaction, loss of volatile com
dental arch.
mechanical compression of high-viscosity material
ponents (eg, alcohols) or water, and swelling due to
i ncreases the fluidity of low-viscosity material, which
water absorption.
Hydrophilic behavior
Because teeth naturally taper sharply at the
Hydrophilia is a material's capacity to absorb water
cementoenamel junction, the deepest undercuts can
and is attributed to the presence of free hydrogen
in turn flows more easily into thin cracks and areas
oten be found in the area apical to the finish line
bonds in the molecular chains. Hydrophilic materials
of the finish line and around the tooth structure
(Fig 9-38). The horizontal gingival retraction that
will absorb water, even i n the form of atmospheric
provides space for the impression material around
humidity after removal from the mouth. Water
beyond the finish line.
Tear strength Tear strength is a material's capacity to resist dam
the finish line must be kept to a minimum to avoid
absorption can deform the i mpression and alter the
age (above all, breakage) even in the presence of
complications. The result is a very thin impression in
volume dimensions. The clinician can only take im
undercuts when the impression is removed from the
the area subjected to highest stress (Figs 9-39 and
pressions with hydrophilic material in a d y environ
Dimensional stability refers to a material's capacity
mouth.JJ-JS Tear strength is influenced by flexibility
9-40). According to Albers,J6 o.s mm is adequate
ment area that is not subject to high temperatures.
to retain its shape over time and under any humid
(compression deformation) and viscosity (the con
horizontal gingival retraction for elastomers in gen
ity or temperature conditions within a tolerance of
sistency of the impression material); a delicate bal
0.2% (per ADA requirements).•• Investing the im
ance between these two properties is required for a
loids, given the properties of the impression materi
of water, for example, when in contact with a moist
material to manifest maximum tear strength.8
als. A material with a high degree of tear strength
surface, and depends on the presence of tensioac
D i m ensional stability
pression with stone immediately after it has been
6
preparations are more prone to tearing because of
material. Therefore,
impression materials that require immediate invest
To exploit the maximum effect of elastic memory, the clinician must be aware of the proper techniques
eral, while 1 mm is required for reversible hydrocol
Hydrophilic behavior, on the other hand, is a
material's capacity to be unafected by the presence
requires less gingival retraction than a material with
tive substances. Thus. a material with hydrophilic
a low degree of tear strength {Figs 9-41 to 9-46).
behavior can adhere to preparations while the
taken can compensate for the relatively low dimen
To overcome the stress of being removed from
sional stability of some impression materials or the
undercuts, an impression material must be highly
possibility of water absorption or secretion. How
flexible. Flexibility determines the amount of force
The placement of the inish line can influence the
ever, as noted earlier, immediate pouring of the
that is required to remove the impression from the
required amount of tear strength. lntracrevicular
stone cast prevents full development of the elastic
mouth: the greater the degree of flexibility, the high- .
impression sets, even if there are traces of moisture . .
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
.
. er the lear strength will be. However, flexibility also increases the capacity for a material to permanently
the greater likelihood of undercuts during tooth
for impression preservation, and especially the max
ment should be avoided because they provide less
deform (Fig 9-32). The material must be flexible
preparation and I he elasticity of the gingival tissue.
imum time limit for pouring an impression. However,
dimensional stability. Immediate investment com
enough to maintain its shape during removal and
the authors believe it is equally important that the
promises the elastic memory and leads to more fre
sufficiently viscose to accurately reproduce impres
clinician avoid pouring the stone impression too
quent internal distortions and deformations of the
sion details.
early. Waiting the necessary time before producing a
stone cast.
stone cast, even a few days, allows the elastic mem ory to develop fully.'B
Thixotropy
memory of the impression
Periodontal hemorrhage (which should
never
occur in this stage) also reduces tear strength. Blood compromises the impression material's polymeriza
An operator can detect a low degree of tear
tion since it fills up the space created for the impres sion material. Another aspect that can cause tears is
Stability continues to be an important focus of
strength by using a microscope (see chapter 2) with
research on impression materials'•: studies have
a good depth of field to look for any imperfections
sharp edges, especially of rough preparations (Figs
demonstrated the stability of impression materials
or alterations in the impression (Fig 9-33).
9-47 and 9-48).
in relation to the time elapsed before investing the
Stress from impression removal from undercuts
In clinical terms, tear strength depends mostly on
impression with stoneJ • or with respect to disinfec
can create a distortion wave in the impression and
the thickness of the material i n the area of the
Thixotropy refers to a material's capacity to become
tion techniques.'J Piwowarczyk et al3' studied six
alter the shape and dimensions of the preparation.
preparation and the finish line, as well as the type
more fluid when subjected to mechanical stimula
silicones and two polyethers, using in vitro tests
While some undercuts exist naturally in the mouth,
of preparation. According to some authors,8·34 the
tion, such as compression when an impression is
and a steel model. The dimensional stability among
during tooth preparation clinicians must not create
tear strength for impression materials can be classi
being taken. This property, which is common to
the i mpression materials ranged from 11 to 19 �m
additional undercuts that could afect the precision
fied in the following descending order: polysulfides,
polyethers and few other materials, manifests each
over a complete dental arch, demonstrating high
of the restoration (Figs 9-34 to 9-37). An impression
polyvinyl siloxanes, polyethers, and hydrocolloids.
of a perfect tooth preparation can therefore be com
time the low-viscosity detail materials placed along
precision. Stability often depends on such condi
the gingival sulcus are pressed by the high-viscosity
tions as the amount of cross bonding that occurs
promised by the presence of any undercuts in the
support materials during tray positioning. The
during the chemical reaction, loss of volatile com
dental arch.
mechanical compression of high-viscosity material
ponents (eg, alcohols) or water, and swelling due to
i ncreases the fluidity of low-viscosity material, which
water absorption.
Hydrophilic behavior
Because teeth naturally taper sharply at the
Hydrophilia is a material's capacity to absorb water
cementoenamel junction, the deepest undercuts can
and is attributed to the presence of free hydrogen
in turn flows more easily into thin cracks and areas
oten be found in the area apical to the finish line
bonds in the molecular chains. Hydrophilic materials
of the finish line and around the tooth structure
(Fig 9-38). The horizontal gingival retraction that
will absorb water, even i n the form of atmospheric
provides space for the impression material around
humidity after removal from the mouth. Water
beyond the finish line.
Tear strength Tear strength is a material's capacity to resist dam
the finish line must be kept to a minimum to avoid
absorption can deform the i mpression and alter the
age (above all, breakage) even in the presence of
complications. The result is a very thin impression in
volume dimensions. The clinician can only take im
undercuts when the impression is removed from the
the area subjected to highest stress (Figs 9-39 and
pressions with hydrophilic material in a d y environ
Dimensional stability refers to a material's capacity
mouth.JJ-JS Tear strength is influenced by flexibility
9-40). According to Albers,J6 o.s mm is adequate
ment area that is not subject to high temperatures.
to retain its shape over time and under any humid
(compression deformation) and viscosity (the con
horizontal gingival retraction for elastomers in gen
ity or temperature conditions within a tolerance of
sistency of the impression material); a delicate bal
0.2% (per ADA requirements).•• Investing the im
ance between these two properties is required for a
loids, given the properties of the impression materi
of water, for example, when in contact with a moist
material to manifest maximum tear strength.8
als. A material with a high degree of tear strength
surface, and depends on the presence of tensioac
D i m ensional stability
pression with stone immediately after it has been
6
preparations are more prone to tearing because of
material. Therefore,
impression materials that require immediate invest
To exploit the maximum effect of elastic memory, the clinician must be aware of the proper techniques
eral, while 1 mm is required for reversible hydrocol
Hydrophilic behavior, on the other hand, is a
material's capacity to be unafected by the presence
requires less gingival retraction than a material with
tive substances. Thus. a material with hydrophilic
a low degree of tear strength {Figs 9-41 to 9-46).
behavior can adhere to preparations while the
taken can compensate for the relatively low dimen
To overcome the stress of being removed from
sional stability of some impression materials or the
undercuts, an impression material must be highly
possibility of water absorption or secretion. How
flexible. Flexibility determines the amount of force
The placement of the inish line can influence the
ever, as noted earlier, immediate pouring of the
that is required to remove the impression from the
required amount of tear strength. lntracrevicular
stone cast prevents full development of the elastic
mouth: the greater the degree of flexibility, the high- .
impression sets, even if there are traces of moisture . .
Fig 9-32 Polyether impression of natural teeth (lmpregum Penta Soft HB and LB. 3M ESPEJ. The tear strength is primarily evident in the interproximal areas. which remain unchanged after removal from lhe mouth. F1g 9-33 lower degree of tear strength i n the buccal aspect of lhe Impression. The impression of the sulcus was damaged dunng removal from lhe oral cavity. The lack of detail of the intact tooth structure apical to the finish line will hamper the technician in interpreting the position and extension of the f1n1sh line. Figs g-4and g -35 Example of poorly executed tooth preparations. An impression has been taken and Invested to create a working cast on which four complete crowns can be made. The most troubling aspect is that the impression was sent to the lab even with serious defects (arrow} m the design and parallelism of the prepared Ieeth lnaccurams 1n lhe impression are manifest in the numerous stnpes caused by the tensile stress placed on the impresSIOn material. Though errors are both conceptual and opera Ilona!. the greatest fallacy lies in thinking that a dental technician can produce an accurate restoration from such an ImpresSIOn Figs 9-36 and 9-37 Magnified views of another case, the working cast and clin1cal situation. Note the undercuts caused by incorrect tooth preparation. w1th areas that are clearly inadequate in terms of thickness and finishing. Figs g -38 Clear and deta�led fin1sh line in the interproximal area. Fig g -3g Ev1dence of excessive ging1val retraction. Although this impression 1s correct. 11 is too thick at the cervical margin. Fig g-40 Evidence of minimal gingival deflection. The thin width and height of the intact tooth structure apical to the fmish line is typical of impressions taken using the single-cord lechn1que. A thin impres sion in this area can d1stort easily during pouring and preclude the creation of more lhan one casl. Figs 9-41 and g-42 Using a microscope. a dental technician reinforces the outside impression border of the intact tooth structure beyond the finish line with a thin line of inert wax. I n this instance. the thin width and height of the impression beyond the finish line facilitates th1s operation. Once the border has been reinforced. the impression can be used to pour several precision casts.
211
279
Fig 9-32 Polyether impression of natural teeth (lmpregum Penta Soft HB and LB. 3M ESPEJ. The tear strength is primarily evident in the interproximal areas. which remain unchanged after removal from lhe mouth. F1g 9-33 lower degree of tear strength i n the buccal aspect of lhe Impression. The impression of the sulcus was damaged dunng removal from lhe oral cavity. The lack of detail of the intact tooth structure apical to the finish line will hamper the technician in interpreting the position and extension of the f1n1sh line. Figs g-4and g -35 Example of poorly executed tooth preparations. An impression has been taken and Invested to create a working cast on which four complete crowns can be made. The most troubling aspect is that the impression was sent to the lab even with serious defects (arrow} m the design and parallelism of the prepared Ieeth lnaccurams 1n lhe impression are manifest in the numerous stnpes caused by the tensile stress placed on the impresSIOn material. Though errors are both conceptual and opera Ilona!. the greatest fallacy lies in thinking that a dental technician can produce an accurate restoration from such an ImpresSIOn Figs 9-36 and 9-37 Magnified views of another case, the working cast and clin1cal situation. Note the undercuts caused by incorrect tooth preparation. w1th areas that are clearly inadequate in terms of thickness and finishing. Figs g -38 Clear and deta�led fin1sh line in the interproximal area. Fig g -3g Ev1dence of excessive ging1val retraction. Although this impression 1s correct. 11 is too thick at the cervical margin. Fig g-40 Evidence of minimal gingival deflection. The thin width and height of the intact tooth structure apical to the fmish line is typical of impressions taken using the single-cord lechn1que. A thin impres sion in this area can d1stort easily during pouring and preclude the creation of more lhan one casl. Figs 9-41 and g-42 Using a microscope. a dental technician reinforces the outside impression border of the intact tooth structure beyond the finish line with a thin line of inert wax. I n this instance. the thin width and height of the impression beyond the finish line facilitates th1s operation. Once the border has been reinforced. the impression can be used to pour several precision casts.
211
279
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
. Thermal expansion
nents, base paste and catalyst, are measured out in a ratio recommended by the manufacturer using var
The ADA has determined that a coefficient of thermal
ious extrusion systems and placed on a suitable
expansion that is less than 2% is acceptable for
mixing surface. It is impossible for the operator to
impression materials.'• Shifts of 2o°C can affect this
mix the two components so that all of the material
coeficient, so clinicians must consider how and
is activated at the same time and thus i n the same
where impressions are stored. Purk et al37 found
stage of chemical reaction. During the plastic stage,
that at the upper and lower limits of extreme tem
the material is kneaded or mixed and, because the
peratures (66°C and -to0C) impression materials
chemical chains are still open, the material can be
experiences distortions, while Corso et al38 found no
gently seated in the mouth to take an impression. In
significant dimensional alterations for temperatures
the elastic stage, the chains are closed and the
ranging between 4°C and 40°C.
material is less malleable.
Evaluating a p p lication range
times of the impression materials and keep the two
9-43
9-4 4
The operator must know working and setting stages absolutely separate. An impression must be
Using impression materials with a versatile applica
taken shortly after mixing the material, because
tion range makes clinical procedures easier, reduces
once the chemical chains close, the i mpression
the number of materials used, and thus optimizes
material cannot correctly adapt and record shape
the material cost and yield (Figs 9-49 to 9-51).
and details of the patient's mouth. If a clinician tries
Evaluation of the application range includes a con
to take an impression with material already in the
sideration of the characteristics discussed so far and
elastic stage, it tends to return to its original shape
of the compatibility with various i nvestment materi
after being removed from the mouth.'
als (eg, stone, epoxy resins, polyurethane resins) or techniques (Figs 9-52 to 9-54).
For several years, equipment has been available to mechanically blend impression materials packaged
Each impression material is compatible with cer
in vacuum-packed cartridges. During extrusion, the
tain i nvestment materials used to pour the master
base paste and catalyst are blended in the proper
cast; for example, hydrocolloids are incompatible
quantities and for the correct amount of time.
with electroplating. Certain materials also are con
Mechanical mixing offers many conveniences,39 in
traindicated for intracrevicular preparations. Thus, in
cluding a faster mixing speed, use of less material,
choosing a material, it is important to assess the
less air incorporated into the mixture, exact mixing
range of application in order to limit the amount of
ratios, and the assurance that all of the impression
i nventory kept in storage and simplify the handling
material is in the same stage (Figs 9-55 to 9-57). The
procedures (eg, paste mixing, working times, expira
disadvantage, according to Keck,4° is that "materials
tion dates) of the impression materials.
mixed automatically have 4% less tear strength than those mixed manually."
M ixing i m pression materials
G
When selecting an impression material, the clini· cian must be aware of all properties and compati
Manual mixing of impression material has always
bilities. An impression material must ofer a high re
presented problems for operators. The two compo-
sistance to tearing and deformation, accurate three- ..
Figs g-43 and g-44 Wax reinforcement of the border makes the finish line more prominent on the plaster cast and fac i litates the difficult oper ation of trimming the cast. However. during structural evaluation with the ceramic in the bisque-bake stage. the clinician must take an elas tomeric impression to establish the correct relationship with the nonretracted gingiva (instead of the reflection typical of the impression stage). Figs g-45 and g-46 To avoid taking another impression. the wax can be removed easily and the relationship with the gingiva reproduced in a new cast. Figs 9-47 and 9-48 Excessive roughness of the tooth preparations. seen at the cervical margin and along the axial walls. can tear the impression by increasing the resistance required to release the impression material from the oral cavity. Both impressions. however. sat isfy basic clinical criteria.
11
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
. Thermal expansion
nents, base paste and catalyst, are measured out in a ratio recommended by the manufacturer using var
The ADA has determined that a coefficient of thermal
ious extrusion systems and placed on a suitable
expansion that is less than 2% is acceptable for
mixing surface. It is impossible for the operator to
impression materials.'• Shifts of 2o°C can affect this
mix the two components so that all of the material
coeficient, so clinicians must consider how and
is activated at the same time and thus i n the same
where impressions are stored. Purk et al37 found
stage of chemical reaction. During the plastic stage,
that at the upper and lower limits of extreme tem
the material is kneaded or mixed and, because the
peratures (66°C and -to0C) impression materials
chemical chains are still open, the material can be
experiences distortions, while Corso et al38 found no
gently seated in the mouth to take an impression. In
significant dimensional alterations for temperatures
the elastic stage, the chains are closed and the
ranging between 4°C and 40°C.
material is less malleable.
Evaluating a p p lication range
times of the impression materials and keep the two
9-43
9-4 4
The operator must know working and setting stages absolutely separate. An impression must be
Using impression materials with a versatile applica
taken shortly after mixing the material, because
tion range makes clinical procedures easier, reduces
once the chemical chains close, the i mpression
the number of materials used, and thus optimizes
material cannot correctly adapt and record shape
the material cost and yield (Figs 9-49 to 9-51).
and details of the patient's mouth. If a clinician tries
Evaluation of the application range includes a con
to take an impression with material already in the
sideration of the characteristics discussed so far and
elastic stage, it tends to return to its original shape
of the compatibility with various i nvestment materi
after being removed from the mouth.'
als (eg, stone, epoxy resins, polyurethane resins) or techniques (Figs 9-52 to 9-54).
For several years, equipment has been available to mechanically blend impression materials packaged
Each impression material is compatible with cer
in vacuum-packed cartridges. During extrusion, the
tain i nvestment materials used to pour the master
base paste and catalyst are blended in the proper
cast; for example, hydrocolloids are incompatible
quantities and for the correct amount of time.
with electroplating. Certain materials also are con
Mechanical mixing offers many conveniences,39 in
traindicated for intracrevicular preparations. Thus, in
cluding a faster mixing speed, use of less material,
choosing a material, it is important to assess the
less air incorporated into the mixture, exact mixing
range of application in order to limit the amount of
ratios, and the assurance that all of the impression
i nventory kept in storage and simplify the handling
material is in the same stage (Figs 9-55 to 9-57). The
procedures (eg, paste mixing, working times, expira
disadvantage, according to Keck,4° is that "materials
tion dates) of the impression materials.
mixed automatically have 4% less tear strength than those mixed manually."
M ixing i m pression materials
G
When selecting an impression material, the clini· cian must be aware of all properties and compati
Manual mixing of impression material has always
bilities. An impression material must ofer a high re
presented problems for operators. The two compo-
sistance to tearing and deformation, accurate three- ..
Figs g-43 and g-44 Wax reinforcement of the border makes the finish line more prominent on the plaster cast and fac i litates the difficult oper ation of trimming the cast. However. during structural evaluation with the ceramic in the bisque-bake stage. the clinician must take an elas tomeric impression to establish the correct relationship with the nonretracted gingiva (instead of the reflection typical of the impression stage). Figs g-45 and g-46 To avoid taking another impression. the wax can be removed easily and the relationship with the gingiva reproduced in a new cast. Figs 9-47 and 9-48 Excessive roughness of the tooth preparations. seen at the cervical margin and along the axial walls. can tear the impression by increasing the resistance required to release the impression material from the oral cavity. Both impressions. however. sat isfy basic clinical criteria.
11
I AG 9-56
FIG 9-55
C O R R E C T
B A S E - C A T A L Y S T
M I X I N G
R A T I 0
FIG 9-57
Figs 9-49 o 9-51 Versatile Impression materials can be used to take Impressions of various restorations. including inlays. indirect gold posts and cores. and complete crowns. In the management of a professional dental office. material versatility is a considerable advantage for stor age and handling F1gs 9-52 o 9-4 Impression materials must be compatible w1th the other matenals. such as electroplating silver. plaster. and polyurethane or epoxy reSin
2
Fig g.55 Pentamix II unit 13M ESPEI for mixing impression materials.
Fig g-56 Garant dispenser 13M ESPEI.
Fig 9-57 Impression material mixed using the Pentamix II.
23
I AG 9-56
FIG 9-55
C O R R E C T
B A S E - C A T A L Y S T
M I X I N G
R A T I 0
FIG 9-57
Figs 9-49 o 9-51 Versatile Impression materials can be used to take Impressions of various restorations. including inlays. indirect gold posts and cores. and complete crowns. In the management of a professional dental office. material versatility is a considerable advantage for stor age and handling F1gs 9-52 o 9-4 Impression materials must be compatible w1th the other matenals. such as electroplating silver. plaster. and polyurethane or epoxy reSin
2
Fig g.55 Pentamix II unit 13M ESPEI for mixing impression materials.
Fig g-56 Garant dispenser 13M ESPEI.
Fig 9-57 Impression material mixed using the Pentamix II.
23
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and I mpression Materials
. dimensional reproduction, and dimensional stability.
Reversible hydrocolloids are neither flexible nor
. on clothing. Pouring of the cast demands scrupulous
The ability to reproduce precise surface details is
viscous, and this lack of elastic memory and
attention because the material's high flexibility lends
necessary for an accurate restoration margin and
thixotropy is associated with fragility at the level of
itself to easy deformation, and the material contin·
Introduced in 1965, polyethers ofer several practical
depends largely on the luidity of the material. When
the gingival sulcus. As a result. the clinician will
ues to react even after removal from the mouth and
advantages, such as high dimensional stability and
an i mpression material has these characteristics, the
have difficulty identifying the cervical limits and will
ongoing reactions that produce alcohols.
likelihood of obtaining a suitable impression increases.
be forced to retract the gingiva more extensively
In the authors' view, polysufides are unsuitable
the cervical margins and no requirement for special
than is generally required with other elastomers.
for fixed and removable restorations because of
apparatus. I n addition, they have a good shelf life
Because they have the lowest tear strength,8 re·
their high rate of distortion, which is well masked by
(2 years) and may be poured up to
versible hydrocolloids are not recommended for
their flexibility. The impressions appear to be accu·
impression taking without any concern, allowing the
intracrevicular preparations, which are often called
rate but actually correspond little to the clinical sit·
impression to set completely for maximum elastic
for in patients who seek high-quality esthetics.
uation they are intended to reproduce.
memory.
Because of the need for immediate pouring, the
Today, polyethers are represented by an assort·
Reversible hydrocolloid materials, which irst appeared
material's elastic memoy, and hence its elastic
on the market in 1925, are made of marine algae
recovery, cannot be exploited. For these reasons,
Condensation silicones
ment of materials with varying degrees of viscosity
(agar). These materials were among the first to be
and especially given the considerable horizontal
used to make precision impressions in prosthodon tics, and they remain popular today because of their
TYPES O F I M PRESSION MATERIAL
Reversible hydrocolloi ds
tages related to their chemical composition: They tolerate slight humidity at the gingival sulcus, have
rapid solidification, along with excellent recording of
7
days after
and hardness, so that they are extremely versatile
The first elastomers, condensation silicones were
with a wide range of application in clinical practice.
retraction they require, the authors believe hydro·
introduced in 1955, 10 years before the first poly·
They are composed of a base paste made of poly
colloids are now obsolete for clinical use.
ethers became available. At the time, they were
ether imine-terminated prepolymer, i nert fillers,
relatively high degree of precision and low cost. Reversible hydrocolloids present unique advan·
Polyethers
Polysulfides Polysulfide materials became available in the 1950s,
widely accepted by dental professionals and contin·
emollients, pigments, and aromatic substances. The
ue to be used frequently in clinical practice. Con·
catalyst is composed of an ester derivative of aro·
densation silicones ofer the advantages of requiring
matic sulphonic acid, inert illers, emollients, and
no custom tray or other special equipment, provid
pigments. The additives and illers are essentially
a pleasant taste, and do not leave indelible marks.
principally as a precision impression for a complete
ing a good record of the cervical limits because of
inorganic and consist of strongly dispersed silica
In addition, a custom tray is not needed for taking
denture, and later extended to fixed prostheses.
their high tear strength, and exhibiting good elastic
and fossil flour, which are responsible for the mate
impressions. Besides these rheologic characteristics,
These materials have high tear strengthJ4 , J 5 owing
recovery and a reasonable degree of versatility, as
rials' increased final rigidity, dimensional stability
other advantages of these materials include a low
to their extraordinay, even excessive, flexibility,
well as a relatively low cost.
after removal from the mouth, and thixotropy.
cost per impression, a long shelf life, and the rela
which produces a highly detailed impression. They
Unfortunately, condensation silicones are hydro·
The d iferent consistencies found among poly·
tive ease of pouring with the investment materials.
provide apparently correct impressions that exhibit
phobic, and their use requires rigorous attention to
ethers, according to the ISO 4823 technical specii·
Reversible hydrocolloids also have some disad
good detail at the cervical limits, can be treated with
keep the gingival sulcus d y during impression tak·
cations, are shown i n Table 9-1. An analysis of the
vantages, including the need for an expensive piece
electroplating for casting, and have a long shelf life.
ing. Because they have inadequate dimensional sta·
table illustrates that the various consistencies of
of equipment for conditioning the materials (special
Unfortunately, excessive flexibility and insuficient
bility, the cast must be poured within 20 minutes,
polyethers determine their applications. For exam
water trays for boiling and cooling, and a humidor
hardness result in elevated marginal distortion,
and care must be taken to avoid deformation, which
ple, the high-viscosity polyethers are indicated for
for impression storage), and they pose a risk of
which renders polysulfide impressions unsuitable for
can occur easily.
scalding the patient i f handled improperly. Moreover,
making accurate restorations. Other disadvantages
The demand for these materials remains steady
als reproduce greater detail. Their wide variability and compatibility permit clinicians to use diferent
suppot functions, whereas the low-viscosity materi
because the materials have the capacity to absorb
include the need to make a custom tray to overcome
today primarily because they are frequently used in
water molecules while the impression is being
the most pronounced undercuts, a high degree of
the putty-wash technique, which involves making a
polyether materials according to the clinical situa·
taken, the cast must be poured immediately (within
sensitivity to heat, and a pronounced hydrophobia
double impression. In the authors' opinion, howev
tion and its requisites; the clinician can decide
a maximum time of 15 minutes') . Consequently,
that requires a completely dry gingival sulcus for
er, their dimensional instability makes them unsuit·
which material to use without compromising proper
electroplating techniques and epoxy resins cannot
impression taking. Furthermore, polysulfide materials
able for current clinical needs.
clinical procedure.
be used for casting.
have a disagreeable odor and leave indelible stains
�
�
5
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and I mpression Materials
. dimensional reproduction, and dimensional stability.
Reversible hydrocolloids are neither flexible nor
. on clothing. Pouring of the cast demands scrupulous
The ability to reproduce precise surface details is
viscous, and this lack of elastic memory and
attention because the material's high flexibility lends
necessary for an accurate restoration margin and
thixotropy is associated with fragility at the level of
itself to easy deformation, and the material contin·
Introduced in 1965, polyethers ofer several practical
depends largely on the luidity of the material. When
the gingival sulcus. As a result. the clinician will
ues to react even after removal from the mouth and
advantages, such as high dimensional stability and
an i mpression material has these characteristics, the
have difficulty identifying the cervical limits and will
ongoing reactions that produce alcohols.
likelihood of obtaining a suitable impression increases.
be forced to retract the gingiva more extensively
In the authors' view, polysufides are unsuitable
the cervical margins and no requirement for special
than is generally required with other elastomers.
for fixed and removable restorations because of
apparatus. I n addition, they have a good shelf life
Because they have the lowest tear strength,8 re·
their high rate of distortion, which is well masked by
(2 years) and may be poured up to
versible hydrocolloids are not recommended for
their flexibility. The impressions appear to be accu·
impression taking without any concern, allowing the
intracrevicular preparations, which are often called
rate but actually correspond little to the clinical sit·
impression to set completely for maximum elastic
for in patients who seek high-quality esthetics.
uation they are intended to reproduce.
memory.
Because of the need for immediate pouring, the
Today, polyethers are represented by an assort·
Reversible hydrocolloid materials, which irst appeared
material's elastic memoy, and hence its elastic
on the market in 1925, are made of marine algae
recovery, cannot be exploited. For these reasons,
Condensation silicones
ment of materials with varying degrees of viscosity
(agar). These materials were among the first to be
and especially given the considerable horizontal
used to make precision impressions in prosthodon tics, and they remain popular today because of their
TYPES O F I M PRESSION MATERIAL
Reversible hydrocolloi ds
tages related to their chemical composition: They tolerate slight humidity at the gingival sulcus, have
rapid solidification, along with excellent recording of
7
days after
and hardness, so that they are extremely versatile
The first elastomers, condensation silicones were
with a wide range of application in clinical practice.
retraction they require, the authors believe hydro·
introduced in 1955, 10 years before the first poly·
They are composed of a base paste made of poly
colloids are now obsolete for clinical use.
ethers became available. At the time, they were
ether imine-terminated prepolymer, i nert fillers,
relatively high degree of precision and low cost. Reversible hydrocolloids present unique advan·
Polyethers
Polysulfides Polysulfide materials became available in the 1950s,
widely accepted by dental professionals and contin·
emollients, pigments, and aromatic substances. The
ue to be used frequently in clinical practice. Con·
catalyst is composed of an ester derivative of aro·
densation silicones ofer the advantages of requiring
matic sulphonic acid, inert illers, emollients, and
no custom tray or other special equipment, provid
pigments. The additives and illers are essentially
a pleasant taste, and do not leave indelible marks.
principally as a precision impression for a complete
ing a good record of the cervical limits because of
inorganic and consist of strongly dispersed silica
In addition, a custom tray is not needed for taking
denture, and later extended to fixed prostheses.
their high tear strength, and exhibiting good elastic
and fossil flour, which are responsible for the mate
impressions. Besides these rheologic characteristics,
These materials have high tear strengthJ4 , J 5 owing
recovery and a reasonable degree of versatility, as
rials' increased final rigidity, dimensional stability
other advantages of these materials include a low
to their extraordinay, even excessive, flexibility,
well as a relatively low cost.
after removal from the mouth, and thixotropy.
cost per impression, a long shelf life, and the rela
which produces a highly detailed impression. They
Unfortunately, condensation silicones are hydro·
The d iferent consistencies found among poly·
tive ease of pouring with the investment materials.
provide apparently correct impressions that exhibit
phobic, and their use requires rigorous attention to
ethers, according to the ISO 4823 technical specii·
Reversible hydrocolloids also have some disad
good detail at the cervical limits, can be treated with
keep the gingival sulcus d y during impression tak·
cations, are shown i n Table 9-1. An analysis of the
vantages, including the need for an expensive piece
electroplating for casting, and have a long shelf life.
ing. Because they have inadequate dimensional sta·
table illustrates that the various consistencies of
of equipment for conditioning the materials (special
Unfortunately, excessive flexibility and insuficient
bility, the cast must be poured within 20 minutes,
polyethers determine their applications. For exam
water trays for boiling and cooling, and a humidor
hardness result in elevated marginal distortion,
and care must be taken to avoid deformation, which
ple, the high-viscosity polyethers are indicated for
for impression storage), and they pose a risk of
which renders polysulfide impressions unsuitable for
can occur easily.
scalding the patient i f handled improperly. Moreover,
making accurate restorations. Other disadvantages
The demand for these materials remains steady
als reproduce greater detail. Their wide variability and compatibility permit clinicians to use diferent
suppot functions, whereas the low-viscosity materi
because the materials have the capacity to absorb
include the need to make a custom tray to overcome
today primarily because they are frequently used in
water molecules while the impression is being
the most pronounced undercuts, a high degree of
the putty-wash technique, which involves making a
polyether materials according to the clinical situa·
taken, the cast must be poured immediately (within
sensitivity to heat, and a pronounced hydrophobia
double impression. In the authors' opinion, howev
tion and its requisites; the clinician can decide
a maximum time of 15 minutes') . Consequently,
that requires a completely dry gingival sulcus for
er, their dimensional instability makes them unsuit·
which material to use without compromising proper
electroplating techniques and epoxy resins cannot
impression taking. Furthermore, polysulfide materials
able for current clinical needs.
clinical procedure.
be used for casting.
have a disagreeable odor and leave indelible stains
�
�
5
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
.
Hardness. measured in shore units, is tested over
and, together with polyethers, are more precise,
time because it increases over time.•• Table 9-2
more stable, and thus by far the most frequently
demonstrates that the characteristics produced by
used material for impression
[
taking in clinical
different components, especially the fillers, can make
prosthodontics. Their primary advantage is versat ili·
a material more suitable for certain functions. For
ty: they can be used with many different techniques,
example, lmpregum Penta has very high rigidity after
including the double impression (putty-wash) tech·
TABLE 9-1 Consistencies of polyeth e rs_____________! __
Material
Consistency (mm)
--
40
Permadyne Light Body
Permadyne Heavy Body
33
lmpregum Penta
33
24 hours and is therefore ideal for taking a precision
nique and the one-step/one-. two-. or three-paste
lmpregum Penta Soft
35
impression for implant-supported prostheses.
techniques. In addition to excellent precision and
l m pregum DuoSot, light body
42
l mpregum DuoSoft, heavy body
32
The advantages that particularly distinguish poly
recording of marginal details, their other advantages
ethers are wettability. which makes them more com
include wettability, excellent elasticity, and pleasant
patible with diverse surfaces; thixotropy, which makes
odor and appearance. Polyvinyl siloxanes make it
the materials more nuid and increases their capacity
possible for several casts to be made from the same
to reproduce details; and good hydrophilic behavior,
impression, though only the first one will have the
which allows them to function optimally even in the
quality of a master cast (the subsequent i mpres
presence of slight humidity in the gingival sulcus.
sions will have lost the detail or the intact tooth
Among the disadvantages are the necessity to
structure beyond the finish line). Moreover, they do
make a custom impression tray, to which polyethers
not require special equipment, are easy to store,
adhere poorly, particularly when a specific adhesive is used incorrectly. High-viscosity polyethers (eg, lm· pregum Penta, Permadyne Heavy Body; 3M ESPE) are
TABLE 9-2 Hardness of polyether over time
Hardness (shore) Material
After 15 min
After
1
h
After 24 h
Permadyne Light Body
33
45
53
Permadyne Heavy Body
allow for electroplating, and are easy to mix into a
46
lmpregum Penta Soft
40
55 47
sa so
paste.
l m pregum Penta
46
55
6!
Among their drawbacks are difficulty in pouring,
quite rigid, especially with respect to removal from
high cost, and considerable hydrophobia, which
the mouth. Thus, to avoid complications such as frac
requires a completely dry gingival sulcus. Further·
tures of weak teeth or avulsion of teeth with little
more, the operator cannot wear latex gloves while
periodontal support, the undercuts must be careful
manipulating polyvinyl silxanes because the reticu
ly filled in with stone paste, provisional cement, or
lar reaction of the chain polymerization Is inhibited
materials with low consistency (eg, Permadyne Light
by latex.•'
.. I M PRESSION TECH N I QU ES
called regular, so that both hardness and viscosity may be obtained from one material.
Body or lmpregum DuoSoft light body; 3M. ESPE).
Polyvinyl siloxanes have been available since
Other negative aspects unrelated to clinical outcome
1975 in various consistencies and with various char
It is generally believed that various viscosities of
Clinicians distinguish between impression tech
are cost, indelible staining of clothing, and marked
acteristics, depending on their composition. In their
impression materials correspond to different quali
niques that involve the use of a single material and
sensitivity to ultraviolet light and excessive heat.
medium-, high-, and very-high-viscosity versions, they
ties and applications. All impression materials are
those that use two or more materials simultaneous
are used as support materials, while low-viscosity
classified either as a support material or a detail
ly. Among the various impression techniques are
material. Support materials must exhibit elevated
the one-step/one-paste technique, the one-step/two
hardness (greater than s o shore units) for stability
paste technique, the one-step/three-paste technique,
Polyvinyl siloxanes, also known as addition silicones,
and high viscosity (35 mm or less). Detail materials
and the two-step/two-paste technique.
are among the most recent generation of elastomers
must be highly nuid to reproduce minute details and
Polvinyl siloxanes
polyvinyl siloxanes are used to reproduce details.
..
therefore must have a low viscosity and a hardness value that is not excessive. To meet the varied needs
One-step/one- paste technique
of clinical operators, manufacturers have also intra·
T h e one-step/one-paste technique is t h e easiest and
duced materials with medium characteristics. often
perhaps the most common technique used for fixed ..
17
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
.
Hardness. measured in shore units, is tested over
and, together with polyethers, are more precise,
time because it increases over time.•• Table 9-2
more stable, and thus by far the most frequently
demonstrates that the characteristics produced by
used material for impression
[
taking in clinical
different components, especially the fillers, can make
prosthodontics. Their primary advantage is versat ili·
a material more suitable for certain functions. For
ty: they can be used with many different techniques,
example, lmpregum Penta has very high rigidity after
including the double impression (putty-wash) tech·
TABLE 9-1 Consistencies of polyeth e rs_____________! __
Material
Consistency (mm)
--
40
Permadyne Light Body
Permadyne Heavy Body
33
lmpregum Penta
33
24 hours and is therefore ideal for taking a precision
nique and the one-step/one-. two-. or three-paste
lmpregum Penta Soft
35
impression for implant-supported prostheses.
techniques. In addition to excellent precision and
l m pregum DuoSot, light body
42
l mpregum DuoSoft, heavy body
32
The advantages that particularly distinguish poly
recording of marginal details, their other advantages
ethers are wettability. which makes them more com
include wettability, excellent elasticity, and pleasant
patible with diverse surfaces; thixotropy, which makes
odor and appearance. Polyvinyl siloxanes make it
the materials more nuid and increases their capacity
possible for several casts to be made from the same
to reproduce details; and good hydrophilic behavior,
impression, though only the first one will have the
which allows them to function optimally even in the
quality of a master cast (the subsequent i mpres
presence of slight humidity in the gingival sulcus.
sions will have lost the detail or the intact tooth
Among the disadvantages are the necessity to
structure beyond the finish line). Moreover, they do
make a custom impression tray, to which polyethers
not require special equipment, are easy to store,
adhere poorly, particularly when a specific adhesive is used incorrectly. High-viscosity polyethers (eg, lm· pregum Penta, Permadyne Heavy Body; 3M ESPE) are
TABLE 9-2 Hardness of polyether over time
Hardness (shore) Material
After 15 min
After
1
h
After 24 h
Permadyne Light Body
33
45
53
Permadyne Heavy Body
allow for electroplating, and are easy to mix into a
46
lmpregum Penta Soft
40
55 47
sa so
paste.
l m pregum Penta
46
55
6!
Among their drawbacks are difficulty in pouring,
quite rigid, especially with respect to removal from
high cost, and considerable hydrophobia, which
the mouth. Thus, to avoid complications such as frac
requires a completely dry gingival sulcus. Further·
tures of weak teeth or avulsion of teeth with little
more, the operator cannot wear latex gloves while
periodontal support, the undercuts must be careful
manipulating polyvinyl silxanes because the reticu
ly filled in with stone paste, provisional cement, or
lar reaction of the chain polymerization Is inhibited
materials with low consistency (eg, Permadyne Light
by latex.•'
.. I M PRESSION TECH N I QU ES
called regular, so that both hardness and viscosity may be obtained from one material.
Body or lmpregum DuoSoft light body; 3M. ESPE).
Polyvinyl siloxanes have been available since
Other negative aspects unrelated to clinical outcome
1975 in various consistencies and with various char
It is generally believed that various viscosities of
Clinicians distinguish between impression tech
are cost, indelible staining of clothing, and marked
acteristics, depending on their composition. In their
impression materials correspond to different quali
niques that involve the use of a single material and
sensitivity to ultraviolet light and excessive heat.
medium-, high-, and very-high-viscosity versions, they
ties and applications. All impression materials are
those that use two or more materials simultaneous
are used as support materials, while low-viscosity
classified either as a support material or a detail
ly. Among the various impression techniques are
material. Support materials must exhibit elevated
the one-step/one-paste technique, the one-step/two
hardness (greater than s o shore units) for stability
paste technique, the one-step/three-paste technique,
Polyvinyl siloxanes, also known as addition silicones,
and high viscosity (35 mm or less). Detail materials
and the two-step/two-paste technique.
are among the most recent generation of elastomers
must be highly nuid to reproduce minute details and
Polvinyl siloxanes
polyvinyl siloxanes are used to reproduce details.
..
therefore must have a low viscosity and a hardness value that is not excessive. To meet the varied needs
One-step/one- paste technique
of clinical operators, manufacturers have also intra·
T h e one-step/one-paste technique is t h e easiest and
duced materials with medium characteristics. often
perhaps the most common technique used for fixed ..
17
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and I mpression Materials
. prostheses. Its popularity probably results from its
lure. Low-viscosity materials can be applied in min
simplicity; it uses a single material with one consis
imal amounts directly along the finish line. using a
tency at one time (Figs 9·58 to 9-60). Moreover, both
syringe equipped with tips suitable for optimal
functions required to obtain a precision impression
extrusion and adaptation. Manufacturer kits include
(ie. detail and support) are carried out using only
preformed tips with standard-diameter openings (Fig
one material of medium to high consistency (eg, reg
9·66). but these can be replaced by syringe tips with
ular for a polyvinyl siloxane. soft or hard for a poly
diferent angles and diameters (Fig 9-67).
ether). Unfortunately, while the support function can
When using the single-cord method of retraction.
be performed just as adequately with a medium- or
which is their preferred method. the authors choose
regular-viscosity material, the same cannot be said
a syringe tip with a very small opening that fits the
for the detail function, which is severely compro
minimal space available, both horizontally and ver
mised in the authors' opinion. This technique leads
tically (Fig 9-68). During extrusion, they use adapt·
to difficulty in reproducing adequate detail of the
able tips for reaching the palatal and lingual sur
finish line preparation without extensive displace
faces of the teeth. With suitably curved tips, the
ment of soft tissue. and thus the cervical margins
operator can ensure that the impression material
are not always clear and precise.
contacts the critical areas to be reproduced in the
The authors firmly prefer the other techniques
impression. Tips produced by Anthogyr or Centrix
over this one because they allow for the use of
permit the operator to modiy the diameter and
materials of diferent consistencies for each function
angle of curvature without creating undesirable bot
(detail or support) i n the same plastic phase. The
tlenecks in the extrusion channel. Tips that can be
clinician never allows one of the materials to hard
adapted to suit the clinical case and the operator's
en before the other (Figs 9-61 to 9·65).
working position allow easy application in areas where access is otherwise difficult (Figs 9-69 and 9-70).
One-step/two- or three-paste tech nique
Variations in the technique should be based on the periodontal biotype and the number of missing teeth. In cases where the periodontal tissue is thin
Impression materials are classified in terms of nuid
and retraction is thus carefully kept to a minimum,
ity and viscosity, and the latter perform better in
the authors avoid using materials with a high vis
reproducing detail. The smallest details are general·
cosity in the custom tray, opting instead for a regu-
ly those around the inish line, delineating between
lar polyether material (eg, lmpregum Penta Soft) to
the tooth preparation from the i ntact tooth struc·
reduce the occlusal force at the gingival sulcus, even
Figs 9-58 and 9-59 One-step/one- paste technique. The technique uses a medium- or high-viscosity material placed in an impression tray. When using a high-viscosity material. the only way to obtain a good impression of the intact tooth structure beyond the finish line is to perform an extensive horizontal retraction of the gingiva. which is not recommended. Fig g -60 Good clinical result using a medium-viscosity material. which requires less horizontal retraction of the gingiva. Fig g-61 One-step/two-paste impression technique. The clinician uses high- and low-viscosity polyethers. simultaneously. by applying the first (light body. low viscosity! in the sulcus and the second (heavy body. high viscosity) in the tray. in the same plastic state. Figs 9-62 o 9-4 One-step/two-paste impressions. illustrating the parameters for a precision impression.
Fig 9-65 Polyvinyl siloxane impression (President. Coltine/Whaledentl using the one-step/two-paste technique.
�
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and I mpression Materials
. prostheses. Its popularity probably results from its
lure. Low-viscosity materials can be applied in min
simplicity; it uses a single material with one consis
imal amounts directly along the finish line. using a
tency at one time (Figs 9·58 to 9-60). Moreover, both
syringe equipped with tips suitable for optimal
functions required to obtain a precision impression
extrusion and adaptation. Manufacturer kits include
(ie. detail and support) are carried out using only
preformed tips with standard-diameter openings (Fig
one material of medium to high consistency (eg, reg
9·66). but these can be replaced by syringe tips with
ular for a polyvinyl siloxane. soft or hard for a poly
diferent angles and diameters (Fig 9-67).
ether). Unfortunately, while the support function can
When using the single-cord method of retraction.
be performed just as adequately with a medium- or
which is their preferred method. the authors choose
regular-viscosity material, the same cannot be said
a syringe tip with a very small opening that fits the
for the detail function, which is severely compro
minimal space available, both horizontally and ver
mised in the authors' opinion. This technique leads
tically (Fig 9-68). During extrusion, they use adapt·
to difficulty in reproducing adequate detail of the
able tips for reaching the palatal and lingual sur
finish line preparation without extensive displace
faces of the teeth. With suitably curved tips, the
ment of soft tissue. and thus the cervical margins
operator can ensure that the impression material
are not always clear and precise.
contacts the critical areas to be reproduced in the
The authors firmly prefer the other techniques
impression. Tips produced by Anthogyr or Centrix
over this one because they allow for the use of
permit the operator to modiy the diameter and
materials of diferent consistencies for each function
angle of curvature without creating undesirable bot
(detail or support) i n the same plastic phase. The
tlenecks in the extrusion channel. Tips that can be
clinician never allows one of the materials to hard
adapted to suit the clinical case and the operator's
en before the other (Figs 9-61 to 9·65).
working position allow easy application in areas where access is otherwise difficult (Figs 9-69 and 9-70).
One-step/two- or three-paste tech nique
Variations in the technique should be based on the periodontal biotype and the number of missing teeth. In cases where the periodontal tissue is thin
Impression materials are classified in terms of nuid
and retraction is thus carefully kept to a minimum,
ity and viscosity, and the latter perform better in
the authors avoid using materials with a high vis
reproducing detail. The smallest details are general·
cosity in the custom tray, opting instead for a regu-
ly those around the inish line, delineating between
lar polyether material (eg, lmpregum Penta Soft) to
the tooth preparation from the i ntact tooth struc·
reduce the occlusal force at the gingival sulcus, even
Figs 9-58 and 9-59 One-step/one- paste technique. The technique uses a medium- or high-viscosity material placed in an impression tray. When using a high-viscosity material. the only way to obtain a good impression of the intact tooth structure beyond the finish line is to perform an extensive horizontal retraction of the gingiva. which is not recommended. Fig g -60 Good clinical result using a medium-viscosity material. which requires less horizontal retraction of the gingiva. Fig g-61 One-step/two-paste impression technique. The clinician uses high- and low-viscosity polyethers. simultaneously. by applying the first (light body. low viscosity! in the sulcus and the second (heavy body. high viscosity) in the tray. in the same plastic state. Figs 9-62 o 9-4 One-step/two-paste impressions. illustrating the parameters for a precision impression.
Fig 9-65 Polyvinyl siloxane impression (President. Coltine/Whaledentl using the one-step/two-paste technique.
�
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
FIG 9-66
C O R R E C T
FIG 9-69
FIG 9-67
R E L AT I O N
D I M E N S I O N S
A N D
A M O N G
H O R I Z O NTA L
T H E
FIG 9-70
T I P ' S
D E F L E C T I O N Fig g-66 Syringe and tip used to extrude low- and medium-viscosity materials. Fig g-67 Comparison of lip included with the Pentamix I I unit (top) and Anthogyr tip (bottom). The smaller-diameter opening of the Anthogyr tip corresponds more readily to the space of the sulcus. Figs g-68 and g_6g Different tips can be used. and the shape of the opening can be altered. Fig g-70 Tip curves also can be customized by the operator to facilitate access i n operating areas.
FIG 9-68
HI
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
FIG 9-66
C O R R E C T
FIG 9-69
FIG 9-67
R E L AT I O N
D I M E N S I O N S
A N D
A M O N G
H O R I Z O NTA L
T H E
FIG 9-70
T I P ' S
D E F L E C T I O N Fig g-66 Syringe and tip used to extrude low- and medium-viscosity materials. Fig g-67 Comparison of lip included with the Pentamix I I unit (top) and Anthogyr tip (bottom). The smaller-diameter opening of the Anthogyr tip corresponds more readily to the space of the sulcus. Figs g-68 and g_6g Different tips can be used. and the shape of the opening can be altered. Fig g-70 Tip curves also can be customized by the operator to facilitate access i n operating areas.
FIG 9-68
HI
CHAPTER 9 Custom Impression Trays and Impression Materials
. in the presence of several teeth and extensive pros theses (Fig 9-71).
.
material used'-that is, sections of thicker material contract more than sections with thinner material.
thickness is suitable for the detail reproduction of a light-bodied material. Nissan et al46 conducted a
I n complex treatments involving numerous eden
Phillips3 underscores the necessity of using less
precision impression, free of distortion from con·
study using 45 impressions made from a steel cast
tulous areas, the authors use a high-viscosity mate·
material by advocating the putty-wash technique,
traction. However, impressions made with this tech
and roughening the putty for thicknesses of
rial (lmpregum Penta) as a support material along
which i nvolves taking an i mpression in two stages,
nique, while very accurate in reproducing detail, are
and 3 mm. Their findings indicate that a thickness
with a low-viscosity material (Permadyne Light Body)
separately applying two materials of different vis
often distorted (Fig 9-78).
in a syringe (Figs 9-72 and 9-73). However, if a thin
cosity.4J .44
When studied through in vitro tests under con
t,
2,
of 3 mm is to be avoided because the resulting plas ter casts differed significantly from the original.
The principle of contraction gave rise to methods
trolled conditions and on steel casts or casts de·
However, the ideal thickness of 2 m m or less poses
use the three-paste technique, involving the appli
that use highly viscous putty as a support material.
signed for repeated insertion and removal, the im
a significant obstacle to correct reinsertion without
cation of a medium-viscosity material over the detail
Once the putty hardens, it works as a support for a
pressions are rated as comparable to or better than
inadvertently touching the putty.
material (lmpregum Penta Soft) using a syringe. This
low-viscosity or light relining material. In this tech
those obtained with a single-step technique.44-4S
On the interior surface, where only the color of
method reduces the pressure from the high-viscosi
nique, a preliminary impression is taken of the
Reinsertion, however, is a key problem in this pro
the light-bodied material should be visible, the ap
ty material and improves the tear strength of the
entire arch using a putty material with a high degree
cedure because it is difficult to recenter and refit the
pearance of a putty color in several areas indicates
low-viscosity material. In cases where the periodon
of hardness. After the hardened putty is removed
impression tray perfectly, avoiding contact with the
the impression's contact with a material already in
tal tissues are thick, adequate gingival reflection
from the mouth, the impression is roughened with
hardened putty in order to create a final impression
the elastic, and not plastic, stage. This anomalous
may be accomplished without hesitation, and high
large laboratory burs or scalpels, then relined with a
whose interior surface is entirely identical in color to
contact with hardened putty, which is thus unable to
viscosity materials can be used for support after fol
low-viscosity impression material. The roughening
the low-viscosity material (Figs 9-79 to 9-82). Only
adapt to any shape, generates a distortion wave
lowing the application of low-viscosity materials to
stage focuses on the interproximal areas, removing
when the impression is free of direct tooth contact
that originates from a point not necessarily involved
record the sulcus.
the septa and the midline of the teeth. By minimiz
with the putty is it truly accurate, but all too often
in the prosthetic treatment, resulting in an impres sion with serious defects. For this reason, the authors prefer techniques in which the materials are in the
biotype is a consideration as well, the clinician can
ing the space for the low-viscosity materiai,4S the
this technique yields inaccurate and distorted
viscosity material is used to reproduce detail and
clinician reduces the amount of contraction, at least
impressions.
the paste used i n the tray, regardless of viscosity,
in theorya At this point, the clinician reseats the
A clinical technique for avoiding tooth-putty con
is used for support.
i mpression tray, which has been relined with low
tact on reinsetion involves roughing out the interi
viscosity material. The first impression works like a
or as much as possible while ensuring that the
In summary, for all possible combinations low
Two-step/two-paste technique ( putty wash)
custom tray; it leaves minimal space for the filling material, but is highly precise, and functions to sup port the light material as it reproduces details of the
During polymerization and hardening, impression ma terials shrink in direct proportion to the quantity of
2
In theory this technique is appealing, and conceptually it provides a method for obtaining a high
finish line (Figs 9-74 to 9-77).
_
same physical state (plastic), such as the one-step/ two-paste technique.
..
CHAPTER 9 Custom Impression Trays and Impression Materials
. in the presence of several teeth and extensive pros theses (Fig 9-71).
.
material used'-that is, sections of thicker material contract more than sections with thinner material.
thickness is suitable for the detail reproduction of a light-bodied material. Nissan et al46 conducted a
I n complex treatments involving numerous eden
Phillips3 underscores the necessity of using less
precision impression, free of distortion from con·
study using 45 impressions made from a steel cast
tulous areas, the authors use a high-viscosity mate·
material by advocating the putty-wash technique,
traction. However, impressions made with this tech
and roughening the putty for thicknesses of
rial (lmpregum Penta) as a support material along
which i nvolves taking an i mpression in two stages,
nique, while very accurate in reproducing detail, are
and 3 mm. Their findings indicate that a thickness
with a low-viscosity material (Permadyne Light Body)
separately applying two materials of different vis
often distorted (Fig 9-78).
in a syringe (Figs 9-72 and 9-73). However, if a thin
cosity.4J .44
When studied through in vitro tests under con
t,
2,
of 3 mm is to be avoided because the resulting plas ter casts differed significantly from the original.
The principle of contraction gave rise to methods
trolled conditions and on steel casts or casts de·
However, the ideal thickness of 2 m m or less poses
use the three-paste technique, involving the appli
that use highly viscous putty as a support material.
signed for repeated insertion and removal, the im
a significant obstacle to correct reinsertion without
cation of a medium-viscosity material over the detail
Once the putty hardens, it works as a support for a
pressions are rated as comparable to or better than
inadvertently touching the putty.
material (lmpregum Penta Soft) using a syringe. This
low-viscosity or light relining material. In this tech
those obtained with a single-step technique.44-4S
On the interior surface, where only the color of
method reduces the pressure from the high-viscosi
nique, a preliminary impression is taken of the
Reinsertion, however, is a key problem in this pro
the light-bodied material should be visible, the ap
ty material and improves the tear strength of the
entire arch using a putty material with a high degree
cedure because it is difficult to recenter and refit the
pearance of a putty color in several areas indicates
low-viscosity material. In cases where the periodon
of hardness. After the hardened putty is removed
impression tray perfectly, avoiding contact with the
the impression's contact with a material already in
tal tissues are thick, adequate gingival reflection
from the mouth, the impression is roughened with
hardened putty in order to create a final impression
the elastic, and not plastic, stage. This anomalous
may be accomplished without hesitation, and high
large laboratory burs or scalpels, then relined with a
whose interior surface is entirely identical in color to
contact with hardened putty, which is thus unable to
viscosity materials can be used for support after fol
low-viscosity impression material. The roughening
the low-viscosity material (Figs 9-79 to 9-82). Only
adapt to any shape, generates a distortion wave
lowing the application of low-viscosity materials to
stage focuses on the interproximal areas, removing
when the impression is free of direct tooth contact
that originates from a point not necessarily involved
record the sulcus.
the septa and the midline of the teeth. By minimiz
with the putty is it truly accurate, but all too often
in the prosthetic treatment, resulting in an impres sion with serious defects. For this reason, the authors prefer techniques in which the materials are in the
biotype is a consideration as well, the clinician can
ing the space for the low-viscosity materiai,4S the
this technique yields inaccurate and distorted
viscosity material is used to reproduce detail and
clinician reduces the amount of contraction, at least
impressions.
the paste used i n the tray, regardless of viscosity,
in theorya At this point, the clinician reseats the
A clinical technique for avoiding tooth-putty con
is used for support.
i mpression tray, which has been relined with low
tact on reinsetion involves roughing out the interi
viscosity material. The first impression works like a
or as much as possible while ensuring that the
In summary, for all possible combinations low
Two-step/two-paste technique ( putty wash)
custom tray; it leaves minimal space for the filling material, but is highly precise, and functions to sup port the light material as it reproduces details of the
During polymerization and hardening, impression ma terials shrink in direct proportion to the quantity of
2
In theory this technique is appealing, and conceptually it provides a method for obtaining a high
finish line (Figs 9-74 to 9-77).
_
same physical state (plastic), such as the one-step/ two-paste technique.
..
9-BO
9-8 2
Fig g-71 1mpression o_f a maxilla 'y restoration using medium-viscosity polyether support material and low-viscosity polyether detail materi . al. The thon ompressoon of the on tact tooth structure beyond the finish line is a common feature of thin periodontal biotypes. Figs g -12 and 9-73 1mpression made with a medium-viscosity support material and a low-viscosity detail material for a complex restoration. The finish line is cle � rly visible _aro_und the circumferenc_e of each toot � . Fig 9-7� Irreversible hydrocolloid impression of a healthy dentition. An area of com pressoon _ on the oncosal edge of the maxollary central onCISors (due to excessive pressure during insertion and application in the mouth) resulted on contact between the metalloc tray and the oncosal edge. Fig g -75 The impression for this cast appeared accurate to the naked eye. but once it was invested with plaster the incisal defect became evident. Figs 9-76 and 9-77 Comparison of healthy dentition and the working cast developed from the faulty impression. Severe deformation caused by an area of compression occurs when an impression is taken with a rigid support (custom tray or prehardened putty) and contact is erroneously made between the support and the tooth to be restored.
Fig g-78 Impression made using the putty-wash technique. The presence of the yellow putty. which had already hardened at the time of rein sertion with the green impression material. clearly indicates areas of compression. Therefore. when two colors are seen. the effect is similar to a metal tray coming into contact with an incisal edge. Distortion is usually masked by the elasticity of the silicone. but it is nevertheless present and can resull in a restoration wilh undesired friction and poor marginal fit. Fig 9-79 Sagittal cross section of a cast impression. Properly centering an impression tray is difficult when the materials are in the same plastic state: it is even more difficult with the thinly _ spread relonong materoal of the putty-wash technoque. Fog 9-80 In reducong the forst putty ompressoon. too much material was removed. lead ing to an excess of _low-viscosity reliner. Figs g -81 and g -82 Cross se � tions of two different teeth from the same impression. Medium-intensity g putty compressoon IS evodent on Fog - 8 1 . but severe compressoon IS evodent on the premolar preparatoon of Fig 9-82. A longitudinal cross section permits the evaluation of the common distortions and alterations of the different impression materials and techniques.
9-BO
9-8 2
Fig g-71 1mpression o_f a maxilla 'y restoration using medium-viscosity polyether support material and low-viscosity polyether detail materi . al. The thon ompressoon of the on tact tooth structure beyond the finish line is a common feature of thin periodontal biotypes. Figs g -12 and 9-73 1mpression made with a medium-viscosity support material and a low-viscosity detail material for a complex restoration. The finish line is cle � rly visible _aro_und the circumferenc_e of each toot � . Fig 9-7� Irreversible hydrocolloid impression of a healthy dentition. An area of com pressoon _ on the oncosal edge of the maxollary central onCISors (due to excessive pressure during insertion and application in the mouth) resulted on contact between the metalloc tray and the oncosal edge. Fig g -75 The impression for this cast appeared accurate to the naked eye. but once it was invested with plaster the incisal defect became evident. Figs 9-76 and 9-77 Comparison of healthy dentition and the working cast developed from the faulty impression. Severe deformation caused by an area of compression occurs when an impression is taken with a rigid support (custom tray or prehardened putty) and contact is erroneously made between the support and the tooth to be restored.
Fig g-78 Impression made using the putty-wash technique. The presence of the yellow putty. which had already hardened at the time of rein sertion with the green impression material. clearly indicates areas of compression. Therefore. when two colors are seen. the effect is similar to a metal tray coming into contact with an incisal edge. Distortion is usually masked by the elasticity of the silicone. but it is nevertheless present and can resull in a restoration wilh undesired friction and poor marginal fit. Fig 9-79 Sagittal cross section of a cast impression. Properly centering an impression tray is difficult when the materials are in the same plastic state: it is even more difficult with the thinly _ spread relonong materoal of the putty-wash technoque. Fog 9-80 In reducong the forst putty ompressoon. too much material was removed. lead ing to an excess of _low-viscosity reliner. Figs g -81 and g -82 Cross se � tions of two different teeth from the same impression. Medium-intensity g putty compressoon IS evodent on Fog - 8 1 . but severe compressoon IS evodent on the premolar preparatoon of Fig 9-82. A longitudinal cross section permits the evaluation of the common distortions and alterations of the different impression materials and techniques.
CHAPTER 9 Custom Impression Trays and Impression Materials
CAUSES
I rregular material in the fin ish line area
Failures that occur while taking an impression are
•
. FAI LU R ES A N D T H E I R P R I N C I PAL
B ETTER R E S U LTS U S I N G MATE R I A L S I N SA M E P H YS I CA L STATE
Lack of polymerization resulting from the pres
caused by factors related to human error-either
ence of blood or incompatible hemostatic or
aulty operational decision making or inadequate eval
astringent substances (Fig 9-90)
uation of objectives. In addition, complications unan ticipated by tests performed under in vitro conditions may arise in clinical situations that are far from ideal.
Rough or powdery plaster cast •
Rough and irregular i m pression surface •
Incomplete polymerization resulting from premature removal from the mouth, incorrect ratios or incorrect mixing of the components, or the presence of oily
• •
Excess tensioactive substance let on the impression
•
Incorrect manipulation of the plaster
•
Rapid polymerization resulting from excessive
Distortion •
•
Catalyst-base ratio too high for condensation sil icones
•
of the tray after adhesive application, or use of
ing substances not daubed with alcohol or from
an unsuitable adhesive
non polymerization of the resin composite due to
•
Air bubbles Excessively rapid polymerization impeding the
• •
•
Incorrect filling of the tray (Figs 9-83 and 9-84)
•
fi
Excessive or insuficient space created for the low Continuous pressure on an impression material
•
Movement of the tray during the polymerization stage
I rregular-shaped holes •
Use of excessive amount of material
that has already developed elastic properties
mixing process •
Elastic properties of the impression material devel oped before insertion of the tray'
viscosity material during the putty-wash technique
low of the material Incorporation of air in the mechanical or manual
Loss of mechanical retention for the materials un afected by the adhesive
•
•
Poor adhesion of the elastomer to the tray caused by an insufficient adhesive layer, premature filling
Surface interference from polyethers with bond
lack of oxygen
•
Resin impression tray inadequately hardened and still subject to polymerization contraction
humidity or high temperatures •
Premature investment of the i mpression before
During mechanical mixing, the two components (base paste and catalyst) were not added simul taneously
•
Premature removal of the cast
the minimum time elapsed
substances or organic material on the teeth •
Inadequate cleaning of the impression Excess water left on the surface of the impression
Moisture or detritus on the surface of the teeth
•
Delay in casting from polysulfide or condensation
•
Premature removal from the mouth or removal
Fig 9-83 Small air bubble near the cervical margin. Air bubbles cannot always be prevented. but because it is outside of tho restoration area. this one will not influence the subsequent procedures or compromise the impression. Fig 9-4 Small bubble on the surface of the tooth due to a tooth preparation defect. When the cast is poured. the tooth preparation will have an air bubble. which tho technician can eliminate easily without jeopardizing the restoration.
silicone impressions
Poor adaptation of the material to the surface of
with improper movement (eg, removal from only
the tooth (Figs 9-85 to 9-89)
one side) (Figs 9-91 to 9-93)
. f7
CHAPTER 9 Custom Impression Trays and Impression Materials
CAUSES
I rregular material in the fin ish line area
Failures that occur while taking an impression are
•
. FAI LU R ES A N D T H E I R P R I N C I PAL
B ETTER R E S U LTS U S I N G MATE R I A L S I N SA M E P H YS I CA L STATE
Lack of polymerization resulting from the pres
caused by factors related to human error-either
ence of blood or incompatible hemostatic or
aulty operational decision making or inadequate eval
astringent substances (Fig 9-90)
uation of objectives. In addition, complications unan ticipated by tests performed under in vitro conditions may arise in clinical situations that are far from ideal.
Rough or powdery plaster cast •
Rough and irregular i m pression surface •
Incomplete polymerization resulting from premature removal from the mouth, incorrect ratios or incorrect mixing of the components, or the presence of oily
• •
Excess tensioactive substance let on the impression
•
Incorrect manipulation of the plaster
•
Rapid polymerization resulting from excessive
Distortion •
•
Catalyst-base ratio too high for condensation sil icones
•
of the tray after adhesive application, or use of
ing substances not daubed with alcohol or from
an unsuitable adhesive
non polymerization of the resin composite due to
•
Air bubbles Excessively rapid polymerization impeding the
• •
•
Incorrect filling of the tray (Figs 9-83 and 9-84)
•
fi
Excessive or insuficient space created for the low Continuous pressure on an impression material
•
Movement of the tray during the polymerization stage
I rregular-shaped holes •
Use of excessive amount of material
that has already developed elastic properties
mixing process •
Elastic properties of the impression material devel oped before insertion of the tray'
viscosity material during the putty-wash technique
low of the material Incorporation of air in the mechanical or manual
Loss of mechanical retention for the materials un afected by the adhesive
•
•
Poor adhesion of the elastomer to the tray caused by an insufficient adhesive layer, premature filling
Surface interference from polyethers with bond
lack of oxygen
•
Resin impression tray inadequately hardened and still subject to polymerization contraction
humidity or high temperatures •
Premature investment of the i mpression before
During mechanical mixing, the two components (base paste and catalyst) were not added simul taneously
•
Premature removal of the cast
the minimum time elapsed
substances or organic material on the teeth •
Inadequate cleaning of the impression Excess water left on the surface of the impression
Moisture or detritus on the surface of the teeth
•
Delay in casting from polysulfide or condensation
•
Premature removal from the mouth or removal
Fig 9-83 Small air bubble near the cervical margin. Air bubbles cannot always be prevented. but because it is outside of tho restoration area. this one will not influence the subsequent procedures or compromise the impression. Fig 9-4 Small bubble on the surface of the tooth due to a tooth preparation defect. When the cast is poured. the tooth preparation will have an air bubble. which tho technician can eliminate easily without jeopardizing the restoration.
silicone impressions
Poor adaptation of the material to the surface of
with improper movement (eg, removal from only
the tooth (Figs 9-85 to 9-89)
one side) (Figs 9-91 to 9-93)
. f7
FIG 9-90
FIG 9·91
D I STORT I O N : T H E P R I N C I PAL E N E M Y O F T H E P R O S T H E S I S FIG 9-85
FIG 9-86
FIG 9-87
FIG 9-92
FIG 9-88
FIG 9-89
FIG 9-93
Fig g .as Defect involving the finish line. While the defects in the two preVIous examples d1d not hinder further work. this impression must be retaken. The impression should be exammed under a microscope to avo1d sending the laboratory Impressions that cannot be used and requiring an additional appointment with the patient to take impressions. Figs 9-86 to 9-89 Two different impressions of the same teeth. both cast in epoxy res1n. Figs 9-86 and g.a7 The cervical limits and detail of the finish line are correct. but the impression has not adapted properly on the buccal aspect. The cast from this impression highlights the area of distortion. Figs g .aa and g .ag A second impression was retaken during the same appointment because the defect was noticed immediately. The clinician may have difficulty knowing the degree of imperfection 1n an impression. F1g g. go Occasionally. a portion of retrac tion cord can become trapped in the impression. Magnification should be used to check whether the cord would compromise a cast of the intact tooth structure apical to the finish tine. In this case. the cord does not alter the situation significantly. so the impression can be sent to the laboratory as is. and the cord will be removed only after casting. F1gs g .g 1 and g . gz Polyvinyl s1loxane impression with stretched areas and bubbles at the prepara tion margin. The cast shows serious defects i n both the tooth preparation and the impression: work cannot be continued. Fig 9-93 Cross section of a cast impression and impression tray to evaluate the spacing and the centenng of the custom tray Impression Because the tray was badly centered in the patient's mouth and came into contact with the shoulder of a tooth. It would have beon clinically useless
FIG 9-90
FIG 9·91
D I STORT I O N : T H E P R I N C I PAL E N E M Y O F T H E P R O S T H E S I S FIG 9-85
FIG 9-86
FIG 9-87
FIG 9-92
FIG 9-88
FIG 9-89
FIG 9-93
Fig g .as Defect involving the finish line. While the defects in the two preVIous examples d1d not hinder further work. this impression must be retaken. The impression should be exammed under a microscope to avo1d sending the laboratory Impressions that cannot be used and requiring an additional appointment with the patient to take impressions. Figs 9-86 to 9-89 Two different impressions of the same teeth. both cast in epoxy res1n. Figs 9-86 and g.a7 The cervical limits and detail of the finish line are correct. but the impression has not adapted properly on the buccal aspect. The cast from this impression highlights the area of distortion. Figs g .aa and g .ag A second impression was retaken during the same appointment because the defect was noticed immediately. The clinician may have difficulty knowing the degree of imperfection 1n an impression. F1g g. go Occasionally. a portion of retrac tion cord can become trapped in the impression. Magnification should be used to check whether the cord would compromise a cast of the intact tooth structure apical to the finish tine. In this case. the cord does not alter the situation significantly. so the impression can be sent to the laboratory as is. and the cord will be removed only after casting. F1gs g .g 1 and g . gz Polyvinyl s1loxane impression with stretched areas and bubbles at the prepara tion margin. The cast shows serious defects i n both the tooth preparation and the impression: work cannot be continued. Fig 9-93 Cross section of a cast impression and impression tray to evaluate the spacing and the centenng of the custom tray Impression Because the tray was badly centered in the patient's mouth and came into contact with the shoulder of a tooth. It would have beon clinically useless
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
�
�
and finish the prosthetic work on the master cast,
ments are screwed on the implant, the screw holes
preferably in a single-casting monoblock.
are protected with moist cotton swabs to prevent
I M PRESS I O N S FOR I M PLANT
and even plaster) and requires many techniques (eg,
S U P P O RTED RESTORAT I O N S
various ways of splinting). The literature is replete with in vitro studies that underscore the inadequate
Otherwise, the clinician must take an initial im
the plaster from closing up the holes. and the tray
Impression materials are t h e only solution for gath·
results obtained using medium- and high-viscosity
pression using the conventional pickup technique
is filled with extra-hard, q uick-drying plaster (Snow
ering necessary clinical information to construct
elastomers, 59 and others where the gap left after
functional and esthetic restorations.
and then seat the abutments on the implants in par
White, Kerr Hawe) using a syringe with a cut tip. The
taking an impression with polyethers averages 190
allel in the laboratory, using a bur and a parallel
plaster is allowed to harden completely, and care is
ometer.
The advent of implant dentistry and the develop
�m 6o The lack of consistent results creates error
ment of prosthetic implant techniques. which in
and false expectations for the clinical operator;
volve the study and analysis of the passive fit, have
there is no doubt that an elastomer impression of
called into question the validity and accuracy of
several i mplants, i f executed in the traditional man
i mpression materials. Giordano underscored the
ner, will not yield reliable results.
taken to remove the excess material onto the sur face of the small mold, onto which an adhesive suit
Modular custom i m p ression tray When taking an impression of mixed dentition,
able for elastomers will be applied (Fig 9-100).
After the most apical area of the first tray is filled with an elastomer extruded through a syringe, the
limitations of impression materials in stating that
Suppoted by findings in the literature,6• the
including natural teeth and implants, a modular
second tray is illed with the impression material
implant-supported restorations require extreme
authors are convinced that the only way to avoid
impression tray, composed of a small open mold on
and centered precisely over the tray holding the
accuracy; small impressions are acceptable for fixed
error during transfer of the implant position is to
the top that serves to support the plaster, can be
hardened plaster. When the elastomer has hard
prostheses because of the movement permitted by
use plaster as an impression material or to splint
used. The custom tray holds the small mold and is
ened, the blocking screws anchoring the transfer
the periodontal ligament, but this luxury does not
the elements being transferred.6' Plaster is the
cut away to permit the unscrewing of the transfer
copings are removed, and the entire system is
exist when using implants.•'
impression material of choice for achieving an exact
copings. This custom tray (with a cutaway area for
extracted from the mouth, thus making a precision
The techniques of impression taking for an
reproduction of the implant position, and in the case
the implants) fits the entire arch and is used to take
impression that includes both the position of the
implant-supported restoration have changed over
of edentulous patients, who must undergo a full
an impression of the residual teeth in elastomeric
time. Methods of implant positioning in the labora·
mouth rehabilitation with implants, this can be
material.
tory have evolved from a direct technique, to
accomplished using a plastic impression tray or a
To make a modular custom impression tray, the
The dental technician will then make a single cast
clinician must have a cast that represents the
on the abutments, which will be made to provide a
implants and their relationship to the adjacent teeth
(Fig 9· 101).
removal and subsequent reinsertion of the transfer
custom tray created specifically for the purpose. The
coping, to the latest procedure known as the pick
dental technician will destroy the tray to remove the
implant site, indicated by the healing abutments or
passive fit with the implants directly in the lab.
up technique.•;' These techniques use traditional
plaster impression and pour a cast using other den·
a diagnostic cast. The implant site is delimited with
Therefore, no paste is needed to detect tension or
impression materials (generally elastomers) with
tal stone that is properly isolated with a layer of
a block of sot wax or by a small mold of the same
distortion directly i n the mouth.
custom trays that are cut out where the implant
insulating material.
resin, so that it occupies the part that will later be
The accuracy of this i mpression technique is illus trated clinically in a case of multiple implants i n the
emerges, allowing the removal of the anchor screw
The clinical procedure becomes more complicat-
filled with plaster. The example shows a clinical case
before the hardened impression material is removed
ed when implants are present in a mixed dentition,
in which the analogue (ie, a cast produced from an
posterior dentition. In a 63·year-old female patient,
from the oral cavity (Fig 9-94). Scientific studies of
including healthy natural teeth and teeth prepared
impression with the transfer coping using the pick
two implants were placed in the mandibular left
impression techniques have found that when work
for a prosthesis. For this reason, the authors have
up technique) is already inserted in the plaster.
quadrant and three in the mandibular right quad
ing on a single element, the pickup technique with
designed a modular system of custom impression
Around this block, a small, well-adapted mold of
rant. The patient authorized the taking of three
subsequent repositioning in the i mpression for the
trays, which are made directly in the clinician's
self-curing resin (MultiTray) is left open occlusally. It
impressions with custom trays, two modular and
casting is preferable to the cut-away procedure,
office. This system results in a one-step impression
is polymerized in the light-curing unit (Multilight) for
one using the conventional pickup technique. The
though it tends to result in rotational errors.53
made of plaster for the i m plants and of polyether or polyvinyl siloxane for the remaining dentition. I f the
The custom tray is made by applying a sheet of
two plaster-elastomer casts, shaping and casting a
prosthetic fit have demonstrated that definitive
clinician uses parallel implants or implants without
wax, with a thickness calibrated for the elastomer, to
mono block structure in noble metal alloy on the two
passive.
an internal hexagon or connections that impede the
the resin mold, following the procedure already
lateral segments. The framework thus obtained can
Impression taking with implants involves the use of
removal of the transfer coping, it is possible to
described for making a custom impression tray (Figs
be fit to the cast to verify the implant position ob
different materials (eg, high-viscosity elastomers
obtain their exact position i n a single impression ..
Over the years, in vitro and survey studiess•-ss of restorations
are
neither precise
nor
5 minutes (Figs 9-95 and 9-96).
9-97 to 9-99). After the transfer copings or abut-
abutments were prepared di rectly on one of the
tained from the three diferent impressions, two in ..
301
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
�
�
and finish the prosthetic work on the master cast,
ments are screwed on the implant, the screw holes
preferably in a single-casting monoblock.
are protected with moist cotton swabs to prevent
I M PRESS I O N S FOR I M PLANT
and even plaster) and requires many techniques (eg,
S U P P O RTED RESTORAT I O N S
various ways of splinting). The literature is replete with in vitro studies that underscore the inadequate
Otherwise, the clinician must take an initial im
the plaster from closing up the holes. and the tray
Impression materials are t h e only solution for gath·
results obtained using medium- and high-viscosity
pression using the conventional pickup technique
is filled with extra-hard, q uick-drying plaster (Snow
ering necessary clinical information to construct
elastomers, 59 and others where the gap left after
functional and esthetic restorations.
and then seat the abutments on the implants in par
White, Kerr Hawe) using a syringe with a cut tip. The
taking an impression with polyethers averages 190
allel in the laboratory, using a bur and a parallel
plaster is allowed to harden completely, and care is
ometer.
The advent of implant dentistry and the develop
�m 6o The lack of consistent results creates error
ment of prosthetic implant techniques. which in
and false expectations for the clinical operator;
volve the study and analysis of the passive fit, have
there is no doubt that an elastomer impression of
called into question the validity and accuracy of
several i mplants, i f executed in the traditional man
i mpression materials. Giordano underscored the
ner, will not yield reliable results.
taken to remove the excess material onto the sur face of the small mold, onto which an adhesive suit
Modular custom i m p ression tray When taking an impression of mixed dentition,
able for elastomers will be applied (Fig 9-100).
After the most apical area of the first tray is filled with an elastomer extruded through a syringe, the
limitations of impression materials in stating that
Suppoted by findings in the literature,6• the
including natural teeth and implants, a modular
second tray is illed with the impression material
implant-supported restorations require extreme
authors are convinced that the only way to avoid
impression tray, composed of a small open mold on
and centered precisely over the tray holding the
accuracy; small impressions are acceptable for fixed
error during transfer of the implant position is to
the top that serves to support the plaster, can be
hardened plaster. When the elastomer has hard
prostheses because of the movement permitted by
use plaster as an impression material or to splint
used. The custom tray holds the small mold and is
ened, the blocking screws anchoring the transfer
the periodontal ligament, but this luxury does not
the elements being transferred.6' Plaster is the
cut away to permit the unscrewing of the transfer
copings are removed, and the entire system is
exist when using implants.•'
impression material of choice for achieving an exact
copings. This custom tray (with a cutaway area for
extracted from the mouth, thus making a precision
The techniques of impression taking for an
reproduction of the implant position, and in the case
the implants) fits the entire arch and is used to take
impression that includes both the position of the
implant-supported restoration have changed over
of edentulous patients, who must undergo a full
an impression of the residual teeth in elastomeric
time. Methods of implant positioning in the labora·
mouth rehabilitation with implants, this can be
material.
tory have evolved from a direct technique, to
accomplished using a plastic impression tray or a
To make a modular custom impression tray, the
The dental technician will then make a single cast
clinician must have a cast that represents the
on the abutments, which will be made to provide a
implants and their relationship to the adjacent teeth
(Fig 9· 101).
removal and subsequent reinsertion of the transfer
custom tray created specifically for the purpose. The
coping, to the latest procedure known as the pick
dental technician will destroy the tray to remove the
implant site, indicated by the healing abutments or
passive fit with the implants directly in the lab.
up technique.•;' These techniques use traditional
plaster impression and pour a cast using other den·
a diagnostic cast. The implant site is delimited with
Therefore, no paste is needed to detect tension or
impression materials (generally elastomers) with
tal stone that is properly isolated with a layer of
a block of sot wax or by a small mold of the same
distortion directly i n the mouth.
custom trays that are cut out where the implant
insulating material.
resin, so that it occupies the part that will later be
The accuracy of this i mpression technique is illus trated clinically in a case of multiple implants i n the
emerges, allowing the removal of the anchor screw
The clinical procedure becomes more complicat-
filled with plaster. The example shows a clinical case
before the hardened impression material is removed
ed when implants are present in a mixed dentition,
in which the analogue (ie, a cast produced from an
posterior dentition. In a 63·year-old female patient,
from the oral cavity (Fig 9-94). Scientific studies of
including healthy natural teeth and teeth prepared
impression with the transfer coping using the pick
two implants were placed in the mandibular left
impression techniques have found that when work
for a prosthesis. For this reason, the authors have
up technique) is already inserted in the plaster.
quadrant and three in the mandibular right quad
ing on a single element, the pickup technique with
designed a modular system of custom impression
Around this block, a small, well-adapted mold of
rant. The patient authorized the taking of three
subsequent repositioning in the i mpression for the
trays, which are made directly in the clinician's
self-curing resin (MultiTray) is left open occlusally. It
impressions with custom trays, two modular and
casting is preferable to the cut-away procedure,
office. This system results in a one-step impression
is polymerized in the light-curing unit (Multilight) for
one using the conventional pickup technique. The
though it tends to result in rotational errors.53
made of plaster for the i m plants and of polyether or polyvinyl siloxane for the remaining dentition. I f the
The custom tray is made by applying a sheet of
two plaster-elastomer casts, shaping and casting a
prosthetic fit have demonstrated that definitive
clinician uses parallel implants or implants without
wax, with a thickness calibrated for the elastomer, to
mono block structure in noble metal alloy on the two
passive.
an internal hexagon or connections that impede the
the resin mold, following the procedure already
lateral segments. The framework thus obtained can
Impression taking with implants involves the use of
removal of the transfer coping, it is possible to
described for making a custom impression tray (Figs
be fit to the cast to verify the implant position ob
different materials (eg, high-viscosity elastomers
obtain their exact position i n a single impression ..
Over the years, in vitro and survey studiess•-ss of restorations
are
neither precise
nor
5 minutes (Figs 9-95 and 9-96).
9-97 to 9-99). After the transfer copings or abut-
abutments were prepared di rectly on one of the
tained from the three diferent impressions, two in ..
301
CHAPTER 9 Custom Impression Trays and Impression Materials
�
plaster-polyether and one in complete polyether.
ament, which compensates, in part, for a minimal
The abutments are screwed on the analogues on
degree of imperfection and permits the seating of
each of the three casts to check the adaptation of
the fixed dental restorations.
the single cast.
The authors' working philosophy demands that
The key aspect is the repeatability of the mixed
during tooth preparation for a conventional pros
plaster-€1astomer i mpression: the structures adapt
thesis, the clinician must think not only about seat
perfectly to the positions on these casts, while those
ing the restoration, but above all of eliminating,
made in all elastomer result in considerable gaps
through close adherence to the recommended pro
and poor adaptation (igs 9-102 to 9-105). This aspect
cedures, all possible sources of tension on the
further recommends the use of plaster for implant
i mpression materials (Figs 9-106 to 9-108). During
impressions. The nonrepeatability of elastomeric im
preparation, the clinician must act in accordance
pressions, true for both implants and natural denti
with the characteristics of the impression materials,
tion, proves that though these materials have accu
even before considering the aspects related to the
rate results for in vitro studies, the stress they are
type of prosthesis and the material used for making
subjected to in clinical settings often exceeds the
it. Given the characteristics of the impression mate
elastic limit of the material. Precise prosthetic restor
rials available today, this is the means by which the
ations that adapt well to the natural dentition are
clinician may achieve maximum precision (Figs 9-109
closely linked to the presence of the periodontal lig-
to 9-134).
•
Fig 9-94 Pickup technique for making impressions for implant-supported prostheses. This type of impression yields unpre dictable results in clinical treatment. Fig 9-95 Fabrication of a modular custom impression tray. There are two modules. one for taking a plaster impression of the implant area and the other for taking an elastomeric impression of the remai ning den tition. The plaster module is made by either adapting a strip of curing resin around a block of wax or directly shaping the resin and positioning it around the implant site to contain the plaster. Figs g_g6 and 9-g7 Spacing wax covers the cast and the mold for the plaster. Wax has been removed in areas to make occlusal stops for centering the impression. Figs g -98 and 9-99 Finished modular custom impression tray.
02
3
CHAPTER 9 Custom Impression Trays and Impression Materials
�
plaster-polyether and one in complete polyether.
ament, which compensates, in part, for a minimal
The abutments are screwed on the analogues on
degree of imperfection and permits the seating of
each of the three casts to check the adaptation of
the fixed dental restorations.
the single cast.
The authors' working philosophy demands that
The key aspect is the repeatability of the mixed
during tooth preparation for a conventional pros
plaster-€1astomer i mpression: the structures adapt
thesis, the clinician must think not only about seat
perfectly to the positions on these casts, while those
ing the restoration, but above all of eliminating,
made in all elastomer result in considerable gaps
through close adherence to the recommended pro
and poor adaptation (igs 9-102 to 9-105). This aspect
cedures, all possible sources of tension on the
further recommends the use of plaster for implant
i mpression materials (Figs 9-106 to 9-108). During
impressions. The nonrepeatability of elastomeric im
preparation, the clinician must act in accordance
pressions, true for both implants and natural denti
with the characteristics of the impression materials,
tion, proves that though these materials have accu
even before considering the aspects related to the
rate results for in vitro studies, the stress they are
type of prosthesis and the material used for making
subjected to in clinical settings often exceeds the
it. Given the characteristics of the impression mate
elastic limit of the material. Precise prosthetic restor
rials available today, this is the means by which the
ations that adapt well to the natural dentition are
clinician may achieve maximum precision (Figs 9-109
closely linked to the presence of the periodontal lig-
to 9-134).
•
Fig 9-94 Pickup technique for making impressions for implant-supported prostheses. This type of impression yields unpre dictable results in clinical treatment. Fig 9-95 Fabrication of a modular custom impression tray. There are two modules. one for taking a plaster impression of the implant area and the other for taking an elastomeric impression of the remai ning den tition. The plaster module is made by either adapting a strip of curing resin around a block of wax or directly shaping the resin and positioning it around the implant site to contain the plaster. Figs g_g6 and 9-g7 Spacing wax covers the cast and the mold for the plaster. Wax has been removed in areas to make occlusal stops for centering the impression. Figs g -98 and 9-99 Finished modular custom impression tray.
02
3
CHAPHR 9 Custom Impression Trays a n d Impression Materials
s ,.,J � ,
--
Figs 9-100 and 9-101 In vitro example. The clinician takes a plaster impression (Snow Whitel of the transfer coping screwed onto the implants. After the plaster hardens in the patient"s mouth. excess material is removed. adhesive is applied to the exteri or of the plaster _ both _ conta�ns mold. and elaslomeric material is sealed i n the rest of the dental arch in the custom tray. I n this manner. a s1ngle 1mpress1on modules. as seen in Fig 9 - 1 0 1 . Fig g-102 Three impressions were taken of two areas (the mandibular right and left quadrants! to be restored with implant-supported fixed prostheses. The impressions were taken using three series of transfer copin � s. one 1n onl y elastomenc _ material and the other two in a combination of plaster and elastomer. according to the modular custom impress1on tray technique. Fig 9-103 Fixed partial denture in a single casting. realized using the first cast from the plaster and polyether impression. Fig g -104 Abutments re moved and positioned on the cast of the elastomer impression. illustrating the framework"s lack of fit. Fig 9-105 Abutments removed and positioned on the second plaster-elastomer cast. illustrating the correspondence and good fit. The abutments can b e perfectly supenm posed on the first plaster-elastomer model. This underscores the clinical repeatability of plaster impressions. l4
Fig g-106 Correct impression yields a distinct and unbroken finish line for the entire perimeter of the tooth. Fig 9-107 Same type of impression details obtained with minimal horizontal retraction. This type of impression ensures the long-term stability of the gingiva. Fig g -108 Adequate impression requiring improved tooth preparation for the primary reduction and the finishing. The impression material must establish more than just the restorations insertion axis. Fig g. Jog Clinical case of a 64-year-old female patient who presented with serious periodontal problems and only five Ieeth in the maxillary arch. The teeth will be restored with a telescopic prosthesis after suitable periodontal treat ment.
CHAPHR 9 Custom Impression Trays a n d Impression Materials
s ,.,J � ,
--
Figs 9-100 and 9-101 In vitro example. The clinician takes a plaster impression (Snow Whitel of the transfer coping screwed onto the implants. After the plaster hardens in the patient"s mouth. excess material is removed. adhesive is applied to the exteri or of the plaster _ both _ conta�ns mold. and elaslomeric material is sealed i n the rest of the dental arch in the custom tray. I n this manner. a s1ngle 1mpress1on modules. as seen in Fig 9 - 1 0 1 . Fig g-102 Three impressions were taken of two areas (the mandibular right and left quadrants! to be restored with implant-supported fixed prostheses. The impressions were taken using three series of transfer copin � s. one 1n onl y elastomenc _ material and the other two in a combination of plaster and elastomer. according to the modular custom impress1on tray technique. Fig 9-103 Fixed partial denture in a single casting. realized using the first cast from the plaster and polyether impression. Fig g -104 Abutments re moved and positioned on the cast of the elastomer impression. illustrating the framework"s lack of fit. Fig 9-105 Abutments removed and positioned on the second plaster-elastomer cast. illustrating the correspondence and good fit. The abutments can b e perfectly supenm posed on the first plaster-elastomer model. This underscores the clinical repeatability of plaster impressions. l4
Fig g-106 Correct impression yields a distinct and unbroken finish line for the entire perimeter of the tooth. Fig 9-107 Same type of impression details obtained with minimal horizontal retraction. This type of impression ensures the long-term stability of the gingiva. Fig g -108 Adequate impression requiring improved tooth preparation for the primary reduction and the finishing. The impression material must establish more than just the restorations insertion axis. Fig g. Jog Clinical case of a 64-year-old female patient who presented with serious periodontal problems and only five Ieeth in the maxillary arch. The teeth will be restored with a telescopic prosthesis after suitable periodontal treat ment.
�
Custom I mpression Trays a n d ImpresSIOn Materia
Fig 9-110
Fig 9-1 1 1
ln1t1al stage of treatment. immed�ately follow1ng resectiYe surgery and reconstruction of the missing teeth with fiberglass dowels.
After proper periodontal treatment. the smallest poss1ble retraction cord was posit1oned to vertically retract the gingiva.
Fig 9-112 Finish line repoSitioning and finishing of the tooth preparation Figs 9-113 and g -114 Following the use of oscillating instruments and manual rounded chisels. the tooth preparat1ons are well polished. and the finish line is properly positioned.
01
�
Custom I mpression Trays a n d ImpresSIOn Materia
Fig 9-110
Fig 9-1 1 1
ln1t1al stage of treatment. immed�ately follow1ng resectiYe surgery and reconstruction of the missing teeth with fiberglass dowels.
After proper periodontal treatment. the smallest poss1ble retraction cord was posit1oned to vertically retract the gingiva.
Fig 9-112 Finish line repoSitioning and finishing of the tooth preparation Figs 9-113 and g -114 Following the use of oscillating instruments and manual rounded chisels. the tooth preparat1ons are well polished. and the finish line is properly positioned.
01
CHAPTER 9 Custom Impression Trays and Impression Materials
Figs g-115 o g-111 Higher magnification shows the finish line position. which will be juxlagingival after repositioning.
Figs g -118 to g-120 Lateral and occlusal views demonstrate the good parallelism of the preparations and the care taken to avoid injury to the gin giva. Figs g-121 and g-122 Elastomeric impression. Because the compression area is on the mucosal tissue and not on the teeth. the impression can be used.
CHAPTER 9 Custom Impression Trays and Impression Materials
Figs g-115 o g-111 Higher magnification shows the finish line position. which will be juxlagingival after repositioning.
Figs g -118 to g-120 Lateral and occlusal views demonstrate the good parallelism of the preparations and the care taken to avoid injury to the gin giva. Figs g-121 and g-122 Elastomeric impression. Because the compression area is on the mucosal tissue and not on the teeth. the impression can be used.
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
Figs g-123 and 9-124 Extra hard plaster cast shows the accurate finish tines of the tooth preparations and welt-reproduced details.
igs 9-125 o g-m Gold castings for double telescopic crowns for the filling i n the palienrs mouth. During the marginal adaptation. the pre
cision of the framework was evaluated on the cast MagnifiCatiOn ensures that the same adaptation occurs in the mouth.
310
Figs 9-128and 9-129 High-noble gold copings. which witt be cemented directly onto the prepared teeth. Fig 9-130 Secondary structures adapted to the primary copings. The secondary structures witt be cemented inside the prosthetic framework after electroplating. Figs g -131 and 9-132 Definitive restoration. including the metal-reinforced prosthesis and telescopic crowns in a single block. coaled with an esthetic resin composite ISinfony. 3M ESPEI. The esthetic coating uses one of the latest resin composites for a lighter prosthesis. The advan tage of this type of restoration is the possibility of easily resolving any complications with one or more teeth. without having to start over from the beginning. 311
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
Figs g-123 and 9-124 Extra hard plaster cast shows the accurate finish tines of the tooth preparations and welt-reproduced details.
igs 9-125 o g-m Gold castings for double telescopic crowns for the filling i n the palienrs mouth. During the marginal adaptation. the pre
cision of the framework was evaluated on the cast MagnifiCatiOn ensures that the same adaptation occurs in the mouth.
310
Figs 9-128and 9-129 High-noble gold copings. which witt be cemented directly onto the prepared teeth. Fig 9-130 Secondary structures adapted to the primary copings. The secondary structures witt be cemented inside the prosthetic framework after electroplating. Figs g -131 and 9-132 Definitive restoration. including the metal-reinforced prosthesis and telescopic crowns in a single block. coaled with an esthetic resin composite ISinfony. 3M ESPEI. The esthetic coating uses one of the latest resin composites for a lighter prosthesis. The advan tage of this type of restoration is the possibility of easily resolving any complications with one or more teeth. without having to start over from the beginning. 311
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
R EFERENCES
12.
Eames WB, Wallace SW, Suway NB, Rogers LB. Accuracy and dimensional stability of elastomeric impression
t. Schulz HH, Schwickerath H. Die Abformung in der
Zahnheilkunde. Cologne: Deutscher lrzte-Verlag, 1989. 2.
materials. ) Prosthet Dent 1979;42:159-162. 13.
Richards MW, Zeiaei 5, Bagby MD, Okubo 5, Soltani ). Working times and dimensional accuracy of the one step putty/wash impression technique. J Prosthodont
3·
dentures. J Prosthet Dent 1988;59:288-291. 14·
Revised American Dental Association Specification no.
1998:7:25-255·
19 for Non-aqueous, Elastomeric Dental Impression Ma
Phillips RW. Science of Dental Materials, ed 9. Phila
terials. J Am Dent Assoc 1977:94:733-741.
delphia: Saunders, 1991.
15. Johnson GH, Lepe X, Aw TC. The efect of surface mois·
4· Carrotte PV, Johnson A, Winstanley RB. The inluence of
ture on detail reproduction of elastomeric impressions. I Prosthet Dent 2oo3;90(4) :354-364.
the impression tray on the accuracy of impressions for crown and bridge work-An investigation and review.
16.
Br Dent J 199B;t85:580-585.
for preparation of individual mold trays [in German).
Owen CP, Goolam R. Disinfection of impression materi als to prevent viral cross contamination: A review and
5· Wirz ), Scharer P, Kauhnann P. Selected acrylate resins
6.
Lin CC, Ziebert GJ. Donegan 51. Dhuru VB. Accuracy of impression materials for complete-arch ixed partial
a protocol. tnt I Prosthodont 1993;6:48o-494· 17.
ADA Council on Scientiic Aairs and ADA Council on
Dent Labor 1979;27:573-580.
Dental Practice. Inection control recommendations for
Lehner CR, Sch�rer P. Impression materials in crown·
the dental oice and the dental laboratoy. I Am Dent
bridge prosthodontics. The determination of their place and practical tips [in German> Schweiz Monatsschr
Assoc 1996;t27:672�. t8.
Kugel G, Pery RD, Ferrari M, Lalicata P. Disinfection and
Zahnmed 199t;tOt:62>38.
communication practices: A survey of U.S. dental labo
7.
Ortensi L, Strocchi ML. Modiied custom tray. ) Prosthet
ratories. I Am Dent Assoc 2000;131;786-792.
8.
Craig RG. Restorative Dental Materials, ed to. St Louis:
sional stability of elastomeric impression materials fol
Mosby, 1997.
lowing disinfection. I Prosthet Dent 1990;63:27-276.
Dent 2000;84:237-240.
9·
19. Langenwalter EM, Aquilino SA, Tuner A. The dimen
Cho GC, Donovan TE, Chee W, White SN. Tensile bond
20. atyas ), Dao N, Caputo A, Lucatoto FM. Eects of
strength of polvinyl siloxane impressions bonded to a
disinfectants on dimensional accuracy of impression
custom tray as a function of dying time: Pat I. J Prosthet Dent 1995:73:419-423.
materials. I Prosthet Dent 1990;64:25-31. 21.
to. Linke BA, Nicholls )1, Faucher RR. Distortion analysis of stone casts made from impression materials. I Prosthet Dent 1985:54:794-802. 11.
Dounis GS, Zieber! G), Dounis KS. A comparison of
Ken M, Rathmer RM, Strub JR. Three-dimensional investigation of the accuracy of impression materials ater disinfection. J Prosthet Dent 1993:70:44-456.
22.
Davis BA. Powers JM. Efect of immersion disinfection on properties of impression materials. J Prosthodont
impression materials for complete-arch fixed patial dentures. J Prosthet Dent 1991:65:t65-169.
ig 9-133 Definitive restoration in the mouth. ig 9-14 Patient's smile.
312
m
CHAPTER 9 Custom I mpression Trays and Impression Materials
R EFERENCES
12.
Eames WB, Wallace SW, Suway NB, Rogers LB. Accuracy and dimensional stability of elastomeric impression
t. Schulz HH, Schwickerath H. Die Abformung in der
Zahnheilkunde. Cologne: Deutscher lrzte-Verlag, 1989. 2.
materials. ) Prosthet Dent 1979;42:159-162. 13.
Richards MW, Zeiaei 5, Bagby MD, Okubo 5, Soltani ). Working times and dimensional accuracy of the one step putty/wash impression technique. J Prosthodont
3·
dentures. J Prosthet Dent 1988;59:288-291. 14·
Revised American Dental Association Specification no.
1998:7:25-255·
19 for Non-aqueous, Elastomeric Dental Impression Ma
Phillips RW. Science of Dental Materials, ed 9. Phila
terials. J Am Dent Assoc 1977:94:733-741.
delphia: Saunders, 1991.
15. Johnson GH, Lepe X, Aw TC. The efect of surface mois·
4· Carrotte PV, Johnson A, Winstanley RB. The inluence of
ture on detail reproduction of elastomeric impressions. I Prosthet Dent 2oo3;90(4) :354-364.
the impression tray on the accuracy of impressions for crown and bridge work-An investigation and review.
16.
Br Dent J 199B;t85:580-585.
for preparation of individual mold trays [in German).
Owen CP, Goolam R. Disinfection of impression materi als to prevent viral cross contamination: A review and
5· Wirz ), Scharer P, Kauhnann P. Selected acrylate resins
6.
Lin CC, Ziebert GJ. Donegan 51. Dhuru VB. Accuracy of impression materials for complete-arch ixed partial
a protocol. tnt I Prosthodont 1993;6:48o-494· 17.
ADA Council on Scientiic Aairs and ADA Council on
Dent Labor 1979;27:573-580.
Dental Practice. Inection control recommendations for
Lehner CR, Sch�rer P. Impression materials in crown·
the dental oice and the dental laboratoy. I Am Dent
bridge prosthodontics. The determination of their place and practical tips [in German> Schweiz Monatsschr
Assoc 1996;t27:672�. t8.
Kugel G, Pery RD, Ferrari M, Lalicata P. Disinfection and
Zahnmed 199t;tOt:62>38.
communication practices: A survey of U.S. dental labo
7.
Ortensi L, Strocchi ML. Modiied custom tray. ) Prosthet
ratories. I Am Dent Assoc 2000;131;786-792.
8.
Craig RG. Restorative Dental Materials, ed to. St Louis:
sional stability of elastomeric impression materials fol
Mosby, 1997.
lowing disinfection. I Prosthet Dent 1990;63:27-276.
Dent 2000;84:237-240.
9·
19. Langenwalter EM, Aquilino SA, Tuner A. The dimen
Cho GC, Donovan TE, Chee W, White SN. Tensile bond
20. atyas ), Dao N, Caputo A, Lucatoto FM. Eects of
strength of polvinyl siloxane impressions bonded to a
disinfectants on dimensional accuracy of impression
custom tray as a function of dying time: Pat I. J Prosthet Dent 1995:73:419-423.
materials. I Prosthet Dent 1990;64:25-31. 21.
to. Linke BA, Nicholls )1, Faucher RR. Distortion analysis of stone casts made from impression materials. I Prosthet Dent 1985:54:794-802. 11.
Dounis GS, Zieber! G), Dounis KS. A comparison of
Ken M, Rathmer RM, Strub JR. Three-dimensional investigation of the accuracy of impression materials ater disinfection. J Prosthet Dent 1993:70:44-456.
22.
Davis BA. Powers JM. Efect of immersion disinfection on properties of impression materials. J Prosthodont
impression materials for complete-arch fixed patial dentures. J Prosthet Dent 1991:65:t65-169.
ig 9-133 Definitive restoration in the mouth. ig 9-14 Patient's smile.
312
m
t P ER Custom Impression Trays a n d I mpression Materials
23.
24.
Lepe X, Johnson GH, Berg JC. Surface characteristics of
materials for monophase elastic impression making. t nt
used on gingival retraction cords. I Prosthet Dent 1993:
181 186.
I Prosthodont 2002:t5: t68-t74·
70:114 -117.
rmpression materials. I Dent Res 1984:6) : 1 5 5 157.
polyvinyl siloxane putty-wash impression techniques. I
Salem NS, Combe EC, Watts DC. Mechanical propenres
Prosthet Dent 2000;8):16t-t6s.
·
76:) 56-)62.
of elastomeric impression materials. I Oral Rehabil
Thouati , Deveaux E. lost A. Behin P. Dimensional sta·
1988:t 5 : 12S-132. 35.
29.
36. Albers HF. Impressions: A Text for Selection of Materials
meric impression materials. J Prosthet Dent 1999;81:
and Techniques. Santa Rosa, A: Alto Books, 1990:
621-624.
45-46.
Johnson GH, Chellis KD, Gordon GE, Lepe X. Dimen·
37·
effects of diferent storage conditions on polyether and
hydrocolloid and elastomeric impressions disinfected
polyvinylsiloxane impressions. I Am Dent Assoc 1998: 129:1014-1021. 38.
Dent 199t:65=743.748.
prostheses and the master casts in routine edentulous
Hung SH, Purk JH. nra DE, Eick JD. Accuracy of one·step
situations. 1 Oral Rehabil 1995 : 2 2 : 5 5 7-564.
46.
bulk on the accuracy of polyvinyl siloxane putty·wash
ing implant-suppoted prostheses in the edentulous jaw.
als. Gen Dent 2000:48:646-648. 48.
Corso M, Abanomy A, Di Canzio J. Zurakowski D,
58.
Jemt T, Book K. Prosthesis misfit and marginal bone
Spector MR, Donovan TE, Nicholls 11. An evaluation of
loss in edentulous implant patients. lnt I Oral axillofac
impression techniques for osseointegrated implants. I
Implants 1996:11:62o625.
Prosthet Dent 1990:63:444-447·
of the accuracy of implant
626-6)1.
Prosthet Dent 1993:69:s88-s93·
49·
lnt I Oral axilloac Implants 1996: 1 1 : t 5 1-158.
Giordano R 2nd. Issues in handling impression materi
ether impression materials. I Prosthet Dent 1998:79:
S9·
Wee AG. Comparison of impression materials for direct multi-implant impressions. I Prosthet Dent 2000:83:
Hsu CC. Millstein PL. Stein RS. A comparative analysis transfer techniques. J
32)-))1.
6o. Romero GG, Engelmeier R, Powers )M, Canterbuy A.
Phillips KM, Nicholls 11. Ma T, Rubenstein )E. The accu·
Accuracy of three corrective techniques for implant bar
vanced fixed prosthodontics: A comprehensive review.
racy of three implant impression techniques: A three
fabrication. I Prosthet Dent 2000:84:6o2-607.
Pract Periodontics Aesthet Dent 1999:11:497-504.
dimensional analysis. lnt I Oral Maxillofac Implants
Keck SC. Automixing: A new concept ln elastomeric
•994:9=533-540.
Lee A. Predictable elastomeric impressions in ad·
Detail reproduction, contact angles, and die hardness of
impression material delivey systems. J Prosthet Dent
elastomeric impression and gypsum die material com·
1985 : 54=479-48). 41.
Dent 1996:75:)14-324. S7· Jemt . In vivo measurements of precision of it involv
impressions. I Oral Rehabil 2002;29:35 7-)61. 47.
Science, 1998:1 18-126.
40.
fit at the implant prosthodontic interace. J Prosthet
Nissan 1. Gross M, Shifman A, Assif D. Efect of wash
Lepe X, Johnson GH, Berg )(, Aw TC, Stroh GS. Wetta
Ragarn )(, Grosko ML, Raj M, Ryan TN, Johnston WM.
56. Jemt T, Rubenstein IE, Carlsson L, Lang BR. easuring
sion technique. I Prosthet Dent •992:67: 583-589.
dimensional stability of polyvinyl siloxane and poly·
binations. lnt J Prosthodont 2oo; t):214-22o.
314
ings and welded titanium frameworks. easurements of the precision of the it between completed implant
Morgana SM. The effect of temperature changes on the
268-276.
1996:11:21-222.
Tjan AH, Li . Efects of reheating on the accuracy of
(eds). Applied Dental Materials, ed 8. Oxford: Blackwell
39·
impression techniques. t nt I Oral Maxillofac Implants
addition silicone putty-wash Impressions. I Prosthet
cation and requirements. In: Mccabe JF. Walls AWG
bility, imbibition, and mass change of disinfected low·
single-tooth implants. lnt I Prosthodont 200t:t4:1S2-t58. Ass r f D. Marshak B, Schmidt A. Accuracy of implant
5 5 · Jemt . Three-dimensional distonion of gold alloy cast
versus two-step putty wash addition silicone impres
Purk )H, Willes MG, Tira DE, Eick JD, Hung SH. The
sional stability and detail reproduction of irreversible
cCabe )F, Walls AW. Impression materials: Classifi
45·
Dent 1990:6):282-285.
disinfectant agents on dimensional stability of elasto
viscosity impression materials. J Prosthet Dent 2002;88:
30.
Tam LE, Brown JW. The tear resistance of various im· pression materials with and without modifiers. J Prosthet
Adabo GL, Zanarottr E. Fonseca RG, Cruz A. Effect of
44.
Daoudi MF, Setchell DJ, Searson LJ. A laboratory investi· gation of the accuracy of two impression techniques for
43· Nissan J. Laufer BZ, Brosh T, ssif D. Accuracy of three
)). Keck SC, Douglas WH. Tear strength of non-aqueous
ical disinfectant solutions on the stability and accuracy 34
53.
54·
Rlos MP, Morgana SM. Stein RS, Rose L. Effeas of chem
by immersion. J Prosthet Dent 1998:79=44-453· 28.
de Camargo LM, Chee W, Donovan TE. Inhibition of
after long-term disinfection. I Prosthet Dent 1995:74:
mersed in disinfectants. I Prosthet Dent 1996:76:8-14.
27.
42.
polymerization of polyvinyl siloxanes by medicaments
bility of seven elastomeric impression materials lm·
26.
Piwowarczyk A, Ottl P, Buchler A, Lauer HC, Hoffmann A. In vitro study on the dimensional accuracy of selected
of the dental impression complex. I Prosthet Dent 1996:
25.
)2.
a polyether and addition silicone impression materials
so.
51.
material. lnt J Oral axilloac Implants 1999:14 :88s-888. 62.
Wise M. Fit of implant-suppMed fixed prostheses fab
78:596-6o4.
ricated on master casts made from a dental stone and
Wee AG, Aquilino SA, Schneider RL. Strategies to
a dental plaster. I Prosthet Dent 200t;86:sJ2-5J8.
31. Clancy JM, Scandrett FR, Ettinger RL Long-term dimen
the time-dependent dimensional stability of eleven
sional stabrlity of three current elastomers. I Oral Rehabil
elastomeric impression materials . I Prosthet Dent 1984;
achieve fit in implant prosthodontics: A review of the lit
t983:tO:J2S-333·
S 2 : t 2o-t2S.
erature. lnt I Prosthodont 1999:t2:t67-178.
52.
plant impression splinted techniques: Efect of splinting
Riedy SJ, Lang BR, Lang BE. Fit of implant frameworks fabricated by diferent techniques. J Prosthet Dent 1997:
Wil liams PT, Jackson DG, Bergman W. An evaluation of
61. Assif D, Nissan J. a rsano I, Singe r A. Accuracy of im
3t5
t P ER Custom Impression Trays a n d I mpression Materials
23.
24.
Lepe X, Johnson GH, Berg JC. Surface characteristics of
materials for monophase elastic impression making. t nt
used on gingival retraction cords. I Prosthet Dent 1993:
181 186.
I Prosthodont 2002:t5: t68-t74·
70:114 -117.
rmpression materials. I Dent Res 1984:6) : 1 5 5 157.
polyvinyl siloxane putty-wash impression techniques. I
Salem NS, Combe EC, Watts DC. Mechanical propenres
Prosthet Dent 2000;8):16t-t6s.
·
76:) 56-)62.
of elastomeric impression materials. I Oral Rehabil
Thouati , Deveaux E. lost A. Behin P. Dimensional sta·
1988:t 5 : 12S-132. 35.
29.
36. Albers HF. Impressions: A Text for Selection of Materials
meric impression materials. J Prosthet Dent 1999;81:
and Techniques. Santa Rosa, A: Alto Books, 1990:
621-624.
45-46.
Johnson GH, Chellis KD, Gordon GE, Lepe X. Dimen·
37·
effects of diferent storage conditions on polyether and
hydrocolloid and elastomeric impressions disinfected
polyvinylsiloxane impressions. I Am Dent Assoc 1998: 129:1014-1021. 38.
Dent 199t:65=743.748.
prostheses and the master casts in routine edentulous
Hung SH, Purk JH. nra DE, Eick JD. Accuracy of one·step
situations. 1 Oral Rehabil 1995 : 2 2 : 5 5 7-564.
46.
bulk on the accuracy of polyvinyl siloxane putty·wash
ing implant-suppoted prostheses in the edentulous jaw.
als. Gen Dent 2000:48:646-648. 48.
Corso M, Abanomy A, Di Canzio J. Zurakowski D,
58.
Jemt T, Book K. Prosthesis misfit and marginal bone
Spector MR, Donovan TE, Nicholls 11. An evaluation of
loss in edentulous implant patients. lnt I Oral axillofac
impression techniques for osseointegrated implants. I
Implants 1996:11:62o625.
Prosthet Dent 1990:63:444-447·
of the accuracy of implant
626-6)1.
Prosthet Dent 1993:69:s88-s93·
49·
lnt I Oral axilloac Implants 1996: 1 1 : t 5 1-158.
Giordano R 2nd. Issues in handling impression materi
ether impression materials. I Prosthet Dent 1998:79:
S9·
Wee AG. Comparison of impression materials for direct multi-implant impressions. I Prosthet Dent 2000:83:
Hsu CC. Millstein PL. Stein RS. A comparative analysis transfer techniques. J
32)-))1.
6o. Romero GG, Engelmeier R, Powers )M, Canterbuy A.
Phillips KM, Nicholls 11. Ma T, Rubenstein )E. The accu·
Accuracy of three corrective techniques for implant bar
vanced fixed prosthodontics: A comprehensive review.
racy of three implant impression techniques: A three
fabrication. I Prosthet Dent 2000:84:6o2-607.
Pract Periodontics Aesthet Dent 1999:11:497-504.
dimensional analysis. lnt I Oral Maxillofac Implants
Keck SC. Automixing: A new concept ln elastomeric
•994:9=533-540.
Lee A. Predictable elastomeric impressions in ad·
Detail reproduction, contact angles, and die hardness of
impression material delivey systems. J Prosthet Dent
elastomeric impression and gypsum die material com·
1985 : 54=479-48). 41.
Dent 1996:75:)14-324. S7· Jemt . In vivo measurements of precision of it involv
impressions. I Oral Rehabil 2002;29:35 7-)61. 47.
Science, 1998:1 18-126.
40.
fit at the implant prosthodontic interace. J Prosthet
Nissan 1. Gross M, Shifman A, Assif D. Efect of wash
Lepe X, Johnson GH, Berg )(, Aw TC, Stroh GS. Wetta
Ragarn )(, Grosko ML, Raj M, Ryan TN, Johnston WM.
56. Jemt T, Rubenstein IE, Carlsson L, Lang BR. easuring
sion technique. I Prosthet Dent •992:67: 583-589.
dimensional stability of polyvinyl siloxane and poly·
binations. lnt J Prosthodont 2oo; t):214-22o.
314
ings and welded titanium frameworks. easurements of the precision of the it between completed implant
Morgana SM. The effect of temperature changes on the
268-276.
1996:11:21-222.
Tjan AH, Li . Efects of reheating on the accuracy of
(eds). Applied Dental Materials, ed 8. Oxford: Blackwell
39·
impression techniques. t nt I Oral Maxillofac Implants
addition silicone putty-wash Impressions. I Prosthet
cation and requirements. In: Mccabe JF. Walls AWG
bility, imbibition, and mass change of disinfected low·
single-tooth implants. lnt I Prosthodont 200t:t4:1S2-t58. Ass r f D. Marshak B, Schmidt A. Accuracy of implant
5 5 · Jemt . Three-dimensional distonion of gold alloy cast
versus two-step putty wash addition silicone impres
Purk )H, Willes MG, Tira DE, Eick JD, Hung SH. The
sional stability and detail reproduction of irreversible
cCabe )F, Walls AW. Impression materials: Classifi
45·
Dent 1990:6):282-285.
disinfectant agents on dimensional stability of elasto
viscosity impression materials. J Prosthet Dent 2002;88:
30.
Tam LE, Brown JW. The tear resistance of various im· pression materials with and without modifiers. J Prosthet
Adabo GL, Zanarottr E. Fonseca RG, Cruz A. Effect of
44.
Daoudi MF, Setchell DJ, Searson LJ. A laboratory investi· gation of the accuracy of two impression techniques for
43· Nissan J. Laufer BZ, Brosh T, ssif D. Accuracy of three
)). Keck SC, Douglas WH. Tear strength of non-aqueous
ical disinfectant solutions on the stability and accuracy 34
53.
54·
Rlos MP, Morgana SM. Stein RS, Rose L. Effeas of chem
by immersion. J Prosthet Dent 1998:79=44-453· 28.
de Camargo LM, Chee W, Donovan TE. Inhibition of
after long-term disinfection. I Prosthet Dent 1995:74:
mersed in disinfectants. I Prosthet Dent 1996:76:8-14.
27.
42.
polymerization of polyvinyl siloxanes by medicaments
bility of seven elastomeric impression materials lm·
26.
Piwowarczyk A, Ottl P, Buchler A, Lauer HC, Hoffmann A. In vitro study on the dimensional accuracy of selected
of the dental impression complex. I Prosthet Dent 1996:
25.
)2.
a polyether and addition silicone impression materials
so.
51.
material. lnt J Oral axilloac Implants 1999:14 :88s-888. 62.
Wise M. Fit of implant-suppMed fixed prostheses fab
78:596-6o4.
ricated on master casts made from a dental stone and
Wee AG, Aquilino SA, Schneider RL. Strategies to
a dental plaster. I Prosthet Dent 200t;86:sJ2-5J8.
31. Clancy JM, Scandrett FR, Ettinger RL Long-term dimen
the time-dependent dimensional stability of eleven
sional stabrlity of three current elastomers. I Oral Rehabil
elastomeric impression materials . I Prosthet Dent 1984;
achieve fit in implant prosthodontics: A review of the lit
t983:tO:J2S-333·
S 2 : t 2o-t2S.
erature. lnt I Prosthodont 1999:t2:t67-178.
52.
plant impression splinted techniques: Efect of splinting
Riedy SJ, Lang BR, Lang BE. Fit of implant frameworks fabricated by diferent techniques. J Prosthet Dent 1997:
Wil liams PT, Jackson DG, Bergman W. An evaluation of
61. Assif D, Nissan J. a rsano I, Singe r A. Accuracy of im
3t5
C H A P T E R
1 0
L A B O RAT O R Y
P R O C E D U RES
FIG 10-2
FIG 10-1
C R EATI O N OF THE W O R K I N G CAST
Because plaster is compatible with all i mpression materials and can be used with the various comput
I m pression a nalysis
W O R K I N G
erized scanning systems (computer-aided design/com
C A S T
S Y S T E M S
puter assisted manufacturing ICAD/CAMD. it is the
High-quality restorations begin with correct impres
material of choice for making casts. Using plaster
sions, since errors and minor defects in the impres
guarantees predictable results from practical and
sion are inevitably transferred to the working cast
well-tested techniques.
and may compromise the final adaptation of the
Plaster also is the most economical material avail
restoration. The dental technician must not only
able for cast fabrication, and in addition to its pre
take perfect impressions in the laboratory, but also
cision, it ofers the hardness and compression resis
examine them carefully under the microscope to con
tance essential to working on a cast without risking
irm that their dimensions and detail reproduction
surface damage.J-7 Varieties of plaster are classified
are precise (Fig 10-1). Once the accuracy of the im
in terms of their degree of expansion, flexion, com
pression is confirmed, extreme care must be taken
pression resistance, and hardness. The most common
to avoid introducing mistakes during the fabrication
types are natural plasters fortified with low-expansion
of the master cast to guarantee optimal adaptation
synthetic resin6 (ResinRock, Whip Mix), which offer
and integration of the restoration i n the oral cavity.
high resistance to abrasion and scratches,6.8 good
Materials for master working casts
of the finest type IV plasters, and favorable volu
FIG 10-J
FIG 1 0-4
plasticity, dimensional stability comparable to that
311
metric expansion ranging from o.o7% to o.o8%.
The technician selects a cast material that is com
Alternatives to plaster include epoxy and poly
patible with the type of cast to be made and the
urethane resins. Unlike plasters, which expand, these
type of impression material that was used, because
materials are characterized by volumetric shrinkage
interaction between incompatible materials can give
of o.os%. but they have been shown to provide
rise to imperfections.'·' Manufacturers offer a vast
precise detail reproduction. Their two basic compo
range of construction systems (eg, Model-Tray System,
nents, resin and polyamine, begin to polymerize as
Model-Tray) and cast materials, such as plasters and
soon as they are mixed; the resin must be poured
polyurethane and epoxy resins.
immediately into the impression while it remains in ..
Fig 10-1 To create a working cast with good dimensional precision and excellent detail reproduction. the dentat technician must work with a precise impression. Note the detailed reproduction of the finish tine. Figs 10-2 and 10-3 Ouatity of the restoration atso depends on the precision of the master cast. Each stage must be performed using tho appro priate materials and systems. Fig 10-4 Plaster cast from a reversible hydrocolloid impression. Given the water absorption and secretion of hydrocolloid materials. the tech nician must pour a cast within 10 minutes of taking the impression.
317
C H A P T E R
1 0
L A B O RAT O R Y
P R O C E D U RES
FIG 10-2
FIG 10-1
C R EATI O N OF THE W O R K I N G CAST
Because plaster is compatible with all i mpression materials and can be used with the various comput
I m pression a nalysis
W O R K I N G
erized scanning systems (computer-aided design/com
C A S T
S Y S T E M S
puter assisted manufacturing ICAD/CAMD. it is the
High-quality restorations begin with correct impres
material of choice for making casts. Using plaster
sions, since errors and minor defects in the impres
guarantees predictable results from practical and
sion are inevitably transferred to the working cast
well-tested techniques.
and may compromise the final adaptation of the
Plaster also is the most economical material avail
restoration. The dental technician must not only
able for cast fabrication, and in addition to its pre
take perfect impressions in the laboratory, but also
cision, it ofers the hardness and compression resis
examine them carefully under the microscope to con
tance essential to working on a cast without risking
irm that their dimensions and detail reproduction
surface damage.J-7 Varieties of plaster are classified
are precise (Fig 10-1). Once the accuracy of the im
in terms of their degree of expansion, flexion, com
pression is confirmed, extreme care must be taken
pression resistance, and hardness. The most common
to avoid introducing mistakes during the fabrication
types are natural plasters fortified with low-expansion
of the master cast to guarantee optimal adaptation
synthetic resin6 (ResinRock, Whip Mix), which offer
and integration of the restoration i n the oral cavity.
high resistance to abrasion and scratches,6.8 good
Materials for master working casts
of the finest type IV plasters, and favorable volu
FIG 10-J
FIG 1 0-4
plasticity, dimensional stability comparable to that
311
metric expansion ranging from o.o7% to o.o8%.
The technician selects a cast material that is com
Alternatives to plaster include epoxy and poly
patible with the type of cast to be made and the
urethane resins. Unlike plasters, which expand, these
type of impression material that was used, because
materials are characterized by volumetric shrinkage
interaction between incompatible materials can give
of o.os%. but they have been shown to provide
rise to imperfections.'·' Manufacturers offer a vast
precise detail reproduction. Their two basic compo
range of construction systems (eg, Model-Tray System,
nents, resin and polyamine, begin to polymerize as
Model-Tray) and cast materials, such as plasters and
soon as they are mixed; the resin must be poured
polyurethane and epoxy resins.
immediately into the impression while it remains in ..
Fig 10-1 To create a working cast with good dimensional precision and excellent detail reproduction. the dentat technician must work with a precise impression. Note the detailed reproduction of the finish tine. Figs 10-2 and 10-3 Ouatity of the restoration atso depends on the precision of the master cast. Each stage must be performed using tho appro priate materials and systems. Fig 10-4 Plaster cast from a reversible hydrocolloid impression. Given the water absorption and secretion of hydrocolloid materials. the tech nician must pour a cast within 10 minutes of taking the impression.
317
CHA Laboratoy Procedures
I
"" the plastic phase and, because of its sensitivity to moisture, kept in a dry environment.
thus reduces the potential for material difficulties.
"" 10-6). This layer of polyurethane resin prevents
care is taken to safeguard all pertinent anatomic
expansion of the plaster cast from absorption of the
information. The dies are then repositioned in the
bonder of the Plexiglas base, which would alter the
impression, and a plaster cast of the remaining arch
I n general, polyurethane resins (PX Extrarock, PX
The Zeiser system (Zeiser Dental) is composed of
Dental) are not compatible with all impression mate
a removable cast that is easily inserted into a Plexi
rials and should not be used with either polysulfide
glas base. Unlike the Pindex system from which it
The dies must be separated by hand, preferably
seves the anatomic details of the soft tissues while
or hydrocolloid impressions. Although they are com
evolved, the Zeiser system guarantees precise adap
using the microscope, for optimal control and to
permitting the technician to work with removable
patible with polyethers, an isolating product (PX
tation of the cast material and this Plexiglas (former
prevent accidental damage to the
preparation
resin dies that precisely imitate the radicular anato
Extrarock D, PX Dental) should be used to prevent
ly plaster) base, and thus greater control of linear
edges. However, for a fixed partial denture, the tech
my of each individual tooth (Figs 10-11 and 10-12).
is poured. The result is a working cast that pre
cast's physicochemical characteristics.
bonding between the i mpression material and the
though not volumetric- movement. Brass pins in the
nician should keep the area together in a block
Such an anatomic cast is an optimum reproduction
resin.
base of each sectioned part are adapted to the
rather than separating individual dies (Fig 10·7).
of the clinical situation, and it proves very useful for
The obvious diferences between resin and plas
Plexiglas base by means of calibrated, heat-aided
Keeping the restoration section in one piece gives
subsequent restoration phases (Figs 10-13 to 10-16).
ter concern their respective expansion and contrac
drilling, providing optimal stability to each remov
the technician maximum stability and preserves the
The Model System (Tricodent) 13 for preparing a
tion properties. Nonetheless, findings of dimension
able die.10·u
distances between the dies and thus the exact
working cast is easy, practical, and economic. The
al testing9- 10 to assess differences in detail repro
During preparation of the master cast, the pre
dimensions of the clinical situation. Taking this pre
system includes a special plastic box for holding the
duction indicate that casts made from both materials
pared dies are coated with a special silicone (Pro
caution assumes even greater importance when a
plaster cast; this box is equipped with internal ver
reproduce details accurately. When compared, neither
tector, Benzer Dental) to create a protective film that
ceramic margin (36o-degree or collarless) is planned
tical grooves for repositioning the dies and two side
epoxy resin shrinkage nor plaster expansion has a
will be removed only when the cast is complete (Figs
for the entire circumference of the restoration or
clips that can open to block the plaster model: on
signiicant clinical efect. When appropriate procedures
10-2 and 10·3).
when the shoulder portion of the ceramic is layered
the back are two small rest levers that permit com
solely on the buccal surface.
plete extraction. The borders of the impression are
are followed, both materials meet the American
In pouring the cast, particular attention should be
Dental Association (ADA) guidelines for a precision
paid to the intrinsic properties of the i mpression
To facilitate subsequent procedures carried out in
crown ater cementation.
material. Hydrocolloids, for example, limit normal
making the wax pattern, such as trimming the mar
from the gingival tissues, so it is possible to mark
laboratory procedures and require modified cast prep
gins (or allowing for the possibility of ceramic mar
the midline so as to facilitate alignment of the
tant properties that distinguish the two materials.
aration. Because hydrocolloids vary dimensionally
gins), a laboratory bur should be used to remove
impression with the central axis in the Tricodent sys
Because of its hardness. an epoxy resin cast is less
through water absorption and secretion, the plaster
plaster in the areas corresponding to the mucous
tem. During this construction phase the two black
fragile and therefore maintains details and precision 10
cast must be developed in 10 minutes or less. Such
membrane in the edentulous zone (Fig 10·8).12 To
closure clips are adapted and, once the base has
better during laboratory procedures and generates
time restriction precludes the possibility of creating
record the details of the soft tissue in the edentu·
been isolated with a silicone material, the impres
less stress for the dental technician.
a Zeiser-type master cast directly from hydrocolloid
lous zone, a rigid silicone cast (Gingifast Rigid,
sion is cast by filling the tray with type IV extra-hard
Since both plaster and resin materials are subject
impressions. Therefore, if hydrocolloids are used, the
Zhermack) can be used to allow easy repositioning
plaster. Before the plaster hardens, the impression
to aging and deterioration, technicians also must be
clinician must immediately pour a cast (Fig 10-4)
on the master cast as needed (Figs 10-9 and 10-10).
tray is positioned upside-down on the system, taking
aware of expiration dates, especially once the pack
using a vacuum mixer and send it to the laboratory
Alternatively, a polyurethane resin cast (PX Extra
care to remove all excess material. Single-plaster
rock) can be made using only the individual dies
casting is one of the advantages of modern systems (Fig 10·17)- 10,1 1,14.15
Breakage and wear resistance are the most impor
age has been opened.•-6-1o
318
that greatly si mplifies the laboratory procedures and
for fabrication of the master cast. Afteward, the prepared dies are covered with iso
that are involved rather than the entire arch. The
lating silicone, and the plaster is trimmed with a dy
individual master dies of resin are roughed out, and
Systems a n d methods for cast construction
cast squaring machine (Trimex Px 1000, Micerium).
To ensure the stability of the working cast, the dental
low-contraction polyurethane resin (PX Extrarock)
technician can use a technique for cast construction
between the cast and Plexiglas base (Figs 10-5 and .
rounded of, leaving a distance of at least 6 mm
..
Following the Zeiser technique, the technician layers
319
CHA Laboratoy Procedures
I
"" the plastic phase and, because of its sensitivity to moisture, kept in a dry environment.
thus reduces the potential for material difficulties.
"" 10-6). This layer of polyurethane resin prevents
care is taken to safeguard all pertinent anatomic
expansion of the plaster cast from absorption of the
information. The dies are then repositioned in the
bonder of the Plexiglas base, which would alter the
impression, and a plaster cast of the remaining arch
I n general, polyurethane resins (PX Extrarock, PX
The Zeiser system (Zeiser Dental) is composed of
Dental) are not compatible with all impression mate
a removable cast that is easily inserted into a Plexi
rials and should not be used with either polysulfide
glas base. Unlike the Pindex system from which it
The dies must be separated by hand, preferably
seves the anatomic details of the soft tissues while
or hydrocolloid impressions. Although they are com
evolved, the Zeiser system guarantees precise adap
using the microscope, for optimal control and to
permitting the technician to work with removable
patible with polyethers, an isolating product (PX
tation of the cast material and this Plexiglas (former
prevent accidental damage to the
preparation
resin dies that precisely imitate the radicular anato
Extrarock D, PX Dental) should be used to prevent
ly plaster) base, and thus greater control of linear
edges. However, for a fixed partial denture, the tech
my of each individual tooth (Figs 10-11 and 10-12).
is poured. The result is a working cast that pre
cast's physicochemical characteristics.
bonding between the i mpression material and the
though not volumetric- movement. Brass pins in the
nician should keep the area together in a block
Such an anatomic cast is an optimum reproduction
resin.
base of each sectioned part are adapted to the
rather than separating individual dies (Fig 10·7).
of the clinical situation, and it proves very useful for
The obvious diferences between resin and plas
Plexiglas base by means of calibrated, heat-aided
Keeping the restoration section in one piece gives
subsequent restoration phases (Figs 10-13 to 10-16).
ter concern their respective expansion and contrac
drilling, providing optimal stability to each remov
the technician maximum stability and preserves the
The Model System (Tricodent) 13 for preparing a
tion properties. Nonetheless, findings of dimension
able die.10·u
distances between the dies and thus the exact
working cast is easy, practical, and economic. The
al testing9- 10 to assess differences in detail repro
During preparation of the master cast, the pre
dimensions of the clinical situation. Taking this pre
system includes a special plastic box for holding the
duction indicate that casts made from both materials
pared dies are coated with a special silicone (Pro
caution assumes even greater importance when a
plaster cast; this box is equipped with internal ver
reproduce details accurately. When compared, neither
tector, Benzer Dental) to create a protective film that
ceramic margin (36o-degree or collarless) is planned
tical grooves for repositioning the dies and two side
epoxy resin shrinkage nor plaster expansion has a
will be removed only when the cast is complete (Figs
for the entire circumference of the restoration or
clips that can open to block the plaster model: on
signiicant clinical efect. When appropriate procedures
10-2 and 10·3).
when the shoulder portion of the ceramic is layered
the back are two small rest levers that permit com
solely on the buccal surface.
plete extraction. The borders of the impression are
are followed, both materials meet the American
In pouring the cast, particular attention should be
Dental Association (ADA) guidelines for a precision
paid to the intrinsic properties of the i mpression
To facilitate subsequent procedures carried out in
crown ater cementation.
material. Hydrocolloids, for example, limit normal
making the wax pattern, such as trimming the mar
from the gingival tissues, so it is possible to mark
laboratory procedures and require modified cast prep
gins (or allowing for the possibility of ceramic mar
the midline so as to facilitate alignment of the
tant properties that distinguish the two materials.
aration. Because hydrocolloids vary dimensionally
gins), a laboratory bur should be used to remove
impression with the central axis in the Tricodent sys
Because of its hardness. an epoxy resin cast is less
through water absorption and secretion, the plaster
plaster in the areas corresponding to the mucous
tem. During this construction phase the two black
fragile and therefore maintains details and precision 10
cast must be developed in 10 minutes or less. Such
membrane in the edentulous zone (Fig 10·8).12 To
closure clips are adapted and, once the base has
better during laboratory procedures and generates
time restriction precludes the possibility of creating
record the details of the soft tissue in the edentu·
been isolated with a silicone material, the impres
less stress for the dental technician.
a Zeiser-type master cast directly from hydrocolloid
lous zone, a rigid silicone cast (Gingifast Rigid,
sion is cast by filling the tray with type IV extra-hard
Since both plaster and resin materials are subject
impressions. Therefore, if hydrocolloids are used, the
Zhermack) can be used to allow easy repositioning
plaster. Before the plaster hardens, the impression
to aging and deterioration, technicians also must be
clinician must immediately pour a cast (Fig 10-4)
on the master cast as needed (Figs 10-9 and 10-10).
tray is positioned upside-down on the system, taking
aware of expiration dates, especially once the pack
using a vacuum mixer and send it to the laboratory
Alternatively, a polyurethane resin cast (PX Extra
care to remove all excess material. Single-plaster
rock) can be made using only the individual dies
casting is one of the advantages of modern systems (Fig 10·17)- 10,1 1,14.15
Breakage and wear resistance are the most impor
age has been opened.•-6-1o
318
that greatly si mplifies the laboratory procedures and
for fabrication of the master cast. Afteward, the prepared dies are covered with iso
that are involved rather than the entire arch. The
lating silicone, and the plaster is trimmed with a dy
individual master dies of resin are roughed out, and
Systems a n d methods for cast construction
cast squaring machine (Trimex Px 1000, Micerium).
To ensure the stability of the working cast, the dental
low-contraction polyurethane resin (PX Extrarock)
technician can use a technique for cast construction
between the cast and Plexiglas base (Figs 10-5 and .
rounded of, leaving a distance of at least 6 mm
..
Following the Zeiser technique, the technician layers
319
CHAPTER 1 0 Laboratoy Procedures
I
Fig 10-5 Creating a Zeiser-type master cast from a hydrocolloid impression requires a different procedure than that used lor a polyether impression. It is necessary to modify the development of the impression on the basis of the material itself. Fig 10-6 Layering polyurethane resin between the cast and the Plexiglas base guarantees better dimensional stability lor the whole system. Fig 10-7 In the case of a fixed partial denture. the cast should be sectioned into blocks to improve stability between dies and reduce movement between the elements of the connected structure. Fig 10-8 Block-cut cast used to create a cermet fixed partial denture with a ceramic micromargin. Fig 10-9 Gingival reproduction in rigid silicone is necessary to prevent loss of soft tissue detail in the edentulous zone and monitor the progress of the gingiva. Fig 10-1D Definitive restoration in situ. Note the integration with the soft tissue as well as the stability and precision of the fixed partial den ture. Fig 1D-11 Construction of a master cast with removable dies in polyurethane resin. This type of cast accurately records soft tissue detail in the plaster. Fig 1D-12 Definitive cermet crown with a ceramic micromargin on the removable die. This type of cast makes it possible to remove an individual die from the cast. which facilitates work. Figs 10-13 to 10-16 Perfect correspondence between the master cast and the postcementation clinical situation for both the right and left lateral sectors. respectively. The construction of this type of cast can effective ly reproduce the oral cavity. Fig 1D-17 Tricodent-type master cast. equipped with a plastic base. The correct position of the removable dies is guaranteed by the grooves inside the box and the lateral blockage system. which uses special sell-blocking clips. o
321
CHAPTER 1 0 Laboratoy Procedures
I
Fig 10-5 Creating a Zeiser-type master cast from a hydrocolloid impression requires a different procedure than that used lor a polyether impression. It is necessary to modify the development of the impression on the basis of the material itself. Fig 10-6 Layering polyurethane resin between the cast and the Plexiglas base guarantees better dimensional stability lor the whole system. Fig 10-7 In the case of a fixed partial denture. the cast should be sectioned into blocks to improve stability between dies and reduce movement between the elements of the connected structure. Fig 10-8 Block-cut cast used to create a cermet fixed partial denture with a ceramic micromargin. Fig 10-9 Gingival reproduction in rigid silicone is necessary to prevent loss of soft tissue detail in the edentulous zone and monitor the progress of the gingiva. Fig 10-1D Definitive restoration in situ. Note the integration with the soft tissue as well as the stability and precision of the fixed partial den ture. Fig 1D-11 Construction of a master cast with removable dies in polyurethane resin. This type of cast accurately records soft tissue detail in the plaster. Fig 1D-12 Definitive cermet crown with a ceramic micromargin on the removable die. This type of cast makes it possible to remove an individual die from the cast. which facilitates work. Figs 10-13 to 10-16 Perfect correspondence between the master cast and the postcementation clinical situation for both the right and left lateral sectors. respectively. The construction of this type of cast can effective ly reproduce the oral cavity. Fig 1D-17 Tricodent-type master cast. equipped with a plastic base. The correct position of the removable dies is guaranteed by the grooves inside the box and the lateral blockage system. which uses special sell-blocking clips. o
321
I hi· fltll',lt IH,i· llllh •I 11•·11 ·.il.rrpt·flt·d Hl',lttJrt••·ul ·.lfll
11.11 Ill
t)uf
lf·i llfiS I H''(MtHt I •I
(ifi'P·H•·
IHW. h II lito oil f t••,•, IJ·,u·� ·.p�·t "' ' di.JirttHJtl
iHW� jMh•tllt'fi b t tllii •HJIIIIJI'II ��� 1 '11J t}/tJ .uuj (tJifjt•tJ
lt,l '•IJH•tl, I ll••
111
W,0·>•·>3
the restoration. In general, the procedure involves
used extensively.23·43 Compared with more recent
with the exception that the former cements exhibit a
isolation of the surface oxygen with a glycerine gel
cementation materials, this cement has a number of
deterioration of mechanical stresses in some perfor·
to ensure final polymerization of the thin cement
disadvantages. such as solubility in a moist environ· ..
of patients. Following are three case presentations that demonstrate these ideals (Figs 13-60 to 13·91). •
31
.-
Cement at ion -: = . .J
--� � -
--
TAB L E 1 3 - 1 Clinical i n dications for various cements and prosthetic restorations
Zinc Type of restoration Metal-ceramic crowns with weak margins
Zinc
polycar-
phosphates
boxylates
/-
++
+
+
+
/-
+
+
with ceramic micromargins
ZOE -
I-
-
/-
-
Feldspathic ceramic crowns or veneers
-
-
-
Cast ceramic or leucite crowns or veneers
-
-
-
Ceramic crowns with alumina/zirconia core
-
-
-
Non-noble alloy and ceramic resin-bonded adhesive prosthesis
-
-
-
Acrylic resin provisional crowns
-
+
/
-
+
/-
-
++
Metal-ceramic crowns with AGC (Wieland)
-
++
(-) Strongly discouraged;
-
2
() *
Used by the authors.
(GI) glass-ionomer cement.
(/) + -
not recommended;
(+)
possible;
( ) ++
recommended;
(
)
+++
+++
+++
*
*
*
(without eugenol) -
strongly recommended.
L
resins
-
-
++
-
-
-
+++
-
II-
-
+++
/-
+
-
-
-
-
*
I-
+
+++
+
+++
-
+
/*
/-
+++ *
+++
-
DualPhotopolymerizing polymerizing adhesive resins adhesive resins
-
+
+++
Auto· polymerizing adhesive resins
/-
+++
+
-
++
GIC
/
+++
*
Nonadhesive
+ -
+
or Captek (Precious Chemicals) systems (ZOE) Zinc oxid�ugenol;
*
+
-
+
permanent cementation without adhesive resin
+++
-
+
with dentinal sensitivity
GIC
Resinmodified
-
-
/-
+++
I
+++
+
+ -
I-
++
-
+++
*
*
*
++
+
-
+
-
+ -
/
++
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
++
+++
+++
*
*
Cementation
1 3-67
Fig 1 3-60 Clinical case of a 40-year-old patient with macrodontia of the maxillary right central incisor and a direct composite restoration of congruent shape and color on the maxillary lefl central incisor following a previous trauma. The obvious esthetic compromise depended on the anomalous width-height ratio of the teeth. The diagnostic waxup and periodontal crown lengthening treatment were designed to improve the width-length ratio.
Fig 13-61 Surgical lengthening of the clinical crown and changes via a delicate stripping procedure using diamond-studded inserts on an EVA type handpiece (61 LR head fitted on a 20 LH low-speed or on a 2 g LH reducer handpiece. Oentatus) and medium-grit metal strips. Fig 13-62 Clinical results 6 months after periodontal crown lengthening.
figs 13-63 and 13-64 Analysis with a periodontal explorer that demonstrates the 1 3-mm length o f the clinical crown o n the right central incisor following surgery. The new emergence profile enables a redistribution of space. Preparation of the lefl central incisor involves changing the shape of the tooth to achieve improved proportion among the teeth. Fig 13-65 Cementation of the provisional resin restoration following preparation of the four teeth for ceramic veneers. Figs 1 3-66 o 13-6g Views of the original restoration and the four new feldspathic ceramic veneers after cementation. figs 1 3-70 and 13-71 Patient's smile before and after treatment. The porcelain laminate veneers show significant esthetic improvement in shape. color. and size ratio.
Cementation
1 3-67
Fig 1 3-60 Clinical case of a 40-year-old patient with macrodontia of the maxillary right central incisor and a direct composite restoration of congruent shape and color on the maxillary lefl central incisor following a previous trauma. The obvious esthetic compromise depended on the anomalous width-height ratio of the teeth. The diagnostic waxup and periodontal crown lengthening treatment were designed to improve the width-length ratio.
Fig 13-61 Surgical lengthening of the clinical crown and changes via a delicate stripping procedure using diamond-studded inserts on an EVA type handpiece (61 LR head fitted on a 20 LH low-speed or on a 2 g LH reducer handpiece. Oentatus) and medium-grit metal strips. Fig 13-62 Clinical results 6 months after periodontal crown lengthening.
figs 13-63 and 13-64 Analysis with a periodontal explorer that demonstrates the 1 3-mm length o f the clinical crown o n the right central incisor following surgery. The new emergence profile enables a redistribution of space. Preparation of the lefl central incisor involves changing the shape of the tooth to achieve improved proportion among the teeth. Fig 13-65 Cementation of the provisional resin restoration following preparation of the four teeth for ceramic veneers. Figs 1 3-66 o 13-6g Views of the original restoration and the four new feldspathic ceramic veneers after cementation. figs 1 3-70 and 13-71 Patient's smile before and after treatment. The porcelain laminate veneers show significant esthetic improvement in shape. color. and size ratio.
CHAPTE' Cementation
Fig 13-72 Clinical case in which the maxillary left anterior dentition requires restoration, the central incisor with a veneer and the lateral in cisor. canine. and both premolars with all-ceramic crowns. Fig 1 3-73 Definitive restoration immediately following cementation. Fig 13-74 Postoperative view. 3 years later. The stability of the tissues and the periodontal health confirm the validity of the operating technique.
Figs 13-75 and 13-77 Clinical case of a 32-year-old patient who wanted to replace the maxillary right lateral in cisor crown because of its poor esthetics. Removal of the crown revealed inadequate tooth preparation. in terms of health and shape. In addition to replacing the old restora tion after endodontic and restoration therapy. the clinician proposed restoring the two central incisors with porcelain laminate veneers. The left central incisor had a large restoration as a result of trauma. and the right central incisor had two Class 3 com posite restorations. The required restoration of the central incisors would give more personality to the overall smite.
Figs 13-78 to 13-79 fetdspathic ceramic restorations were cemented after tooth whitening and restorative treatment with a fiberglass pin. Figs 13-80 and 13-81 Magnification of the central incisors before and after adhesive cementation. Figs 13-82 and 13-83 Excellent integration of the fetdspathic ceramic restorations.
1
CHAPTE' Cementation
Fig 13-72 Clinical case in which the maxillary left anterior dentition requires restoration, the central incisor with a veneer and the lateral in cisor. canine. and both premolars with all-ceramic crowns. Fig 1 3-73 Definitive restoration immediately following cementation. Fig 13-74 Postoperative view. 3 years later. The stability of the tissues and the periodontal health confirm the validity of the operating technique.
Figs 13-75 and 13-77 Clinical case of a 32-year-old patient who wanted to replace the maxillary right lateral in cisor crown because of its poor esthetics. Removal of the crown revealed inadequate tooth preparation. in terms of health and shape. In addition to replacing the old restora tion after endodontic and restoration therapy. the clinician proposed restoring the two central incisors with porcelain laminate veneers. The left central incisor had a large restoration as a result of trauma. and the right central incisor had two Class 3 com posite restorations. The required restoration of the central incisors would give more personality to the overall smite.
Figs 13-78 to 13-79 fetdspathic ceramic restorations were cemented after tooth whitening and restorative treatment with a fiberglass pin. Figs 13-80 and 13-81 Magnification of the central incisors before and after adhesive cementation. Figs 13-82 and 13-83 Excellent integration of the fetdspathic ceramic restorations.
1
CHAPT:R 1 .
Cementation
1 3·86
Fig 13-4 Frontal view in relation to the mandibular dentition: esthetic a n d anatomic integration is apparent.
Fig 13-85 Occlusal view. The only tooth not incorporated in the restoration is the left lateral incisor.
Fig 13-86 Esthetic integration is evident through the stereomicroscope. The gingiva reflects periodontal health and good adaptation of the restorations. ig 13-87 Lateral view of the veneers under the stereomicroscope in relation to the mandibular teeth.
8
Figs 13-88 and 13-89 Stereomicroscopic views highlighting the health and esthetic achievement of the restorations. Figs 13-90 and 13-g 1 Frontal and occlusal views of the natural teeth highlight the transparent in cisal effects and the natural anatomy created for function.
CHAPT:R 1 .
Cementation
1 3·86
Fig 13-4 Frontal view in relation to the mandibular dentition: esthetic a n d anatomic integration is apparent.
Fig 13-85 Occlusal view. The only tooth not incorporated in the restoration is the left lateral incisor.
Fig 13-86 Esthetic integration is evident through the stereomicroscope. The gingiva reflects periodontal health and good adaptation of the restorations. ig 13-87 Lateral view of the veneers under the stereomicroscope in relation to the mandibular teeth.
8
Figs 13-88 and 13-89 Stereomicroscopic views highlighting the health and esthetic achievement of the restorations. Figs 13-90 and 13-g 1 Frontal and occlusal views of the natural teeth highlight the transparent in cisal effects and the natural anatomy created for function.
REFERE
CES
t6
""0- �..· -c a"d
o of 1 sl .., .a 1920473-47S
2.
.. S ��� u o' �a
a·a
.3 . 1.. a...'
3
. o ' E .t a a a· C J ! P•r ,•, ..
d�ra
:7
of a :E"""
E
-� l :e -· 1975:33.29 -29.
- (O�e •G. A �1. K1 of r C
".d of If.."g 'E ade-
us. ! en
Ps 19SS:L,B4lls 3
ar�o P. &a1s r m .